Prospectus for the public offering in Germany and Luxembourg of
Transcription
Prospectus for the public offering in Germany and Luxembourg of
Prospectus for the public offering in Germany and Luxembourg of 6,000,000 ordinary no-par value bearer shares (the “Delivery Shares”) and of up to 900,000 ordinary no-par value bearer shares (subject to an over-allotment option) and for admission to the regulated market (regulierter Markt) with simultaneous admission to the regulated market sub-segment with additional post-admission obligations (Prime Standard) of the Frankfurt Stock Exchange of 15,050,000 existing ordinary no-par value bearer shares (existing share capital) and up to 6,000,000 newly issued ordinary no-par value bearer shares deriving from a capital increase from authorised capital for a contribution in cash - each such share carrying full dividend rights from and including the financial year 2011 — of China Specialty Glass AG Gruenwald/Munich, Germany International Securities Identification Number (ISIN): DE000A1EL8Y8 German Securities Identification Number (WKN): A1EL8Y Sole Global Coordinator Joint Bookrunner and Joint Lead Manager VISCARDI AG, Munich, Germany Joint Bookrunner and Joint Lead Manager biw Bank für Investments und Wertpapiere AG, Willich, Germany Selling Agents comdirect bank AG Quickborn, Germany DAB bank AG Munich, Germany Cortal Consors S.A. Zweigniederlassung Deutschland Nuremberg, Germany S Broker AG & Co. KG Wiesbaden, Germany Asiasons WFG Securities Pte Ltd Singapore 17 June 2011 ING-DiBa AG Frankfurt/Main, Germany This document constitutes a prospectus for the purposes of sec. 5 German Securities Prospectus Act (Wertpapierprospektgesetz) (“WpPG”) and art. 3 of the prospectus directive 2003/71/EC (the “Prospectus Directive”), and has been filed with and approved by the German Federal Financial Supervisory Authority (Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht) (the “BaFin”) after a review for completeness of the prospectus, including a review for coherence and comprehensibility of the presented information, according to sec. 13 para. 1 WpPG. The approved prospectus will be notified by the BaFin to the competent authorities in the Luxembourg in accordance with sec. 18 WpPG and art. 18 of the Prospectus Directive to allow a public offering in Luxembourg. TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 2. 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 3. 3.1 3.2 3.3 4. 5. 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 6. 7. 7.1 7.2 7.3 8. 8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 8.5 8.6 8.7 8.8 8.9 8.10 8.11 9. 9.1 9.2 9.3 9.4 10. 10.1 10.2 11. SUMMARY OF THE PROSPECTUS ........................................................ 5 General information on China Specialty Glass-Group and its business ..........5 Summary of the Offering...................................................................... 13 Summary of Key Financial Information................................................... 21 Selected Financial Information .............................................................. 22 Summary of the Risk Factors ................................................................ 26 GERMAN TRANSLATION OF THE SUMMARY — ZUSAMMENFASSUNG DES PROSPEKTS .............................................................................. 32 Allgemeine Informationen zur China Specialty Glass-Group und ihrer Geschäftstatigkeit ............................................................................... 32 Zusammenfassung des Angebots .......................................................... 40 Zusammenfassung ausgewählter Finanzangaben..................................... 50 Ausgewählte Finanzangaben ................................................................. 52 Zusammenfassung der Risikofaktoren.................................................... 55 RISK FACTORS ................................................................................ 62 Risks Related to China Specialty Glass-Group’s Business .......................... 62 Risks Related to the Political, Social and Legal Environment of the People’s Republic of China ................................................................................ 94 Risk Related to the Offering................................................................ 105 RESPONSIBILTY STATEMENT ........................................................ 108 GENERAL INFORMATION ............................................................... 109 Documents on Display ....................................................................... 109 Statutory Auditors ............................................................................. 109 Forward-Looking Statements .............................................................. 110 Third Party Information...................................................................... 111 Notes Regarding Currency and Financial Information ............................. 114 SUBJECT-MATTER OF THE PROSPECTUS ........................................ 116 SELLING RESTRICTIONS ............................................................... 117 Notice to U.S. Residents..................................................................... 118 Notice Regarding the European Economic Area ..................................... 118 Notice Regarding Japan...................................................................... 119 THE OFFERING .............................................................................. 120 Subject-Matter of the Offering ............................................................ 120 Price Range, Offering Period, Subscription, Offer Price and Number of Allotted Shares ............................................................................................. 122 Rights Attached to the Offered Shares ................................................. 123 Projected Timetable for the Offering .................................................... 124 Information Concerning the Shares in the Company .............................. 124 Allotment Criteria .............................................................................. 126 Stabilisation Measures, Over-Allotment and Greenshoe Option................ 127 Stock Exchange Admission and Commencement of Trading .................... 128 Delivery and Settlement..................................................................... 129 Designated Sponsor........................................................................... 129 Market Protection Agreements (Lock up) .............................................. 129 REASONS FOR THE OFFERING, USE OF ISSUE PROCEEDS, ISSUE COSTS AND INTERESTED THIRD PARTIES ..................................... 131 Issue Proceeds and Costs ................................................................... 131 Reasons for the Offering .................................................................... 131 Use of the Issue Proceeds .................................................................. 132 Interested Parties involved in the Offering............................................ 133 DIVIDEND POLICY; EARNINGS AND DIVIDENDS PER SHARE ........ 135 Dividend Rights and Dividend Policy .................................................... 135 Earnings and dividend per share ......................................................... 136 DILUTION...................................................................................... 137 2 12. 12.1 12.2 12.3 13. 14. 14.1 14.2 14.3 14.4 14.5 14.6 15. 15.1 15.2 15.3 15.4 15.5 15.6 16. 16.1 16.2 16.3 16.4 16.5 16.6 16.7 16.8 16.9 16.10 16.11 16.12 16.13 16.14 16.15 16.16 16.17 17. 17.1 17.2 17.3 17.4 17.5 17.6 17.7 17.8 17.9 17.10 17.11 17.12 17.13 17.14 17.15 17.16 17.17 CAPITALISATION, INDEBTEDNESS AND BORROWING REQUIREMENTS ...................................................................................................... 139 Capitalisation and Indebtedness .......................................................... 139 Borrowing Requirements .................................................................... 140 Working Capital Statement ................................................................. 141 SELECTED FINANCIAL INFORMATION ........................................... 142 OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW ........................................... 147 Overview.......................................................................................... 149 Key Factors Affecting Results of Operations .......................................... 151 Results of Operations......................................................................... 154 Statement of financial position data..................................................... 161 Cash flow statement .......................................................................... 168 Critical Accounting Policies ................................................................. 170 MARKET AND INDUSTRY OVERVIEW ............................................. 175 Introduction ..................................................................................... 175 Chinese economy .............................................................................. 176 Security glass market ........................................................................ 179 Construction glass market .................................................................. 183 Sales and distribution ........................................................................ 184 Competition...................................................................................... 185 REGULATORY FRAMEWORK ........................................................... 188 PRC Legal System ............................................................................. 188 The General Principles of the Civil Law ................................................. 192 The Opinions of the Supreme People’s Court on Several Issues concerning the Implementation of the General Principles of the Civil Law (for Trial Implementation) ............................................................................... 192 Laws Regarding Social Standards ........................................................ 192 Laws and Regulations concerning Use of Bulletproof Glass by Financial Institutions....................................................................................... 195 Governmental Regulations in Product Sales and Distribution ................... 196 Company Law ................................................................................... 197 Investment Regulations, Distribution and Transfer Restrictions ............... 197 Regulations on Overseas Listing .......................................................... 202 PRC Tort Liability Law ........................................................................ 202 PRC Product Liability Law ................................................................... 203 Protection of Consumer Rights and Interests ........................................ 205 PRC Competition and Antitrust Laws .................................................... 206 PRC Environmental Law ..................................................................... 207 PRC Tax Laws ................................................................................... 210 Patent and Trademark Protection ........................................................ 213 Legislation on Land in the PRC ............................................................ 217 BUSINESS...................................................................................... 221 Overview.......................................................................................... 221 History............................................................................................. 223 Strengths ......................................................................................... 223 Strategy........................................................................................... 227 Products........................................................................................... 231 Customers........................................................................................ 240 Sales and Distribution ........................................................................ 243 Marketing......................................................................................... 245 Production........................................................................................ 246 Procurement and Supply .................................................................... 249 Research and Development ................................................................ 252 Employees........................................................................................ 254 Insurance......................................................................................... 256 Material Contracts ............................................................................. 256 Property, Plant and Equipment............................................................ 259 Intellectual Properties ........................................................................ 263 Investments ..................................................................................... 266 3 17.18 17.19 18. 18.1 Environment ..................................................................................... 268 Legal Proceedings.............................................................................. 269 GENERAL INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY.................................. 270 Formation, Entry in the Commercial Register, Company Name and Registered Office............................................................................................... 270 18.2 Company Object ............................................................................... 271 18.3 Financial Year and Term of the Company.............................................. 271 18.4 Group Structure and Recent Corporate Developments of the Group ......... 272 18.5 Development of the Group’s Business .................................................. 278 18.6 Announcements; Paying and Depositary Agent...................................... 279 19. INFORMATION ON THE CAPITAL OF THE COMPANY AND APPLICABLE PROVISIONS ................................................................................. 281 19.1 Registered Share Capital; Authorised Capital ........................................ 281 19.2 General Form, general Representation and general Transferability of Shares ....................................................................................................... 282 19.3 General Provisions relating to Profit Allocation and Dividend Payments, to a Liquidation of the Company and to Subscription Rights as well as General Provisions governing Changes in the Share Capital ................................ 283 19.4 Takeover Offers, Exclusion of Minority Shareholders (Squeeze-Out) and Shareholding Notification Requirements ............................................... 286 20. INFORMATION ON THE GOVERNING BODIES OF THE COMPANY.... 292 20.1 Overview.......................................................................................... 292 20.2 Management Board ........................................................................... 294 20.3 Supervisory Board............................................................................. 301 20.4 Certain Information on the Members of the Supervisory Board and the Management Board ........................................................................... 307 20.5 General Shareholders’ Meeting............................................................ 308 20.6 Corporate Governance ....................................................................... 311 21. SHAREHOLDER STRUCTURE (BEFORE AND AFTER THE OFFERING) 313 22. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS................................................... 315 22.1 Lease Agreements ............................................................................. 316 22.2 Credit Guarantees ............................................................................. 317 22.3 Undertakings .................................................................................... 318 22.4 Licence Agreements........................................................................... 318 22.5 Trademark Transfer Agreement........................................................... 319 22.6 Other Transactions ............................................................................ 319 23. TAXATION IN GERMANY ................................................................ 322 23.1 Taxation of Corporations .................................................................... 322 23.2 Taxation of Shareholders.................................................................... 324 23.3 Other Taxes...................................................................................... 331 24. TAXATION IN LUXEMBOURG.......................................................... 332 24.1 Taxation of Income Derived from and Capital Gains Realized on the Shares held by Luxembourg Residents............................................................ 333 24.2 Taxation of Income Derived from and Capital Gains Realized on the Shares by Luxembourg Non-residents ............................................................ 335 24.3 Other Taxes...................................................................................... 336 25. UNDERWRITING............................................................................ 338 25.1 Underwriting Agreement .................................................................... 338 25.2 Commissions .................................................................................... 338 25.3 Securities Loans and Greenshoe Option................................................ 339 25.4 Termination ...................................................................................... 340 25.5 Indemnification ................................................................................. 341 25.6 Other Relationships ........................................................................... 342 26. RECENT DEVELOPMENTS AND OUTLOOK ....................................... 343 GLOSSARY................................................................................................. 345 FINANCIAL SECTION……………………………………………………………………….…F-1 SIGNATURE PAGE………………………………………………………………………………S-1 4 1. SUMMARY OF THE PROSPECTUS The following summary is intended as an introduction to this Prospectus and should be read in conjunction with the more detailed information contained in the rest of this Prospectus. Investors should base their decision on whether to invest in the shares described in this Prospectus on the examination of the entire Prospectus. China Specialty Glass AG, Gruenwald, Germany (the “Company” or “CSG-AG” and together with its direct and indirect subsidiaries “China Specialty Glass-Group” or the “Group”), VISCARDI AG, Munich, Germany (“VISCARDI” or “Sole Global Coordinator”), and biw Bank für Investments und Wertpapiere AG, Hausbroicher Str. 222, 47877 Willich, Germany (“biw AG”) (VISCARDI and biw AG together the “Joint Lead Managers” or “Underwriters”) assume responsibility for the content of the summary of the Prospectus, including a translation thereof, in accordance with sec. 5 para. 2 sent. 3 no. 4 of the German Securities Prospectus Act (Wertpapierprospektgesetz — WpPG). They may be held liable for the content of the summary, but only in the event that the summary is misleading, incorrect or contradictory when read in conjunction with other parts of the Prospectus. In the event that claims are asserted before a court of law based on information contained in this Prospectus, the investor appearing as plaintiff may be required to bear the costs of translating the Prospectus prior to the commencement of legal proceedings in compliance with the national laws of the individual Member States of the European Economic Area. 1.1 General information on China Specialty Glass-Group and its business 1.1.1 Introduction and Overview The Company is a stock corporation under German law headquartered in Gruenwald near Munich, Germany, and is registered with the commercial register of the local Court of Munich under HRB 185783 and under the name of China Specialty Glass AG. The Company is the holding company of Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited (“HWG HK-Holding”) which was incorporated under the laws of Hong Kong. HWG HK-Holding holds all shares of Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd. (“HWG-Ltd.”), incorporated in Guangzhou, Guangdong Province, China, which is currently the only operating company of the Group. HWG-Ltd. has a subsidiary, Sichuan Hing 5 Wah Glass Co., Ltd. (“HWG-SC”) which was incorporated in Chengdu City, Sichuan Province, China, and has not been operationally trading at the date of this Prospectus, although it has invested in property, plant and equipment, land use rights and design rights and has assumed liabilities in respect of these investments and commitments in respect of its planned investments. HWG HK-Holding, HWG-Ltd. and HWG-SC are collectively referred to as “HWG HK-Group”; the Company and HWG HK-Group are collectively referred to as “China Specialty Glass-Group” or the “Group” (see graphic illustration below for clarification of the Group structure as of the date of this Prospectus). China Specialty Glass AG Ultimate holding 1) "CSG-AG" or "Company" Listing entity "China Specialty Glass-Group" or "Group" 100% 2) Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Ltd Intermediate holding "HWG HK-Holding" "HWG HK-Group" 100% Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co. Ltd Operational entity 3) "HWG-Ltd" 100% Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Industry Co. Ltd3) Subsidiary "HWG-SC" Incorporated in 1) Germany, 2) Hong Kong and 3) China (PRC) China Specialty Glass-Group Group plans an initial public offering (“IPO”) of CSG-AG at the Frankfurt Stock Exchange in June 2011 after a planned IPO in December 2010 was postponed due to an unfavourable market and IPO environment at that time. China Specialty Glass-Group develops, produces and sells specialty glass under its “Hing Wah” brand. The Group distributes its products to customers in the domestic market in China directly through its own sales network. China Specialty Glass-Group considers itself to be one of the leading security glass manufacturers in China producing security glass, a class of specialty glass used primarily for personal protection against physical violence and forced intrusion, for the Chinese banking security and automotive security industry. It also provides various specialty glass products for the construction glass market. For security glass products which are demanded by the Chinese 6 banking security and automotive security industry, the Group is a significant player both in terms of production output and market share (source: p. 104, “Research Report on China Bulletproof Glass Industry” from Respect Market Research Inc., in the following “RMR Report”, 2010). The Group provides technical consultation and installation guidance to its customers in connection with sales. China Specialty Glass-Group’s current production facility is located in Guangzhou, Guangdong Province, in southern China, and operated by the Group’s wholly-owned operative subsidiary HWG-Ltd. The Group’s new production facility in Sichuan Province, which is to be operated by HWG-SC, is currently under construction. China Specialty Glass-Group’s major products sold under its “Hing Wah” brand can be categorized into two groups: security glass which includes bulletproof glass and intruder-resistant glass; and construction glass which includes architecture laminated glass, architecture tempered glass, fire-resistant glass, hollow glass and electrically-controlled colour-changing glass. The Group’s security glass is used in places where cash or valuable goods are traded such as banks, jewellery stores, securities brokerage houses, postal service and insurance companies (“Bank Security Glass Market”). The Group’s security glass is also used for armoured vehicles which offer security and safety to their passengers such as cash-in-transit vehicles for banks, police vehicles, military personnel carriers and armoured limousines (“Automotive Security Glass Market”). In addition, the Group provides its construction glass products to the construction industry where they are used as windows, doors, curtain walls (outer covering of buildings of which the outer walls are non-structural and merely protect the building from the weather) or internal decorations in commercial buildings and private houses (“Construction Glass Market”). The Group began selling its products in 1994. Its end customers are exclusively commercial enterprises: banks in the Bank Security Glass Market, refitting automobile manufacturers in the Automotive Security Glass Market, and construction service providers in the Construction Glass Market. The sales of HWG-Ltd., which is currently the Group’s only wholly-owned operative subsidiary, increased from EUR 40.2 million in 2008 to EUR 50.9 million in 2009 and to EUR 69.6 million in 2010 corresponding to an average annual growth rate of 31.7% during this period. The net profits increased from EUR 10.6 million in 2008 to EUR 14.1 million in 2009 and to EUR 22.3 7 million in 2010 corresponding to an average annual growth rate of 45.6%. The majority of the sales was generated by the Group’s security glass which is sold on the Bank Security Glass Market with sales of EUR 17.5 million, EUR 23.0 million and EUR 32.1 million for 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively; and on the Automotive Security Glass Market with sales of EUR 15.4 million, EUR 22.4 million and EUR 30.0 million for the years 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively. These sales correspond to 43.5%, 45.2% and 46.1% and 38.3%, 44.0% and 43.1% of total revenue for these years, respectively. The Company believes that the Chinese security glass market (Bank Security Glass Market and Automotive Security Glass Market) and Construction Glass Market will continue to develop in a positive way in the future. In particular, with the expected increase in consumer wealth and commercial activities, the commercial entities which demand bank security glass are also expected to expand both in number (e.g., increase of bank branches in rural areas and smaller cities) and in individual size (e.g., increase of operating surface area of post offices). In these commercial entities, security measures are closely monitored and regulated by the Chinese government. Demand for the Group’s products, which are certified by the regulatory authorities, is expected to increase accordingly. Similarly, an increase in the number of wealthy Chinese citizens and their concern for and awareness of safety and security for themselves and their families bodes well for the increase in demand for the Group’s automotive security glass and construction glass products. The Company intends to increase production and sales of the Group’s glass products to meet this demand. 1.1.2 The Strategy Company believes the following strategic objectives and their implementation will drive the Group’s future growth: · Profit from the growth of the Chinese security glass market by expanding the domestic sales network and strengthening the Hing Wah brand and in mid-range scope from market diversification through international expansion: As a significant player in the Chinese security glass market, the Company intends to further expand the Group’s sales network domestically in order to benefit from the further growth of the Chinese security glass market. The Company intends to expand the presence of the Group’s sales teams in China by covering the provinces or regions that are currently not actively served by the Group and by covering the regions that are 8 already served by the Company more densely in order to put the Group closer to its existing and future customers, thus better serving their needs and increasing the attractiveness of the Group’s product offers. The Company believes this expansion will significantly increase the awareness of the Hing Wah brand and the Group’s product sales. The Company also intends to expand the sales of the Group’s products internationally in order to reduce the Group’s dependency on the Chinese domestic market. · Expand production capacity and participate in consolidation of Chinese security glass industry and growth in western and central regions in China: As transportation costs for security and construction glass are significant, especially with regard to long distance delivery, the Group has so far focused on more developed provinces and regions close to the Group’s current production site in Guangzhou, Guangdong Province. The Company believes the market for the Group’s products in these regions and provinces is far from saturated and intends to continue to participate in its future growth. To this end, the Company intends to increase the Group’s production capacity and efficiency in its current production site in Guangzhou by adding new production facilities, upgrading the production equipment and increasing the automation of its production process. The Company also intends to use the Group’s Guangzhou facility to expand its market presence in selected Asian countries. The Company also believes that the future sales growth will increasingly come from regions and provinces in China where the Group currently has a competitive disadvantage due to the long distance to the Group’s present production site. Therefore, the Company plans to establish a new production site closer to the potential end customers in the city of Chengdu, Sichuan Province, in order to benefit not only from the growth in the security glass, but also in the construction glass market in these regions and provinces. It is planned that the new facility will commence operation in the second half of 2011 and reach maximum production capacities in about two years’ time. Additionally, the Company intends to expand the Group’s production capacities and access to experienced personnel and local markets in other parts of China through acquisitions of smaller competitors. 9 · Focus on higher-margin products and product innovation in the security glass market as well as on the lower-margin Construction Glass Market: The Company intends to expand the business of the Group in the security glass market which is a niche market characterized by the absence of a large number of competitors and a high unit selling price for products. The Company intends to continue the Group’s tradition of innovation and bring new and competitive products to the market in the years to come, while improving its products already on the market by adding new features or improving product performance. The Company believes that both are essential to customers’ product loyalty and to the Group’s market position. In contrast, the Construction Glass Market demands a high product volume and variety at a lower profit margin. To optimize the utilization rate, which refers to the ratio between actual production output and the available production capacity in the same year, of its production facilities and gain benefit in large-scale raw material purchase, the Company intends to continue serving this product segment without losing its main focus on the security glass market. · Strengthen Research and Development (“R&D”) capacity and capability: The Company considers the Group’s R&D capability and capacity to innovate to be essential for its future growth and its ability to continue to dominate in the high-margin security glass market. Therefore, it intends to expand the Group’s R&D activities by increasing its annual expenditures, establishing a separate research and development centre at the Guangzhou headquarters of HWG-Ltd., increasing the number of its R&D staff and continuing its co-operation with established universities and professional colleges in China. The Group’s research and development activities are expected to focus on introducing new products such as multi-resistant security windows and interlocking secure doors (a specially designed door system that offers additional security features over normal doors) to the market. The R&D team also intends to bring forth innovations that improve production efficiency and cut production costs as well. 10 1.1.3 Competitive Strengths The Group considers the following competitive strengths as essential for its future growth: · Industry pioneer, strong market presence and well-recognized brand in China · Largest security glass manufacturer in China (source: p. 103 – 105, RMR Report, 2010) benefitting from economies of scale, extensive distribution channel and strong customer loyalty · Cost-efficient production, effective cost control and profitable operation · Focus on regulated product segment benefitting from government policy and restrictive regulations · Strong product innovation capability · Experienced management team with industrial expertise and extensive business network in China 1.1.4 Further Information on the Company and China Specialty Glass-Group Management Board Mr. Nang Heung Sze, Mr. Chun Li Shi and Mr. Chi-Hsiang Michael Lee Supervisory Board Mr. Helmut Meyer, Mr. Xin Yong Shi and Mr. Volker Schlegel Share capital shares and (before implementation EUR 15,050,000.00 divided into 15,050,000 non par-value ordinary bearer shares of the Offering) Auditor The Company’s auditor is Grant Thornton GmbH Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft (“Grant Thornton”), 11 Domstrasse 15, 20095 Hamburg, a member of the German Chamber of Public Accountants (Wirtschaftsprüferkammer). Shareholders Before implementation of the Offering 11,194,957 (before shares (74.39%) are held indirectly by Mr. Nang implementation of the Offering) Heung Sze through Luckyway Global Group Limited, 735,568 shares (4.89%) are held indirectly by Mr. Ching Hoi Sze through Quick Reach Group Limited, 524,928 shares (3.49%) are held indirectly by Mr. Hung Hui Ke through Expert Intelligence Global Limited, 1,694,034 shares (11.26%) are held indirectly by Mr. Yan Kong Wong through Sea Dragon Investments Limited and 900,513 shares (5.98%) are held indirectly by Mr. Chi Mang Cheung through Hong Kong Investments Group Limited. The latter four companies (together the “HW Investors”) and Luckyway Global Group Limited which is also the Founding Shareholder of the Company (together the “Current Major Shareholders”) hold all shares in the Company immediately prior to the Offering. Registration financial year and The Company is registered with the commercial register of HRB 185783. the The local court calendar of year Munich (i.e. under 1 January through 31 December) is also the financial year (Geschäftsjahr) of the Company. The first financial year was a short financial year (Rumpfgeschäftsjahr). Employees As of 31 March 2011, China Specialty Glass-Group had a total of 479 employees (trainees included). As of the date of this Prospectus there has been no material change in the number of employees. Miscellaneous Parties related to the Company have engaged and presently engage in business and legal relationships with companies of China Specialty Glass-Group. 12 1.2 Summary of the Offering Offering The Offering consists of a public offering in the Federal Republic of Germany and Luxembourg as well as private placements in other jurisdictions outside the Federal Republic of Germany, Luxembourg and the United States of America. The Offering consists of up to 6,900,000 no-par value bearer shares (lnhaber-Stückaktien) of China Specialty Glass AG, each with a calculated value of EUR 1.00 and carrying full dividend rights from and including the financial year 2011 (the "Offered Shares"). Of this amount, (i) 6,000,000 no-par value bearer shares originate from a securities loan free of charge that was granted by Luckyway Global Group Limited to biw AG (the “Delivery Shares”; see “Delivery of the Offered Shares and Securities Loan” below). In order to fulfil its retransfer obligation vis-à-vis Luckyway Global Group Limited from the securities loan, biw AG will subscribe the shares from an according capital increase of the Company from authorised capital against cash contributions, which is expected to be resolved by the Management Board and approved by the Supervisory Board on or around 20 June 2011 with the then existing shareholders waiving their subscription rights. Upon registration of the capital increase with the commercial register of the Company the shares from the capital increase will be transferred to Luckyway Global Group Limited. (ii) 900,000 no-par value bearer shares originate from a securities loan free of charge that was granted by Luckyway Global Group Limited, Quick Reach Group Limited, Expert Dragon Investments 13 Intelligence Global Limited and Limited, Hong Sea Kong Investment Group Limited (the “Greenshoe Shareholders”) to biw AG in connection with a potential over-allotment (the “Greenshoe Shares”). Both the Delivery Shares and the Greenshoe Shares are part of the Company’s current share capital of 15,050,000 shares (the “Existing Shares”) which shall be admitted to trading at the regulated market of the Frankfurt Stock Exchange. Offering Period The offering period is expected to begin on 20 June 2011 and to end on 29 June 2011 at 12:00 noon Central European Summer Time (“CEST”). Purchase orders are freely revocable until the offering period expires. On the final day of the offering period, retail and institutional investors will be able to submit offers to purchase shares until 12:00 noon CEST. Price Range and The price range within which purchase orders may be Offer Price submitted is between EUR 9.00 and EUR 12.00 per Offered Share. After the offering period expires, the Company and the Underwriters will use the order book created in the bookbuilding process to jointly set the offer price for the Offered Shares (“Offer Price”) and the placement volume. Pricing and placement volume will be set based on the orders submitted by investors during the offering period and collected in the order book. The Offer Price is scheduled to be published subsequently to the fixing of the Offer Price in an ad hoc disclosure on an electronic information system and on the Company’s website (www.csg-ag.de) on 29 June 2011. In particular for the event that the placement volume 14 proves insufficient to satisfy all orders submitted at the Offer Price, the Underwriters reserve the right to reject orders, either in whole or in part. Amendments to the The Company reserves the right, in agreement with Terms of the Offer the Underwriters, to reduce the number of Offered Shares, to lower or raise the upper limit and/or the lower limit of the price range and/or to extend or shorten the offering period. If the option to modify the number of Offered Shares, the price range and/or the offering period (collectively referred to as the “Offer Terms”) is exercised, and to the extent required under the German Securities (Wertpapierprospektgesetz), a Prospectus supplement to Law this Prospectus will be filed with BaFin and published following approval thereof on the Company’s website (www.csg-ag.de). To the extent legally required, any changes will also be published in an ad hoc disclosure. Investors will not be notified individually. Delivery of the It is expected that delivery of the Offered Shares will Offered Shares and take place two banking days following expiration of Securities Loan the offering period subject to payment to biw AG of the Offer Price. Luckyway Global Group Limited will enter into a securities loan agreement under which it grants to biw AG a total number of 6,000,000 no-par value bearer shares by way of a securities loan free of charge to facilitate timely delivery of these shares to the investors. The Greenshoe Shareholders will provide biw AG with 900,000 no-par value bearer shares (the “Greenshoe Shares”) for a potential over-allotment by way of a securities loan free of charge (see “Greenshoe Shares, Greenshoe Option”). Over-Allotment/ In connection with the placement of the Offered Stabilisation Shares, and to the extent permitted by applicable law, and in connection of the Offering, VISCARDI as stabilisation manager may make over-allotments and 15 execute stabilisation measures aimed at supporting the stock exchange or market price of the Company’s shares in order to offset any sales pressure that may exist. Stabilisation measures may be affected as of the date of the commencement of trading of the Existing Shares and must be completed no later than the 30th calendar day after such date. Greenshoe Shares, The Greenshoe Shareholders will provide biw AG, prior Greenshoe Option to the allotment of the Offered Shares, with 900,000 no-par value bearer shares (the “Greenshoe Shares”) (a maximum of 15% of the total number of Delivery Shares being allocated) for a potential over-allotment by way of a securities loan free of charge. The Greenshoe Shareholders will grant biw AG the option to purchase the Greenshoe Shares from the Greenshoe Shareholders at the Offer Price less the agreed commission and other costs (“Greenshoe Option”), and thus satisfy the retransfer obligation from the securities loan. General Allotment The Company, the Greenshoe Shareholders and the Criteria Underwriters will comply with the "Principles for the Allotment of Share Issues to Private Investors" ("Grundsätze für die Zuteilung von Aktienemissionen an Privatanleger"), which were issued on 7 June 2000 by the Exchange Expert Commission (Börsensachverständigenkommission) of the German Federal Ministry of Finance (Bundesministerium der Finanzen). Minimum Allotment Any minimum allotment will be determined once the order book has been closed and will be published in accordance with the allotment principles. No right to allotment exists. Sole Global VISCARDI Coordinator Germany Joint Bookrunners, VISCARDI 16 AG, Brienner Str. 1, 80333 Munich, AG, Brienner Str. 1, 80333 Munich, Joint Lead Managers Germany and Underwriters biw Bank für Investments und Wertpapiere AG, Hausbroicher Str. 222, 47877 Willich, Germany Selling Agents DAB bank AG, Landsberger Str. 300, 80687 Munich, Germany comdirect bank AG, Pascalkehre 15, 25451 Quickborn, Germany Cortal Consors S.A., Zweigniederlassung Deutschland, Postfach 1743, 90006 Nuremberg, Germany S Broker AG & Co. KG, Karl-Bosch-Str. 10, 65203 Wiesbaden, Germany Asiasons WFG Securities Pte Ltd, 5 Shenton Way, #28-01, UIC Building, Singapore 068808 ING-DiBa AG, Theodor-Heuss-Allee 106, 60468 Frankfurt am Main, Germany Admission to An application for admission of all up to 21,050,000 Trading and Listing shares of the Company including the shares from the capital increase to trading on the regulated market segment (Regulierter Markt) of the Frankfurt Stock Exchange with simultaneous admission to the sub-segment of the regulated market with additional post-admission obligations (Prime Standard) is expected to be filed on 29 June 2011. It is expected that the trading of the Existing Shares will commence on the second banking day following the expiration of the offering period, i.e. on 1 July 2011, and that the trading of the shares from the capital increase will commence two banking days following the registration of the capital increase, i.e. on 13 July 2011. Early Termination of The underwriting agreement which will be concluded the Offering inter alia between the Company, the Greenshoe Shareholders and the Underwriters shortly after the date of this Prospectus provides that the Underwriters may terminate the underwriting agreement under certain circumstances, even after the shares have been delivered. 17 If the underwriting agreement is terminated before the shares have been delivered, the Offering will not take place. In such case, allocations of shares to investors will become invalid, and investors will have no claim for delivery. Claims relating to any subscription fees paid and costs incurred by any investor in connection with the subscription are governed solely by the legal relationship between the investor and the institution to which the investor submitted its purchase order. Market Protection The Company will undertake vis-à-vis the Underwriters Agreement that for a period of 6 months from the first day of (Lock-up) trading of the Company’s Existing Shares it will not and for a period of further 6 months it will not without the prior written consent of the Underwriters: (a) implement any capital increase from authorised capital; (b) propose any capital increase to its general shareholders’ meeting; (c) announce, implement or propose to its general shareholders’ meeting any issue of any financial instruments carrying conversion or option rights with respect to the shares in the Company or any transactions having an equivalent economic effect; (d) directly or indirectly sell, offer, market, distribute, transfer, encumber or in any other way dispose of shares in the Company; (e) enter into any transactions (including derivative transactions) that are the economic equivalent of the above. Luckyway Global Group Limited will undertake vis-à-vis the Underwriters that, for a period of 12 months from the from the first day of trading of the 18 Existing Shares it will not and for a period of further 6 months it will not without the prior written consent of the Underwriters: (a) initiate or consent to any of the measures set out above; (b) directly or indirectly sell, offer, market, distribute, transfer, encumber or in any other way dispose of shares or other financial instruments in the Company; the same applies to any transactions constituting the economic equivalent of a sale, such as the issue of option or conversion rights to shares of the Company and other comparable transactions (including derivative transactions); (c) directly or indirectly initiate or consent that the shares in the Company or other financial instruments, which may be converted into shares or which give a right to acquire shares in the Company, are issued, sold, offered, marketed or otherwise disposed of or that an offer relating to any of such transactions is announced. Furthermore, Expert Intelligence Global Limited, Hong Kong Investment Group Limited, Quick Reach Group Limited and Sea Dragon Investments Limited will undertake vis-à-vis the Underwriters that, for a period of 6 months from the first day of trading of the Existing Shares, they will not undertake any of the aforementioned transactions. These lock-up restrictions do not apply to the issuance of shares in the Company for the purpose of making acquisitions or the capital increase according to which the Underwriters will subscribe shares of the Company in order to fulfil its retransfer obligation vis-à-vis Luckyway Global Group Limited from the securities loan. 19 Costs of the Offering As the costs are contingent on the total number of for the Company shares placed and the Offer Price, which determine the amount of commissions, it is not possible at present to reliably predict the amount of the costs. Based on the price range, the Company estimates that it will incur costs (including Underwriters’ fees and assuming that the Company pays the full amount of the discretionary performance-based incentive fee and assuming full exercise of the Greenshoe Option) between approximately EUR 4.5 million and EUR 5.4 million. Use of Proceeds The Company plans to use the net issue proceeds accruing to it from the placement of the Offered Shares to finance further internal and external growth including, if any, selected acquisitions, to implement and finance its strategic objectives and for general business purposes. Assuming that all of the Delivery Shares are placed and assuming full exercise of the Greenshoe Option, the attainable gross issue proceeds accruing to the Company from the Offering will be between approximately EUR 54.0 million and EUR 72.0 million. Further assuming that the net issue proceeds of the Offering accruing to the Company amount to approximately EUR 49.5 million to EUR 66.6 million, the net issue proceeds will be used as follows: · approximately 25% of the net issue proceeds for the establishment of a new production base in Sichuan; · approximately 25% of the net issue proceeds for financing further growth; · approximately 5% of the net issue proceeds for establishing a new research and development centre; · approximately 25% of the net issue proceeds for modernizing and expanding production capacity of Guangzhou factory; · approximately 10% of the net issue proceeds for the financing of the exclusive distributorship agreement with the industrial group Saint-Gobain; · approximately 10% of the net issue proceeds for working capital. 20 German Securities A1EL8Y Identification Number (WKN) International DE000A1EL8Y8 Securities Identification Number (ISIN) Ticker Symbol 1.3 8GS Summary of Key Financial Information The current Group structure with CSG-AG as holding company was established in November 2010 by way of contribution in kind of the shares in HWG HK-Holding to the Company. CSG-AG itself was founded on 10 May 2010 and entered into the commercial register on 18 May 2010. Therefore, only the consolidated financial statements of CSG-AG for the short financial year 2010 (from date of initial existence of the Group on 22 November 2010 until 31 December 2010), in which CSG-AG’s subsidiaries were consolidated as of 22 November 2010, and the consolidated interim financial statements of CSG-AG for the three months ended 31 March 2011, all in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as endorsed for application in the EU, as well as the single entity financial statements of CSG-AG in accordance with the German Commercial Code (Handelsgesetzbuch – HGB) for the short financial year 2010 (from incorporation of CSG-AG on 10 May 2010 until 31 December 2010) exist as financial statements of the Company and the Group in its current form. For the time before its establishment, in particular for the financial years 2008 and 2009, the Group has no historical financial data and thus has a complex financial history within the meaning of Article 4a of the Regulation (EC) No. 809/2004. The consolidated financial statements of CSG-AG for 2010 as well as the single entity financial statements for 2010 have been audited by Grant Thornton, whereas the consolidated interim financial statements have been reviewed by Grant Thornton. HWG-Ltd. is the wholly owned, intermediate subsidiary of the Company, having its legal domicile in the People's Republic of China, and currently carries out exclusively the operational business within the Group. On 21 31 October and 5 November 2007, HWG HK-Holding entered into two share purchase agreements to purchase all of the shares in HWG-Ltd. and on 15 January 2008 the acquisition became effective by registration with the competent authority. HWG-Ltd. was during the reporting period the only significant operating subsidiary of the Group. Hence, in order to present the business, financial condition and result of operations for the last three financial years and the first quarter of 2011 in relation to the business of the Group, HWG-Ltd. has prepared financial statements as at and for the years ended 31 December 2008, 31 December 2009 and 31 December 2010 as well as interim financial statements for the three months ended 31 March 2011, all in accordance with IFRS, as endorsed for application in the EU. The financial statements were audited by Grant Thornton with the exception of the interim financial statements which were reviewed by Grant Thornton. The abovementioned financial statements of HWG-Ltd. are not the legally required financial statements of the Company but have been prepared on a voluntary basis for the purpose of this Offering. The purpose of these financial statements is to allow the investor to compare the development of the business, financial condition and the results of operations of China Specialty Glass-Group over the last three years and the first quarter of 2011. As, in addition, the consolidated financial statements and single entity financial statements of CSG-AG only refer to a short financial year (2010), the selected financial information which is reflected in section 1.4 "Selected Financial Information" was derived from the aforementioned financial statements of HWG-Ltd. and the consolidated interim financial statements of CSG-AG for the three months ended 31 March 2011. 1.4 Selected Financial Information The tables below show selected information relating to the audited financial statements of HWG-Ltd. for the financial years 2008, 2009 and 2010 as well as the reviewed interim financial statements of HWG-Ltd. and the reviewed consolidated interim financial statements of CSG-AG for the first three months of the financial year 2011, all in accordance with IFRS, as endorsed for application in the EU. The figures are subject to rounding adjustments that were carried out according to established commercial standards. As a result, the figures stated in a table may not exactly add up to the total values that may also be stated in the table. 22 HWG-Ltd. Selected Financial Information Twelve months ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 (audited)¹ (audited)¹ (audited)¹ EUR EUR thousand % EUR thousand % thousand % Selected Statement of Comprehensive Income Data Revenue 40,216 100% 50,910 100% 69,564 100% Cost of sales -23,000 57% -28,032 55% -38,111 55% Gross Profit Selling and distribution expenses 17,216 43% 22,878 45% 31,453 45% -1,205 3% -1,704 3% -2,277 3% -848 2% -874 2% -1,038 1% -965 3% -1,384 3% -1,878 3% 14,198 35% 18,916 37% 26,260 38% 51 0% 47 0% 108 0% -104 0% -106 0% -110 0% 14,145 35% 18,857 37% 26,258 38% -3,545 9% -4,726 9% -4,006 6% 10,600 26% 14,131 28% 22,252 32% Administrative expenses Research and development costs Profit from operations Finance income Finance costs Profit before income tax Income tax Profit for the period Selected Statement of financial position Data Total assets 24,892 31,753 59,651 Total liabilities 12,604 6,904 10,299 Total equity 12,288 24,849 49,352 10,841 11,548 22,343 -710 -185 -4,706 Selected Cash Flow and Financing Data Cash flow from operating activities Cash flow from investing activities Cash flow from financing activities -5,725 -7,672 859 14,330 16,811 37,801 1,383 1,604 1,813 12,947 15,207 35,988 Gross profit margin 42.8% 44.9% 45.2% EBIT 14,198 18,916 26,260 EBIT margin 35.3% 37.2% 37.7% Net profit margin 26.4% 27.8% 32.0% 467 464 451 Cash at end of period Interest bearing bank borrowings Net funds (Cash less borrowings) Other Selected Financial data Number of employees ¹ Audited information with the exception of "Other Selected Financial Data" which is calculated or derived from the audited financial statements 23 HWG-Ltd. Selected Financial Information Three months ended 31 March 2011 (reviewed)1 EUR thousand Three months ended 31 March 2010 (reviewed)1 EUR thousand % % Selected Statement of Comprehensive Income Data Revenue 16,441 Cost of sales Gross Profit Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Research and development costs Profit from operations Finance income Finance costs Profit before income tax Income tax Profit for the period 100% 11,454 100% -8,850 54% -6,451 56% 7,591 46% 5,003 44% -609 4% -441 4% -326 2% -190 2% -391 2% -338 3% 6,265 38% 4,034 35% 79 0% 18 0% -30 0% -22 0% 6,314 38% 4,030 35% -950 5% -685 6% 5,364 33% 3,345 29% Selected Balance Sheet Data² Total assets Total liabilities Total equity Selected Cash Flow and Financing Data Cash flow from operating activities Cash flow from investing activities Cash flow from financing activities Cash at end of period Interest bearing bank borrowings Net funds (Cash less borrowings) 61,998 59,651 9,627 10,299 52,371 49,352 3,109 6,114 -2,368 -2 -142 -22 36,700 24,668 1,624 1,747 35,076 22,921 46.2% 43.6% Other Selected Financial data Gross profit margin EBIT 6,265 4,034 EBIT margin 38.1% 35.2% Net profit margin 32.6% 29.2% 456 456 Number of employees ¹ The interim financial data has been subject to review. ² The 2010 figures shown in the “Selected Balance Sheet Data” derive from the twelve months ended 31 December 2010 shown in the financial statements of HWG-Ltd. 24 CSG-AG Selected Consolidated Financial Information Three months ended 31 March 2011 (reviewed)1 EUR Thousand Short year ended 31 December 2010 (audited) EUR Thousand % Selected Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income Data Revenue 16,441 100% Cost of sales -8,850 54% Gross profit Selling and distribution expenses 7,591 46% -609 4% -440 3% -391 2% 6,151 37% Administrative expenses Research and development costs Profit from operations Finance income Finance costs Profit before income tax Taxation Net profit 37 0% -26 0% 6,162 37% -950 5% 5,212 32% Selected Consolidated Balance Sheet Data Total assets 62,728 60,374 Total liabilities 10,051 10,563 Equity 52,677 49,811 Selected Consolidated Cash Flow Data Cash flow from operating activities Cash flow from investing activities Cash flow from financing activities Cash at end of period Interest bearing bank borrowings Net cash (cash and cash equivalents less interest bearing bank liabilities) 2,516 -2,386 -138 36,739 37,912 1,624 1,813 35,115 36,099 Further Selected Consolidated Financial Data Gross profit margin EBIT 46,2% 6,151 EBIT-margin 37,4% Net profit margin 31,7% Number of employees 456 ¹ The interim financial data has been subject to review. 25 % 1.5 Summary of the Risk Factors Before deciding to purchase shares of China Specialty Glass AG, prospective investors are invited to carefully read and consider the risks described below and the other information contained in this Prospectus. The occurrence of one or more of these risks, either individually or in conjunction with other circumstances, could materially impair the business activities of China Specialty Glass AG and/or any of its direct and indirect subsidiaries and/or have a material adverse effect on the financial condition and results of operations of China Specialty Glass-Group. The order in which the risks are described is neither an indication as to the likelihood of occurrence nor the severity or significance of the individual risks. At the same time, these risk factors are based on assumptions that may subsequently prove to be incorrect. In addition, further risks or factors, of which the Company is currently unaware, may be of significance and impair the business activities of China Specialty Glass-Group and have a material adverse effect on its financial condition and results of operations. The market price of the Company’s shares could substantially decline due to the occurrence of any such risks. Investors could lose part or all of their investment. Risks related to China Specialty Glass Group’s business · The markets for security glass and construction glass in which the Group operates and distributes its products are competitive. Increasing competition could have negative effects on the Group. · The sale of a substantial portion of China Specialty Glass-Group’s products is subject to China Compulsory Certifications issued by a qualified certification institution and approval certificates for production registration of security products issued by the local counterpart of the Ministry of Public Security and failure to obtain or renew these certifications or certificates could hinder the sale of the respective products. · The Group’s business depends largely on the demand for bulletproof glass by Chinese financial institutions (e.g. banks) and refitting automotive manufacturers. · The Group operates in a highly regulated market and depends on maintaining its ability to sell its products to customers in the sensitive areas of Chinese internal security and finance. 26 · China Specialty Glass-Group is subject to risks of interruptions in operation, quality problems and unexpected technical difficulties, as well as to product safety, occupational safety and environmental risks. · Rising material prices and labour costs could adversely affect the profitability of China Specialty Glass-Group’s business. · High fluctuation of employees may have a negative effect on the Group. · The Management Board of the Company is not experienced with German legal requirements for listed companies and has no German language skills and only one member of the Management Board speaks English. In addition, the Group currently only has small finance and accounting departments with limited experience. Furthermore, the Group does not have a comprehensive risk management system or comprehensive system of internal control. · As all members of the Management Board are located outside Germany and two members of the Supervisory Board reside in Germany, the Company’s Supervisory Board may have difficulties in adequately supervising the Management Board. · The Group’s expansion plan to set up a production base in Chengdu, China, may fail. · The Group’s failure to execute its expansion plans and manage its growth successfully could adversely affect the Group’s future performance. · The Group’s international expansion strategy may fail. · The Group may experience difficulties in making strategic acquisitions of businesses and technologies. · China Specialty Glass-Group might not be able to protect its intellectual property and know-how adequately and they might be infringed by third parties. · China Specialty Glass-Group could infringe on the intellectual property rights of third parties or have to license such rights from third parties in order to operate. · The Company may be unable to produce new products that gain sufficient commercial acceptance. 27 · The Exclusive Distributorship Agreement with the industrial group Saint-Gobain may fail or may not be profitable. · Defects or improper handling of the China Specialty Glass-Group’s products could result in a damage of its reputation and could adversely affect the Group’s business. · China Specialty Glass-Group may have insufficient insurance to cover its potential risks. · The Group could fail to retain and recruit key personnel, which could adversely affect the future performance of the Group. · The Company and/or the Group may not be able to secure adequate financing to fund the Group’s growth. · Guangzhou Property Management Center has not completed land use right formalities with regard to an area covering 53 square meters and a separate piece of allocated land of 9,416 square meters on which the buildings are leased to HWG-Ltd. and thus might not be allowed to use the buildings any more. · The Group is exposed to risks relating to potential legal disputes, administrative proceedings, fines or damage claims, in particular with respect to shareholder compensation, alleged patent breaches, as well as warranty claims from product liability. · China Specialty Glass-Group may be required to make additional payments for social insurance and housing funds. · The interests of the current major shareholder Luckyway Global Group Limited may conflict with the interests of the Company and other shareholders. These conflicts of interests may be amplified as Luckyway Global Group Limited is controlled by members of the Management Board. · The Group maintains and will continue to maintain business and legal relationships for its business operations with companies or persons that are related to China Specialty Glass-Group or its board members. · The Group is exposed to fluctuations in foreign exchange rates and to potential exchange restrictions. · The most significant asset in the financial statements of the Company is HWG HK-Holding, which has been contributed through a capital increase 28 by way of contribution in kind. An extraordinary depreciation of HWG HK-Holding would have negative effects on the Company’s financial position and profitability. · The Company became the holding company of China Specialty Glass-Group in 2010 shortly after the Company was acquired by the Founding Shareholder Luckyway Global Group Limited and therefore has a short financial history which may impact the quality and comparability of China Specialty Glass-Group’s financial information. · The tax burden of the Group may increase as a result of tax audits or as a result of German Trade Tax. · The tax status of China Specialty Glass-Group as a “high-tech enterprise”, a beneficiary of the tax arrangement between the People’s Republic of China (“PRC”) and Hong Kong or as a “tax resident enterprise” or tax legislation or its interpretation might change which could increase the tax burden of the Group. · There exist a number of tax risks which could result in additional tax liabilities for HWG-Ltd. or the Group. · The business activities of the operating company of China Specialty Glass-Group are and will continue to be subject to laws and regulations relating to environmental protection. · HWG-Ltd. may be presumed to have market dominance in the Chinese security glass market and therefore may be subject to restrictions under the PRC Anti-Monopoly Law. Risks related to the political, social and legal enviroment of the People’s Republic of China · The Group’s business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects could be adversely affected by the economic, political and legal environment and developments in China. · The Chinese “Provisions on the Acquisition of Domestic Enterprises by Foreign Investors” (the M&A Provisions) may have a material adverse effect on the Company. 29 · The Company is a holding company and faces typical risks from its holding activities, e.g. its liquidity depends upon having access to the liquid funds of its operating subsidiary located in China. · Regulations of the State Administration of Foreign Exchange (“SAFE”) relating to offshore investments by PRC residents or passport holders may adversely affect the Company’s business operations and financing alternatives. · PRC regulations relating to loans and direct capital investments by offshore parent companies to PRC entities may delay or prevent China Specialty Glass-Group from using the proceeds of this Offering or from adopting the most favourable financing structure. · Economic instability in China could adversely affect the Group’s business. · A destabilization of the political system could threaten China’s economic liberalization and have a negative impact on the Group’s business. · Health epidemics and outbreaks of contagious diseases, including avian influenza, could materially and adversely affect the Chinese economy and the Group’s business. · The PRC legal system and regional and national taxation laws contain inherent uncertainties and inconsistencies which can create uncertainty regarding the Group's business. · The judiciary’s lack of independence and limited experience and the difficulty of enforcing court decisions and governmental discretion in enforcing court orders could prevent China Specialty Glass-Group from obtaining effective remedies in court proceedings. · Seeking recognition and enforcement in China of foreign judgements against the Company, its assets, management personnel or directors might be difficult or impossible for investors. · Restrictions might be imposed on foreign investments in PRC companies. 30 Risk related to the Offering · The Company cannot ensure that public trading in the Company’s shares will develop. · A volatile stock exchange price for the shares might develop. · The Underwriting Agreement might be rescinded, in which case the Offering would not take place. · The Group conducts its operations through its subsidiaries and, as a result, is dependent and will depend to a large extent on its subsidiaries to pay dividends to the Group so that it, in turn, has funds to pay dividends to its shareholders. · For investors financing the share purchase price with a loan there is an increased risk of loss. 31 2. GERMAN TRANSLATION OF THE SUMMARY — ZUSAMMENFASSUNG DES PROSPEKTS Die folgende Zusammenfassung ist als Einführung zu diesem Prospekt zu verstehen und steht im Zusammenhang mit den in anderen Teilen des Prospekts enthaltenen detaillierteren Informationen. Anleger sollten ihre Entscheidung, ob sie in die in diesem Prospekt beschriebenen Wertpapiere investieren, auf die Prüfung des gesamten Prospekts stützen. Die China Specialty Glass AG, Grünwald, Deutschland (die “Gesellschaft” oder die “CSG-AG”, zusammen mit ihren unmittelbaren und mittelbaren Tochtergesellschaften die “China Specialty Glass-Group” oder “Gruppe”), die VISCARDI AG, München, Deutschland (“VISCARDI” oder der “Alleinige Globale Koordinator”) und biw Bank für Investments und Wertpapiere AG, Hausbroicher Str. 222, 47877 Willich, Deutschland („biw AG“) (VISCARDI und biw AG gemeinsam die „Transaktionsführenden Banken“ oder die „Übernehmenden Banken“) übernehmen gemäß § 5 Abs. 2 S. 3 Nr. 4 Wertpapierprospektgesetz (WpPG) die Verantwortung für den Inhalt dieser Prospektzusammenfassung einschließlich einer Übersetzung hiervon. Sie können für den Inhalt der Zusammenfassung haftbar gemacht werden, jedoch nur für den Fall, dass die Zusammenfassung irreführend, unrichtig oder widersprüchlich ist, wenn sie zusammen mit den anderen Teilen dieses Prospekts gelesen wird. Für den Fall, dass vor einem Gericht Ansprüche aufgrund der in diesem Prospekt enthaltenen Informationen geltend gemacht werden, könnte der als Kläger auftretende Anleger in Anwendung der einzelstaatlichen Rechtsvorschriften der einzelnen Staaten des Europäischen Wirtschaftsraums die Kosten für die Übersetzung des Prospekts vor Prozessbeginn zu tragen haben. 2.1 Allgemeine Informationen zur China Specialty Glass-Group und ihrer Geschäftstatigkeit 2.1.1 Einführung und Überblick Die Gesellschaft ist eine Aktiengesellschaft deutschen Rechts mit Sitz in Grünwald, nahe München, Deutschland, und ist im Handelsregister des Amtsgerichts München unter HRB 185783 sowie unter dem Namen China Specialty Glass AG eingetragen. Die Gesellschaft ist die Holdinggesellschaft von Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited („HWG HK-Holding“), die 32 gemäß den Gesetzen Hongkongs gegründet wurde. Die HWG HK-Holding hält alle Anteile an der Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd. („HWG-Ltd.“), gegründet in Guangzhou, Provinz Guangdong, China, welche gegenwärtig die einzige operativ tätige Gesellschaft der Gruppe ist. HWG-Ltd. hat eine Tochtergesellschaft, die Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Co., Ltd. (“HWG-SC”), die in Chengdu, Provinz Sichuan, China, gegründet wurde und bis zum Datum dieses Prospekts noch nicht operativ tätig geworden ist, obwohl sie in investiert und Sachanlagen, Landnutzungsrechte und Baumusterrechte Verbindlichkeiten hinsichtlich ihrer durchgeführten Investitionen und Verpflichtungen hinsichtlich ihrer geplanten Investitionen aufgenommen hat. HWG HK-Holding, HWG-Ltd. und HWG-SC werden zusammen als „HWG HK-Group“ bezeichnet; die Gesellschaft und die HWG HK-Group werden zusammen als „China Specialty Glass-Group“ oder die „Gruppe“ bezeichnet (siehe graphische Darstellung unten zur Verdeutlichung der Struktur der Gruppe zum Zeitpunkt dieses Prospekts). China Specialty Glass AG 1) "CSG-AG" oder "Unternehmen" Muttergesellschaft "China Specialty Glass-Gruppe" oder "Gruppe" Gesellschaft für Börsengang 100% 2) Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Ltd Zwischengesellschaft "HWG HK-Holding" "HWG HK-Gruppe" 100% Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co. Ltd3) Operative Gesellschaft "HWG-Ltd" 100% Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Industry Co. Ltd3) Tochtergesellschaft "HWG-SC" Registriert in 1) Deutschland, 2) Hong Kong and 3) China (VR) Die China Specialty Glass-Group strebt einen Börsengang der CSG-AG an der Frankfurter Wertpapierbörse im Juni 2011 an, nachdem ein geplanter Börsengang im Dezember 2010 aufgrund eines damals ungünstigen Marktund Börsenumfeldes verschoben wurde. Die China Specialty Glass-Group entwickelt, produziert und verkauft Spezialglas unter ihrer Marke „Hing Wah”. Die Gruppe vertreibt ihre Produkte direkt durch ihr eigenes Verkaufsnetzwerk an Kunden auf dem inländischen Markt in China. Die China Specialty Glass-Group sieht sich als einen der 33 führenden Sicherheitsglashersteller in China, der für die chinesische Bankenund Sicherheitsfahrzeugindustrie Sicherheitsglas herstellt, ein Spezialglas, welches in erster Linie für den persönlichen Schutz gegen physische Gewalt und erzwungenes verschiedene Eindringen verwendet Spezialglasprodukte Sicherheitsglasprodukte, die Sicherheitsfahrzeugindustrie von wird. für der nachgefragt Sie den vertreibt zudem Bauglasmarkt. chinesischen werden, ist Für Bankendie und Gruppe ein dominierender Akteur sowohl in Bezug auf die Produktionsleistung als auch den Marktanteil (Quelle: S. 104, “Bericht zur chinesischen Panzerglasindustrie” aus Respect Market Research Inc., im Folgenden als “RMR Bericht” bezeichnet, 2010). Die Gruppe bietet ihren Kunden im Zusammenhang mit dem Verkauf technische Beratung und Hilfestellung für den Einbau an. Die derzeitige Produktionsanlage der China Specialty Glass-Group befindet sich in Guangzhou, Provinz Guangdong, in Südchina, und wird von der operativen hundertprozentigen Tochtergesellschaft der Gruppe, der HWG-Ltd., betrieben. Die neue Produktionsanlage der Gruppe in Sichuan, welche von HWG-SC betrieben werden soll, befindet sich derzeit im Bau. Die von der China Specialty Glass-Group unter der Marke „Hing Wah“ vertriebenen Hauptprodukte können in zwei Gruppen unterteilt werden: Sicherheitsglas, einschließlich Panzerglas und einbruchsicheres Glas; sowie Bauglas, einschließlich Verbund-Sicherheitsglas und Hartglas für architektonische Zwecke, feuerbeständiges Glas, Hohlglas und elektrisch gesteuertes farbwechselndes Glas. Das Sicherheitsglas der Gruppe wird an Orten eingesetzt, an denen mit Geld oder wertvollen Gütern gehandelt wird, wie bei Banken, Juweliergeschäften, Börsenmaklerhäusern, Zustelldiensten und Versicherungsunternehmen (“Banken-Sicherheitsglas-Markt”). Das Sicherheitsglas der Gruppe wird außerdem für gepanzerte Fahrzeuge genutzt, die Passagieren Sicherheit und Schutz bieten Polizeifahrzeuge, sollen, wie Werttransportfahrzeuge Militärpersonaltransporter und für gepanzerte Banken, Limousinen (“Fahrzeug-Sicherheitsglas-Markt”). Zudem vertreibt die Gruppe ihre Bauglasprodukte in der Bauindustrie, wo sie als Fenster, Türen, Vorhangfassaden (Abdeckung von Gebäuden, deren Außenwände nicht tragend sind, sondern lediglich gegen das Wetter Schutz bieten) oder Innenausstattung in Geschäftsgebäuden und Privathäusern verwendet werden (“Bauglasmarkt”). Die Gruppe hat 1994 begonnen ihre Produkte zu vertreiben. Ihre Endkunden 34 sind ausschließlich Handelsunternehmen, im Banken-Sicherheitsglas-Markt Banken, im Fahrzeug-Sicherheitsglas-Markt Um-/Ausrüstungen vornehmen, und im Automobilhersteller, Bauglasmarkt die Dienstleister im Baugewerbe. Der Umsatz der aktuell alleinigen operativen hundertprozentigen Tochtergesellschaft der Gruppe HWG-Ltd. erhöhte sich von EUR 40,2 Millionen in 2008 auf EUR 50,9 Millionen in 2009 und auf EUR 69,6 Millionen in 2010. Dies entspricht einer durchschnittlichen jährlichen Wachstumsrate von 31,7% in diesem Zeitraum. Das Nettoergebnis erhöhte sich von EUR 10,6 Millionen in 2008 auf EUR 14,1 Millionen in 2009 und auf EUR 22,3 Millionen in 2010. Wachstumsrate Dies von entspricht 45,6%. Die einer durchschnittlichen Mehrheit der Verkäufe jährlichen betraf das Sicherheitsglas der Gruppe, das auf dem Banken-Sicherheitsglas-Markt mit Verkäufen von EUR 17,5 Millionen, EUR 23,0 Millionen bzw. EUR 32,1 Millionen für 2008, 2009 bzw. 2010; und dem Fahrzeug-Sicherheitsglas-Markt mit Verkäufen von EUR 15,4 Millionen, EUR 22,4 Millionen bzw. EUR 30,0 Millionen für 2008, 2009 bzw. 2010 verkauft wird. Diese Verkäufe entsprechen 43,5%, 45,2% und 46,1% bzw. 38,3%, 44,0% und 43,1% der Gesamtumsatzerlöse für diese Jahre. Die Gesellschaft ist der Sicherheitsglasmarkt Auffassung, dass sich der chinesische (Banken-Sicherheitsglas-Markt und Fahrzeug-Sicherheitsglas-Markt) und Bauglasmarkt in der Zukunft weiter positiv entwickeln wird. Insbesondere mit Blick auf den erwarteten Anstieg des Konsumentenwohlstandes und der Geschäftsaktivitäten wird erwartet, dass Handelsunternehmen, die Banken-Sicherheitsglas benötigen, sowohl im Hinblick auf Anzahl (z.B. Zunahme der Bankfilialen in ländlichen Gebieten und kleineren Städten) und individuelle Größe (z.B. Erhöhung der Betriebsfläche von Postämtern) ebenfalls entsprechend zunehmen werden. In diesen Handelsunternehmen werden Sicherheitsmaßnahmen umfassend von der chinesischen Regierung überwacht und reguliert. Es ist zu erwarten, dass die Nachfrage für die Produkte der Gruppe, die von den Kontrollbehörden zertifiziert werden, entsprechend ansteigt. Ebenso verspricht ein Anstieg der Anzahl von wohlhabenden chinesischen Staatsbürgern und ihrem Bedürfnis nach und ihrem Bewusstsein für Sicherheit und Schutz für sich selbst und ihre Familien einen Anstieg der Nachfrage nach Produkten der Gruppe im Bereich Fahrzeug-Sicherheitsglas und Bauglas. Die Gesellschaft plant, die Produktion und Verkäufe der Glasprodukte der Gruppe zu erhöhen, um diese Nachfrage zu erfüllen. 35 2.1.2 Strategie Die Gesellschaft ist der Auffassung, dass die folgenden strategischen Ziele und ihre Umsetzung das zukünftige Wachstum der Gruppe antreiben werden: · Vom Wachstum des chinesischen Sicherheitsglasmarktes durch Erweiterung des inländischen Vertriebsnetzwerkes und Stärkung der Marke Hing Wah sowie mittelfristig von der Diversifizierung der Märkte durch internationale Expansion profitieren: Als ein maßgeblicher Akteur auf dem chinesischen Sicherheitsglasmarkt plant die Gesellschaft, das Vertriebsnetzwerk der Gruppe im Inland weiter auszubauen, um vom weiteren Wachstum des chinesischen Sicherheitsglasmarktes zu profitieren. Die Gesellschaft hat vor, die Präsenz des Vertriebsteams in China zu erweitern, indem Provinzen oder Regionen, die die Gruppe derzeit nicht aktiv bedient, abgedeckt werden und Regionen, die bereits bedient werden, stärker angesprochen werden, um die Gruppe näher an ihre derzeitigen und zukünftigen Kunden zu bringen. So sollen die Bedürfnisse der Kunden besser befriedigt und die Attraktivität der Produktangebote der Gruppe gesteigert werden. Die Gesellschaft ist der Meinung, dass diese Expansion die Wahrnehmung der Marke Hing Wah sowie die Produktverkäufe der Gruppe bedeutend steigern wird. Die Gesellschaft beabsichtigt ferner, den Verkauf der Produkte der Gruppe international zu erweitern, um die Abhängigkeit der Gruppe auf dem chinesischen Inlandsmarkt zu reduzieren. · Erweiterung der Konsolidierung der Produktionskapazitäten chinesischen und Teilnahme Sicherheitsglasindustrie an und der dem Wachstum in westlichen und in zentralen Regionen in China: Da die Transportkosten für Sicherheits- und Bauglas erheblich sind, insbesondere bei Lieferungen über weite Entfernungen, hat sich die Gruppe bislang auf besser entwickelte Provinzen und Regionen in der Nähe ihres derzeitigen Produktionsstandortes in Guangzhou, Provinz Guangdong, konzentriert. Die Gesellschaft glaubt, dass der Markt für die Produkte der Gruppe in diesen Regionen und Provinzen noch weit von einer Sättigung entfernt ist und plant, weiterhin an dessen zukünftigem Wachstum teilzunehmen. Dazu möchte die Gesellschaft die Produktionskapazität und -effizienz der Gruppe an ihrem derzeitigen Produktionsstandort in Guangzhou durch die Errichtung neuer Produktionsanlagen, die Aufrüstung ihrer Produktionsausrüstung sowie durch eine Steigerung der Automatisierung ihres Produktionsprozesses 36 erhöhen. Die Gesellschaft plant zudem, die Anlage in Guangzhou für den Ausbau ihrer Marktpräsenz in ausgewählten asiatischen Ländern zu nutzen. Die Gesellschaft ist außerdem der Auffassung, dass das zukünftige Verkaufswachstum zunehmend von Regionen und Provinzen in China ausgehen wird, wo die Gruppe derzeit durch die große Distanz zu ihrem Produktionsstandort einen Wettbewerbsnachteil hat. Daher plant die Gesellschaft, eine neue Produktionsstätte in der Stadt Chengdu, Provinz Sichuan, zu errichten, die näher an den potentiellen Endkunden liegt, um vom Wachstum sowohl im Sicherheitsglas- als auch im Bauglasmarkt in diesen Regionen und Provinzen zu profitieren. Die neue Anlage soll in der zweiten Jahreshälfte 2011 den Betrieb aufnehmen und die maximale Produktionskapazität in etwa zwei Jahren erreichen. Außerdem beabsichtigt die Gesellschaft die Produktionskapazitäten der Gruppe und den Zugang zu erfahrenem Personal und lokalen Märkten in anderen Teilen Chinas durch Akquisitionen kleinerer Wettbewerber zu erweitern. · Fokussierung auf Produkte Produktinnovationen im mit höherer Gewinnspanne Sicherheitsglasmarkt sowie und auf den in dem Bauglasmarkt mit niedrigerer Gewinnspanne: Die Gesellschaft plant, das Geschäft der Gruppe Sicherheitsglasmarkt zu erweitern, der ein Nischenmarkt ist und sich durch das Fehlen einer großen Anzahl von Wettbewerbern und einen hohen Verkaufspreis pro Stück für Produkte auszeichnet. Die Gesellschaft strebt an, in den kommenden Jahren die Innovationstradition der Gruppe fortzuführen sowie neue und wettbewerbsfähige Produkte auf den Markt zu bringen, während die bereits auf dem Markt vorhandenen Produkte durch Hinzufügung neuer Eigenschaften oder Verbesserung der Produktleistung verbessert werden sollen. Die Gesellschaft ist der Ansicht, dass beides wesentlich ist für die Produkttreue der Kunden und die Marktstellung der Gruppe. Im Gegensatz dazu erfordert der Bauglasmarkt ein hohes Produktionsvolumen sowie Produktionsvielfalt bei geringeren Gewinnspannen. Um die Nutzungsrate, die das Verhältnis von tatsächlicher Produktionsleistung und verfügbarer Produktionskapazität im selben Jahr meint, ihrer Produktionsanlagen zu optimieren und Vorteile beim Einkauf von umfangreichen Ressourcenlieferungen zu generieren, plant die Gesellschaft, dieses Produktsegment weiterhin zu bedienen, ohne dabei ihren Hauptfokus auf die Sicherheitsglasindustrie zu verlieren. 37 · Stärkung der Kapazitäten und des Leistungsvermögens im Bereich Forschung und Entwicklung (“F&E“): Die Gesellschaft sieht die F&E-Kapazitäten der Gruppe und deren Innovationskraft als essentiell an für ihr zukünftiges Wachstum sowie ihre Fähigkeit, dominieren. den margenstarken Daher plant sie, Sicherheitsglasmarkt die F&E-Aktivitäten weiterhin der Gruppe zu zu erweitern, und zwar durch eine Steigerung der jährlichen Ausgaben, der Errichtung eines gesonderten Zentrums für Forschung und Entwicklung am Hauptsitz der HWG-Ltd. in Guangzhou, eine Steigerung der Anzahl ihrer Mitarbeiter im Bereich F&E und durch Fortführung ihrer Kooperation mit etablierten Universitäten und Berufsakademien in China. Es wird erwartet, dass sich die Aktivitäten der Gruppe im Bereich Forschung und Entwicklung auf die Einführung neuer Produkte, wie multiresistente Sicherheitsfenster und verriegelbare Sicherheitstüren (ein spezielles Türsystem, welches zusätzliche Sicherheitseigenschaften gegenüber gewöhnlichen Türen aufweist) konzentrieren werden. Das F&E-Team plant zudem, Innovationen hervorzubringen, die die Produktionseffizienz verbessern und Produktionskosten einsparen. 2.1.3 Wettbewerbsstärken Die Gesellschaft sieht die folgenden Wettbewerbsstärken als unerlässlich für ihr zukünftiges Wachstum an: · Vorreiter der Branche, starke Marktpräsenz und anerkannte Marke in China · Größter Sicherheitsglashersteller in China (Quelle: S. 103 – 105, RMR Bericht, 2010), der von Skaleneffekten, weitreichenden Vertriebskanälen und starker Konsumententreue profitiert · Kostengünstige Produktion, effektive Kostenkontrolle und rentabler Betrieb · Fokus auf reguliertem Produktsegment, das von der Regierungspolitik und restriktiven Gesetzesvorschriften profitiert · Starkes Potenzial im Bereich Produktinnovation · Erfahrenes Management-Team mit Industriefachwissen ausgedehntem geschäftlichem Netzwerk in China 38 und 2.1.4 Weitere Informationen zur Gesellschaft und der China Specialty Glass-Group Vorstand Herr Nang Heung Sze, Herr Chun Li Shi und Herr Chi-Hsiang Michael Lee Aufsichtsrat Herr Helmut Meyer, Herr Xin Yong Shi und Herr Volker Schlegel Grundkapital und EUR 15.050.000,00, eingeteilt in 15.050.000 auf den Aktien (vor der Inhaber lautende Aktien ohne Nennbetrag Durchführung des Börsengangs) Wirtschaftsprüfer Der Wirtschaftsprüfer der Gesellschaft ist die Grant Thornton (“Grant GmbH Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft Thornton”), Domstrasse 15, 20095 Hamburg, Mitglied der Wirtschaftsprüferkammer. Aktionäre (vor der Vor der Durchführung des Börsengangs hält Herr Durchführung Nang Heung Sze indirekt durch die Luckyway Global Börsengangs) des Group Limited 11.194.957 Aktien (74,39%); 735.568 Aktien (4,89%) werden indirekt von Herrn Ching Hoi Sze durch die Quick Reach Group Limited gehalten, 524.928 Aktien (3,49%) werden indirekt von Herrn Hung Hui Ke durch die Expert Intelligence Global Limited gehalten, 1.694.034 Aktien (11,26%) werden indirekt von Herrn Yan Kong Wong durch die Sea Dragon Investments Limited gehalten und 900.513 Aktien (5,98%) werden indirekt von Herrn Chi Mang Cheung durch die Hong Kong Investments Group Limited gehalten. Die zuletzt genannten vier Gesellschaften (zusammen die „HW Investoren“) und die Luckyway Global Group Limited, die auch Gründungsaktionärin der Gesellschaft ist (zusammen die „Gegenwärtigen Großaktionäre“), halten unmittelbar vor dem Börsengang alle Aktien an der Gesellschaft. 39 Eintragung Geschäftsjahr und Die Gesellschaft Amtsgerichts ist im München Handelsregister unter des HRB 185783 eingetragen. Das Kalenderjahr (d.h. 1. Januar bis 31. Dezember) Gesellschaft. ist auch Das das erste Geschäftsjahr Geschäftsjahr der war ein Rumpfgeschäftsjahr. Mitarbeiter Zum 31. März 2011 beschäftigte die China Specialty Glass-Group insgesamt 479 Mitarbeiter (einschließlich Auszubildende). Zum Zeitpunkt des Prospekts hat sich die Anzahl der Mitarbeiter nicht wesentlich verändert. Verschiedenes Mit der Gesellschaft verbundene Parteien gingen und gehen derzeit geschäftliche und rechtliche Beziehungen mit Gesellschaften der China Specialty Glass-Group ein. 2.2 Zusammenfassung des Angebots Angebot Das Angebot besteht aus einem öffentlichen Angebot in der Bundesrepublik Deutschland und Luxemburg sowie Privatplatzierungen in anderen Staaten außerhalb der Bundesrepublik Deutschland, Luxemburg und den Vereinigten Staaten von Amerika. Gegenstand des Angebots sind bis zu 6.900.000 Inhaberstückaktien der China Specialty Glass AG mit einem berechneten Wert von jeweils EUR 1,00 und mit voller Gewinnanteilberechtigung ab und einschließlich des Geschäftsjahres 2011 (die „Angebotsaktien“). Davon stammen (i) 6.000.000 Inhaberstückaktien aus einem unentgeltlichen Wertpapierdarlehen, welches Luckyway Global Group Limited der biw AG 40 gewährt hat (die „Lieferungs-Aktien“; siehe unten „Lieferung der Angebotsaktien Wertpapierdarlehen“). Um Rückübertragungspflicht Global Group ihre gegenüber Limited und Luckyway aus dem Wertpapierdarlehen zu erfüllen, wird die biw AG die Aktien aus einer Barkapitalerhöhung der entsprechenden Gesellschaft aus genehmigtem Kapital zeichnen, die am oder um den 20. Juni 2011 vom Vorstand beschlossen und vom Aufsichtsrat genehmigt wird, wobei die dann vorhandenen Aktionäre auf ihre Bezugsrechte verzichten. Nach Eintragung der Kapitalerhöhung Gesellschaft in das werden Handelsregister die Aktien aus der der Kapitalerhöhung auf Luckyway Global Group Limited übertragen. (ii) 900.000 Inhaberstückaktien stammen aus einem unentgeltlichen Wertpapierdarlehen, welches Luckyway Global Group Limited, Quick Reach Group Limited, Expert Intelligence Global Limited, Sea Dragon Investments Limited and Hong Kong Investment Group Limited (die „Greenshoe-Aktionäre“) Hinblick auf eine der biw eventuelle AG im Mehrzuteilung gewährt haben (die „Greenshoe-Aktien“). Sowohl die Lieferungs-Aktien Greenshoe-Aktien sind Teil als des auch die aktuellen Grundkapitals der Gesellschaft von 15.050.000 Aktien (die „Bestehenden Aktien“), die zum Börsenhandel am regulierten Markt der Frankfurter Wertpapierbörse zugelassen werden sollen. Angebotsfrist Die Angebotsfrist beginnt voraussichtlich am 20. Juni 2011 und endet voraussichtlich am 29. Juni 2011 und 12.00 Uhr (Mitteleuropäische Sommerzeit („MESZ“). 41 Kaufangebote sind bis zum Ende der Angebotsfrist frei widerruflich. Am letzten Tag der Angebotsfrist können Kaufangebote von privaten und institutionellen Anlegern bis 12:00 Uhr (MESZ) abgegeben werden. Preisspanne und Die Preisspanne, innerhalb derer Kaufangebote Platzierungspreis abgegeben werden können, beträgt EUR 9,00 bis 12,00 pro Angebotsaktie. Nach Ablauf der Platzierungspreis Angebotsfrist für die („Platzierungspreis“) werden der Angebotsaktien sowie das Platzierungsvolumen von der Gesellschaft und den Übernehmenden Banken anhand des im Bookbuilding-Verfahren erstellten gemeinsam festgelegt. Der sowie Platzierungsvolumen das Orderbuchs Platzierungspreis werden auf Grundlage der von den Investoren während der Angebotsfrist erteilten Aufträge festgelegt und im Orderbuch gesammelt. Es ist vorgesehen, dass der Platzierungspreis im Anschluss an Platzierungspreises die in Festlegung Form einer des Ad-hoc Mitteilung über ein elektronisch betriebenes Informationssystem und auf der Internetseite der Gesellschaft (www.csg-ag.de) am 29. Juni 2011 veröffentlicht wird. Insbesondere für Platzierungsvolumen den nicht Fall, dass das ausreicht, um sämtliche Kaufaufträge zum Platzierungspreis zu bedienen, behalten sich die Übernehmenden Banken das Recht vor, Kaufaufträge ganz oder teilweise abzulehnen. 42 Änderungen der Die Gesellschaft behält sich, in Abstimmung mit Angebotsbedingungen den Übernehmenden Banken, das Recht vor, die Anzahl der Angebotsaktien zu verringern, die obere und/oder untere Grenze der Preisspanne zu ermäßigen oder zu erhöhen und/oder die Angebotsfrist zu verlängern oder zu verkürzen. Wenn die Option zur Änderung der Anzahl der Angebotsaktien, der Preisspanne und/oder der Angebotsfrist (zusammen die „Angebotsbedingungen“) ausgeübt wird, und soweit dies nach dem Wertpapierprospektgesetz erforderlich ist, wird ein Nachtrag zum Prospekt bei der BaFin eingereicht und nach erfolgter Billigung durch die BaFin auf der Internetseite der Gesellschaft (www.csg-ag.de) veröffentlicht. Soweit dies rechtlich erforderlich ist, werden alle Änderungen auch in einer Ad-hoc Mitteilung veröffentlicht. Eine individuelle Unterrichtung der Anleger erfolgt nicht. Lieferung der Die Lieferung der Angebotsaktien Angebotsaktien und voraussichtlich Wertpapierdarlehen Ablauf der Angebotsfrist gegen Zahlung des zwei Platzierungspreises erfolgt Bankarbeitstage an die nach Übernehmenden Banken (oder den Abrechnungsagenten). Luckyway Global Group Limited wird einen Wertpapierdarlehensvertrag abschließen und gemäß diesem Vertrag der biw AG insgesamt 6.000.000 Inhaber-Stückaktien kostenfrei durch ein unentgeltliches Wertpapierdarlehen gewähren, um die rechtzeitige Lieferung dieser Aktien an die Investoren zu erleichtern. Die Greenshoe-Aktionäre 900.000 werden der biw Inhaberstückaktien “Greenshoe-Aktien”) im Rahmen AG (die eines unentgeltlichen Wertpapierdarlehens für eine eventuelle Mehrzuteilung zur Verfügung stellen (siehe „Greenshoe-Aktien, Greenshoe-Option“). 43 Mehrzuteilung/ Im Zusammenhang mit der Platzierung der Stabilisierung Angebotsaktien können im rechtlich zulässigen Umfang und im Angebot Zusammenhang mit Mehrzuteilungen dem und Stabilisierungsmaßnahmen von VISCARDI als Stabilisierungsmanager vorgenommen werden, um den Börsen- oder Marktpreis der Aktien der Gesellschaft zu stützen und einen bestehenden Verkaufsdruck auszugleichen. Stabilisierungsmaßnahmen können mit dem Zeitpunkt der Aufnahme der Börsennotierung der Bestehenden Aktien der Gesellschaft eingeleitet werden und müssen spätestens am 30. Kalendertag danach abgeschlossen werden. Greenshoe-Aktien, Die Greenshoe-Aktionäre werden der biw AG Greenshoe-Option vor der Zuteilung der Angebotsaktien 900.000 Inhaberstückaktien (die “Greenshoe-Aktien”) (maximal 15% der insgesamt zuzuteilenden Lieferungs-Aktien) im Rahmen eines unentgeltlichen Wertpapierdarlehens für eine eventuelle Mehrzuteilung zur Verfügung stellen. Die Greenshoe-Aktionäre werden der biw AG die Option einräumen, die Greenshoe-Aktien von den Greenshoe-Aktionären Platzierungspreis zum abzüglich vereinbarter Provisionen und sonstiger Kosten zu erwerben („Greenshoe-Option“), wodurch sie der Verpflichtung zur Rückübertragung aus dem Wertpapierdarlehen nachkommen. Allgemeine Die Gesellschaft, die Greenshoe-Aktionäre und Zuteilungskriterien die Übernehmenden „Grundsätze für Banken die werden Zuteilung die von Aktienemissionen an Privatanleger“ beachten, die am 7. Juni 2000 Börsensachverständigenkommission Bundesministerium herausgegeben wurden. 44 der von der beim Finanzen Mindestzuteilung Sobald das Orderbuch geschlossen wurde, wird eine etwaige Mindestzuteilung festgelegt, und gemäß den Zuteilungsgrundsätzen veröffentlicht. Es besteht kein Recht auf eine Zuteilung. Alleiniger Globaler VISCARDI AG, Brienner Str. 1, 80333 München, Koordinator Deutschland VISCARDI AG, Brienner Str. 1, 80333 München, Gemeinsame Buchführer, Deutschland Transaktionsführende biw Bank für Investments und Wertpapiere AG, Banken und Hausbroicher Übernehmende Banken Deutschland Verkaufsagenten DAB bank AG, Landsberger Str. 300, 80687 Str. 222, 47877 Willich, München, Deutschland comdirect bank AG, Pascalkehre 15, 25451 Quickborn, Deutschland Cortal Consors S.A., Zweigniederlassung Deutschland, Postfach 1743, 90006 Nürnberg, Deutschland S Broker AG & Co. KG, Karl-Bosch-Str. 10, 65203 Wiesbaden, Deutschland Asiasons WFG Securities Pte Ltd, 5 Shenton Way, #28-01, UIC Building, Singapur 068808 ING-DiBa AG, Theodor-Heuss-Allee 106, 60468 Frankfurt am Main, Deutschland Zulassung zum Ein Antrag auf Zulassung sämtlicher bis zu Börsenhandel und zur 21.050.000 Börsennotierung einschließlich Aktien der der Gesellschaft Aktien aus der Kapitalerhöhung zum Regulierten Markt an der Frankfurter Wertpapierbörse zusammen mit der Zulassung zum Teilbereich des Regulierten Marktes mit weiteren Zulassungsfolgepflichten (Prime Standard) wird voraussichtlich am 29. Juni 2011 eingereicht. Die Notierungsaufnahme der Bestehenden Aktien wird voraussichtlich am zweiten 45 Bankarbeitstag nach Ablauf der Angebotsfrist, d.h. am 1. Juli 2011, und die Notierungsaufnahme Kapitalerhöhung der wird Bankarbeitstage Aktien d.h. der voraussichtlich zwei Eintragung der nach Kapitalerhöhung, aus am 13. Juli 2011, erfolgen. Vorzeitige Beendigung Der Übernahmevertrag, der kurz nach dem des Angebots Datum dieses Prospekts unter anderem von der Gesellschaft, den Greenshoe-Aktionären sowie den wird, Übernehmenden sieht vor, Banken dass die abgeschlossen Übernehmenden Banken den Übernahmevertrag bei Vorliegen von bestimmten Umständen kündigen können. Dies ist auch nach Lieferung der Aktien möglich. Im Falle einer Kündigung des Übernahmevertrags vor Lieferung der Aktien findet das Angebot nicht statt. In einem solchen Fall werden Aktienzuteilungen an die Investoren ungültig und die Investoren haben keinen Lieferungsanspruch. Ansprüche aus gezahlten Zeichnungsgebühren und den Investoren im Zusammenhang mit entstandenen Kosten ausschließlich nach der Zeichnung bestimmen den sich rechtlichen Verhältnissen zwischen dem jeweiligen Investor und der Institution, bei der dieser ein Kaufangebot abgegeben hat. Marktschutzvereinbarung Die Gesellschaft verpflichtet sich gegenüber den (Lock-Up) Übernehmenden Banken, für einen Zeitraum von 6 Monaten ab dem Tag der Notierungsaufnahme der Bestehenden Aktien der Gesellschaft Zeitraum von 6 sowie für Monaten einen ohne weiteren vorherige schriftliche Zustimmung der Übernehmenden Banken: (a) 46 keine Kapitalerhöhung aus genehmigtem Kapital durchzuführen; (b) keine Kapitalerhöhung ihrer Hauptversammlung vorzuschlagen; (c) keine Emission von mit Wandlungs- oder Optionsrechten auf Aktien Gesellschaft der ausgestatteten Finanzinstrumenten und keine anderen wirtschaftlich vergleichbare Transaktionen anzukündigen, durchzuführen oder ihrer Hauptversammlung vorzuschlagen; (d) weder mittelbar noch unmittelbar Aktien der Gesellschaft anzubieten, zu zu verkaufen, vermarkten, zu vertreiben, zu übertragen, zu belasten oder in anderer Weise darüber zu verfügen; (e) keine Transaktionen Derivativgeschäfte) den oben (einschließlich durchzuführen, genannten die wirtschaftlich entsprechen. Luckyway Global Group Limited verpflichtet sich gegenüber den Übernehmenden Banken, für einen Zeitraum von 12 Monaten ab dem Tag der Notierungsaufnahme der Bestehenden Aktien der Gesellschaft Zeitraum von sowie 6 für Monaten einen ohne weiteren vorherige schriftliche Zustimmung der Übernehmenden Banken: (a) die oben genannten Maßnahmen weder zu initiieren noch ihnen zuzustimmen; (b) weder mittelbar noch unmittelbar Aktien oder andere Finanzinstrumente der Gesellschaft zu verkaufen, anzubieten, zu 47 vermarkten, zu vertreiben, zu übertragen, zu belasten oder in anderer Weise darüber zu verfügen; gleiches gilt für alle Transaktionen, die wirtschaftlich einem Verkauf Ausgabe entsprechen, von Options- Wandlungsrechten Gesellschaft z.B. auf und oder Aktien andere die der vergleichbare Transaktionen (einschließlich Derivativgeschäfte); (c) weder direkt noch indirekt zu veranlassen oder zuzustimmen, Gesellschaft dass Aktien oder Finanzinstrumente, der andere die in Aktien umgewandelt werden können oder ein Recht zum Erwerb Gesellschaft verkauft, von Aktien gewähren, angeboten, anderweitig ausgegeben, vermarktet abgegeben der werden oder oder anderweitig darüber verfügt wird oder ein Angebot bezüglich einer solchen Transaktion bekannt gemacht wird. Weiterhin verpflichten sich Expert Intelligence Global Limited, Hong Kong Investment Group Limited, Quick Reach Group Limited und Sea Dragon Investments Limited gegenüber den Übernehmenden Banken, für einen Zeitraum von 6 Monaten ab dem Tag der Notierungsaufnahme der Bestehenden Aktien der Gesellschaft keine der oben genannten Transaktionen durchzuführen. Diese Marktschutzvereinbarungen sind nicht anwendbar auf die Ausgabe von Aktien zur Finanzierung einer Akquisition oder die Kapitalerhöhung, nach der die Übernehmenden Banken Aktien werden, um 48 der ihre Gesellschaft zeichnen Rückübertragungspflicht gegenüber Luckyway Global Group Limited aus dem Wertpapierdarlehen zu erfüllen. Kosten des Börsengangs Da sich die Kosten des Börsengangs nach der für die Gesellschaft gesamten Anzahl der platzierten Aktien und dem Platzierungspreis, auf deren Grundlage der Provisionsbetrag bestimmt wird, richten, können die Kosten des Börsengangs von der Gesellschaft zu diesem Zeitpunkt nicht zuverlässig eingeschätzt werden. Basierend auf der Preisspanne, schätzt die Gesellschaft, dass sich die von der Gesellschaft zu tragenden Kosten (einschließlich der Provisionen für die Übernehmenden Banken und angenommen, dass die Gesellschaft den gesamten Betrag des freiwilligen leistungsorientierten Erfolgshonorars bezahlt sowie angenommen, dass die Greenshoe-Option in vollem Umfang ausgeübt wird) auf insgesamt zwischen ca. EUR 4,5 Mio. und EUR 5,4 Mio. belaufen werden. Verwendung des Die Gesellschaft plant, den von der Platzierung Emissionserlöses der Angebots-Aktien Nettoemissionserlös auf zur sie entfallenden Finanzierung des weiteren internen und externen Wachstums, einschließlich etwaiger Akquisitionen, zur Umsetzung und Finanzierung ihrer strategischen Ziele sowie für allgemeine Geschäftszwecke zu verwenden. Angenommen, alle Lieferungs-Aktien werden und platziert angenommen, die Greenshoe-Option wird in vollem Umfang ausgeübt, wird der erzielbare Bruttoemissionserlös des Angebots für die Gesellschaft etwa zwischen EUR 54,0 Millionen bis EUR 72,0 Millionen betragen. Unter der weiteren Annahme, dass der auf die Gesellschaft entfallende Nettoemissionserlös des Angebots sich auf etwa EUR 49,5 Millionen bis EUR 66,6 Millionen beläuft, wird Nettoemissionserlös wie folgt verwendet: 49 der · Ungefähr 25% des Nettoemissionserlöses für die Erichtung einer neuen Produktionsanlage in Sichuan; · Ungefähr 25% des Nettoemissionserlöses zur Finanzierung des weiteren Wachstums; · Ungefähr 5% des Nettoemissionserlöses für die Errichtung eines neuen Forschungs- und Entwicklungszentrums; · Ungefähr 25% des Nettoemissionserlöses für die Modernisierung und Erweiterung der Produktionskapazitäten der Fabrik in Guangzhou; · Ungefähr 10% des Nettoemissionserlöses für die Finanzierung Vertriebspartnerschaft der mit exklusiven dem Industriekonzern Saint-Gobain; · Ungefähr 10% des Nettoemissionserlöses als Betriebskapital. Wertpapier-Kenn-Nummer A1EL8Y (WKN) International Securities DE000A1EL8Y8 Identification Number (ISIN) Ticker-Symbol 2.3 8GS Zusammenfassung ausgewählter Finanzangaben Die derzeitige Struktur der Gruppe mit der CSG-AG als Holdinggesellschaft ist im November 2010 durch die Einbringung der Anteile an der HWG HK-Holding als Sacheinlage in die Gesellschaft herbeigeführt worden. Die CSG-AG selbst wurde am 10. Mai 2010 gegründet und am 18. Mai 2010 ins Handelsregister eingetragen. Aus diesem Grunde stehen für die Gesellschaft und für die Gruppe in ihrer gegenwärtigen Form nur der Konzernabschluss der CSG-AG für das Rumpfgeschäftsjahr 2010 (vom Datum der Entstehung der Gruppe am 22. November 2010 bis zum 31. Dezember 2010), in dem die 50 Tochtergesellschaften der CSG-AG zum 22. November 2010 konsolidiert wurden, und der Konzernzwischenabschluss für den am 31. März 2011 abgelaufenen Dreimonatszeitraum, beide aufgestellt nach den International Financial Reporting Standards („IFRS“), wie sie in der EU anzuwenden sind, sowie der Einzelabschluss der CSG-AG nach den Vorschriften des Handelsgesetzbuchs (HGB) für das Rumpfgeschäftsjahr 2010 (von der Gründung der CSG-AG am 10. Mai 2010 bis zum 31. Dezember 2010) als Jahresabschlüsse zur Verfügung. Für die Zeit vor ihrer Entstehung, insbesondere für die Geschäftsjahre 2008 und 2009, verfügt die Gruppe über keine historischen Finanzinformationen und hat daher eine komplexe Finanzgeschichte im Sinne von Artikel 4a der Verordnung (EG) Nr. 809/2004. Der Konzernabschluss der CSG-AG für 2010 sowie der Einzelabschluss für 2010 sind von Grant Thornton geprüft worden, wohingegen der Konzernzwischenabschluss von Grant Thornton einer prüferischen Durchsicht unterzogen wurde. Das operative Geschäft innerhalb der China Specialty Glass-Group wird gegenwärtig ausschließlich getätigt von ihrer hundertprozentigen untergeordneten Tochtergesellschaft HWG-Ltd. mit Sitz in der Volksrepublik China. Am 31. Oktober und 5. November 2007 hat HWG HK-Holding zwei Anteilskaufverträge abgeschlossen und zum am Erwerb sämtlicher 15. Januar 2008 Anteile an wurde der der HWG-Ltd. Erwerb durch Registrierung der zuständigen Behörde wirksam. HWG-Ltd. war während des Berichtszeitraums die einzige operative Tochtergesellschaft der Gruppe von Bedeutung. Deshalb hat HWG-Ltd. Abschlüsse für die am 31. Dezember 2008, 31. Dezember 2009 und 31. Dezember 2010 endenden Geschäftsjahre sowie einen Zwischenabschluss für den am 31. März 2011 endenden Dreimonatszeitraum nach IFRS, wie in der EU anzuwenden, erstellt, um die Vermögens- Finanz- und Ertragslage der letzten drei Geschäftsjahre und des ersten Quartals 2011 im Hinblick auf die Geschäftstätigkeit der China Specialty Glass-Group darzustellen. Diese Abschlüsse wurden von Grant Thornton geprüft mit Ausnahme des Zwischenabschlusses, der von Grant Thornton einer prüferischen Durchsicht unterzogen wurde. Die oben genannten Abschlüsse der HWG-Ltd. stellen keine rechtlich erforderlichen Abschlüsse der Gesellschaft dar, sondern wurden auf freiwilliger Basis für dieses Angebot erstellt. Der Zweck dieser Abschlüsse besteht darin, Investoren einen Vergleich der Entwicklung der VermögensFinanz- und Ertragslage der China Specialty Glass-Group in den letzten drei 51 Jahren und im ersten Quartal 2011 zu ermöglichen. Da sich ferner der Konzernabschluss und der Einzelabschluss der CSG-AG lediglich auf ein Rumpfgeschäftsjahr (2010) Finanzinformationen, die beziehen, in Kapitel 2.4 wurden die „Ausgewählte ausgewählten Finanzangaben“ wiedergegeben werden, den vorgenannten Abschlüssen der HWG-Ltd. und dem Konzernzwischenabschluss der CSG-AG für den am 31. März 2011 abgelaufenen Dreimonatszeitraum entnommen. 2.4 Ausgewählte Finanzangaben In der nachfolgenden Tabelle sind ausgewählte Angaben zu den geprüften Abschlüssen der HWG-Ltd. für die Geschäftsjahre 2008, 2009 und 2010 sowie zu dem jeweils einer prüferischen Durchsicht unterzogenen Zwischenabschluss der HWG-Ltd. und dem Konzernzwischenabschluss der CSG-AG für den am 31. März 2011 endenden Dreimonatszeitraum (alle Abschlüsse nach IFRS, wie in der EU anzuwenden) enthalten. Die Zahlenangaben wurden nach anerkannten Grundsätzen gerundet. Additionen der Zahlenangaben in der Tabelle können daher zu anderen als den ebenfalls in der Tabelle dargestellten Summen führen. HWG-Ltd. Ausgewählte Finanzangaben Zum 31. Dezember endendes Geschäftsjahr 2008 2009 2010 (geprüft)¹ (geprüft)¹ (geprüft)¹ EUR EUR Tausend % EUR Tausend % Tausend % Ausgewählte Angaben aus der Gewinn-und Verlustrechnung Umsatzerlöse 40.216 100% 50.910 100% 69.564 100% Herstellungskosten -23.000 57% -28.032 55% -38.111 55% Bruttoergebnis Aufwendungen für Verkauf und Vertrieb 17.216 43% 22.878 45% 31.453 45% -1.205 3% -1.704 3% -2.277 3% -848 2% -874 2% -1.038 1% -965 3% -1.384 3% -1.878 3% 14.198 35% 18.916 37% 26.260 38% Verwaltungsaufwand Kosten für Forschung und Entwicklung Ergebnis aus Geschäftstätigkeit Finanzerträge Finanzierungskosten Ergebnis vor Ertragssteuer Ertragssteuern Periodenüberschuss 51 0% 47 0% 108 0% -104 0% -106 0% -110 0% 14.145 35% 18.857 37% 26.258 38% -3.545 9% -4.726 9% -4.006 6% 10.600 26% 14.131 28% 22.252 32% Ausgewählte Angaben aus der Bilanz 52 Summe der Vermögenswerte Summe der Verbindlichkeiten Summe des Kapitals Ausgewählte Angaben aus der Kapitalflussrechnung Cash flow aus Geschäftstätigkeit Cash flow aus Investitionstätigkeit Cash flow aus Finanzierungstätigkeit Zahlungsmittel zum Periodenende Verzinsliche Bankverbindlichkeiten Nettovermögen (Zahlungsmittel abzüglich Verbindlichkeiten) 24.892 31.753 59.651 12.604 6.904 10.299 12.288 24.849 49.352 10.841 11.548 22.343 -710 -185 -4,706 -5.725 -7.672 859 14.330 16.811 37.801 1.383 1.604 1.813 12.947 15.207 35.988 Weitere ausgewählte Finanzinformationen Bruttoergebnis-Marge 42,8% 44,9% 45,2% EBIT 14.198 18.916 26.260 EBIT-Marge 35,3% 37,2% 37,7% Nettoergebnis-Marge 26,4% 27,8% 32.0% 467 464 451 Zahl der Beschäftigten ¹ Geprüfte Finanzangaben mit Ausnahme von “Weitere ausgewählte Finanzinformationen”, die sich aus den geprüften Abschlüssen berechnen bzw. ableiten lassen HWG-Ltd. Ausgewählte Finanzangaben Am 31.März 2011 endender Dreimonatszeitraum (prüferische Durchsicht)1 EUR Tausend Am 31.März 2010 endender Dreimonatszeitraum (prüferische Durchsicht)1 EUR Tausend % % Ausgewählte Angaben aus der Gewinn-und Verlustrechnung Umsatzerlöse 16.441 Herstellungskosten Bruttoergebnis Aufwendungen für Verkauf und Vertrieb Verwaltungsaufwand Kosten für Forschung und Entwicklung Ergebnis aus Geschäftstätigkeit 100% 11.454 -8.850 54% -6.451 56% 7.591 46% 5.003 44% -609 4% -441 4% -326 2% -190 2% -391 2% -338 3% 6.265 38% 4.034 35% 79 0% 18 0% -30 0% -22 0% 6.314 38% 4.030 35% -950 5% -685 6% 5.364 33% 3.345 29% Finanzerträge Finanzierungskosten Ergebnis vor Ertragssteuer Ertragssteuern Periodenüberschuss Ausgewählte Angaben aus der Bilanz² Summe der Vermögenswerte 100% 61.998 53 59.651 Summe der Verbindlichkeiten Summe des Kapitals Ausgewählte Angaben aus der Kapitalflussrechnung Cash flow aus Geschäftstätigkeit Cash flow aus Investitionstätigkeit Cash flow aus Finanzierungstätigkeit Zahlungsmittel zum Periodenende Verzinsliche Bankverbindlichkeiten Nettovermögen (Zahlungsmittel abzüglich Verbindlichkeiten) 9.627 10.299 52.371 49.352 3.019 6.114 -2.368 -2 -142 -22 36.700 24.668 1.624 1.747 35.076 22.921 46,2% 43,6% Weitere ausgewählte Finanzinformationen Bruttoergebnis-Marge EBIT 6.265 4.034 EBIT-Marge 38,1% 35,2% Nettoergebnis-Marge 32,6% 29,2% 456 456 Zahl der Beschäftigten ¹ Die Zwischenfinanzangaben wurden einer prüferischen Durchsicht unterzogen. ² Die in der Rubrik „Ausgewählte Angaben aus der Bilanz“ für 2010 ausgewiesenen Zahlen entstammen dem geprüften Abschluss der HWG-Ltd. zum 31. Dezember 2010. CSG-AG Ausgewählte Konzern-Finanzangaben Am 31.März 2011 endender Dreimonatszeitraum (prüferische Durchsicht)1 EUR Tausend Zum 31. Dezember 2010 endendes Rumpfgeschäftsjahr (geprüft) EUR Tausend % Ausgewählte Angaben aus der Konzern-Gewinn-und Verlustrechnung Umsatzerlöse 16.441 100% Herstellungskosten -8.850 54% Bruttoergebnis Aufwendungen für Verkauf und Vertrieb 7.591 46% Verwaltungsaufwand Kosten für Forschung und Entwicklung Ergebnis aus Geschäftstätigkeit -609 4% -440 3% -391 2% 6.151 37% 37 0% -26 0% 6.162 37% -950 5% 5.212 32% Finanzerträge Finanzierungskosten Ergebnis vor Ertragssteuer Ertragssteuern Periodenüberschuss Ausgewählte Angaben aus der Konzernbilanz Summe der Vermögenswerte 62.728 60.374 Summe der Verbindlichkeiten 10.051 10.563 Summe des Kapitals 52.677 49.811 54 % Ausgewählte Angaben aus der Konzern-Kapitalflussrechnung Cash flow aus Geschäftstätigkeit Cash flow aus Investitionstätigkeit Cash flow aus Finanzierungstätigkeit Zahlungsmittel zum Periodenende Verzinsliche Bankverbindlichkeiten Nettovermögen (Zahlungsmittel abzüglich Verbindlichkeiten) 2.516 -2.386 -138 36.739 37.912 1.624 1.813 35.115 36.099 Weitere ausgewählte Konzern-Finanzinformationen Bruttoergebnis-Marge EBIT 46,2% 6.151 EBIT-Marge 37,4% Nettoergebnis-Marge 31,7% Zahl der Beschäftigten 456 ¹ Die Zwischenfinanzangaben wurden einer prüferischen Durchsicht unterzogen. 2.5 Zusammenfassung der Risikofaktoren Potentielle Anleger sollten die nachfolgend beschriebenen Risiken sowie die anderen in diesem Prospekt enthaltenen Informationen sorgfältig lesen und abwägen, bevor sie die Entscheidung zum Kauf von Aktien der China Specialty Glass AG treffen. Das Eintreten eines oder mehrerer dieser Risiken, entweder einzeln oder zusammen mit anderen Umständen, kann sich wesentlich nachteilig auf die Geschäftstätigkeit der China Specialty Glass AG und/oder ihre direkten bzw. indirekten Tochtergesellschaften auswirken und/oder die Finanzlage und das Betriebsergebnis der China Specialty Glass AG erheblich beeinträchtigen. Die Reihenfolge der Beschreibung der Risikofaktoren ist kein Hinweis auf die Wahrscheinlichkeit des Eintretens eines solchen Risikos oder auf die Schwere bzw. Bedeutung der einzelnen Risiken. Gleichzeitig basieren diese Risikofaktoren auf Vermutungen, die sich zu einem späteren Zeitpunkt als unzutreffend herausstellen können. Darüber hinaus können weitere Risiken oder Faktoren, von denen die Gesellschaft derzeit keine Kenntnis hat, von Bedeutung sein, die Geschäftstätigkeit der China Specialty Glass-Group schädigen und ihre Finanzlage sowie ihr Betriebsergebnis erheblich beeinträchtigen. Infolge des Eintretens solcher Risiken könnte der Börsenkurs der Aktien der Gesellschaft erheblich sinken. Anleger könnten ihr investiertes Kapital ganz oder teilweise verlieren. 55 Risiken im Zusammenhang mit der Geschäftstätigkeit der China Specialty Glass-Group · Die Märkte für Sicherheitsglas und Bauglas, in denen die Gruppe tätig ist und ihre Produkte vertreibt, sind von Wettbewerb geprägt. Steigender Wettbewerb könnte sich negativ auf die Gruppe auswirken. · Der Vertrieb eines erheblichen Teils der Produkte der China Specialty Glass-Group unterliegt sowohl Pflichtzertifizierungen in China (China Compulsory Certification), die von einem zugelassenen Zertifizierungsinstitut ausgestellt werden, als auch Genehmigungsbögen für die Anmeldung der Produktion von Sicherheitsprodukten, die vom örtlichen Pendant des Ministeriums für Öffentliche Sicherheit ausgestellt werden, und sollte es nicht gelingen, diese Zertifizierungen oder Genehmigungsbögen zu erlangen oder erneuern, so könnte dies den Verkauf der entsprechenden Produkte behindern. · Die Geschäftstätigkeit der Gruppe hängt größtenteils von der Nachfrage nach Panzerglas seitens chinesischer Kreditinstitute (z.B. Banken) und Automobilhersteller, die Um-/Nachrüstungen vornehmen, ab. · Die Gruppe ist in einem hochregulierten Markt tätig und ist abhängig von der Beibehaltung der Möglichkeit, ihre Produkte an Kunden aus sensiblen Bereichen der chinesischen nationalen Sicherheit und des chinesischen Finanzwesens zu verkaufen. · Die China Specialty Glass-Group Betriebsunterbrechungen, technischen Schwierigkeiten unterliegt Risiken Qualitätsproblemen sowie Risiken im und in Form von unerwarteten Zusammenhang mit Produktsicherheit, Arbeitssicherheit und Umweltschutz. · Steigende Materialpreise und Lohnkosten können die Rentabilität der Geschäftstätigkeit der China Specialty Glass-Group beeinträchtigen. · Eine hohe Mitarbeiterfluktuation kann negative Auswirkungen auf die Gruppe haben. · Der Vorstand der Gesellschaft hat keine Erfahrung mit den gesetzlichen Vorschriften für börsennotierte Unternehmen in Deutschland und hat keine Deutschkenntnisse und nur ein Vorstandsmitglied spricht englisch. Zusätzlich verfügt die Gruppe derzeit nur über kleine Abteilungen für Finanzen und Buchhaltung mit wenig Erfahrung und darüber hinaus über 56 keine Rechtsabteilung. Zudem verfügt die Gesellschaft derzeit über kein umfassendes Risikomanagementsystem oder umfassendes internes Kontrollsystem. · Da alle Mitglieder des Vorstands außerhalb Deutschlands leben und zwei Mitglieder des Aufsichtsrats in Deutschland wohnen, kann der Aufsichtsrat der Gesellschaft unter Umständen Schwierigkeiten bei der hinreichenden Überwachung des Vorstands haben. · Der Expansionsplan der Gruppe, eine Produktionsstätte in Chengdu, China, aufzubauen, könnte fehlschlagen. · Sollte es der Gruppe nicht gelingen, ihre Expansionspläne durchzuführen und ihr Wachstum erfolgreich zu gestalten, könnte dies die zukünftige Leistung der Gruppe negativ beeinflussen. · Die internationale Expansionsstrategie der Gruppe könnte fehlschlagen. · Die Gruppe könnte auf Schwierigkeiten stoßen, strategische Akquisitionen von Geschäften und Technologien vorzunehmen. · Die China Specialty Glass-Group ist unter Umständen nicht in der Lage, ihr geistiges Eigentum und Know-how hinreichend zu schützen und dieses Eigentum bzw. Know-how könnte durch Dritte verletzt werden. · Die China Specialty Glass-Group könnte Rechte Dritter am geistigen Eigentum verletzen und könnte gezwungen sein, sich solche Rechte von Dritten lizenzieren zu lassen, um tätig zu werden. · Die Gesellschaft ist unter Umständen nicht in der Lage, neue Produkte herzustellen, die ausreichend kommerzielle Akzeptanz erhalten. · Die Exklusivvertriebsvereinbarung mit dem Industriekonzern Saint-Gobain kann fehlschlagen oder nicht gewinnbringend sein. · Mängel bei Produkten der China Specialty Glass-Group oder unsachgemäße Handhabung der Produkte können zu einer Rufschädigung der Gruppe führen und die Geschäftstätigkeit der Gruppe beeinträchtigen. · Die China Specialty Glass-Group ist unter Umständen nicht ausreichend versichert, um ihre potentiellen Risiken zu decken. · Der Gruppe könnte es nicht gelingen, Schlüsselpersonal zu binden und einzustellen, was die zukünftige 57 Leistung der Gruppe negativ beeinflussen könnte. · Die Gesellschaft und/oder die Gruppe sind unter Umständen nicht in der Lage, eine hinreichende Finanzierung sicherzustellen, um das Wachstum der Gruppe zu finanzieren. · Guangzhou Property Management Center hat die Formalitäten für die Landnutzungsrechte hinsichtlich einer Fläche von 53 m2 und einem separaten zugeordneten Grundstück von 9.416 m2, auf denen Gebäude an HWG-Ltd. vermietet sind, noch nicht abgeschlossen und könnte infolgedessen die Berechtigung verlieren, die Gebäude weiter zu nutzen. · Die Gruppe ist Risiken Rechtstreitigkeiten, im Zusammenhang Verwaltungsverfahren, Schadenersatzansprüchen ausgesetzt, mit potentiellen Bußgeldern insbesondere im oder Hinblick auf Entschädigung von Aktionären, vermeintliche Patentverletzungen sowie Garantieansprüchen aus Produkthaftung. · Die China Specialty Glass-Group muss unter Umständen zusätzliche Zahlungen für Sozialversicherung und Zuschüsse zum Eigenheimerwerb (housing funds) leisten. · Die Interessen des derzeitigen Großaktionärs Luckyway Global Group Limited können zu den Interessen der Gesellschaft und anderer Aktionäre in Widerspruch stehen. Diese Interessenskonflikte können verstärkt werden, da Luckyway Global Group Limited von Mitgliedern des Vorstands kontrolliert wird. · Die Gruppe unterhält Geschäfts- und Rechtsbeziehungen für ihre Geschäftstätigkeiten mit Unternehmen und Personen, die mit der China Specialty Glass-Group oder deren Vorstandsmitgliedern in Zusammenhang stehen, und wird diese auch weiterhin unterhalten. · Die Gruppe ist Wechselkursschwankungen und potentiellen Devisenbeschränkungen ausgesetzt. · Der bedeutendste Vermögensgegenstand in der Bilanz der Gesellschaft ist die HWG HK-Holding, welche im Wege einer Sachkapitalerhöhung eingebracht worden ist. Eine außerordentliche Abschreibung der HWG HK-Holding hätte negative Auswirkungen auf die Finanz- und Ertragslage der Gesellschaft. · Die Gesellschaft wurde 2010 zur Holdinggesellschaft der China Specialty 58 Glass-Group, kurz Aktiengesellschaft nachdem sie wirtschaftlich nach deutschem neugegründet wurde, Recht und als verfügt deshalb nur über eine kurze Finanzgeschichte, was sich auf die Qualität und Vergleichbarkeit der Finanzinformationen der China Specialty Glass-Group auswirken könnte. · Die Steuerlast der Gruppe kann infolge von Steuerprüfungen oder aufgrund der deutschen Gewerbesteuer steigen. · Der Steuerstatus der China Specialty Glass-Group als „Hochtechnologie-Unternehmen“ als Begünstigte des Steuerabkommens zwischen China und Hongkong oder als „steuerlich im Inland ansässiges Unternehmen“, die Steuergesetzgebung oder deren Auslegung können sich verändern, was die Steuerlast der Gruppe erhöhen könnte. · Es bestehen mehrere steuerliche Risiken, die zu höheren Steuerverbindlichkeiten für HWG-Ltd. oder die Gruppe führen könnten. · Die Geschäftstätigkeiten der operativen Gesellschaft der China Specialty Glass-Group unterliegen den Gesetzen und Vorschriften mit Bezug auf Umweltschutz und werden diesen auch weiterhin unterliegen. · Es könnte angenommen marktbeherrschende werden, Stellung im dass chinesischen HWG-Ltd. eine Sicherheitsglassmarkt zukommt und HWG-Ltd. könnte daher gewissen Beschränkungen des chinesischen Kartellrechts unterworfen werden. Risiken im Zusammenhang mit dem politischen, sozialen und rechtlichen Umfeld der Volksrepublik China · Die Geschäftstätigkeit, finanzielle Lage, das Betriebsergebnis und die Perspektiven der Gruppe könnten durch das wirtschaftliche, politische und rechtliche Umfeld sowie die wirtschaftlichen, politischen und rechtlichen Entwicklungen in China negativ beeinflusst werden. · Die chinesischen „Bestimmungen zur Akquisition inländischer Unternehmen durch ausländische Investoren“ (die M&A-Bestimmungen) können zu erheblichen Beeinträchtigungen für die Gesellschaft führen. · Die Gesellschaft ist eine Holdinggesellschaft und unterliegt typischen Risiken aus ihren Holdingtätigkeiten, z.B. hängt ihre Liquidität davon ab, ob sie Zugang zu den liquiden Mitteln ihrer operativen Tochtergesellschaft mit Sitz in China hat. 59 · Die SAFE Regulations in Bezug auf Offshore-Investments von Bürgern der Volksrepublik China oder Inhabern eines chinesischen Passes können die Geschäftstätigkeiten und Finanzierungsalternativen der Gesellschaft beeinträchtigen. · Die Regelungen der Volksrepublik China für Darlehen und direkte Kapitalanlagen von Offshore-Muttergesellschaften an Unternehmen der Volksrepublik China können dazu führen, dass die China Specialty Glass-Group die Erlöse dieses Angebots nur verzögert oder gar nicht nutzen kann, oder können die Gruppe daran hindern, die günstigste Finanzierungsstruktur anzuwenden. · Die wirtschaftliche Instabilität in China kann die Geschäftstätigkeit der Gruppe beeinträchtigen. · Eine Destabilisierung des politischen Systems kann die wirtschaftliche Liberalisierung Chinas bedrohen und sich negativ auf die Geschäfte der Gruppe auswirken. · Epidemien oder Ausbrüche ansteckender Krankheiten, einschließlich Vogelgrippe, können die chinesische Wirtschaft und die Geschäfte der Gruppe wesentlich beeinträchtigen. · Das Rechtssystem der Volksrepublik China sowie regionale und nationale Steuergesetze beinhalten inhärente Unklarheiten und Unstimmigkeiten, was Unsicherheit bezüglich der Geschäfte der Gruppe schaffen kann. · Die mangelnde Unabhängigkeit und begrenzte Erfahrung der Justiz, Schwierigkeiten bei der Durchsetzung von Gerichtsurteilen sowie der Ermessensspielraum der Regierung gerichtlichen Entscheidungen bei der Vollstreckung aus können dazu führen, dass die China Specialty Glass-Group keine wirksamen Rechtsbehelfe im Rahmen einer Gerichtsverhandlung erhalten kann. · Die Anerkennung und Durchsetzung ausländischer Urteile in China gegen die Gesellschaft, ihr Vermögen, Führungspersonal oder Vorstände könnte für Investoren schwierig oder unmöglich sein. · Ausländischen Investitionen in Unternehmen der Volksrepublik China können Beschränkungen auferlegt werden. 60 Risiken im Zusammenhang mit dem Angebot · Die Gesellschaft kann nicht garantieren, dass sich ein öffentlicher Börsenhandel mit Aktien der Gesellschaft entwickelt. · Ein volatiler Börsenkurs für die Aktien kann sich entwickeln. · Der Übernahmevertrag könnte aufgehoben werden, woraufhin das Angebot nicht stattfinden würde. · Die Gruppe tätigt ihre Geschäfte durch ihre Tochtergesellschaften und ist demzufolge jetzt und auch in Zukunft in hohem Maße davon abhängig, dass die Tochtergesellschaften Dividende an die Gruppe bezahlen, damit die Gruppe wiederum die Mittel dafür hat, Dividende an ihre Aktionäre auszuschütten. · Für Anleger, die den Aktienkaufpreis fremdfinanzieren, kommt es zu einem erhöhten Verlustrisiko. 61 3. RISK FACTORS The risks described below and the other information contained in this Prospectus should be carefully read and considered by future investors before they reach a decision whether to purchase shares in the Company. The occurrence of these risks alone or in combination with other circumstances may materially affect the cash flow and business of China Specialty Glass-Group as well as its financial condition and results of operations. Moreover, the share price could fall significantly if any of these risks were to materialize, in which case the investors could lose part or all of their investment. Additional risks and uncertainties, which are currently not known to the Company or which the Company currently believes are immaterial, could likewise impair the business operations and have a material adverse effect on the cash flow, the results of operations and the financial condition of China Specialty Glass-Group. Investors should pay particular attention to the fact that the operating entity of the Group is incorporated in China and governed by a legal and regulatory environment which in various aspects may differ from that of other countries. The order in which the risks are presented does not necessarily reflect the likelihood of their occurrence or the magnitude of their potential impact on the cash flows, results of operations and financial condition of China Specialty Glass-Group, its ability to continue as a going concern or the price of the shares. 3.1 Risks Related to China Specialty Glass-Group’s Business 3.1.1 The Markets for Security Glass and Construction Glass in which the Group Operates and Distributes its Products Are Competitive. Increasing Competition Could Have Negative Effects on the Group. The Group operates mainly in China and especially in the niche security glass market with a limited number of competitors. In future, the Group plans to build up new capacities especially for the much larger Construction Glass Market. Due to the large number of competitors in the Chinese Construction Glass Market, the competition in this market is significantly higher than in the security glass market. Irrespective of the current competition in the security glass market or Construction Glass Market, it cannot be ruled out that the competition in both markets will increase through the market entry of new competitors or by market expansion of current competitors. In addition, China Specialty Glass-Group and its operating company HWG-Ltd. are smaller than some of their current or potential future competitors. These competitors may have greater financial, technical, operational and marketing 62 resources than the Group. They may be able to respond more rapidly or more effectively to new or emerging technologies, changes in customer preferences, supplier related developments or shifts in the business landscape. They may devote greater resources than the Group to the development, promotion, sale, and after-sales support of their products, thus making their products more attractive to customers. Some of the Group's current or potential competitors may have broader and more trusted customer bases and more extensive or deeper supplier and other industry relationships that they can use to retain their current customers and to attract new customers. Some of these companies may have more established and larger customer support organizations. In addition, they may adopt more aggressive pricing policies or offer more attractive terms to customers than they currently do, or than the Group is able to offer, or they may bundle their competitive products with broader product offerings and may introduce new and improved products. Current and potential competitors might merge or otherwise establish cooperative relationships with each other or with third parties to enhance their products or market position. As a result, it is possible that new competitors or new relationships between existing competitors may emerge and may rapidly acquire a significant market share to the detriment of the Group's business. The Group’s competitors may improve the features and performance of their current products and introduce new technologies, products and services. Successful new product introductions or enhancements by its competitors could reduce the Group’s sales or market acceptance of its products, causing intense price competition and making its products less attractive to its customers or even obsolete. To remain competitive, the Group must intensify its investment in and continue to invest significant resources in, amongst other things, research and development, sales and marketing and customer support. There can be no assurance that the Group will have sufficient resources to make these investments or that it will be able to make the technological advances necessary for its products and services to remain competitive. Increased competition could result in price reductions, fewer or smaller customer orders, reduced margins and loss of market share of China Specialty Glass-Group. 63 3.1.2 The Sale of a Substantial Portion of China Specialty Glass-Group’s Products is Subject to China Compulsory Certifications Issued by a Qualified Certification Institution and Approval Certificates for Production Registration of Security Products Issued by the Local Counterpart of the Ministry of Public Security and Failure to Obtain or Renew these Certifications or Certificates Could Hinder the Sale of the Respective Products. The sale of the Group’s security glass, e.g. bulletproof glass products, is subject to obtaining China Compulsory Certifications issued by a qualified certification institution (“3C Certification”) which have to be renewed annually. The production and sale of bulletproof glass products is also subject to obtaining approval certificates for production registration of security products issued by the Guangdong Administration of Public Security. Such certificates are valid, in general, for four years and are subject to annual review. Apart from one certification for the sale of two types of security glass, the Group has normally obtained the required certifications and certificates as well as the renewal and annual review of the certifications for its products until now. Nevertheless, the Group cannot exclude that it will fail in the future to obtain or to have renewed the necessary certifications or certificates for its products which could hinder the sale of the respective products and substantially reduce the Group’s sales. 3.1.3 The Group’s Business Depends Largely on the Demand for Bulletproof Glass by Chinese Financial Institutions (e.g. Banks) and Refitting Automotive Manufacturers. The demand of Chinese banks and refitting automotive manufacturers for bulletproof glass contributed in aggregate approximately 82%, 89% and 89% to China Specialty Glass-Group’s total revenues in 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively. The Group distributes its bulletproof glass through its own distribution network to its commercial customers, i.e. the Group sells directly to the financial institutions and refitting automotive manufacturers. In doing so the Group has to comply with the purchase policies of their customers; in particular the Group has to participate in bidding processes and to maintain business relationships with competent procurement managers of such financial institutions and refitting automotive manufacturers. In this respect the future growth of the Group will depend on the Group’s ability to maintain and improve these business relationships, in particular since the Group also generates further sales of bulletproof glass through referrals within the 64 banking and automotive industry. Any failure by the Group to maintain and to develop its business relationships with Chinese financial institutions and refitting automotive manufacturers and their relevant purchasers could have a material adverse affect on the Group’s business. 3.1.4 The Group Operates in a Highly Regulated Market and Depends on Maintaining its Ability to Sell its Products to Customers in the Sensitive Areas of Chinese Internal Security and Finance. The Group operates its security glass business in the sensitive areas of Chinese internal security and finance. It cannot be excluded that companies, especially state-owned banks, or government institutions may in future be obliged to purchase security sensitive products from Chinese companies as opposed to foreign-owned companies. The Group cannot rule out that its business relationships, especially with state-owned banks, might be negatively affected by the indirect transfer of its subsidiaries in the People’s Republic of China (“PRC”) to the Company. Any failure by the Group to maintain its ability to sell its products to its customers, especially state-owned banks, could have a material adverse affect on its business. 3.1.5 China Specialty Glass-Group is Subject to Risks of Interruptions in Operation, Quality Problems and Unexpected Technical Difficulties, as well as to Product Safety, Occupational Safety and Environmental Risks. Despite the technical and safety standards which the Group applies to the operation and maintenance of its production facilities, the risk of operational disturbances which have occurred in the past cannot be excluded in the future. Although HWG-Ltd. intends to use some of the proceeds of the Offering to modernize HWG-Ltd.’s production facilities, China Specialty Glass-Group might be burdened with greater expenditures for repair and maintenance than competing companies with more modern production facilities. Especially production stoppage due to the older or outdated parts of the production facilities can adversely affect the performance of the Group. Furthernore, HWG-Ltd. may be forced to provide large financial outlays at short notice in order to purchase new production facilities and equipment. In addition, interruptions in production, product quality problems and unexpected technical difficulties may be caused by (i) external factors, which the Group is unable to influence, such as natural disasters including earthquakes, flooding or lightning, war, electricity shortages, acts of terrorism, international conflicts, governmental policies or decrees, and 65 general strikes, or by (ii) internal factors, which the Group can partially influence such as technical interruptions, material defects, accidents or mistakes in operational procedures that cause fire, explosion or release of toxic or hazardous substances. In all of these cases humans, third party property or the environment may sustain damage resulting in material financial liabilities for the Group. Damage of this kind may have civil or criminal law consequences and may lead to the closure of relevant production facilities. If any of the operational or environmental risks occur, the Group’s business, financial condition and results of operations may be adversely affected. 3.1.6 Rising Material Prices and Labour Costs Could Adversely Affect the Profitability of China Specialty Glass-Group’s Business. China Specialty Glass-Group’s production and profitability depend, amongst other factors, on the availability and purchase price of raw materials such as normal flat glass and chemical materials such as Polyurethane (“PU”), Polyvinyl Butyral (“PVB”) films or Polycarbonate (“PC”). Raw material purchase and direct labour costs account for the majority of the Group’s total expenses. The raw material prices are subject to fluctuations. If the raw materials required by China Specialty Glass-Group for its business activities are not available or if significant price changes in raw material costs occurs, in particular for normal flat glass, and the Group is not able to pass on to customers price increases of such materials in the future, this could adversely affect the profitability of China Specialty Glass-Group’s business. The entire workforce of HWG-Ltd., which is currently China Specialty Glass-Group’s sole operating company, is located in China. Over the last two years, labour costs amounted to less than 6% of the Group’s entire costs of sale. These labour costs include wages, social security contributions and other welfare benefits. Over the last years, wages have increased. Thus, when comparing the average salary paid to employees who work for companies which are not exclusively owned by an individual or individuals in Chinese urban areas in 2009 and those paid in 2008, the average paid salary increased by approximately 12% (Source: National Bureau of Statistics of China, http://www.stats.gov.cn/was40/gjtjj_detail.jsp?searchword= %C6%BD%BE%F9%B9%A4%D7%CA&channelid=6697&record=2.). Moreover, a significant increase in the minimum wages has taken place in the last years: the minimum wages paid in Guangzhou are regulated by local 66 legislation and have risen from RMB 860 per month (as of 1 April 2008) to RMB 1,100 per month (as of 1 May 2010) and they are expected to increase even further, as minimum wages promulgated by the Guangzhou Administration of Human Resource and Social Security have been increasing steadily over recent years. This increase has a direct effect on the wages paid by China Specialty Glass-Group. Although the Group’s management is of the opinion that the Group has compensated its employees with satisfactory salaries in the past, the Group may be forced to increase wages and other fringe benefits in order to remain an attractive employer. Moreover, labour costs have been affected by new statutory provisions – the PRC Labour Contract Law and its interpretative rules – which came into force on 1 January 2008 and 18 September 2008, respectively. These regulations imposed additional obligations on employers and enhanced employee protection measures such as restrictions on the dismissal of employees and the requirement of a severance payment in case an employment contract expires or is terminated. Labour costs in China have risen significantly in recent years and could continue to increase significantly in the future. Furthermore, some companies in China have responded to recent labour unrest with a generous increase in workers’ compensations. Although the management of the Group considers that its labour force has been fairly treated and compensated, the possibility cannot be excluded that labour unrest occurs in the Group’s companies in the future. In addition, there is the possibility that new legal provisions will impose further obligations on employers. All these potential developments could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, its financial position and profits. 3.1.7 High Fluctuation of Employees May Have a Negative Effect on the Group. The Group employs local workers as well as workers from other parts of China. One factor that influences employee fluctuation is the return of migration workers to their hometowns during the annual New Year festivals and the risk that some of them may not return to their employers in China’s coastal regions. The Group has experienced fluctuation of its employees in the past and has been able to recruit and train new workers to replace those who have left. However, if this development recurs and if the Group is not able to replace its workforce on time and in quality, a loss of know-how and internal problems in the production processes (e.g. shortage of production staff) cannot be excluded. This could have a negative effect on the business operation, financial position and profitability of the Group. 67 In order to identify satisfactory candidates for its workforce, and to reduce the dependency on migration workers, HWG-Ltd. has signed agreements with universities and colleges for internships. Under such agreements, the universities and colleges supply students to work as interns on HWG-Ltd.’s production lines. Such interns form a significant portion of HWG-Ltd.’s production workforce. If the internship agreements are terminated or not renewed and HWG-Ltd. is unable to reach similar arrangements with other colleges or to replace the interns with other staff, HWG-Ltd. may face difficulties in meeting the demand for its products due to serious shortages in its production staff. In addition, if interns are substituted by permanent employees, HWG-Ltd.’s labour costs may increase significantly. HWG-Ltd.’s business, financial condition and results of operations may be adversely affected if any of the abovementioned risks materialize. 3.1.8 The Management Board of the Company Is Not Experienced with German Legal Requirements for Listed Companies and Has No German Language Skills and Only One Member of the Management Board Speaks English Fluently. In addition, the Group Currently only Has Small Finance and Accounting Departments with Limited Experience. Furthermore, the Group Does Not Have a Comprehensive Risk Management System or Comprehensive System of Internal Control. The Group has no experience in complying with German legal requirements for listed companies. The entire management of the Company resides in China, none of the management team members speaks German and only one member of the Management Board speaks English fluently. The Group currently only has small finance and accounting departments but does not have a legal department, and is not used to dealing with increased legal, accounting, transparency and administrative requirements imposed on a publicly listed company in Germany. The obligation to comply with German standards of orderly accounting, the regulations of law, corporate governance requirements and post-admission obligations, in particular requirements relating to the publication of ad-hoc information, quarterly reports as well as various other reporting, notification and publication obligations resulting from the planned listing of the shares in the Company on the Frankfurt Stock Exchange will put increased demand on its ability to handle legal, compliance, finance and accounting matters. In addition, due to limited experience and resources of these departments, the Group has had and may have difficulties in preparing financial reports on a timely basis. 68 Moreover substantial transactions such as payments of wages and salaries as well as entertainment expenses have been made in cash in the past. Such a huge number of transactions may expose the Group to the risk of misappropriation. A number of contracts of the Group have not been concluded in writing, for example some commercial contracts and employment contracts. In addition, the working hour arrangements for some employees have not been registered with the labour authority and are not fully in compliance with PRC employment regulations. It cannot be excluded that the failure to register the respective employees could lead to additional and unfounded claims in connection with these contracts or arrangements, such as wage claims, being asserted against the respective company of the Group and that after one year of employment without written employment contracts, unfixed-term employment contracts would be deemed to have been concluded with the relevant employees. Additionally, the Group’s risk management system and internal control system and the Group’s written documentation of legal matters such as contracts are basic and may not be adequate as required by law and German standards of orderly accounting. If the Group fails to implement an adequate risk management system and internal control system and to comply fully with post-admission obligations, such failures could lead to penalties and sanctions as outlined under German law. Furthermore, they could also lead to material errors in the financial statements of the Company, the discovery of which after publication of these statements could lead to restatements. Occurrence of such events may have material adverse effects on the business, financial condition, and results of operations as well as the share price of the Company. 3.1.9 As all Members of the Management Board Are Located outside Germany and Two Members of the Supervisory Board Reside in Germany, the Company’s Supervisory Board May Have Difficulties in Adequately Supervising the Management Board. The Company is a holding company in Germany without any significant operational business of its own while the Group’s assets are largely located in China. All members of the Company’s management are located outside Germany due to their attendance to the Group’s business in China and have no German and only limited English language skills. Two of the Supervisory Board members are German citizens, and the remaining member of the 69 Supervisory Board is a PRC citizen. The non-German member of the Supervisory Board has only limited experience in fulfilling his/her obligations arising from the German Stock Corporation Act (Aktiengesetz). The German members of the Supervisory Board also have had and may have difficulties in fulfilling their statutory supervisory duties vis-à-vis the management residing in China as a result of the physical distance to China and language barriers. In addition, the members of the Management Board have only limited experience with German corporate governance requirements and the Management Board’s statutory reporting obligations. Any lack of supervision of the Management Board by the Company's Supervisory Board may have material adverse effects on the business, financial condition, and results of operations of the Company. 3.1.10 The Group’s Expansion Plan to Set Up a Production Base in Chengdu, China, May Fail. The Company intends to increase its production capacities, especially in the field of construction glass, by setting up a new production base in Chengdu, Sichuan Province, China, which is to be operated by its indirect subsidiary HWG-SC. Apart from the usual risks which are related to such an investment (these could be, amongst other things, higher cost than originally planned, difficulties in obtaining required permissions or licences or difficulties in recruiting qualified personnel), the Group faces additional risks related to the timely completion of construction of the production base in Chengdu. The investment in Chengdu is based on a project investment and construction contract between HWG-Ltd. and the Management Committee of Guangdong - (“Management Wenchuan Industrial Committee”) of May Park Administration 2010, under which Committee HWG-Ltd. guarantees a certain investment and tax intensity and undertakes to meet various deadlines for the different plant construction phases. According to a confirmation letter issued by the Management Committee on 18 October 2010 the construction of the said project was delayed due to a change in the location of the construction site which is to be determined by the government. A new site for the project has been selected. However, the Group has not obtained the respective land use right for the land where the site is located yet; it has made advance payments in the context of a bidding process which has not yet been formally completed. The Group expects that the process will be formally completed in the year 2011 and that the land use rights will successfully pass to the Group. However, it cannot be excluded that there will be further delay or that Group will fail altogether to obtain the land use 70 right which could cause the expansion plan of the Group to fail. Furthermore, HWG-Ltd. and the Management Committee have not entered into any new agreement or supplemental agreement for an adjusted construction plan (following the change in the location of the construction site) until now. This means that the relevant clauses (including the clauses concerning the construction deadline) of the project investment and construction contract are not binding. Non-compliance may entitle the Management Committee to repatriate the respective land use right free of any compensation, which could cause the expansion plan of the Group to fail. Investments made by the Group which include the advance payment made in the context of the land use right bidding process and payments for construction work could be lost in this case. However, if the non-compliance by the Company has been caused by the Management Committee, the Company has the right to adjust its investment and tax intensity accordingly. The new production base is the first investment in a production base outside of Guangzhou, Guangdong province, where the currently sole operating company of the Group, HWG-Ltd., is located. Thus, the Group does not yet have any experience in managing such projects in other provinces of China and its lack of experience may lead to mistakes and additional costs. Furthermore, the production base in Chengdu and HWG-SC will be located thousands of miles from Guangzhou, where HWG-Ltd. is headquartered. After the earthquake in the Sichuan province in 2008 the infrastructure is still under reconstruction and the current infrastructure does not ensure an appropriate environment for investments. Furthermore, the geographical distance between the production base in Chengdu and the management of HWG-Ltd. in Guangzhou will make it difficult for HWG-Ltd. to monitor the development of the setting-up of the production base and the post-completion operation of the production base as well as compliance with the local authorities. In addition, the new production base shall mainly focus on glass for the construction glass market. This strategy may fail, in particular, if the Group is not able to reach the required revenues. The average profit margin which the Group may generate in the construction glass business is lower than the profit margin which the Group reaches in the Bank Security Glass or Automotive Security Glass Market. To reach comparable profits or even to avoid losses by manufacturing and selling construction glass from the new production base in Chengdu, the production base in Chengdu has to reach a high utilization rate, which refers to the ratio between actual production 71 output and the available production capacity in the same year (“Utilization Rate”), in connection with a respective market demand. In this respect, a high Utilization Rate of the new production base may be reached with delay, as the Utilization Rate of the current production base was around 55.9% in 2010 (the calculation of the Group’s Utilization Rate is subject to 24 hours operation within a 3 shift model). The Group, however, cannot exclude that in the future the market demand and thus the utilization rates of its production bases will be low or its construction glass will not meet the customers’ expectation. If any of the abovementioned circumstances are to occur, this could have material adverse effects on the business, financial condition and results of operations of the Company. 3.1.11 The Group’s Failure to Execute Its Expansion Plans and Manage Its Growth Successfully Could Adversely Affect the Group’s Future Performance. The Group plans to expand its distribution significantly in the following years, and intends to further advance such growth, in particular, by expanding and strengthening its production capacity, modernising its product lines as well as opening new plants, broadening its marketing and distribution network, investing in an IT-infrastructure, strengthening its research and development activities and introducing new products. There can be no assurance that the Group will be successful, in part or at all, in these activities and thus in gaining additional customers. Any failure, in part or at all, with regard to the aforementioned activities could cause the Group's expenses to grow disproportionately to its revenues, and its revenues to decline or to grow more slowly than expected. Many investments which are planned by China Specialty Glass-Group require high initial expenditures as well as ongoing expenditures for modernisation and expansion. Such investments will only generate profitable return if utilization of the increased production capacity is warranted by the corresponding market demands. Should the Group build up additional capacities that remain unused due to erroneous assessments of the market development, this could jeopardise the Group's profitability to a considerable extent. As the Group expands its operations and market reach, it is expected to increasingly depend on its IT and data processing systems in the future. Efficient and uninterrupted operations of such systems which partially have 72 to be reimplemented could become essential for the Group’s normal business operation. Any untimely and lengthy disruption or interruption of the operation of the IT and data processing systems used by the Group or problems with the implementation of the new IT and data processing systems can affect the ability of the Group to effectively run its business and may therefore adversely affect its financial condition and results of operations. The Group's anticipated future growth, combined with the requirements the Company will face as a public listed company, will place a significant strain on the Company's and the Group’s management, systems and resources. There is a risk that the Company’s and the Group’s management will have difficulty to manage the various planned investments successfully, or will fail to integrate new personnel, operations, technology, software, products and services satisfactorily into its current operations. 3.1.12 The Group’s International Expansion Strategy May Fail. The Company intends to expand the Group’s customer base outside of China, in particular with regard to selected Asian markets. The operations as well as the entry into other international markets will require significant management attention and commitment of financial resources. Multinational operations are subject to inherent risks, including but not limited to: · increased costs in developing and purchasing products that are compatible with varying local needs; · longer accounts receivable collection periods and greater difficulty in accounts receivable collection; · longer sales cycles; · potential foreign exchange and repatriation controls on foreign earnings, exchange rate fluctuations and currency conversion restrictions; · the burden of complying with a variety of foreign laws, including delays or difficulties in obtaining import and export licences, regulations and unexpected changes in the legal and regulatory environment; · difficulties and costs of staffing and managing multinational operations; · potentially adverse tax consequences, including tax consequences which may arise in connection with inter-company pricing for transactions 73 between separate legal entities within a group operating in different tax jurisdictions; · development of and adherence to industry standards in international markets; and · difficulties in establishing strategic partnerships and high marketing expenses to establish brand awareness. The geographic diversification of its sales minimises the Group’s dependence on national legislation as well as the impact of economic changes in single regions. However, the process of internationalisation carries with it a number of risks, such as general political, macro-economic, social, legal, cultural and tax framework conditions in the individual countries, unexpected changes of regulatory requirements and compliance with a multitude of foreign laws and regulations, which contain rules that are unknown to China Specialty Glass-Group and may deviate materially from the standards with which the Group is familiar. Moreover, China Specialty Glass-Group may not be sufficiently familiar with foreign practices and may misjudge the opportunities and risks that present themselves within the relevant markets. 3.1.13 The Group May Experience Difficulties in Making Strategic Acquisitions of Businesses and Technologies. China Specialty Glass-Group may make strategic acquisitions of businesses and technologies that it believes complement or enhance its current business and operations. In pursuing these acquisitions, the Group may face competition from other companies operating in the specialty glass industry in which the Group is engaged. The Group’s ability to make acquisitions may also be limited by applicable antitrust, anti-takeover, foreign exchange control and other regulations in China and/or any of the other jurisdictions in which the Group does business after the expansion. If one or more of these risks materialise, the Group may be unable to make the desired acquisitions or to complete them on terms attractive to the Group. If this occurs, the Group’s ability to grow in certain business areas may be adversely affected. To the extent that the Group is successful in making such acquisitions, the Group may have to expend substantial amounts of cash, incur debt, assume loss-making business units and incur other types of expenses. The Group may also face difficulties in successfully integrating the businesses or technologies it acquires into its existing organization. Each of these risks may have an adverse effect on the Group’s business, cash flows, results of operations and financial condition. 74 3.1.14 China Specialty Glass-Group Might Not be Able to Protect Its Intellectual Property and Know-How Adequately and They Might be Infringed by Third Parties. The Group holds through its operating company HWG-Ltd. patents and other intellectual property rights registered only in China as well as non-patentable or not patented trade secrets and confidential and non-confidential know-how that are important for the business of the Group. The intellectual property laws in China are still evolving, and the levels of protection and means of enforcement for intellectual property rights in China differ from those in other jurisdictions. In the event that the steps the Group has taken and the protection afforded by the relevant Chinese laws do not adequately safeguard the Group’s proprietary technologies or products, it could suffer losses in revenues and profits due to competing companies selling products which are unlawfully produced based on the Group’s proprietary intellectual property. According to PRC patent law, a company should make appropriate bonus and remuneration payments to an employee who is the inventor or designer of a patent owned by the Company. Three employees of the Group are named as the inventors of registered patents of HWG-Ltd. All three employees have given written statements to HWG-Ltd. waiving their respective rights to receive such bonus and remuneration payments. However, it cannot be ruled out that an employee will ask for bonus and remuneration payments in the future. In addition, the patent application process, including maintenance and enforcement, in China is time-consuming and expensive. It cannot be guaranteed that the Group will be granted the necessary patents based on currently pending and future applications. Even if patents raise a presumption of their validity under law, their approval alone does not necessarily ensure that they are valid or that patents claims can be asserted successfully in the required or desired scope. The Group could find it necessary to enforce and protect patents, licences and other intellectual property rights by taking legal action. Such processes can be time-consuming and expensive. Moreover, it cannot be guaranteed that all of the Group's patents are valid or that the Group has sufficient legal protection against infringement and circumvention. In this case, the Group could lose such legal disputes, which could limit, prevent or at least substantially delay the further marketing or launch of such products. The Group also depends on the existence and protection of its trademark 75 rights, which are registered only in China where the Group sells the majority of its products. Trademark protection is mainly guaranteed through the right to take court action against illegal use of a trademark. Effective trademark protection therefore requires extensive control and research. If the Group does not identify the illegal use of its trademarks early enough or at all, or if the Group is unsuccessful in taking court action to protect its trademark rights, this could adversely affect the reputation and image of the Group at customer level or could adversely affect its ability to effectively protect its trademarks. 3.1.15 China Specialty Glass-Group Could Infringe on the Intellectual Property Rights of Third Parties or Have to License Such Rights from Third Parties in Order to Operate. China Specialty Glass-Group owns granted utility patents and pending invention patents relevant for its products and production technologies in China. However, it can not be excluded that the Group’s competitors may have broader patent and other intellectual property rights in and outside of China, causing the Group to infringe on these rights. Thus, the Group may be prevented from using the relevant technologies in the countries in which the Group may distribute its products. This holds true regardless of whether the Group had previously used these technologies in China or other countries in a permitted way and had failed to apply for a patent. In all of these cases, the Group could possibly be denied the opportunity to manufacture or market products, and the Group would then be forced, if applicable, to acquire licences or change manufacturing processes. Moreover, the Group could be obliged to pay damages for patent infringement or infringement of other intellectual property. In addition, the Group’s competitors could prohibit the Group from producing or selling such products in countries in which the respective competitor holds higher priority patent protection. The Group could also be forced to rely on obtaining access to third-party technologies by acquiring licences, which would incur significant costs. Moreover, it cannot be guaranteed that the Group will be able to obtain the licences required for the success of its business at reasonable terms and conditions in the future. In addition, it cannot be guaranteed that licences acquired will be granted in the required scope. 76 Because the Group has neither registered nor applied for registration of any trademark outside China and part of the Group’s products have been exported out of China by the Group’s customers, the possibility that the Group is infringing on third-party rights in connection with trademarks cannot be excluded. Furthermore, the trademark used by the Group is registered in the PRC only for defined products under the category 19 which may not be broad enough to cover all the products of the Group which use the trademark, especially for automotive security glass products. In addition, the Chinese characters of the Hing Wah trademark are not yet registered. HWG-Ltd. has applied for registration and the Chinese trademark office has made preliminary examinations. If the registration of this trademark is unsuccessful, this will hinder its usage which could have an adverse effect on the Group’s business operations. 3.1.16 The Company May Be Unable to Produce New Products That Gain Sufficient Commercial Acceptance. The Group’s success in the business area of security glass and construction glass depends on its ability to develop new, innovative, customer-oriented and competitive products and to produce them timely, cost-efficiently and in quantity that can meet the market demands. The ability to develop products in the security glass and construction glass market and to sell them successfully depends on a number of factors, including, but not limited to the following: · the ability to attract and retain skilled technical employees; · the ability to assess changes in customer preferences and technologies at the relevant point in time; · the ability to successfully complete the development of products in a timely manner; and · the ability to sell products at an acceptable price and quality. Should the Group fail to substantially maintain or further develop its product portfolio of security glass and construction glass, customers may elect to source comparable products from competitors, which could have an adverse 77 impact on the net assets, financial condition and the results of operation. The same adverse effects will apply if the Group is unable to maintain its existing customer relationships or to offer innovative services to its customers. Furthermore, if alternative materials, production processes or technologies are developed or existing ones are improved, this may facilitate the production of new products replacing those currently offered in the security glass and construction glass area. If such newly developed or further improved products are offered at lower prices, have preferable features or other advantages, and the Group is not able to offer similar new or improved products, this may cause material sales losses that have an adverse impact on the net assets, financial condition and the results of operation. 3.1.17 The Exclusive Distributorship Agreement with the Industrial Group Saint-Gobain May Fail or May Not Be Profitable. On 27 May 2011, the Group’s operating company HWG-Ltd. concluded an exclusive distributorship agreement with the Saint-Gobain Group, an industrial group with its headquarters in Courbevoie, France, which produces a range of construction and high-performance materials (“Saint-Gobain”), specifically with the group company Miroiteries du Rhin SAS, Bennwihr, France. According to this agreement, Saint-Gobain grants China Specialty Glass-Group the right to exclusively distribute various glass products (the “Exclusive Products”) in China and a non-exclusive distribution right with regard to certain other products of Saint-Gobain (the “Non-exclusive Products”, together with the Exclusive Products the “Saint-Gobain Products”). The agreement stipulates that HWG-Ltd. shall purchase certain minimum volumes of the Exclusive Products which are specified in the agreement. According to the agreement, a fixed consideration has to be paid for the exclusivity in addition to the respective purchase prices for the delivered Saint-Gobain Products. The exclusive distributorship agreement could turn out to be unprofitable for the Group should the sales volume of the Saint-Gobain Products not reach the level expected by the Group. In particular, the achieved sales volume could be lower than expected due to competitors that sell glass products on the Chinese market which are of a better quality or which are cheaper, especially since the price level for products of a comparable quality is usually lower in China than in Europe. Furthermore, any failure by the Group to meet the minimum purchase volumes for the Exclusive Products within the term determined in the 78 agreement entitles Saint-Gobain to terminate the exclusivity of the distributorship with regard to the Exclusive Products, which could adversely affect the sales of these products by the Group. The purchase prices for the Saint-Gobain Products are renegotiated on a yearly basis. Should the parties of the agreement fail to agree on the future purchase prices either party is entitled to terminate the agreement, in which case part of the fixed consideration, depending on the time of termination, will not be reimbursed. This could have a material adverse affect on the Group’s business, financial condition and results of operations. 3.1.18 Defects or Improper Handling of the China Specialty Glass-Group’s Products Could Result in a Damage of its Reputation and Could Adversely Affect the Group’s Business. Defects or improper handling of the Group’s products may cause serious personal injury when violence or accidents occur, in particular when the security glass does not meet the safety standard for which it was developed and sold. Although there are quality control measures in place, the products may contain undetected defects, especially when first introduced or when new models or versions are released. Should any person be seriously harmed or killed due to product defects or improper handling of the Group’s products, this could significantly damage the reputation of the China Specialty Glass-Group and could result in the rejection of the Group’s products, the loss of customers, the diversion of resources or increased customer service and support costs. Such risks could be amplified in a market segment with a limited number of customers such as the Automotive Security Glass Market in China in which the Group distributes its security glass. Product defects or improper handling of the Group’s products could thus adversely affect the Group’s business, its financial condition and results of operations. 3.1.19 China Specialty Glass-Group May Have Insufficient Insurance to Cover Its Potential Risks. Chinese companies are not required to maintain product liability insurance cover under Chinese law. However, the Group has entered into a product liability insurance agreement with regard to the products with limited insurance cover. It cannot be ruled out that companies of the Group may face product liability claims to an extent which exceeds the cover of its product liability insurance and thus the insurance may be insufficient. Furthermore, the Group cannot exclude that it will be successful in maintaining or concluding product 79 liability insurance agreements at commercially reasonable rates and thus the Group may not be sufficiently insured against future product liability claims. In addition, the Group is subject to numerous other risks including natural disasters, potential business disruptions or potential litigation, for which the Group has not obtained any insurance. Therefore, all potential losses resulting from such risks or business liabilities, loss of data, equipment/machines and employer liabilities or disruption are currently not covered within the Group. Any product defects, business disruptions, litigation or natural disasters might result in the Group incurring substantial costs and may require the reallocation of the Group’s resources. The occurrence of insufficient and uninsured damages could have material adverse effects on the business, financial condition, and results of operations of the Group. 3.1.20 The Group Could Fail to Retain and Recruit Key Personnel, which Could Adversely Affect the Future Performance of the Group. The future performance of the Group will depend largely on its ability to retain its key management, in particular Mr. Nang Heung Sze, the only English speaking member of the management board Mr. Chi-Hsiang Michael Lee and the other directors in its currently sole operating company HWG-Ltd., especially Mr. Chao Zhou, Mr. Chun Li Shi and Mrs. Xueyan Wang. The Group’s future success will also depend upon its ability to recruit or train qualified personnel for its current and future operating companies, in particular for its R&D, management and sales departments. The Group cannot ensure that it will be able to retain and recruit qualified key personnel for its operating companies. Moreover, key personnel might move to competitors or form a competing company and compete with the Group for customers, business partners, and other key professionals of the Group using their experience and expertise or decide not to choose companies of the Group as employer. Although most individuals in key positions within the Group have signed confidentiality and non-competition agreements in simple form in connection with their employment, the Group cannot assure that it will be able to enforce these agreements successfully and prevent its current key personnel from moving to one of its competitors. Furthermore, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”) and the indirect major shareholder, Mr. Nang Heung Sze, had owned or controlled various companies which were active in the glass industry in addition to China Specialty Glass-Group. Although his ownership or control in those companies 80 has almost completely ceased, it cannot be fully excluded that Mr. Nang Heung Sze may divert know-how and future inventions from China Specialty Glass-Group to one of the competing companies if he chooses to leave the Group. This could result in China Specialty Glass-Group losing valuable intellectual property and having to acquire this intellectual property elsewhere. Additionally, the other companies or newly founded companies not belonging to China Specialty Glass-Group, which are or were owned by Mr. Nang Heung Sze could compete with China Specialty Glass-Group and cause the Group to lose a part of its market share. The loss or reduced engagement, for whatever reason (e.g. illness), of any of the aforementioned persons without suitable replacement could have material adverse effects on the business, financial condition and results of operations of the Group. 3.1.21 The Company and/or the Group May Not Be Able to Secure Adequate Financing to Fund the Group’s Growth. In order to finance the Group’s growth strategy, the Company and/or Group may have to raise additional capital in the future through debt or equity offerings. However, the Company and/or the Group cannot be certain that suitable financing will be available at the relevant point in time, in the required amounts or on acceptable terms. If additional equity or equity-like securities are issued by the Company, this may result in the dilution of existing shareholders’ holdings. If any of the abovementioned risks, restrictions or effects materialise, it may have material adverse effects on the Group’s business, financial conditions and results of operation. If additional debt was incurred by the Company and/or the Group, this would result in debt service obligations of the Company and/or the Group which could have a negative impact on their profitability and could increase their vulnerability to general adverse economic and industry conditions or to the materialization of any of the risks mentioned herein. In addition, the terms of any financing agreement of a company of the Group could limit its ability to pay dividends or restrict its flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in its business or its industry. Moreover, HWG-Ltd. has to obtain approval from the Ministry of Commerce or its local counterpart to increase its total investment and is subject to foreign exchange registration if it intends to borrow funds from entities outside of China. Loans borrowed by HWG-Ltd.’s subsidiary HWG-SC from outside China are subject to approval from the National Development and 81 Reform Commission or its local counterpart as well as approval by, and registration with SAFE or its local counterpart. In addition, HWG-Ltd. and HWG-SC will need to obtain approval and complete registration formalities if they intend to secure financing through equity contributions. In the event that HWG-Ltd. and HWG-SC cannot obtain the necessary financing on reasonable terms, or at all, they may be forced to scale back their plans for future business expansion. Furthermore, HWG-Ltd. and HWG-SC are subject to certain restrictions on the amount of foreign debt they can borrow (see also section 3.2.5 “PRC Regulations pertaining to Loans and Direct Capital Investments by Offshore Parent Companies to PRC Entities May Delay or Prevent China Specialty Glass-Group from Using the Proceeds of this Offering or from Adopting the Most Favourable Financing Structure.”). If the Group were not able to provide HWG-Ltd. or HWG-SC with adequate financial resources, this would have a negative impact on the financial conditions of the Group. 3.1.22 Guangzhou Property Management Center has Not Completed Land Use Right Formalities with regard to an Area Covering 53 Square Meters and a Separate Piece of Allocated Land of 9,416 Square Meters on which the Buildings are Leased to HWG-Ltd. and thus Might Not be Allowed to Use the Buildings any more. The granting formalities for a land use right (the right to utilize a certain piece of land; land in urban areas of China belongs to the State and only rights to use are issued to private enterprises or citizens) have not been completed with regard to an area covering 53 square meters and a separate piece of allocated land of 9,416 square meters on which the buildings are leased to HWG-Ltd., the currently sole operating company of the Group. According to the PRC laws, land and buildings are not permitted to be leased before the land use right granting formalities have been completed. The legal consequence of such a lease before completion of the formalities is, with regard to the two pieces of land described above, that the income (i.e. the rental) received by the owner of the buildings, Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center (previously Guangzhou City Liwan District Qianjin Glass Factory) (“Guangzhou Property Management Center”), will be confiscated by the competent authority; and Guangzhou Property Management Center as the lessor will be subject to a certain penalty. 82 Guangzhou Property Management Center’s sole shareholder, Mr. Chun Li Shi, has undertaken to handle the formalities granting the land use right for the area of 53 square meters and the piece of allocated land of 9,416 square meters to achieve a valid lease contract. Furthermore, an additional undertaking to bear any administrative and civil responsibility arising from the failure to complete the formalities has been provided by Guangzhou Property Management Center’s sole shareholder Mr. Chun Li Shi with respect to the allocated land. However, the leases have been registered with the local administration of real estate and the administration has not imposed or indicated any intention to impose any fine or other penalty. Even though no legal penalties have been imposed on HWG-Ltd. under PRC laws, there is a risk that HWG-Ltd. will not be allowed to use the buildings any more, which may have a detrimental impact on the asset, financial and profit situation of China Specialty Glass-Group as well as its general business activities. 3.1.23 The Group Is Exposed to Risks Relating to Potential Legal Disputes, Administrative Proceedings, Fines or Damage Claims, in Particular with Respect to Shareholder Compensation, Alleged Patent Breaches, as well as Warranty Claims from Product Liability. In its operating business, the Group is exposed to liability risks, especially in connection with product liability or warranties. Although the Group has no pending litigation, the outcome of future proceedings cannot be predicted with certainty due to the uncertainties always associated with legal disputes and administrative proceedings. The realisation of one or more legal disputes, proceedings or damage claims could have materially adverse effects on the asset, financial position and results of operation of the Group. 3.1.24 China Specialty Glass-Group May Be Required to Make Additional Payments for Social Insurance and Housing Funds. According to PRC law in general and Chinese regulations for social insurance and housing funds in particular, China Specialty Glass-Group is, amongst others, required to make contributions to the social insurance and housing funds of its employees. In 2006, the Group started to make payments for social insurance to its full time employees, but cannot exclude that additional payments might be requested. In addition, payments with regard to housing funds have not been made. The Group was not obliged to and has therefore not made any provisions relating to possible claims for additional payments. The Company believes but cannot guarantee that such claims would not exceed EUR 264,000 in total as of 31 December 2010. The current indirect 83 major shareholder Mr. Sze has signed a letter undertaking that he will reimburse HWG-Ltd. for any losses incurred due to such outstanding payment obligations. 3.1.25 The Interests of the Current Major Shareholder Luckyway Global Group Limited May Conflict with the Interests of the Company and Other Shareholders. These Conflicts of Interests May Be Amplified as Luckyway Global Group Limited is Controlled by Members of the Management Board. The current major shareholder Luckyway Global Group Limited holds 74.39% of the Company. Assuming placement of all Offered Shares, Luckyway Global Group Limited will hold 53.18% of the shares (or approximately 50.00% if the Greenshoe Option is fully exercised). Luckyway Global Group Limited will still have a significant impact on the important resolutions of the Company. It will still be able to exercise considerable influence on important resolutions of the Company at the General Shareholders’ Meeting of the Company (including the election of the Supervisory Board and the approval of important capital measures). It cannot be ruled out that the interests of Luckyway Global Group Limited could conflict with its duties as a Company’s shareholder to act in the best interests of the Company and/or interests of other shareholders and it could exercise its influence over the Company to the detriment of the Company. Further conflicts may arise due to the fact that Luckyway Global Group Limited is controlled by a member of the Management Board. In this respect, Mr. Nang Heung Sze, who is a member of the Management Board as is his son Mr. Chun Li Shi, controls Luckyway Global Group Limited. Thus, the indirect shareholding of Mr. Nang Heung Sze could conflict with the individual interests of Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi and their office duties as members of the Management Board to act in the best interests of the Company and/or interests of other shareholders. Conflicts of interest could have an adverse effect on the valuation of the Company’s shares, its results of operations and its financial condition. 3.1.26 The Group Maintains and Will Continue to Maintain Business and Legal Relationships for Its Business Operations with Companies or Persons That Are Related to China Specialty Glass-Group or Its Board Members. The Group has entered and will continue to enter into transactions with related persons or related parties. In particular, HWG-Ltd. concluded two 84 trademark license contracts with Mr. Nang Heung Sze in 2005 and 2008. The two trademarks used by HWG-Ltd. as licensee were subsequently transferred from Mr. Nang Heung Sze to HWG-Ltd. according to a trademark transfer agreement concluded in 2010 (the registration of the transfer of one of the two trademarks is still pending and the transfer has therefore not yet become legally effective). In addition, HWG-Ltd. leases office premises and plants under lease agreements entered into with (i) Mr. Chun Li Shi, Chief Operating Officer (“COO”) of the Company and son of Mr. Nang Heung Sze who is the CEO of the Company and its largest indirect shareholder, and (ii) Guangzhou Property Management Center, a company wholly owned and controlled by Mr. Chun Li Shi, respectively. Moreover, loan guarantees were provided by Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi and mortgages were provided by Guangzhou Property Management Center to secure loans borrowed by the PRC subsidiary of the Group in the past and similar guarantees could be provided in the future. At the time of providing such guarantees, Mr. Nang Heung Sze was the actual controller and Mr. Chun Li Shi the director of HWG-Ltd. According to the Company some related party transactions were not concluded at arm’s length, e.g. Mr. Sze granted the use of the trademarks free of consideration to HWG-Ltd. and the payment for one of the lease agreements concluded with a related party in 2010 has been paid in advance for a time period of 29 years. Said related party transactions may cause conflicts between the interests of the Group on the one hand and the interests of persons or companies related to the Group on the other hand. Such conflicts of interest may be resolved to the detriment of China Specialty Glass-Group and could lead, for example, to the conclusion of contractual terms and conditions which are disadvantageous to the Group. There is an increased risk in the case of contracts and relationships with related parties that the contractual terms and conditions are not in line with the market and may diverge from the market standard to the detriment of the Group. The Group has leased all of its office premises and plants from related parties or companies controlled by related parties. Although some of the lease agreements have long periods of validity, it cannot be excluded that, on expiration of the lease terms, the Group cannot lease these office premises and plants at similar market conditions and rates. 85 3.1.27 The Group is Exposed to Fluctuations in Foreign Exchange Rates and to Potential Exchange Restrictions. The single entity financial statements of HWG-Ltd. and the consolidated and single entity financial statements of CSG-AG included in the Financial Section of this Prospectus as well as future financial statements of CSG-AG will be presented in EUR, whereas the Group's operating currency is RMB, which is currently not a freely convertible currency. A devaluation of the RMB versus the EUR would therefore have an adverse currency conversion effect on the Group’s future consolidated financial statements. As the value of the RMB is controlled by PRC authorities, it is also possible that foreign exchange policies of the PRC government could have a significant impact on currency exchange rates. The Company's proceeds from this Offering may decrease in value if the Company chooses not to or is unable to convert the proceeds into RMB and the EUR devalues against the RMB during such period. Fluctuations in currency exchange rates could have material adverse effects on the business, financial condition and results of operations of the Company and the Group. Furthermore, it cannot be excluded that the PRC authorities or other authorities could implement exchange restrictions. This could limit the ability of the Group to pay dividends or to transfer funds between the different companies of the Group. 3.1.28 The Most Significant Asset in the Financial Statements of the Company Is HWG HK-Holding, Which Has Been Contributed through a Capital Increase by Way of Contribution in Kind. An Extraordinary Depreciation of HWG HK-Holding Would Have Negative Effects on the Company’s Financial Position and Profitabilty. The registered share capital of the Company amounts to EUR 15,050,000.00 and is comprised of 15,050,000 ordinary no-par value shares. The registered share capital was mainly generated by means of a capital increase from EUR 50,000.00 by EUR 15,000,000.00 to EUR 15,050,000.00 and the issuance of 15,000,000 no-par value shares against contributions in kind of HWG HK-Holding into the Company. The capital increase became legally effective with its registration with the local court of Munich on 22 November 2010. The capital increase was based on a valuation certificate confirming that the 86 value of HWG HK-Holding is sufficient to cover the registered value of the capital increase. The auditor for contributions in kind performed the evaluation of HWG HK-Holding in accordance with the professional valuation standard in Germany published by the Institute of Accountants/Auditors (IDW S1). The auditor took into consideration the projections made by HWG-Ltd. and arrived at a valuation which is higher than the registered capital of the shares. It cannot be excluded that the company value of HWG HK-Holding would have been valued differently had different enterprise valuation methods and criteria being used. Moreover, the risk that a depreciation of value occurred or will occur after the valuation cannot be excluded either. In case a different value of the contributed shares in HWG HK-Holding materialises, it cannot be excluded that possible differential liability claims are asserted and/or that corrections regarding the valuation approach are made in the statement of financial position. This could again have a negative impact on the company’s financial position. 3.1.29 The Company Became the Holding Company of China Specialty Glass-Group in 2010 Shortly after the Company Was Acquired by the Founding Shareholder Luckyway Global Group Limited and Therefore has a Short Financial History which May Impact the Quality and Comparability of China Specialty Glass-Group’s Financial Information. The Company is a shelf company which was bought by Luckyway Global Group Limited and therefore the Company has no financial history prior to the purchase by Luckyway Global Group Limited in 2010. The financial information included in this Prospectus has been extracted or derived from the financial statements of HWG-Ltd. for the years 2008, 2009, 2010 and the interim financial statements for the first quarter of 2011 as well as consolidated financial statements of CSG-AG for the short financial year 2010 (from 22 November 2010 until 31 December 2010) and the consolidated interim financial statements of CSG-AG for the three months ended 31 March 2011 as well as the single entity financial statements of CSG-AG for the short financial year 2010 (from 10 May 2010 until 31 December 2010). All the aforementioned financial statements have been prepared in accordance with IFRS, as endorsed for application in the EU, with the exception of the single entity financial statements of CSG-AG which are in accordance with the German Commercial Code (Handelsgesetzbuch – HGB). For a number of reasons, the comparability of the financial information presented in this Prospectus is subject to significant limitations. As China 87 Specialty Glass-Group is in constant and rapid growth this time lag affects the direct comparisons between the different financial years. Therefore, the historical financial information included in this Prospectus may not be comparable to future periods and may not be indicative of the Group’s future results of operations, financial condition or cash flow. Any of the above may impact the quality and comparability of China Specialty Glass-Group’s financial information. 3.1.30 The Tax Burden of the Group May Increase as a Result of Tax Audits or as a Result of German Trade Tax. Until today, neither Chinese nor Hong Kong or German tax authorities have exercised their right to conduct a tax audit with respect to companies of the Group. Tax audits are not carried out on a regular basis by the Chinese tax authorities. Future tax audits may reveal that the tax authorities have views on tax regulations and circumstances that are different from those of the Group. In particular, the possibility cannot be excluded that the Group or the companies of the Group will be required to make additional tax payments. Dividend distributions from HWG HK-Holding to the Company are inter alia subject to German trade tax at the level of the Company. A portion of 95% of these dividends is exempt from German trade tax only (i) to that extent that the profit of HWG HK-Holding results from dividend distributions from HWG-Ltd. and HWG-SC in the same business year and (ii) if HWG-Ltd. and HWG-SC qualify as ordinary operating companies in terms of the trade tax participation exemption regime which includes inter alia manufacturing, processing or assembly of tangible property, trade other than with related parties who make profits from such trade that is taxable in Germany and which excludes inter alia raising and lending capital and profit distributions from other companies and (iii) if the Company is able to prove these requirements towards the German Tax Authorities when it applies for such exemption. Otherwise dividend distributions from HWG HK-Holding to the Company are fully taxable for trade tax purposes for the Company. This increases the tax burden of the Company and has a negative impact on its financial situation. In connection with the risk of additional tax payments, there is also an interest risk because, typically after a grace period, interest must be paid on additional tax payments. Furthermore, there is a risk that tax penalties could be triggered in connection with any potential reduction of tax loss carry forwards or additional tax payments. 88 3.1.31 The Tax Status of China Specialty Glass-Group as a “high-tech enterprise”, a beneficiary of the tax arrangement between the PRC and Hong Kong or as a “tax resident enterprise” or Tax Legislation or Its Interpretation Might Change which could increase the Tax Burden of the Group. The PRC Enterprise Income Tax ("EIT") Law was passed in March 2007 and took effect on 1 January 2008, introducing a uniform income tax rate of 25% for all enterprises (including foreign-invested enterprises (“FIEs”) such as HWG-Ltd.). The EIT Law revoked tax exemptions, reductions and other preferential treatment applicable to FIEs prior to 1 January 2008. However, there will be a transition period for enterprises that received such preferential tax treatment prior to the publication of the EIT Law. Unused tax holidays of FIEs approved before the publication of the EIT Law will continue to be effective until they expire. If the tax holidays have not started due to losses, they are to be deemed to commence from the beginning of 2008, i.e. tax holidays can only be utilised until 2012. The EIT Law also stipulates that where a company is a high-tech enterprise encouraged by the state, it may enjoy preferential EIT tax rate of 15%. HWG-Ltd. has obtained a certificate issued by the competent authorities recognizing it as a high-tech enterprise and has obtained a notice from Guangzhou Baiyun District State Taxation Bureau confirming that HWG-Ltd. is entitled to the preferential tax treatment for high tech enterprise for year 2010. The Group benefited from such tax holidays as its EIT tax rate for 2010 has been reduced by 10% from 25% to 15%. However, if in future, HWG-Ltd. no longer meets the criteria for qualifying as a high-tech enterprise, it will no longer enjoy such preferential treatment. Moreover, the provisions of the EIT Law on taxation are regulated by an arrangement concluded between the Mainland China and the Hong Kong Special Administrative Region, the purpose of which is to avoid a double taxation of income, i.e. the imposition of two or more taxes on the same income (the “Tax Arrangement”). According to art. 10 subs. 2 of the Tax Arrangement, dividends paid to Hong Kong residents are subject to taxation in China and the relevant tax rate is 5%, if a beneficiary of dividends is a Hong Kong resident directly holding at least 25% in a company located and subject to taxation in Mainland China. Thus, dividends distributed to HWG 89 HK-Holding by the subsidiary located in Mainland China may be subject to the Tax Arrangement and as a consequence subject to a withholding tax in China at a rate of 5%. Moreover, art. 21 subs. 3 of the Tax Arrangement stipulates that withholding tax paid in China can be credited against Hong Kong taxes (if any) payable by HWG HK-Holding. However, it is possible that HWG HK-Holding is not regarded as a beneficiary within the meaning of the Tax Arrangement. Therefore, there is the risk that the dividends paid by a company from Mainland China to HWG HK-Holding are not subject to the lower withholding tax rate of 5% but the higher tax rate of 10% as imposed under the EIT Law and its Implementing Rules. Furthermore, the EIT Law has introduced the concept of tax resident enterprise ("TRE") according to which an enterprise which is deemed a TRE would be subject to EIT in the PRC at a rate of 25%. Accordingly, if the “de facto management body” of HWG HK-Holding and/or CSG-AG was located in China, they would be subject to EIT in the PRC at a rate of 25% in accordance with the interpretation of art. 4 of the EIT Implementing Rules given by the Chinese State Administration of Taxation on its website (see also section 16.8 “Investment Regulations, Distribution and Transfer Restrictions”). The location of the de facto management body is to be determined by a substance-over-form method. In particular, mere off-shore board meetings are not sufficient for the de facto management body being located outside of China. Currently, HWG HK-Holding is treated as a non-TRE. The Company has only been established for a short period and its tax residence status has not been reviewed. The Company considers neither itself nor HWG HK-Holding to be a TRE. However, since the management of HWG HK-Holding and the Company are mainly located in China, it cannot be ruled out that HWG HK-Holding or the Company will be regarded a TRE. If HWG HK-Holding is regarded as a TRE, the following will apply: in accordance with art. 26 of the EIT Law and art. 83 of the EIT Implementing Rules, dividend distribution to TREs due to direct investments are exempted from EIT. Dividends distributed by HWG-Ltd. to HWG HK-Holding would therefore be exempted from EIT. However, dividends distributed by HWG HK-Holding to the Company would be subject to a withholding tax of 10% according to the EIT Law unless the Company is also regarded as a TRE. If HWG HK-Holding and the Company are both regarded as TREs, the Company would be subject to enterprise income tax in China at a rate of 25%, except that dividends received by the Company from HWG HK-Holding would be exempted from enterprise income tax in China. The PRC withholding tax on 90 dividends will then only be levied if a TRE distributes dividends to non-TRE shareholders. If HWG HK-Holding is not regarded as a TRE, the following applies: According to the EIT Law, the exemption of withholding tax and dividends distributed by foreign-invested enterprises to their foreign investors under the current tax laws is no longer available, therefore any dividends distributed by HWG-Ltd. will be subject to such withholding tax at a rate of 5%. HWG HK-Holding and the Company are holding companies without any significant operations of their own, and much of their income depends on dividends from the operating subsidiary in China. If HWG-Ltd. as the operating subsidiary, or HWG HK-Holding, were required to withhold PRC income tax on dividends paid to China Specialty Glass-Group, this would have a material adverse effect on the amount of dividends paid to the shareholders. The current tax rules and their interpretation relating to an investment in the Group may be subject to further adverse changes in future as the applicable tax rates and exemptions may change. Any change in China Specialty Glass-Group's tax status or in taxation legislation or its interpretation could affect the value of the investments held by the Company, its ability to provide returns to shareholders and/or alter the post-tax returns to shareholders. Statements in this Prospectus concerning the taxation of China Specialty Glass-Group and the Company's investors are based on current tax laws and practices which are subject to change. In addition, the taxation regime applicable in China may change again and could have an adverse impact on the post-tax profits of HWG-Ltd. As almost all operating profits are generated by HWG-Ltd., which is subject to the tax legislation of China, the materialization of the above risks could have a material adverse effect on the business, financial condition and results of operations of China Specialty Glass-Group. 3.1.32 There Exist a Number of Tax Risks which Could Result in Additional Tax Liabilities for HWG-Ltd. or the Group. Before implementation of the new EIT law in 2008, Article 33 of the Implementation Rules of the old EIT law regulated that the residual value of fixed assets should be no less than 10% of the original cost of the fixed 91 assets, unless the prior approval from the competent tax bureau is obtained. In 2007 HWG-Ltd. only claimed 5% residual value of the original cost of fixed assets and no approval was provided. Therefore, it cannot be ruled out that the surplus depreciation in relation to residual values of property, plant and equipment in 2007 may cause additional tax liabilities for the Group. In addition, entertainment expenses claimed by HWG-Ltd. have exceeded the cap under the old and new EIT Law. This could result in additional tax payments for the Group. 3.1.33 The Business Activities of the Operating Company of China Specialty Glass-Group Are and Will Continue to Be Subject to Laws and Regulations Relating to Environmental Protection. The currently sole operating company of the Group HWG-Ltd. is located in China and also manufactures the products of the Group there. With regard to the manufacturing of the Group’s products the operating company is subject to Chinese laws and regulations relating to environmental protection. Such laws and regulations typically cover a wide range of matters, including, amongst other things, waste handling, and protection of the surrounding air and use of water. The Company believes that its subsidiary in China complies in all material aspects with the Chinese environmental legislation currently in force. However, the storage of waste glass can pose an environment and health hazard. Additionally, operating equipment results in noise. Other hazards such as fire, explosion or mechanical failures, which are out of control of the Group, may lead to the discharge of toxic substances into the environment. Occurrence of any of the abovementioned risks could lead to serious personal injuries, damage to the environment and/or destruction of the Group’s equipment, plants and other assets. This in turn could lead to production stoppage, fines and penalties imposed by the relevant authorities, substantial expenses required to remedy the damage to the environment and potential damage claimed by employees or customers. Furthermore, there is a risk that the laws and regulations applicable to the operating company may become more stringent and require an increased level of investment by the Group to comply with such standards of environmental safety. In addition, the operating company is required to hold certain environmental permits, to obtain approval of environment impact assessment report (“EIAR”) and to inspections for its activities and facilities. 92 pass environmental protection The necessary environmental permits are normally issued for a limited period and must be renewed upon expiry. Any failure by the operating company to renew its environmental permits or the revocation of such permit could prevent it from operating the facilities that require the said permit and may result in fines. The authorities may also impose some conditions or emission limits upon the renewal of a permit, which could result in increased costs and capital expenditure. Should the Group fail to comply with the laws and regulations relating to the environmental protection, this could adversely affect the Group's business, its financial condition and results of operations. 3.1.34 HWG-Ltd. May be Presumed to have Market Dominance in the Chinese Security Glass Market and Therefore May be Subject to Restrictions under the PRC Anti-Monopoly Law. Due to HWG-Ltd.’s extensive market share in the Chinese securities glass market, it is likely that HWG-Ltd. will be presumed to have market dominance and therefore may not abuse its dominance to eliminate or restrict competition. This means that HWG-Ltd. may be subject to certain restrictions under the PRC Anti-Monopoly Law and in particular, may not engage in any of the following: · selling goods at an unfairly high price or purchasing goods at an unfairly low price; · selling goods at below cost without legitimate reason; · refusing to deal with trade counterparties without legitimate reason; · restricting trade counterparties to deal exclusively with it or with business operators designated by it without legitimate reason; · selling goods through a tying arrangement without legitimate reason or imposing other unreasonable trade conditions in the course of trading; · treating equally qualified trade counterparties differently in terms of transaction price or other such transaction conditions without legitimate reason; or · carrying out other acts which are regarded by the authorities as abuse of market dominance. 93 If HWG-Ltd. should abuse its market dominance, the PRC Anti-Monopoly Law enforcement authority might order it to cease its illegal acts, confiscate its illegal income and fine it not less than 1% and not more than 10% of its sales turnover for the preceding year. Furthermore, if HWG-Ltd’s wrongful acts cause third parties to incur losses, it shall compensate such losses. Furthermore, due to HWG-Ltd.’s dominant market position, the Group’s ability to make acquisitions and strategic investments with respect to competitors may also be limited by applicable merger control laws in China and/or any of the other jurisdictions in which the Group does business. If HWG-Ltd. is presumed to have a dominant position and contravenes any of the above restrictions, this could adversely affect the Group's business, its financial condition and results of operations. 3.2 Risks Related to the Political, Social and Legal Environment of the People’s Republic of China 3.2.1 The Group’s Business, Financial Condition, Results of Operations and Prospects Could Be Adversely Affected by the Economic, Political and Legal Environment and Developments in China. All of China Specialty Glass-Group’s business operations are conducted by its currently sole operating company in China HWG-Ltd. and all of its revenues are generated by it. Investors should thus be aware that the Group’s operations are subject to greater risks than operations in more developed markets, including significant legal, economic and political risks. Moreover, emerging economies such as China are subject to rapid change and the information set out herein may therefore become outdated quickly. Investments in emerging markets or in companies that operate in emerging markets are generally exposed to additional risks and are generally only suitable for sophisticated investors who fully appreciate the significance of the risks involved. Investors are urged to consult with their own legal and financial advisors before making an investment. 3.2.2 The Chinese “Provisions on the Acquisition of Domestic Enterprises by Foreign Investors” (the M&A Provisions) May Have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company. On 8 August 2006, six Chinese regulatory agencies, including the Ministry of Commerce ("MOFCOM") and the China Securities Regulatory Commission ("CSRC"), promulgated the Provisions for the Acquisitions of Domestic 94 Enterprises by Foreign Investors ("M&A Provisions"), which came into effect on 8 September 2006 and were further amended by MOFCOM on 22 June 2009. The M&A Provisions regulate, amongst other things, an offshore special purpose vehicle which is controlled directly or indirectly by Chinese legal entities and / or individuals for the purpose of offshore listing of the interests in a domestic company that it actually owns (“SPV”). The M&A Provisions provide that an SPV must obtain the approval of the CSRC prior to the listing and trading of its shares on a foreign stock exchange. On 21 September 2006, the CSRC published a notice specifying the documents and materials required to be submitted to it by SPVs seeking CSRC approval of a foreign listing. A number of additional requirements must be fulfilled in the course of an initial public offering, the violation of which may lead to regulatory actions or other sanctions by the CSRC or other Chinese regulatory agencies. In addition to the provisions relating to foreign indirect listings, the M&A Provisions also stipulate that domestic companies, enterprises or natural persons shall, when they merge or acquire domestic companies related to them in the name of the companies in foreign countries legally established or controlled by them, be submitted to the MOFCOM for approval. The person concerned shall not evade the above requirements by domestic investment of foreign-invested enterprises or by other means. Various transactions were concluded during the corporate restructuring that took place within the Group prior to the listing of the Company. The Company believes that the M&A Provisions relating to foreign indirect listings neither apply to the direct transfer of the shares in HWG-Ltd. to HWG HK-Holding, to their indirect transfer to the Company nor to the initial public offering of the Company’s shares because HWG-Ltd. was a foreign-invested enterprise before the M&A Provisions came into effect. Therefore HWG-Ltd. has obtained approval of the share transfer to HWG HK-Holding under the applicable “Provisions for the Alteration of Investors' Equities in Foreign-funded Enterprises” and has not applied for approval under the M&A Provisions. However, there can be no assurance that CSRC or the MOFCOM will agree with this view and not require respective approvals in connection with the recent corporate restructuring or in connection with the listing of the Company's shares. In addition, it cannot be ruled out that CSRC or the MOFCOM will ultimately refuse to grant such approval. If an approval is required and as long as such approval has not been granted, CSRC or another competent government authority could prevent profits from being distributed by HWG-Ltd. to HWG HK-Holding and to the Company and/or loans from being granted or equity 95 investment being made by HWG HK-Holding or the Company to HWG-Ltd. or HWG-SC. 3.2.3 The Company Is a Holding Company and Faces Typical Risks from its Holding Activities, e.g. its Liquidity Depends upon Having Access to the Liquid Funds of Its Operating Subsidiary Located in China. The Company is a holding company without any significant operating business of its own. Most of the Company’s assets are located in Hong Kong and China. The financial success and continued business of the Company depends largely on the financial position, profitability and success of its holdings in the Group’s companies. The Company is not able to sufficiently finance its running expenses by means of own revenues (excluded are revenues from shares in companies). If there is no distribution of profits from the shares, the financial position and profitability of the Company can sharply deteriorate and consequently endanger the existence of the Company. Current PRC regulations permit the payment of dividends only out of accumulated profits determined in accordance with Chinese accounting standards and regulations. In addition, if a subsidiary of the Group does not constitute a sino-foreign joint venture under PRC law, it is required to set aside at least 10% of its post-tax profits each year to fund a statutory reserve fund until such reserves in aggregate reach 50% of its registered capital. Furthermore, wholly foreign-owned enterprises may be required to set aside a portion of their post-tax profits to fund an employee welfare fund in an amount which lies within the discretion of the subsidiary's board. These reserves are not distributable as cash dividends. Under PRC foreign exchange rules and regulations, payments of current account items, including profit distributions and operating-related expenditures, may be made in foreign currencies without prior approval but are subject to procedural requirements. Strict foreign exchange controls continue to apply to capital account transactions. These transactions must be approved by, and / or registered with SAFE or its local counterparts, and repayment of loan principals, distributions of returns on direct capital investment and investments in negotiable instruments are also subject to restrictions. There can be no assurance that the Group will be able to meet all of its foreign currency obligations under PRC laws or to transfer profits out of China. Should any of the PRC subsidiaries of the Group be, or become, restricted and/or legally prohibited from and/or unable to pay dividends or 96 other distributions outside of China, this could have material adverse effects on the Company’s financial condition. Further, it is to be explicitly emphasized that any deterioration of the economic situation or - in the extreme case - any insolvency of either a subsidiary or of a company in which China Specialty Glass AG holds shares would have a direct negative impact on the Company. There is also the risk of possible adjustments on the value of interests and write-offs of receivables as well as lacking profits from profit and loss transfers, profit sharing, interest rate agreements or capital gains. In case one of these risks is realised, it would have a negative impact on the results of operation of the Company and could possibly even endanger the existence of the Company. 3.2.4 SAFE Regulations Relating to Offshore Investments by PRC Residents or Passport Holders May Adversely Affect the Company’s Business Operations and Financing Alternatives. In October 2005, the State Administration of Foreign Exchange issued a regulation regarding offshore investments by PRC residents, known as SAFE Notice 75. It requires PRC residents to register with, and receive approval from SAFE or its local counterparts in connection with certain offshore investment activities. According to the Company none of the current direct or indirect shareholders of the Company are PRC residents, which means legal entities established in the PRC or individuals who are PRC identity card holders, PRC passport holders or individuals who habitually reside in the PRC for reasons related to economic interests. Mr. Nang Heung Sze who is an indirect shareholder through Luckyway Global Group Limited is a Hong Kong permanent resident. Therefore, the Company is of the view that Mr. Nang Heung Sze is not required to register with, and receive approval from SAFE concerning Notice 75. However, there can be no assurance that SAFE will agree with this view, even if Mr. Nang Heung Sze who applied for such a registration with Guangzhou SAFE in June 2010 was explicitly told by Guangzhou SAFE without receiving a written statement that he was not required to make such a registration. It cannot be ruled out that Guangzhou SAFE or another competent authority may change its legal view in the future and will require Mr. Nang Heung Sze to register with and receive approval from SAFE concerning Notice 75. The failure or inability of any of the Company's current or future direct or indirect shareholders, whose actions the Company does not control, to obtain any required approvals or to make any required registrations in a timely 97 manner could subject China Specialty Glass-Group to fines and legal sanctions, restrict the Company's intended investments in its PRC subsidiaries or limit the Group’s ability to make distributions or pay dividends. Thus, if the competent authority were to change its legal view, the failure of Mr. Nang Heung Sze to make the registration could subject him and the Group to fines, legal sanctions and restriction regarding the investments in HWG-Ltd. or limit the Group’s ability to make distributions or pay dividends on the ground of failure to register the offshore investments with SAFE on time. 3.2.5 PRC Regulations relating to Loans and Direct Capital Investments by Offshore Parent Companies to PRC Entities May Delay or Prevent China Specialty Glass-Group from Using the Proceeds of this Offering or from Adopting the Most Favourable Financing Structure. In utilising the proceeds of this Offering to finance the Group’s business, the Company, as a holding company, or HWG HK-Holding, may make loans or additional capital contributions to HWG-Ltd. and/or HWG-SC, subject to certain conditions and official approvals and/or registrations as further discussed below. Loans to HWG-Ltd. Any loans by an offshore parent company to a foreign invested enterprise (“FIE”) established by it are subject to registration requirements and must be within the margin between each of their total investment amount and registered capital as approved by the Ministry of Commerce or its local counterparts. The approved amount of total investment of HWG-Ltd. is the same as its registered capital. Therefore, unless HWG-Ltd., the PRC subsidiary of the Company which qualifies as an FIE under PRC Law, obtains requisite approval to increase its total investment, it is not allowed to borrow funds from outside China, and any additional offshore funding to HWG-Ltd. will have to be in the form of equity investment. Whether HWG-Ltd. can obtain such approval or whether the approved amount can satisfy the needs of HWG-Ltd. will be subject to the statutory provisions on the minimum ratio of registered capital in total investment as well as the discretion of the local approval authority. Furthermore, loans to HWG-Ltd. as a FIE have to be registered with SAFE or its local counterpart. 98 Loans to HWG-SC The current plan of the management of the Group is to finance HWG-SC’s production base and its operation by using HWG-Ltd.’s profits. If HWG-Ltd.’s profits are not sufficient, HWG-SC will have to be financed by loans or capital contribution from the Company or HWG HK-Holding or through other channels such as loans from banks. There can be no assurance that HWG-SC can obtain sufficient or any loans from banks. At the end of 2010 a loan of RMB 33 million with a term until December 2015 was granted by HWG-Ltd. to Mr. Sze Nang Heung; of this amount, RMB 6 million had to be repaid by Mr. Sze to HWG-Ltd. for the settlement of his current account with HWG-Ltd. Mr. Sze transferred the net amount of the loan of RMB 27 million to HWG-SC for the purpose of its working capital and assigned to HWG-Ltd. his rights from the loan. In March 2011 a similar loan agreement was concluded between HWG-Ltd. and Mr. Sze under which Mr. Sze received a loan of RMB 20 million which he will eventually grant to HWG-SC. The term of this loan is from 23 March 2011 to 25 March 2016. HWG-SC is not regarded as a FIE but a domestic company under PRC law with respect to foreign exchange. On this basis, medium or long-term loans borrowed by HWG-SC from the Company or HWG HK-Holding or any other entity outside China are subject to approval from the National Development and Reform Commission (“NDRC”) and SAFE. If HWG-SC intends to obtain short-term loans (with a term of less than one year) from the Company or HWG HK-Holding or any other entity outside China, they are subject to the balance management implemented by the State, that is to say SAFE would issue an external loan quota at the beginning of every year providing the total amount of the external loans the domestic Chinese companies could take out during this year. In addition, such short-term loans are also subject to the approval of the local SAFE. Capital Contributions to HWG-Ltd. and/or HWG-SC In addition, if the Company or HWG HK-Holding finances HWG-Ltd. and/or HWG-SC through additional capital contributions, such additional capital contributions must first be approved by, and registered with the competent government authority. On 29 August 2008 SAFE promulgated Circular 142, a notice regulating the conversion by a FIE of foreign currency in its capital account into Renminbi by restricting how the converted Renminbi may be used. Circular 142 prohibits the use of Renminbi converted from foreign capital to purchase equity interests in Chinese companies, unless the equity investment is within 99 the approved business scope of the FIE and has been approved by SAFE, or has been “otherwise provided for”. In addition, SAFE increased its supervision of the flow and use of the registered capital of a FIE settled in Renminbi converted from foreign currencies. The use of such Renminbi capital may not be changed without SAFE’s approval and may not in any case be used to repay Renminbi loans if the proceeds of such loans have not been used. Violations of Circular 142 will result in severe penalties, such as significant fines. Due to such restrictions, if the proceeds of the Offering are injected into HWG-Ltd. as capital contribution, HWG-Ltd. as a FIE cannot use such capital to make equity investment in HWG-SC or any other entities. The Group may therefore not be able to use the proceeds of the Offering to equity invest unless such investments are made by the Company directly or through HWG HK-Holding. Furthermore, there is no assurance that entities invested into by the Company or HWG HK-Holding will enjoy the same level of preferential tax or other treatments that may be available to entities invested into by HWG-Ltd. There can be no assurance that the Group will be able to obtain the relevant government registrations or approvals in time, if at all, with respect to future loans or capital contributions by the Company or HWG HK-Holding to HWG-Ltd. and/or HWG-SC. If the Group fails to obtain such registrations or approvals, the ability to use the proceeds of this Offering and its ability to fund and expand the operational business in China could be adversely affected, which could have material adverse effects on the business, financial condition and results of operations of the Group. 3.2.6 Economic Instability in China Could Adversely Affect the Group’s Business. The Chinese economy differs from the economies of most developed countries in many aspects, including the amount of government involvement, the level of development, the growth rate, the control of foreign exchange, and the allocation of resources. While the Chinese economy has grown significantly over the past 30 years, the growth has been uneven geographically among various sectors of the economy, and throughout different periods. There can be no assurance that the Chinese economy will continue to grow, or that if there is growth, such growth will be steady and uniform, or that if there is a slowdown, such slowdown will not have a negative effect on the Group's business. For example, the Chinese economy experienced an accelerated growth in 100 2010 when it overtook Japan to become the world’s second-largest economy behind the US. The gross domestic product (“GDP”) growth of 10.3% last year easily exceeded the 9.2% GDP growth for 2009. This rapid growth was partially contributed to by the increase in exports as the world’s other economies were recovering from the worst global financial and economic crisis in decades, by the increase in domestic consumption and heavy capital investments as the various government economic stimulus policies took effect. Fearing rising inflation and potentially losing control of the economic growth, PRC central government began to introduce macroeconomic measures and monetary policies at the beginning of 2010 to prevent the economy from becoming overheated. The People’s Bank of China (“PBC”) raised the statutory reserve requirement ratio for banks six times and increased interest rate twice in 2010 to soak in the excess liquidity in the economy and to fight inflation. However, although down from 5.1% in November, which was the fastest drop in more than two years, China’s consumer price index still rose to 4.6% year-on-year in December 2010. For the first three months this year, China’s consumer price index increased from 4.9% during the first two months to 5.4% in March. There can be no assurance that these measures will be effective in keeping growth of the economy at a more sustainable level and preventing the inflation from getting out of control. In addition, such measures, even if they benefit the overall Chinese economy in the long-term, may adversely affect the Group if they reduce the business activities of its end customers such as banks. Furthermore, it is uncertain how long the global financial crisis will continue or rather how much adverse impact it will have on the Chinese economy in general and on the Group’s end customers in particular. 3.2.7 A Destabilization of the Political System Could Threaten China’s Economic Liberalization and Have a Negative Impact on the Group’s Business. While the PRC economy has changed fundamentally from a centrally controlled system to a more market-oriented economy over the last three decades, the political system in China still operates under communist control. Although political conditions in China seem to be generally stable, changes may occur in the political system which might affect the ownership or operation of the Group's interests, including, amongst others, changes in government as well as in legislative and regulatory regimes. 101 A material change in China’s economic liberalization triggered by political disruptions or by other means could impact the country’s economic growth in general and the Group’s business in particular. Social instability could increase public support for renewed centralized authority, and nationalism or violence could lead to a tougher stance by the Chinese government on foreign investors operating in China or on foreign investment in general. Any such developments could have material adverse effects on the business, financial condition and results of operations of the Group. 3.2.8 Health Epidemics and Outbreaks of Contagious Diseases, Including Avian Influenza, Could Materially and Adversely Affect the Chinese Economy and the Group’s Business. The Group’s business could be adversely affected by the effects of avian influenza or other epidemics or outbreaks. In recent years, there have been reports of occurrences of avian influenza in various parts of China, including a few confirmed human cases and deaths. Any prolonged recurrence of avian influenza or other adverse public health developments in China may have a material adverse effect on the Group's business operations. These could include illness and loss of its management and key employees, as well as temporary closure of its offices and related other businesses upon which the Group relies. Such losses would severely disrupt the Group’s business operations. The Group has not adopted any written preventive measures or contingency plans to combat any future outbreak of any epidemic. Since most of the Group's operations and substantially all of the Group’s suppliers are based in China, an outbreak of contagious diseases in China, other places in Asia, or elsewhere, or the perception that such an outbreak could occur, as well as the measures taken by the governments of countries affected, could have material adverse effects on the business, financial condition and results of operations of the Group. 3.2.9 The PRC Legal System and Regional and National Taxation Laws Contain Inherent Uncertainties and Inconsistencies which Can Create Uncertainty regarding the Group’s Business. As the Group’s business is currently mainly conducted from China, its operations are governed principally by PRC laws. China is still in the process of developing a comprehensive statutory framework, and its legal system is still considered to be underdeveloped in comparison with legal systems in most western countries. In particular, PRC foreign investment laws and company law as well as provisions for the protection of shareholders’ rights 102 and access to information are less developed and confer less protection than those applicable to companies incorporated in Germany or other member states of the European Economic Area (“EEA”). The following factors create uncertainty with respect to the Group’s business: · inconsistencies between and among the constitution, national law, government decrees as well as governmental, ministerial and local orders, decisions, resolutions and other acts; · conflicting local, regional and national rules and regulations; · inconsistent use of terms for different rules by different localities and government departments; · lack of judicial and administrative guidance on interpreting legislation; · absence of a solid system of checks and balances between the different parts of the government; · relative inexperience of judges and courts in interpreting legislation; · high degree of discretion on the part of governmental authorities, which can result in arbitrary actions such as suspension or termination of licences or approvals; · relatively untested bankruptcy procedures that might be vulnerable to abuse; and · differences in the application of norms between different local authorities. Furthermore, many laws, regulations and legal requirements have only recently been adopted by the central or local governments, and their implementation, interpretation and enforcement may involve uncertainty due to a lack of established practices available for reference. Depending on the government agency or how an application or a case is presented to such an agency, the Group may receive less favourable interpretations of law than its competitors. In addition, any litigation in China may be protracted and result in substantial legal costs and diversion of resources and management attention. Similarly, legal uncertainty in China may limit the legal protection available to potential litigants. 103 3.2.10 The Judiciary’s Lack of Independence and Limited Experience and the Difficulty of Enforcing Court Decisions and Governmental Discretion in Enforcing Court Orders Could Prevent China Specialty Glass-Group from Obtaining Effective Remedies in Court Proceedings. Chinas judicial system may not be as independent or immune to economic, political and nationalistic influences as judicial systems in European jurisdictions. The court system in China is largely understaffed and under-funded. Since courts in China are financially dependent on the respective local governments, judges tend to favour the economic interests of the municipalities or provinces and the enterprises located there. The independence of judges is further undermined by the fact that Chinese judges are only appointed for a limited period of time and may be dismissed during their term of office. Many older judges have not had any prior legal education. Courts in China are often inexperienced in the area of business law. Not all PRC legislation and court decisions are readily available to the public or organized in a manner that facilitates understanding. Enforcement of court orders can in practice be very difficult in China. Additionally, court decisions are often used in furtherance of political and commercial aims. The Group might be subjected to such claims by competitors or other parties and may not be able to receive a fair hearing in the course of the respective trial or legal procedure. Judicial decisions in China can also be unpredictable and may not provide effective remedies. These uncertainties also extend to property rights. Expropriation or nationalization of any of the PRC subsidiaries of China Specialty Glass-Group, their assets or parts thereof, potentially without adequate compensation, could have material negative and adverse effects on the Group. 3.2.11 Seeking Recognition Judgements against and the Enforcement Company, its in China Assets, of Foreign Management Personnel or Directors Might Be Difficult or Impossible for Investors. Most of the Group’s assets are located in Hong Kong and China and most of its management personnel and directors reside there. The Company is a holding company without any significant operational business of its own. China has not entered into treaties or arrangements providing for the recognition and enforcement of judgments made by courts in Germany or most other jurisdictions, including judgments obtained in relation to claims 104 investors may make with regard to this Offering. As a result, it will be difficult or impossible for investors to affect service of process or enforce judgments from courts of other jurisdictions against the Company or its assets, management personnel or directors in China. 3.2.12 Restrictions Might Be Imposed on Foreign Investments in PRC Companies. As part of China’s accession to the World Trade Organization (“WTO”) in 2001, China undertook to eliminate certain trade-related investment measures and to open up specified industry sectors that had previously been closed to foreign investment. Even though China has lived up to most of its WTO commitments, foreign investors still encounter barriers in practice as some of the newly enacted or modified laws and regulations are enforced in an inconsistent manner by different authorities. In addition, there is no guarantee that the Chinese government will not tighten its stance on foreign investors in other areas not covered by the WTO commitments and that control over companies operating in certain sectors considered to be politically sensitive, such as the security glass production, will not change. The MOFCOM and the National Development and Reform Commission ("NDRC") have issued the Foreign Investment Industry Guidance Catalogue that divides certain investment projects into three categories: encouraged, restricted and prohibited with industries and sectors that are not mentioned or listed deemed to be permitted. Based on the latest version of the Foreign Industry Guidance catalogue (effective as of 1 December 2007), the security glass and construction glass sector in which the Company operates is a manufacturing sector and is classified as an encouraged foreign investment industry. The Foreign Investment Industry Guidance Catalogue is, however, regularly revised. Should the security glass and construction glass technology become subject to foreign investment restrictions or prohibitions imposed by any future amendments, this could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, financial condition and results of operations. 3.3 Risk Related to the Offering 3.3.1 The Company Cannot Ensure that Public Trading in the Company’s Shares Will Develop. Prior to the Offering, there was no public trading in the Company’s shares. In 105 addition, only a small number of Chinese companies, via their German holding companies, are listed on a German stock exchange and have been subject to an initial public offering in Germany. As a result, the Company can give no assurance that liquid trading in the shares in the Company will develop after the Offering and that the stock exchange price will not fall below the offer price for the Offered Shares (“Offer Price”). The Offer Price will not necessarily provide any indication of the stock exchange price at which the shares will subsequently be traded on the Frankfurt Stock Exchange or any other exchange. The Company cannot forecast to what extent investors’ interest in its shares will foster trading, nor whether a liquid trading market will develop. While the Offering consists of 6,900,000 shares in the Company, the actual placement volume will be determined by the Company and the Underwriters after the offering period expires. The actual placement volume may be significantly lower than 6,900,000 shares and the free float may therefore be significantly lower than in case of full placement of all Offered Shares. It cannot be excluded that this will have an adverse effect on the liquidity of trading in the Company’s shares. The stock exchange price of the Company’s shares could become subject to greater volatility and consequently buy and sell orders might be executed less efficiently. Under certain circumstances, investors might not be able to sell their shares at the Offer Price or at a higher stock exchange price or might not be able to sell them at all. 3.3.2 A Volatile Stock Exchange Price for the Shares Might Develop. After the Offering, the stock exchange price of the Company’s shares could fluctuate considerably, especially because of fluctuating actual or forecasted results, revised earnings outlooks, the failure to meet analysts’ expectations, changed economic conditions in general, or other factors. The general volatility of stock exchange prices could also exert pressure on the stock exchange price of the Company’s shares without any direct connection with the Company’s business, its financial condition or profitability or its business prospects. Because the shares are growth stocks, the Company’s shares are particularly susceptible to fluctuations. 3.3.3 The Underwriting Agreement Might Be Rescinded, in which case the Offering Would Not Take Place. The underwriting agreement provides that the Underwriters may, under certain conditions, rescind the underwriting agreement. If the underwriting agreement is rescinded, the Offering will not take place. Claims relating to 106 any securities commissions already paid and costs incurred by any investor in connection with the subscription are controlled solely by the legal relationship between the investor and the institution to which the investor submitted its order. Any allotments already made to investors will be invalidated. In such cases, investors have no claim for delivery of shares in the Company. Any investors who have made short sales would bear the risk of not being able to cover such positions. 3.3.4 The Group Conducts Its Operations Through Its Subsidiaries and, as a Result, Is Dependent and Will Depend to a Large Extent on Its Subsidiaries to Pay Dividends to the Group so that It, in Turn, Has Funds to Pay Dividends to Its Shareholders. Each of China Specialty Glass-Group’s subsidiaries is subject to various restrictions on its payment of dividends, based on the jurisdiction of its incorporation. For example, a jurisdiction may limit the amount of dividends a company may pay, the sources of funds that can be used to pay dividends or require certain portions of profit be retained as reserves. Furthermore, payment of dividends by certain subsidiaries is restricted by agreements to which they are party, in particular their financing arrangements. These restrictions may prevent the Group’s subsidiaries from paying dividends to the Group, which, in turn, may limit the Group’s ability to pay dividends to its shareholders. Additionally, the payment of future dividends will depend on the conditions then existing, including the Group’s earnings, financial conditions, future projects, business conditions and other relevant factors. 3.3.5 For Investors Financing the Share Purchase Price with a Loan There Is an Increased Risk of Loss. Potential investors should be aware that if they have to finance the acquisition of shares through a loan, they have to accept not only the loss incurred by non-occurrence of their expectations, but also to pay interest and repay the loan. This increases the risk of loss substantially. Potential investors should not rely on repaying the loan and paying the interest of the loan with the proceeds of the shares. Prior to the credit-financed acquisition of shares, potential investors should check their financial standing in relation to whether they are able to pay the interest of the loan and, where appropriate, to repay the loan on a short-term basis if losses occur instead of expected profits. 107 4. RESPONSIBILTY STATEMENT China Specialty Glass AG, Gruenwald, Germany (the “Company” or “CSG-AG” and together with its direct and indirect subsidiaries “China Specialty Glass-Group” or the “Group”), VISCARDI AG, Munich, Germany (“VISCARDI” or “Sole Global Coordinator”) and biw Bank für Investments und Wertpapiere AG, Hausbroicher Str. 222, 47877 Willich, Germany (“biw AG”) (VISCARDI and biw AG together the “Joint Lead Managers” or “Underwriters”), assume responsibility for the content of the Prospectus pursuant to sec. 5 para. 4 of the German Securities Prospectus Act (Wertpapierprospektgesetz – WpPG) and declare that to their knowledge, the information contained in this Prospectus is correct and no material facts are omitted and, having taken all reasonable care to ensure that such is the case, that the information contained in this Prospectus is, to the best of their knowledge, in accordance with the facts and contains no omission likely to affect its import. 108 5. GENERAL INFORMATION 5.1 Documents on Display For the period during which this Prospectus is valid, copies of the following documents cited in this Prospectus may be inspected during regular business hours at the offices of CSG-AG in Gruenwald near Munich, An den Roemerhuegeln 1, 82031 Gruenwald, Germany: · the Company’s Articles of Association; · Financial statements of HWG-Ltd. for the three years ended 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010 in accordance with IFRS (audited); · Interim financial statements of HWG-Ltd. for the three months ended 31 March 2011 in accordance with IFRS (reviewed); · Consolidated financial statements of CSG-AG for the short financial year 2010 (from 22 November 2010 until 31 December 2010) in accordance with IFRS (audited); · Consolidated interim financial statements of CSG-AG for the three months ended 31 March 2011 in accordance with IFRS (reviewed); · Single entity financial statements of CSG-AG for the short financial year 2010 in accordance with HGB (from 10 May 2010 until 31 December 2010) (audited). The Company’s future annual and interim financial reports will be available at the Company’s offices and on its website www.csg-ag.de. 5.2 Statutory Auditors The Company’s auditor is Grant Thornton GmbH Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft (“Grant Thornton”), Domstrasse 15, 20095 Hamburg, a member of the German Chamber of Public Accountants (Wirtschaftsprüferkammer). Grant Thornton has audited the financial statements of HWG-Ltd. from 2008 until 2010, the consolidated financial statements of CSG-AG for the short financial year 2010 (from 22 November 2010 until 31 December 2010) and the single entity financial statements of CSG-AG for the short financial year 2010 (from 10 May 2010 until 31 December 2010) and has reviewed the 109 interim financial statements of HWG-Ltd. and the consolidated interim financial statements of CSG-AG, both for the three months ended 31 March 2011. All the abovementioned financial statements of HWG-Ltd. and CSG-AG have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), as endorsed for application in the EU, and the additional requirements of German commercial law pursuant to section 315a para. 1 German Commercial Code (Handelsgesetzbuch – HGB), with the exception of the Company’s single entity financial statements for the short financial year from 10 May 2010 to 31 December 2010, which have been prepared in accordance with HGB. Grant Thornton has issued an unqualified auditor’s opinion on the aforementioned audited financial statements and has issued an unqualified review opinion on the aforementioned reviewed financial statements. 5.3 Forward-Looking Statements This Prospectus contains certain forward-looking statements referring to the business, the financial performance and earnings of the Company as well as China Specialty Glass-Group and the markets and areas of business in which China Specialty Glass-Group operates. Forward-looking statements are statements relating to future facts, events and other circumstances not constituting historical facts. In particular, this applies to statements containing information on future financial results, plans and expectations regarding the business and management of China Specialty Glass-Group, its growth and profitability and general economic and regulatory conditions and other factors affecting China Specialty Glass-Group. Expressions such as “expect”, “intend”, “plan”, “assume” or “probably” are indicative of such statements. Such statements merely reflect the Company’s opinion at the present time with respect to future events, and as such their realisation is subject to risks and uncertainties. The forward-looking statements in this Prospectus include: · the implementation of the Company’s strategic plans and the impact of these plans on China Specialty Glass-Group’s financial condition and results of operations; · the use of the issue proceeds; · the development of competitors and the competitive situation; 110 · the Company’s expectations with respect to the impact of economic, operational, legal and other risks relating to China Specialty Glass-Group’s business; and other statements regarding China Specialty Glass-Group’s future business development and general economic and technological developments and other general conditions relevant to the business. These forward-looking statements are based on current planning, assessments, forecasts and expectations of the Company and on certain assumptions, which, although the Company believes them to be reasonable at the present time, may prove to be incorrect. Numerous factors may cause China Specialty Glass-Group’s actual development, performance or earnings generated to differ materially from the development, performance or earnings expressly or implicitly assumed in the forward-looking statements. For a complete discussion of the factors that could impact the future development of the business of China Specialty Glass-Group and the markets on which it operates, the Company specifically recommends reading section 3 “Risk Factors”, section 14 “Operating and Financial Review”, section 15 “Market and Industry Overview”, section 17 “Business” and section 26 “Recent Developments and Outlook” in this Prospectus. Should any one or more of these changes or uncertainties occur or should the Company’s underlying assumptions prove incorrect, it cannot be ruled out that actual results may differ materially from the assumptions, estimates or expectations described in this Prospectus. This could prevent the Company from achieving its financial and strategic objectives. Neither the Company nor the Underwriters intend to update the forward-looking statements set forth in this Prospectus beyond that which is required by law. 5.4 Third Party Information This Prospectus contains industry, market and customer data as well as calculations taken from industry reports, market research reports, publicly available information and commercial publications (“External Information”). External Information was, in particular, used for statements regarding markets and market developments. In this context, the available information with regard to the markets in which the Group distributes its products is limited and the only market study was provided upon request and was paid by the Group. This Prospectus also contains assessments of market data and information derived therefrom, which is not ascertainable from publications of market 111 research institutes or from any other independent sources. Such information is based on the Company’s internal assessments made on the basis of the many years of experience and expertise of its management and staff, evaluations of industry information (from trade journals, trade fairs, specialist talks) or Company-internal assessments. These may therefore differ from the estimates of China Specialty Glass-Group’s competitors or information gathered in the future by market research institutes or other independent sources. The Company and the Underwriters do not warrant the accuracy of the External Information upon which the Company’s assessments are based. Other Company estimates, by contrast, are based on published information or figures from external, publicly available sources. The following sources, in particular, were relied on in preparing the Prospectus: · National Bureau of Statistics of China (Website: http://www.stats.gov.cn/english/) · Bureau of Statistics of Sichuan Provincial Government Guangdong Provincial Government (http://www.sc.stats.gov.cn/) · Bureau of Statistics of (http://www.gdstats.gov.cn/) · China Statistical Yearbook 2009, National Bureau of Statistics of China · International Monetary Fund, World Economic Outlook 2010 · BIS, Working Paper No. 312, Bank for International Settlement, June 2010 · Understanding China’s Retail Market by Sheng Lu, China Business Review Online, CBR May-June 2010 · Chinese automobile market statistics (www.sohu.com/auto) · China Auto News (http://qiche.com.cn/files/201007/22035.shtml as of 22 July 2010) · Inautonews (http://www.inautonews.com/luxury-car-sales-in-china- may-reach-11-mln-units-by-2015) · China Banking Regulatory Commission Annual Report 2009, June 2010 112 · China Building Material Association (http://www.cbminfo.com/tabid/ 63/InfoID/327671/Default.aspx) · “Development Trends of Energy Saving Glass Products – An Analysis of Building Glass Market” (http://www.chinabmi.com/news/2010720/ 45762.html as of 20 July 2010) · Icandata (http://www.icandata.com/data/201103/031GM3292011. html) Public information on Chinese security glass, particularly on bulletproof glass, is scarce. The Company relies on the information provided by the market research report from Respect Market Research Ltd., an independent market research company commissioned by the Group: · “Research Report on China Bulletproof Glass Industry” from Respect Market Research Ltd., 2010 Respect Market Research Ltd. claims that the market research was conducted according to the market standard methodologies and the results/finding of the research was verified by the authoritive Information Centre of Building Materials Industry, PRC. In this market research report, the following information sources were quoted: · China Architectural and Industrial Glass Association · General Administration of Customs of the People’s Republic of China · China Banking Regulatory Commission · China Association of Automobile Manufacturers The majority of the market information contained in this Prospectus is a condensation of information derived by the Company on the basis of the above studies. Specific studies were cited only in those cases where the relevant information may be taken directly from such a study. The remaining assessments of the Company are based on internal sources, unless expressly indicated otherwise in this Prospectus. Industry and market research reports, publicly available sources and commercial publications generally state that, while the information contained therein stems from sources that are assumed to be reliable, the accuracy and completeness of such information is not guaranteed and the calculations contained therein are based on a number of assumptions. Consequently, 113 these caveats also apply to the information included in this Prospectus. Neither the Company nor the Underwriters have verified the accuracy or completeness of External Information. Therefore, the Company and the Underwriters assume no responsibility for or grant any warranties in respect of the accuracy of such External Information. Any information taken from third parties has been accurately reproduced in this Prospectus. As far as the Company and the Underwriters are aware and able to ascertain from the information taken from third parties, no facts have been omitted that would make the reproduced information incorrect or misleading. 5.5 Notes Regarding Currency and Financial Information Regarding the financial statements of the Company, investors should be aware of the fact that CSG-AG’s consolidated and single entity financial statements presented in this Prospectus are translations into English of the financial statements prepared in German language. Investors should further be aware that numerical data (including certain percentage rates) were rounded up. These adjustments were undertaken to act in accordance with commercial standards. Thus there is the likelihood of differences between the total amounts of sums and the individual amounts. These differences may also occur in regard to individual figures presented in tables and their aggregate amount. In case of percentage the calculation was always based on the actual value. Consequently stated percentage rates may differ from percentage rates based on rounded values. The currency in which the financial statements of CSG-AG and of HWG-Ltd. are presented is euro, whereas the operating currency of China Specialty Glass-Group is Renminbi (“RMB”). The table below shows the exchange rates used for the respective translations: 31 31 31 31 December 2008 December 2009 December 2010 March 2011 Period end rates EUR 1.00 = RMB 9.2563 EUR 1.00 = RMB 9.9742 EUR 1.00 = RMB 8.8231 EUR 1.00 = RMB 9.2343 Average rates EUR 1.00 = RMB EUR 1.00 = RMB EUR 1.00 = RMB EUR 1.00 = RMB 10.1588 9.4904 8.9789 8.9807 Accordingly the financial statements presented in EUR for each relevant period in this Prospectus are not fully comparable to each other because different RMB/EUR exchange rates applied to each period presented. All information contained in this Prospectus regarding currencies if not 114 otherwise indicated refers to euro. If amounts in other currencies are contained in this Prospectus they are marked as such by the corresponding currency designation or the respective symbol. 115 6. SUBJECT-MATTER OF THE PROSPECTUS The subject-matter of this Prospectus for the purpose of the public offering in Germany and jurisdictions Luxembourg are up to and private 6,900,000 placement no-par value in bearer certain shares other (the “Offering”), consisting of: · 6,000,000 no-par value bearer shares from a securities loan free of charge which was granted by Luckyway Global Group Limited to biw AG (the “Delivery Shares”; see section 25.3 “Securities Loans and Greenshoe Option”); an equivalent number of shares from a capital increase of the Company from authorised capital against cash contribution will be subscribed by biw AG and transferred to Luckyway Global Group Limited to fulfil the retransfer obligation from the securities loan; and · 900,000 no-par value bearer shares that originate from a securities loan free of charge that was granted by the Greenshoe Shareholders to biw AG in connection with a potential over-allotment (the “Greenshoe Shares”; see section 25.3 “Securities Loans and Greenshoe Option”); (the “Greenshoe Shares”, together with the Delivery Shares collectively referred to as the “Offered Shares”). The subject matter of this Prospectus for the purpose of admission to trading on the regulated market segment (Regulierter Markt) of the Frankfurt Stock Exchange with simultaneous admission to the sub-segment of the regulated market with additional post-admission obligations (Prime Standard) of the Frankfurt Stock Exchange are up to 21,050,000 ordinary no-par value bearer shares, consisting of · 15,050,000 Existing Shares; and · up to 6,000,000 shares from a capital increase of the Company, each with a calculated value of EUR 1.00 and carrying full dividend rights from and including the financial year 2011. 116 7. SELLING RESTRICTIONS The Offering consists of a public offering in the Federal Republic of Germany and Luxembourg as well as private placements in other jurisdictions outside the Federal Republic of Germany, Luxembourg and the United States of America. Neither the Company nor the Underwriters have taken any action or will take any action in any jurisdiction, with the exception of Germany and Luxembourg, which may result in a public offering of the Offered Shares. The delivery of this Prospectus and the marketing of the Offered Shares are subject to restrictions in certain countries. Persons who come into possession of this Prospectus are required by the Company and the Underwriters to inform themselves about such restrictions and to observe such restrictions, including any tax issues and currency restrictions that may be relevant in connection with the Offering. All investors should examine through their own advisers the tax consequences of an investment in the Offered Shares. This Prospectus does not constitute an offer of or an invitation to purchase or subscribe for any Offered Shares in any jurisdiction in which such an offer or invitation would be unlawful. The Offered Shares are subject to transfer and selling restrictions in certain jurisdictions. Potential purchasers and/or subscribers of the Offered Shares are to comply with all applicable laws and provisions in countries or territories in which they acquire, subscribe for, offer or sell the Offered Shares or possess or distribute this Prospectus and are to obtain consent, approval or permission, as required, for the acquisition of the Offered Shares. Neither the Company nor the Company’s auditors nor the Underwriters accept any liability for any violation of these restrictions by any person, irrespective of whether such a person is an existing shareholder or a potential purchaser and/or subscriber of the Offered Shares. This Prospectus may not be distributed in or otherwise made available, and the Offered Shares may not be offered or sold, directly or indirectly, in any jurisdiction outside Germany or Luxembourg, unless such distribution, offering, sale or exercise is permitted under applicable laws in the relevant jurisdiction, and the Company and the Underwriters may require receipt of satisfactory documentation to that effect. 117 7.1 Notice to U.S. Residents The Offered Shares have not been approved, disapproved or recommended by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission, any state securities commission in the United States of America or any other U.S. regulatory authority, nor have any of such regulatory authorities passed upon or endorsed the merits of the Offering or the accuracy or adequacy of this Prospectus. The Offered Shares have not been and will not be registered under the U.S. Securities Act of 1933, as amended (“US Securities Act”), or any state securities laws in the United States of America. No offer or sale of the Offered Shares is permitted unless in connection with an offering or sale under Regulation S of the US Securities Act. 7.2 Notice Regarding the European Economic Area In relation to each Member State of the European Economic Area that has implemented the Prospectus Directive (each a “Relevant Member State”), no offering of the Offered Shares to the public will be made in any Relevant Member State prior to the publication of a prospectus concerning the Offered Shares which has been approved by the competent authority in such Relevant Member State or, where relevant, approved in another Relevant Member State and notified to the competent authority in such Relevant Member State, all pursuant to the Prospectus Directive, except that with effect from and including the date of implementation of the Prospectus Directive in such Relevant Member State, an offering of the Offered Shares may be made to the public at any time in such Relevant Member State: a) to legal entities which are authorised or regulated to operate in the financial markets as well as entities not so authorised or regulated whose corporate purpose is solely to invest in securities; b) to legal entities which meet at least two of the following criteria: (i) an average of at least 250 employees in the last financial year; (ii) a total balance sheet sum exceeding EUR 43,000,000.00; and (iii) an annual net turnover exceeding EUR 50,000,000.00 showing on their last single entity or consolidated financial statements; c) to fewer than 100 natural or legal persons other than qualified investors within the meaning of the Prospectus Directive, subject to the prior written consent of the Company and the Underwriters; or 118 d) in any other circumstances which do not require the publication by the Company of a prospectus under art. 3 of the Prospectus Directive. For the purposes of the aforementioned section, the expression an “offering of the Offered Shares to the public” in relation to the Offered Shares in any Relevant Member State means a communication to persons in any form and by any means, presenting sufficient information on the terms of the Offering and the Offered Shares, so as to enable an investor to decide purchase or subscribe for the Offered Shares, as the same may be varied in that Relevant Member State by any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in that Relevant Member State. The term “Prospectus Directive” means the Directive 2003/71/EC including any relevant implementation procedures in the Relevant Member State. 7.3 Notice Regarding Japan The shares have not been and will not be registered under the Securities and Exchange Law of Japan and may not be offered or sold, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to, or for the account or benefit of, any resident of Japan (which term as used herein means any person resident in Japan, including any corporation or other entity organized under the laws of Japan) or to, or for the account or benefit of, any person for reoffering or resale, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to, or for the account or benefit of, any resident of Japan, except (i) pursuant to an exemption from the registration requirements of, or otherwise in compliance with, the Securities and Exchange Law of Japan and (ii) in compliance with any other relevant laws and regulations of Japan. 119 8. THE OFFERING 8.1 Subject-Matter of the Offering The Offering will be made and trading in the Offered Shares will take place in euro. The Offered Shares are denominated in euro. The subject-matter of the Offering including any potential over-allotment (the “Offering”) relates to a total of up to 6,900,000 ordinary no-par value bearer shares, consisting of: · 6,000,000 Delivery Shares and · 900,000 no-par value ordinary bearer shares originating from a securities loan free of charge that was granted by the Greenshoe Shareholders to biw AG in connection with a potential over-allotment (the “Greenshoe Shares”), each with a calculated value of EUR 1.00 and carrying full dividend rights from and including the financial year 2011. The Offering consists of a public offering in the Federal Republic of Germany and Luxembourg as well as private placements in other jurisdictions outside the Federal Republic of Germany, Luxembourg and the United States of America. Luckyway Global Group Limited will enter into a securities loan agreement under which it grants to biw AG a total number of 6,000,000 no-par value bearer shares (Inhaber-Stückaktien) by way of a securities loan free of charge. The purpose of the securities loan is to facilitate timely delivery of up to 6,000,000 shares of the Company (in case of a full exercise of the Over-allotment) to the investors. In order to fulfil its retransfer obligation vis-à-vis Luckyway Global Group Limited from the securities loan, biw AG will subscribe for up to 6,000,000 shares from a capital increase of the Company from authorised capital against cash contributions described below and transfer these shares to Luckyway Global Group Limited upon registration of the capital increase with the commercial register. These up to 6,000,000 shares are expected to be issued from the Authorised Capital 2010/I by a resolution of the Management Board subject to the approval of the Supervisory Board. The meetings are expected to be held on or around 20 June 2011. The then existing shareholders will waive their 120 subscription rights to the shares from the capital increase. biw AG will be entitled to subscribe for up to 6,000,000 shares shortly after the end of the offering period. The application for registration of the resolution on the capital increase is expected to be made with the commercial register of the local court (Amtsgericht) of Munich on 4 July 2011. It is expected that registration and effectiveness of the capital increase will take place on or around 11 July 2011. Assuming that the maximum number of shares is issued, the share capital of the Company after the capital increase will amount to EUR 21,050,000.00 consisting of 21,050,000 no-par value shares with a calculated amount of EUR 1.00 per share. Depending on the extent to which the Delivery Shares are placed with investors and the extent to which the over-allotment is exercised, the Offered Shares will represent a calculated total of up to EUR 6,900,000 of the Company’s share capital. Thus, taking into account the maximum placement volume of Delivery Shares and an according capital increase amount and including a potential over-allotment, up to 32.78% of the Company’s shares will be offered under the Offering. The Offered Shares which constitute the subject-matter of the Offering carry the same rights as all other shares of the Company and confer no additional rights or benefits. The net proceeds from the sale of the Delivery Shares under the Offering will accrue to the Company. The net proceeds from the sale of the Greenshoe Shares, if applicable, will accrue to the Greenshoe Shareholders. VISCARDI AG, Brienner Str. 1, 80333 Munich, is the Sole Global Coordinator and together with biw Bank für Investments und Wertpapiere AG, Hausbroicher Str. 222, 47877 Willich, Joint Lead Manager and Joint Bookrunner of the Offering. Selling Agents are DAB bank AG, Landsberger Str. 300, 80687 Munich, comdirect bank AG, Pascalkehre 15, 25451 Quickborn, Cortal Consors S.A., Zweigniederlassung Deutschland, Postfach 1743, 90006 Nuremberg, and S Broker AG & Co. KG, Karl-Bosch-Str. 10, 65203 Wiesbaden, Asiasons WFG Securities Pte Ltd, 5 Shenton Way, #28-01, UIC Building, Singapore 068808 and ING-DiBa AG, Theodor-Heuss-Allee 106, 60468 Frankfurt am Main, Germany. 121 8.2 Price Range, Offering Period, Subscription, Offer Price and Number of Allotted Shares The price range within which purchase orders may be submitted is between EUR 9.00 and EUR 12.00. Shortly after the publication of the Prospectus, the Company and the Underwriters will begin the roadshow for the shares, most likely on 20 June 2011. The offering period, during which investors will be given the opportunity to submit orders for the Offered Shares, is expected to begin on 20 June 2011 and is expected to end on 29 June 2011 at 12:00 noon CEST. On the final day of the offering period, retail and institutional investors will be able to submit orders until 12:00 noon CEST. Orders will be freely revocable until the respective offering period expires. During the offering period, retail investors may submit orders for the public offering in the Federal Republic of Germany to the Underwriters as well as to the Selling Agents. Orders must be submitted for a minimum of 50 shares and may stipulate a price limit within the price range which is denominated in round euro amounts or round euro cent figures of 25, 50 or 75 cents. The Company reserves the right, in agreement with the Underwriters, to reduce the number of Offered Shares, to lower or raise the upper limit and/or the lower limit of the price range and/or to extend or shorten the offering period. If the option to modify the number of Offered Shares, the price range and/or the offering period (collectively referred to as the “Offer Terms”) is exercised, and to the extent required under the German Securities Prospectus Law (Wertpapierprospektgesetz), a supplement to this Prospectus will be filed with BaFin and published following approval thereof on the Company’s website (www.csg-ag.de). To the extent legally required, any changes will also be published in an ad hoc disclosure. Printed copies of the supplement will be available free of charge during regular business hours at the office of VISCARDI, Brienner Str. 1, 80333 Munich and at the office of biw Bank für Investments und Wertpapiere AG, Hausbroicher Str. 222, 47877 Willich. Investors will not be notified individually. Changes to the Offer Terms will not invalidate orders that have already been submitted. Investors who have already submitted orders prior to the publication of any supplement are entitled under the German Securities Prospectus Law to revoke their orders within two business days of the 122 publication of the supplement. The revocation must be declared in text form to the party specified in the supplement as the recipient of such revocation; revocations is to be deemed timely if dispatched before the notice period expires. Instead of revoking their orders, investors may within two days of the publication of the supplement opt to modify orders submitted prior thereto or to submit new limit or market orders. For information on cases involving a termination of the Offering in connection with the termination of the underwriting agreement by the Underwriters, see section 25.4 “Termination”. After the offering period expires, the Company and the Underwriters will use the order book created in the bookbuilding process to jointly set the Offer Price and the placement volume. Pricing and the placement volume will be set based on the orders submitted by investors during the offering period and collected in the order book. Once the Offer Price has been fixed, the Offered Shares will be allotted to investors based on the submitted orders. The Offer Price is scheduled to be published subsequently to the fixing of the Offer Price in an ad hoc disclosure on an electronic information system and on the Company’s website (www.csg-ag.de) on 29 June 2011. Investors who have submitted their orders through the Underwriters should be able to obtain the information from the Underwriters as to the Offer Price and the number of shares they have been allotted starting, at the earliest, on the banking day immediately following pricing. Trading in the Company’s shares may commence before investors are notified of the number of shares they have been allotted. The delivery of the allotted shares in book-entry form against payment of the Offer Price to the Underwriters is expected to take place two banking days following expiration of the offering period. Particularly in the event that the placement volume proves insufficient to satisfy all the orders submitted at the Offer Price, the Underwriters reserve the right to reject orders, either in whole or in part. 8.3 Rights Attached to the Offered Shares The Offered Shares will rank pari passu with the Existing Shares and thus have subscription rights to future capital increases on the same terms and to the same extent as the Existing Shares. For information in relation to the rights attached to the shares, see section 8.5 “Information Concerning the Shares in the Company” below and section 19 “Information on the Capital of the Company and Applicable Provisions”. 123 8.4 Projected Timetable for the Offering The scheduled timetable for the Offering is as follows: 17 June 2011 Approval of the Prospectus by BaFin Notification of approval of the Prospectus to the Luxembourg Commission for the Supervision of the Financial Sector (Commission de Surveillance du Secteur Financier – CSSF) Publication of the Prospectus on the Company’s website www.csg-ag.de 20 June 2011 Commencement of the offering period 29 June 2011 End of the offering period at 12:00 noon CEST Determination of the Offer Price, placement volume and allotment Publication of the Offer Price and the number of Offered Shares as well as the allotment criteria placed in an ad-hoc disclosure on an electronic information system and on the Company’s website www.csg-ag.de 30 June 2011 Listing approval issued by the Frankfurt Stock Exchange for the Existing Shares 1 July 2011 Book-entry delivery of the Offered Shares to investors against payment of the Offer Price Commencement of trading of the Company’s Existing Shares Subscription of up to 6,000,000 shares from the capital increase by biw AG 11 July 2011* Registration of the capital increase with the commercial register of the Company 13 July 2011* Listing approval issued by the Frankfurt Stock Exchange for the shares from the capital increase * May be delayed due to the commercial register of the local court in Munich. This Prospectus and any supplements thereto will be published on the Company’s website (www.csg-ag.de). Printed copies of the Prospectus and any supplements thereto will be available upon request and free of charge during regular business hours at the office of VISCARDI, Brienner Str. 1, 80333 Munich, Germany, as well as at the office of biw Bank für Investments und Wertpapiere AG, Hausbroicher Str. 222, 47877 Willich, Germany from the day of publication. 8.5 Information Concerning the Shares in the Company 8.5.1 Dividend Rights, Rights to Share in the Liquidation Proceeds, Subscription Rights and Voting Rights Dividend Rights The shares of the Company carry full dividend rights from and including the financial year 2011. This applies as well to the shares from the capital increase from the time of the registration of the capital increase (which is 124 expected to take place on or around 11 July 2011). Dividends are paid in euro to each shareholder’s account through central depository to the custodian bank which will pay them to the shareholders’ accounts. The distribution of dividends on the Company’s shares for the past fiscal year is subject to the General Shareholders’ Meeting (for further details, see section 19.3.1 “Provisions relating to Profit Allocation and Dividend Payments”). No restrictions on dividends or special procedures apply to holders of the shares who are not residents of Germany. Reference is made to section 23 “Taxation in Germany” and section 24 “Taxation in Luxembourg” for a description of the tax treatment of dividends under the laws of Germany and Luxembourg, respectively. Shareholders whose shares are entered into custodial accounts via foreign institutions should inform themselves about the procedure applicable at such institutions. Rights on Liquidation Proceeds Should the Company be dissolved, any liquidation proceeds remaining after discharging the Company’s liabilities will accrue to the shareholders pursuant to the German Stock Corporation Act in proportion to the respective shares they hold in the Company’s share capital. Subscription Rights Shareholders generally have the right to subscribe for new shares issued pursuant to any future capital increases in a ratio proportionate to the respective shares they hold in the Company’s share capital (subscription right) in connection with share capital increases against cash contributions. Exemption are made in regard to conditional capital increase or the issuance of convertible bonds, income bonds, profit participation rights or bonds with warrants as well as in respect of the sale of treasury shares. Furthermore, the General Shareholders’ Meeting may partially or completely exclude the subscription rights in specific cases. The exclusion of the subscription rights need to be permissible under the German Stock Corporation Act (for further details, see section 19.3.3 “Provisons relating to Subscription Rights”). Voting Rights In accordance with the Company’s Articles of Association, each share carries one vote at the General Shareholders’ Meeting. All shares including shares of Luckyway Global Group Limited, Quick Reach Group Limited, Expert 125 Intelligence Global Limited, Sea Dragon Investments Limited and Hong Kong Investment Group Limited (the “Current Major Shareholders”) carry the same voting rights. No restrictions on voting rights exist with the exception of those stipulated by law in specific cases. Attendance of the General Shareholders’ Meeting and exercise of voting rights are governed by the Articles of Association and general Company law (for further details, see section 20.5 “General Shareholders’ Meeting”). 8.5.2 Form and Representation of the Shares All of the Company’s shares are or will be issued as ordinary no-par value bearer shares (Inhaber-Stückaktien). The shares are represented by one or more global certificates without dividend coupons. The shares are deposited with Clearstream Banking AG, Frankfurt/Main, as securities clearing and depository bank. The same applies to the shares from the capital increase, which will be represented by an additional global certificate and also be deposited with Clearstream Banking AG, Frankfurt/Main. The Articles of Association of the Company excludes the shareholders’ claim to be issued with share certificates, unless such certificates are required under the regulations of a stock exchange on which the share is listed. 8.5.3 Transferability, Lock-Up The shares are freely transferable. With the exception of the restrictions set out in the section 8.11 “Market Protection Agreements (Lock up)” and section 25 “Underwriting”, there are no lock-up requirements or restrictions on the transferability of the Company’s shares. 8.5.4 ISIN/WKN/Common Code/Ticker Symbol The Securities Identification Number (WKN) of the shares is A1EL8Y, the International Securities Identification Number (ISIN) is DE000A1EL8Y8 and the Ticker Symbol is 8GS. 8.6 Allotment Criteria 8.6.1 General Allotment No agreements exist between the Company, the Greenshoe Shareholders and the Underwriters with respect to the allotment procedure prior to the commencement of the offering period. The Company, the Greenshoe Shareholders and the Underwriters will comply with the “Principles for the Allotment of Shares Issues to Private Investors” (“Grundsätze für die 126 Zuteilung von Aktienemissionen an Privatanleger”). These principles were issued on 7 June 2000 by the Exchange Expert Commission (Börsensachverständigenkommission) of the German Federal Ministry of Finance (Bundesministerium für Finanzen). The Company, the Greenshoe Shareholders and the Underwriters will determine and publish the specific details of the allotment procedure in accordance with the “Principles for the Allotment of Shares Issues to Private Investors” once the offering period has expired. 8.6.2 Minimum Allotment Any minimum allotment will be determined once the order book has been closed and will be published in accordance with the allotment principles. No right to allotment exists. 8.7 Stabilisation Measures, Over-Allotment and Greenshoe Option In connection with the placement of the Company’s shares and to the extent permitted by applicable law including the Commission Regulation (EC) No. 2273/2003 dated 22 December 2003 and in connection with the Offering, VISCARDI as stabilisation manager may make over-allotments and execute stabilisation measures aimed at supporting the stock exchange or market price of the Company’s shares in order to offset any sales pressure that may exist. The stabilisation manager is under no obligation to take stabilisation measures. Therefore, there is no guarantee that any stabilisation measures will indeed be implemented. If stabilisation measures are taken, these may be terminated at any time without prior notice. Such measures may be taken from the date the Existing Shares list for trading in order to support the initial exchange price, if necessary, and must be completed no later than 30 calendar days after such date (“Stabilisation Period”). Stabilisation measures may lead to the stock exchange or market price of the Company’s shares being higher than would have been the case without such measures. In addition, such measures may temporarily result in the stock exchange or market price reaching a level that is not sustainable in the long run. As regards potential stabilisation measures, in addition to the maximum total of 6,000,000 Delivery Shares of the Company being offered, investors may be allotted up to 900,000 additional shares from a securities loan free of charge that was granted by the Greenshoe Shareholders to biw AG (a maximum of 15% of the total number of Delivery Shares being allocated) (“Over-allotment”). Over-allotment within this meaning is also possible if the Delivery Shares offered are not fully placed with investors. For the 127 number of shares provided by the various Greenshoe Shareholders see section 25.3 “Securities Loans and Greenshoe Option”. In this context, the Greenshoe Shareholders will grant biw AG the option to purchase up to 900,000 Existing Shares (a maximum of 15% of the total number of Delivery Shares being allocated) from the Greenshoe Shareholders at the Offer Price less the agreed commission and other costs (“Greenshoe Option”), and thus satisfy the retransfer obligation under the securities loan. This Greenshoe Option expires 30 calendar days after trading in the Existing Shares commences and may be exercised at maximum to the extent that shares of the Company have been placed by way of Over-allotment. Within one week following the end of the Stabilisation Period, an announcement will be published in the Frankfurter Allgemeine Zeitung and on the Company’s website (www.csg-ag.de) as to whether or not any stabilisation measures were carried out, the date on which these stabilisation measures were commenced, the date on which the last stabilisation measure was taken, and the price range within which stabilisation measures were carried out (for each date on which a stabilisation measure was carried out). The implementation of the Over-allotment and the exercise of the Greenshoe Option and the date thereof, as well as the number and class of the relevant shares will also be promptly published in the manner stated above. 8.8 Stock Exchange Admission and Commencement of Trading An application for admission of all the Company’s shares (including the shares from the capital increase) to trading on the regulated market (regulierter Markt) with simultaneous admission to the regulated market sub-segment with additional post-admission obligations (Prime Standard) of the Frankfurt Stock Exchange is expected to be finalised on 29 June 2011. It is expected that trading of the Existing Shares will commence on the second banking day following the expiration of the offer period, i.e. on 1 July 2011 and that the trading of the shares from the capital increase will commence two banking days following the registration of the capital increase, i.e. on 13 July 2011. The decision on admission of the shares is at the sole discretion of the Frankfurt Stock Exchange. 128 8.9 Delivery and Settlement The Offered Shares will be delivered through Clearstream Banking AG, Frankfurt/Main, Germany, to the investors’ securities deposit account maintained by a bank through a depository chain with Clearstream Banking AG, Frankfurt/Main. Delivery of the Offered Shares to investors against payment of the Offer Price is expected to take place on 1 July 2011. The shares will be made available to shareholders as co-ownership interests in the respective global certificate. 8.10 Designated Sponsor VISCARDI is assuming the function of a designated sponsor for the Company’s shares trading on the Frankfurt Stock Exchange. According to the designated sponsor agreement which the Company will execute with VISCARDI, VISCARDI will include the submission of limit orders to buy or sell shares of the Company into the electronic trading system of the Frankfurt Stock Exchange during regular trading hours. This is designed, in particular, to achieve higher liquidity in the trading of the shares. 8.11 Market Protection Agreements (Lock up) The Company will undertake vis-à-vis the Underwriters that for a period of 6 months from the first day of trading of the Existing Shares it will not and for a period of further 6 months it will not without the prior written consent of the Underwriters: (a) implement any capital increase from authorised capital; (b) propose any capital increase to its general shareholders’ meeting; (c) announce, implement or propose to its general shareholders’ meeting any issue of any financial instruments carrying conversion or option rights with respect to the shares in the Company or any transactions having an equivalent economic effect; (d) directly or indirectly sell, offer, market, distribute, transfer, encumber or in any other way dispose of shares in the Company; (e) enter into any transactions (including derivative transactions) that are 129 the economic equivalent of the above. Luckyway Global Group Limited will undertake vis-à-vis the Underwriters that, for a period of 12 months from the from the first day of trading of the Existing Shares it will not and for a period of further 6 months it will not without the prior written consent of the Underwriters: (a) initiate or consent to any of the measures set out above; (b) directly or indirectly sell, offer, market, distribute, transfer, encumber or in any other way dispose of shares or other financial instruments in the Company; the same applies to any transactions constituting the economic equivalent of a sale, such as the issue of option or conversion rights to shares of the Company and other comparable transactions (including derivative transactions); (c) directly or indirectly initiate or consent that the shares in the Company or other financial instruments, which may be converted into shares or which give a right to acquire shares in the Company, are issued, sold, offered, marketed or otherwise disposed of or that an offer relating to any of such transactions is announced. Furthermore, Expert Intelligence Global Limited, Hong Kong Investment Group Limited, Quick Reach Group Limited and Sea Dragon Investments Limited will undertake vis-à-vis the Underwriters that, for a period of 6 months from the first day of trading of the Existing Shares, they will not undertake any of the aforementioned transactions. These lock-up restrictions do not apply to the issuance of shares in the Company for the purpose of making acquisitions or the capital increase according to which the Underwriters will subscribe shares of the Company in order to fulfil its retransfer obligation vis-à-vis Luckyway Global Group Limited from the securities loan. 130 9. REASONS FOR THE OFFERING, USE OF ISSUE PROCEEDS, ISSUE COSTS AND INTERESTED THIRD PARTIES 9.1 Issue Proceeds and Costs The gross issue proceeds from the sale of the Delivery Shares less the issue costs to be borne by the Company (the net issue proceeds) accrue to the Company under the Offering. The amount of the gross issue proceeds depends on the number of shares offered and actually placed and the Offer Price. Assuming that all of the Delivery Shares are placed, the attainable gross issue proceeds accruing to the Company from the Offering will be between approximately EUR 54.0 million and EUR 72.0 million. Due to the fact that the costs are contingent on the total number of shares placed and the Offer Price, which determine the amount of commissions, it is not possible at present to reliably predict the amount of the costs. Based on the price range, the Company estimates that it will incur costs (including Underwriters’ fees and assuming that the Company pays the full amount of the discretionary performance-based incentive fee) totalling approximately EUR 4.5 million to EUR 5.4 million. Subject to the aforementioned uncertainties, the Company believes that, given these assumptions, it is possible to generate approximately EUR 49.5 million to EUR 66.6 million in net issue proceeds. The net proceeds from the sale of the Greenshoe Shares, insofar as it is exercised, will accrue to the Greenshoe Shareholders. The Greenshoe Shareholders will receive approximately EUR 8.7 million as the arithmetic mean of the net issue proceeds considered possible by the Greenshoe Shareholders from the sale of the Greenshoe Shares if the Greenshoe Option is fully exercised. 9.2 Reasons for the Offering The net issue proceeds accruing to the Company are intended to strengthen the Company’s capitalisation and financial position and support the intended expansion of its activities and the implementation of its strategy. In particular, the Company aims to finance the growth process. The listing is also intended to enable the Company to sharpen its public profile as well as its profile on the international capital market. 131 9.3 Use of the Issue Proceeds The Company plans to use the net issue proceeds accruing to it from the placement of the Offered Shares to finance further internal and external growth including, if any, selected acquisitions, to implement and finance its strategic objectives and for general business purposes. Specifically, based on the assumption that the net issue proceeds of the Offering accruing to the Company amount to approximately EUR 58.0 million, the Company plans to split the net issue proceeds between the following purposes: Purpose approx. % Establishment of new production base in Sichuan Province 25 Financing of further growth 25 Establishment of a new research and development centre 5 Modernize and expand production capacity of Guangzhou factory 25 Financing of the exclusive distributorship agreement with the industrial group Saint-Gobain 10 Working capital 10 Establishment of a new production base in Sichuan Province The Group is currently establishing a new factory in Sichuan Province. It has applied to acquire the right to use a land with an area of approximately 200,000 square meters. It estimates that the operations of this new factory can commence in the second half of 2011 and that the maximum production capacities of around 2.8 million square meters per annum for construction glass products or around 800,000 square meters per annum for security glass products will be reached in about two years’ time. Financing of further growth The Group plans to finance its further growth with the net issue proceeds. Establishment of a new research and development centre The Group plans to invest in the development of a research and development centre. The Group intends to acquire some new research and development and inspection equipment in order to innovate and develop new projects. It has some ideas for the future on the increasing output of “the bulletproof and 132 intruder-resistant glass” and hopes to obtain new patents, which could lead to some new product lines. The Group further intends to strengthen its cooperation with some universities and colleges in order to recruit the talents and the experts of bulletproof glass industry and to establish and to develop a strong research and development team. Modernize and expand production capacity of Guangzhou factory The Group plans to modernize and expand all its existing machines for the production of construction glass, the flat type of the bulletproof glass product line, the product lines for bulletproof glass for cars and accessory production equipment. For further details see section 17.4 “Strategy”. Financing of the exclusive distributorship agreement with the industrial group Saint-Gobain HWG-Ltd. has concluded an exclusive distributorship agreement with the Saint-Gobain Group under which a certain consideration will be paid by HWG-Ltd. for the exclusive distribution rights for selected products of Saint-Gobain in China. For further details see section 17.14.4 “Exclusive Distributorship Agreement”. Working capital The Group intends to strengthen its working capital with the net issue proceeds. 9.4 Interested Parties involved in the Offering In connection with the Offering and the listing of the Company’s shares (the “Transaction”), the Underwriters are in a contractual relationship with China Specialty Glass-Group. VISCARDI was appointed by the Company as Sole Global Coordinator and together with biw AG as Joint Lead Manager and Joint Bookrunner. VISCARDI and biw AG advise the Company on the Transaction and coordinate the structuring and execution thereof and will purchase and sell the Offered Shares in accordance with the executed underwriting agreement. The compensation of the Underwriters is incentive-based and depends, amongst other factors, on the amount of the offer proceeds such that the Underwriters have an interest in the successful implementation of the Offering. 133 The Underwriters or their affiliates may enter into business relations with the Company or render services to the Company in the ordinary course of business. VISCARDI also has an interest in the Offering on account of its designated sponsor agreement, in particular (see section 8.10 “Designated Sponsor”). In addition, related parties may have a personal interest in the issue because there are certain legal and business relationships existing with the Company (for more information, see section 22 “Related Party Transactions” and section 20.2.5 “Conflicts of Interest”). 134 10. DIVIDEND POLICY; EARNINGS AND DIVIDENDS PER SHARE 10.1 Dividend Rights and Dividend Policy Sec. 60 para. 1 German Stock Corporation Act (“AktG”) stipulates that the shareholders’ respective share in the profits depends on their share in the Company’s share capital. Accordingly, each share participates in the Company’s profit, if any, with a dividend per share on an equal basis. Under German law, a resolution on a dividend and its distribution must be based on a balance sheet profit recognised in the Company’s financial statements prepared in accordance with the German Commercial Code (“HGB”). When determining the profit that is available for distribution, the net profit/loss must be adjusted for profit/loss carry forwards from the previous year and withdrawals from/allocations to reserves. Certain reserves must generally be established by law (see sec. 150 AktG) and the amount allocated to such reserves must be deducted in the calculation of the profit available for distribution until the reserves have been established in full. Dividends may be decided and distributed only from the Company’s balance sheet profit stated in its individual financial statements. In contrast to consolidated financial statements prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”), these individual financial statements are prepared in accordance with HGB. Dividends are subject to German capital gains tax (see section 23.2 “Taxation of Shareholders”). The amount of the dividend will be proposed to the General Shareholders’ Meeting jointly by the Management Board and the Supervisory Board for the respective past financial year. The dividend for the past financial year will be decided by the shareholders at the General Shareholders’ Meeting of the following year. Dividends decided at the General Shareholders’ Meeting are payable on the first business day following the General Shareholders’ Meeting, unless otherwise provided for in the dividend resolution. Details of the dividends will be published in the electronic version of the German Federal Gazette (elektronischer Bundesanzeiger). In accordance with sec. 195 of the German Civil Code (“BGB”), the entitlement to a dividend becomes time-barred within the regular period of limitation of three years for the benefit of the Company. The Company’s ability to pay a dividend in future years will depend on the amount of the annual result and the net profit available for distribution. This ability is limited to the profits generated from the Company’s subsidiaries and 135 sub-subsidiaries, i.e. the operative business located in China, due to the company being a holding company. The Company cannot make a statement as to the amount of future profits or as to whether profits will be generated at all. Accordingly, the Company cannot guarantee that dividends will be paid in future years. The amount of the actual dividend payout will depend on a number of factors (see section 3 “Risk factors”). Factors that influence the dividend include the profitability, liquidity, capital requirements and business outlook of the Company as well as the general economic environment. 10.2 Earnings and dividend per share CSG-AG was a shelf company which was founded on 10 May 2010 and the Group was established in November 2010. Therefore no dividends were paid in the past. HWG-Ltd. as currently sole operating company of the Group did however generate profits and distribute dividends in the past. On the basis of its financial statements as at and for the years ended 31 December 2008, 31 December 2009 and 31 December 2010, the following summary shows the profit for the respective financial year of HWG-Ltd. and earnings per share (rounded to two decimal points), each in accordance with IFRS and its distributed dividends as of and for the years ended 31 December 2008, 31 December 2009 and 31 December 2010. For comparability with the share capital structure of the Company, it has been assumed that the number of shares used to calculate earnings per share and dividends per share is the number of shares in CSG-AG following the capital increase and transfer of shares in HWG-HK Holding to CSG-AG. Financial Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 10,600,000 14,131,000 22,252,000 8,103,000 0 2,339,000 15,050,000 15,050,000 15,050,000 Earnings per share in EUR (undiluted) ......... 0.70 0.94 1.48 Earnings per share in EUR (diluted) 0.70 0.94 1.48 Dividends per share in EUR 0.54 0.00 0.16 Profit for the year (in EUR) Dividends Assumed number of shares on 2010 31 December* * For better comparability, the number of shares in CSG-AG following the effectiveness of the capital increase to 15,050,000 shares has been used throughout the period. 136 11. DILUTION The net book value of the Company’s equity attributable to the Company’s shareholders amounted to EUR 52.7 million as of 31 March 2011 based on its interim consolidated financial statements prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards, as endorsed for application in the EU, for the three months ended 31 March 2011. This corresponds to approximately EUR 3.50 per share (calculated on the basis of 15,050,000 shares of the Company in issue as of the date of this Prospectus). Assuming that: • all 6,900,000 Offered Shares are placed; • the Underwriters fully exercise the Greenshoe Option; and • the Offer Price of EUR 10.50 corresponds to the midpoint of the price range of between EUR 9.00 and EUR 12.00, the net issue proceeds of the Offering accruing to the Company will amount to approximately EUR 58.0 million considered possible by the Company (see also Section 9 “Reasons for the Offering, Use of Issue Proceeds, Issue Costs and Interested Third Parties”) and assuming that the Offering which is the subject of this Prospectus had been implemented on or around 31 March 2011, the net book value of the Company’s equity attributable to the Company’s shareholders at that time would have amounted to approximately EUR 110.7 million (or approximately EUR 5.26 per share) (calculated on the basis of 21,950,000 shares of the Company in issue following full implementation of the capital increase against cash contributions). This corresponds to an increase in the net book value of CSG-AG’s equity attributable to the Company’s shareholders of approximately EUR 1.76 per share corresponding to an increase of 50.2% for the Existing Shareholders and a direct dilution of about EUR 5.24 per share for the purchasers of the Offered Shares and, thus, investors who acquire shares at the midpoint of the price range of between EUR 9.00 and EUR 12.00, which is EUR 10.50, per Offered Share are diluted by about 49.9%. The table below illustrates the amount by which the mid-point of the price range per share would exceed the total share capital per share (immediate dilution per share): 137 Price per share (€) 10.50 Equity attributable to shareholders of the Company per share (€) as of 31 March 2011 3.50 Calculated on the basis of 15,050,000 shares held by the Current Major Shareholders Amended equity attributable to shareholders of the Company per share (€) as of 31 March 2011, and as adjusted under the assumption of full implementation of the capital increase 5.26 Percentage by which the amended equity value exceeds the equity value 50.2% Amount (€) by which the price per share exceeds the total share capital per share (immediate dilution per share) 5.24 Percentage by which the price per share exceeds the total share capital per share 49.9% 138 12. CAPITALISATION, INDEBTEDNESS AND BORROWING REQUIREMENTS 12.1 Capitalisation and Indebtedness The following table shows the actual consolidated capitalisation and indebtedness of the Company in accordance with IFRS as endorsed for application in the EU as of 31 March 2011. The capitalisation of the Company will change following the implementation of the Offering due to the net issue proceeds accruing to the Company depending on the extent of the placement volume of the Delivery Shares and the according amount of the connected capital increase (see section 25.3 “Securities Loans and Greenshoe Option”). For further details please see section 14 “Operating and Financial Review”. Capitalization As at 31 March 2011 (in EUR thousand, unaudited) Total Current Debt 10,051 Guaranteed* 1,624 Secured - Unguaranteed/ Unsecured 8,427 Total Non Current Debt - Guaranteed - Secured - Unguaranteed/ Unsecured - Shareholder’s Equity (excl. retained earnings) 15,774 Share Capital 15,050 Legal Reserve 724 Other Reserves (excl. retained earnings and foreign exchange fluctuation reserve) Total - 25,825 *Short-term bank loans have been guaranteed by personal guarantees and mortgages from related parties. Further details are given in section 22 “Related Party Transactions”. 139 Indebtedness As at 31 March 2011 (in EUR thousand, unaudited) A. Cash 36,739 B. Cash Equivalent - C. Trading Securities - D. Liquidity (A + B + C) 36,739 E. Current Financial Receivable 13,815 F. Current Bank Debt 1,624 G. Current Portion of Non Current Debt - H. Other Current Financial Debt - I. Current Financial Debt (F + G + H) 1,624 J. Net Current Financial Indebtedness (I – E – D) (48,930) K. Non Current Bank Loans - L. Bonds Issued - M. Other Non Current Loans - N. Non Current Financial Indebtedness (K + L + M) - O. Net Financial Indebtedness (J + N) (48,930) The Group is exposed to contingent liabilities amounting to TEUR 264 for potential social security back payment claims, at least TEUR 54 as tax-related contingencies and potential contingencies from an investment and construction project contract which are not quantifiable. Further details are given in section 14.6 “Critical Accounting Policies”. As at 31 March 2011, the HWG HK-Group had no further contingent or indirect liabilities. 12.2 Borrowing Requirements In order to finance the intended growth of China Specialty Glass-Group (see section 17.4 “Strategy”), further borrowing is necessary, especially to the extent that the investments under construction and under development and any further investments require financial resources in excess of the proceeds received by the Company from the Offering of the Delivery Shares. Although the Company estimates that it will have sufficient equity and debt resources following implementation of the Offering to fund its current and planned investments, no assurance is given that China Specialty Glass-Group will be in a position to conclude any necessary financing arrangements on favourable terms, or at all. In the event that China Specialty Glass-Group 140 was not in a position to secure the necessary financing, the Company could be forced to change its investment plans or to incur higher than expected financing costs. 12.3 Working Capital Statement In the opinion of the Company, the working capital of the Group is sufficient for the Group’s present requirements, that is to cover at least those payment obligations which will become due within the twelve months following the date of this Prospectus. 141 13. SELECTED FINANCIAL INFORMATION With regard to the establishment of the Group in November 2010, the Group has a complex financial history within the meaning of art. 4 a of the Regulation (EC) No. 809/2004. The Company was founded on 10 May 2010, registered on 18 May 2010 and then acquired on 27 May 2010 by the Founding Shareholder Luckyway Global Group Limited. On 30 June 2010, the General Shareholders’ Meeting resolved a capital increase from EUR 50,000.00 by EUR 15,000,000.00 to EUR 15,050,000.00 through the issuance of an aggregate of 15,000,000 shares against contributions in kind. Luckyway Global Group Limited, Quick Reach Group Limited, Expert Intelligence Global Limited, Sea Dragon Investments Limited and Hong Kong Investment Group Limited acquired all shares by contributing all their shares in HWG HK-Holding into the Company. The capital increase became legally effective on 22 November 2010. This led to the formation of the Group. Thus, CSG-AG’s consolidated financial statements for the short financial year 2010 (from date of initial existence of the Group on 22 November 2010 until 31 December 2010), in which the Company’s subsidiaries were consolidated as of 22 November 2010, the consolidated interim financial statements of CSG-AG for the three months ended 31 March 2011 as well as the single entity financial statements of CSG-AG for the short financial year 2010 (from 10 May 2010 until 31 December 2010) are the first financial data (within the meaning of annex 1 no. 20.1 of the Regulation (EC) No. 809/2004) of the Company and the Group in its current form, other historical data do not exist. The aforementioned financial statements of CSG-AG are in accordance with IFRS as endorsed for application in the EU with the exception of the single entity financial statements which are in accordance with HGB. The consolidated financial statements for 2010 as well as the single entity financial statements for 2010 have been audited by Grant Thornton, whereas the consolidated interim financial statements have been reviewed by Grant Thornton. The Company is the holding company of HWG HK-Group and thereby is managing the respective companies and/or administering the participation of the respective companies in the glass industry. The HWG HK-Group consists of HWG HK-Holding, HWG-Ltd. and HWG-SC. The operational business of the Group is currently carried out exclusively by HWG-Ltd. and will in future, according to the Company’s plans, also be carried out by HWG-SC. HWG-SC, which was established in May 2010, has not yet started operational trading 142 business, although it has already invested in property, plant and equipment, land use rights and design rights and has assumed liabilities in respect of its investments and commitments in respect of its planned investments. The entities of HWG HK-Group existing prior to the incorporation of the Company are under common control within the meaning of IFRS 3 “Business Combinations”. In order to present the net assets, financial position and results of operations for the last three fiscal years and the first quarter of 2011 in relation to the operational business which is entirely carried out in China, HWG-Ltd. has prepared financial statements in accordance with IFRS, as endorsed for application in the EU, as of and for the years ended 31 December 2008, 31 December 2009 and 31 December 2010 as well as interim financial statements for the three months ended 31 March 2011. These financial statements were audited by Grant Thornton with the exception of the interim financial statements which have been reviewed by Grant Thornton. The aforementioned financial statements of HWG-Ltd. are not the legally required financial statements of the Company but have been prepared on a voluntary basis for the purpose of this Offering. The purpose of these financial statements is to allow the investor to compare the development of the business, financial condition and the results of operations of the Company over the last three years and the first quarter of 2011. As, in addition, the consolidated financial statements and single entity financial statements of CSG-AG only refer to a short financial year (2010), the selected financial information which is reflected in this section was derived from the aforementioned financial statements of HWG-Ltd. and the consolidated interim financial statements of CSG-AG for the three months ended 31 March 2011. For a number of reasons, the comparability of the financial information presented in the tables below is subject to significant limitations: The financial information set out below should be read in conjunction with the explanations and notes given by the management in section 14 “Operating and Financial Review”. The tables below show selected information relating to the financial statements of HWG-Ltd. for the financial years 2008, 2009 and 2010 and the first quarter of 2011 and to the consolidated interim financial statements of CSG-AG for the first quarter of 2011. 143 The following figures were commercially rounded; their sums when added may not be the same as the sums indicated. HWG-Ltd. Selected Financial Information Twelve months ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 (audited)¹ (audited)¹ (audited)¹ EUR EUR thousand % EUR thousand % thousand % Selected Statement of Comprehensive Income Data Revenue 40,216 100% 50,910 100% 69,564 100% Cost of sales -23,000 57% -28,032 55% -38,111 55% Gross Profit Selling and distribution expenses 17,216 43% 22,878 45% 31,453 45% -1,205 3% -1,704 3% -2,277 3% -848 2% -874 2% -1,038 1% -965 3% -1,384 3% -1,878 3% 14,198 35% 18,916 37% 26,260 38% 51 0% 47 0% 108 0% -104 0% -106 0% -110 0% 14,145 35% 18,857 37% 26,258 38% -3,545 9% -4,726 9% -4,006 6% 10,600 26% 14,131 28% 22,252 32% Administrative expenses Research and development costs Profit from operations Finance income Finance costs Profit before income tax Income tax Profit for the period Selected Statement of financial position Data Total assets 24,892 31,753 59,651 Total liabilities 12,604 6,904 10,299 Total equity 12,288 24,849 49,352 10,841 11,548 22,343 -710 -185 -4,706 Selected Cash Flow and Financing Data Cash flow from operating activities Cash flow from investing activities Cash flow from financing activities Cash at end of period Interest bearing bank borrowings Net funds (Cash less borrowings) -5,725 -7,672 859 14,330 16,811 37,801 1,383 1,604 1,813 12,947 15,207 35,988 Other Selected Financial data Gross profit margin 42.8% 44.9% 45.2% EBIT 14,198 18,916 26,260 EBIT margin 35.3% 37.2% 37.7% Net profit margin 26.4% 27.8% 32.0% 467 464 451 Number of employees ¹ Audited information with the exception of "Other Selected Financial Data" which is calculated or derived from the audited financial statements 144 HWG-Ltd. Selected Financial Information Three months ended 31 March 2011 (reviewed)1 EUR thousand Three months ended 31 March 2010 (reviewed)1 EUR thousand % % Selected Statement of Comprehensive Income Data Revenue 16,441 Cost of sales Gross Profit Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Research and development costs Profit from operations Finance income Finance costs Profit before income tax Income tax Profit for the period 100% 11,454 100% -8,850 54% -6,451 56% 7,591 46% 5,003 44% -609 4% -441 4% -326 2% -190 2% -391 2% -338 3% 6,265 38% 4,034 35% 79 0% 18 0% -30 0% -22 0% 6,314 38% 4,030 35% -950 5% -685 6% 5,364 33% 3,345 29% Selected Balance Sheet Data² Total assets Total liabilities Total equity Selected Cash Flow and Financing Data Cash flow from operating activities Cash flow from investing activities Cash flow from financing activities Cash at end of period Interest bearing bank borrowings Net funds (Cash less borrowings) 61,998 59,651 9,627 10,299 52,371 49,352 3,109 6,114 -2,368 -2 -142 -22 36,700 24,668 1,624 1,747 35,076 22,921 46.2% 43.6% Other Selected Financial data Gross profit margin EBIT 6,265 4,034 EBIT margin 38.1% 35.2% Net profit margin 32.6% 29.2% 456 456 Number of employees ¹ The interim financial data has been subject to review. ² The 2010 figures shown in the “Selected Balance Sheet Data” derive from the twelve months ended 31 December 2010 shown in the financial statements of HWG-Ltd. 145 CSG-AG Selected Consolidated Financial Information Three months ended 31 March 2011 (reviewed)1 EUR Thousand Short year ended 31 December 2010 (audited) EUR Thousand % Selected Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income Data Revenue 16,441 100% Cost of sales -8,850 54% Gross profit Selling and distribution expenses 7,591 46% -609 4% -440 3% -391 2% 6,151 37% Administrative expenses Research and development costs Profit from operations Finance income Finance costs Profit before income tax Taxation Net profit 37 0% -26 0% 6,162 37% -950 5% 5,212 32% Selected Consolidated Balance Sheet Data Total assets 62,728 60,374 Total liabilities 10,051 10,563 Equity 52,677 49,811 Selected Consolidated Cash Flow Data Cash flow from operating activities Cash flow from investing activities Cash flow from financing activities Cash at end of period Interest bearing bank borrowings Net cash (cash and cash equivalents less interest bearing bank liabilities) 2,516 -2,386 -138 36,739 37,912 1,624 1,813 35,115 36,099 Further Selected Consolidated Financial Data Gross profit margin EBIT 46,2% 6,151 EBIT-margin 37,4% Net profit margin 31,7% Number of employees 456 ¹ The interim financial data has been subject to review. 146 % 14. OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW The Company was founded on 10 May 2010 and registered on 18 May 2010 and therefore has no historical data, except for the consolidated financial statements for the short financial year 2010 (from 22 November 2010 until 31 December 2010), the consolidated interim financial statements of CSG-AG for the three months ended 31 March 2011 as well as the single entity financial statements for the short financial year 2010 (from 10 May 2010 until 31 December 2010). Since the business of China Specialty Glass-Group essentially corresponds to the business activities of its wholly owned indirect subsidiary, HWG-Ltd., the following discussion and analysis of the financial condition and results of operations is based on the audited financial statements of HWG-Ltd. in accordance with IFRS, as endorsed for application in the EU, as of 31 December 2008, 31 December 2009 and 31 December 2010 as well as the reviewed interim financial statements of HWG-Ltd. for the three months ended 31 March 2011. The audited financial statements of HWG-Ltd. for the financial years ended 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010, the reviewed interim financial statements of HWG-Ltd. for the three months ended 31 March 2011, the audited consolidated financial statements of CSG-AG for the short financial year 2010 (from the date of the Group coming into existence on 22 November 2010 until 31 December 2010), the reviewed consolidated interim financial statements of CSG-AG for the three months ended 31 March 2011 as well as the audited single entity financial statements of CSG-AG for the short financial year 2010 (from incorporation of CSG-AG on 10 May 2010 until 31 December 2010) are presented in the Financial Section of this Prospectus. All the aforementioned financial statements have been prepared in accordance with IFRS, as endorsed for application in the EU, with the exception of the single entity financial statements of CSG-AG which are in accordance with HGB. The financial information printed in the Financial Section of this Prospectus does not guarantee any future financial condition and results of operations of China Specialty Glass-Group or in respect of any periods other than those covered by it. The following discussion and analysis of the business, financial condition and results of operations of the operative company HWG-Ltd. should be read in conjunction with other information in this Prospectus, including but not limited to section 3 “Risk Factors”, section 12 “Capitalisation, Indebtedness 147 and Borrowing Requirements” and section 17 “Business”, including the financial statements and the related notes thereto contained in the Financial Section and section 13 ‘‘Selected Financial Information’’ of this Prospectus. As HWG-Ltd. is currently the sole operating company of the China Specialty Glass-Group and none of the other group entities had any trading operations during 2008 to 2010, the financial data of the China Specialty Glass-Group for these periods is substantially that of HWG-Ltd. and hence only this data of HWG-Ltd. is presented, discussed and analysed below. The major differences between the financial data of HWG-Ltd. and the consolidated financial data of CSG-AG can be explained on the basis of their respective interim financial statements for the three months ended 31 March 2011 as follows: HWG-SC incurred TEUR 27 of administrative costs in the three months to 31 March 2011 (three months to March 2010 TEUR 0), and consequently the consolidated profit of CSG-AG for the three months to 31 March 2011 is TEUR 27 lower than the profit for the single entity HWG-Ltd. for the three months to 31 March 2011 in this regard. HWG-SC has not yet started operational trading business, although it has already invested in property, plant and equipment, land use rights and design rights and has assumed liabilities in respect of its investments and commitments in respect of its planned investments. These investments amounted to EUR 3.9 million as at 31 March 2011. HWG-SC has bank balances of TEUR 29, liabilities to related parties of EUR 3.0 million and equity of EUR 1.0 million as at 31 March 2011. HWG HK-Holding incurred TEUR 37 of administrative costs in the three months to 31 March 2011, and consequently the consolidated profit of CSG-AG for the three months to 31 March 2011 is TEUR 37 lower than the profit for the single entity HWG-Ltd. for the three months to 31 March 2011 in this regard. HWG HK-Holding did not incur any material administrative costs in the three months to 31 March 2010, hence there are no material differences between the profit of HWG-Ltd. and the consolidated profit of HWG HK-Holding for the three months to 31 March 2010. CSG-AG incurred TEUR 49 of administrative costs in the three months to 31 March 2011 (three months to 31 March 2010 TEUR 0), and consequently consolidated profit of CSG-AG for the three months to 31 March 2011 is TEUR 49 lower than the profit for the single entity HWG-Ltd. for the three months to 31 March 2011 in this regard. CSG-AG also owes its shareholder Luckyway TEUR 996 for financing of running costs and advance payments of IPO related costs. The advance payments of IPO related costs amounted to 148 TEUR 876 at 31 March 2011 and were recorded under other assets as payments made in advance. The consolidated financial data of CSG-AG at 31 March 2011 discloses EUR 0.7 million higher assets, EUR 0.3 million higher equity and EUR 0.4 million higher liabilities than the single entity financial data of HWG-Ltd. at 31 March 2011. At 31 March 2011, net funds (Cash less borrowings) are EUR 35.1 million in the consolidated financial data of CSG-AG and also in the single entity financial data of HWG-Ltd. because none of the Group companies apart from HWG-Ltd. had substantial cash balances. With reference to the single entity financial statements of CSG-AG, this company is a holding company, has neither sales nor employees and its major asset is its investment in HWG HK-Holding. The following figures were commercially rounded. It is therefore possible that the addition of such rounded amounts will not yield the same figures as the sum of the full amounts. 14.1 Overview China Specialty Glass-Group develops, produces and sells specialty glass under its “Hing Wah” brand. The Group distributes its products to customers in the domestic market in China directly through its own sales network. China Specialty Glass-Group considers itself to be one of the leading specialty glass manufacturers in China producing in particular security glass for the Chinese banking and automotive refitting manufacturers industry and various specialty glass products for the Construction Glass Market. For bulletproof security glass products which are demanded by the Chinese banking and automotive refitting manufacturers industry, the Group is a significant player in the respective security glass market segment, both in terms of production output and market share. China Specialty Glass-Group’s current operative facility is located in Guangzhou in the Guangdong Province in southern China and managed by the Group’s operative company HWG-Ltd. China Specialty Glass-Group’s major products sold under its “Hing Wah” brand name are categorized into two groups: security glass and construction glass. Security glass is divided into two main segments, according to its area of application: firstly, security glass which improves the security of fixed locations, e.g. bank branches or jewellery stores (collectively 149 referred to as “bank security glass”), and secondly, security glass for the refitting of vehicles in the automotive sector (collectively referred to as “automotive security glass”). Security glass includes bulletproof glass, bomb blast-resistant glass and intruder-resistant glass. Construction glass includes architectural laminated glass, architectural tempered glass, fire-resistant glass, hollow glass and electrically-controlled colour-changing glass. The demand for the Group’s security glass products derives mainly from the Chinese banking and automotive refitting manufacturers industry. On the one hand, the Group’s bank security glass is demanded by commercial entities where cash or valuable goods are traded such as banks, jewellery stores, securities brokerage houses, postal service and insurance companies. On the other hand, the Group’s automotive security glass is used for refitting vehicles for which security and safety have a high priority such as cash-in-transit vehicles for banks, police vehicles, military personnel carriers and armoured limousines. In addition, the Group provides its construction glass products mainly to the construction industry, where they are used as windows, doors, curtain walls (outer covering of buildings of which the outer walls are non-structural and merely protect the building from the weather) or internal decorations in commercial buildings and private houses. The Group has sold its products since 1994 and its end customers are exclusively commercial enterprises, such as banks for its bank security glass, refitting automobile manufacturers for its automotive security glass and construction service providers for its construction glass. For the distribution of the Group’s products, the Group currently relies on its own sales network consisting of sales representatives covering 19 provinces and regions in China. The demand for security glass by the banking and the automotive refitting manufacturers industry and for construction glass by construction service providers in China is increasing. Similarly, the Group, which is engaged in these markets, has grown with the respective markets. The sales of HWG-Ltd. increased from EUR 40.2 million in 2008 to EUR 50.9 million in 2009 and to EUR 69.6 million in 2010. The net profits of HWG-Ltd. increased from EUR 10.6 million in 2008 to EUR 14.1 million in 2009 and to EUR 22.3 million in 2010. In this respect, the Group benefited from its leading position in the respective glass market. Accordingly, bank security glass with sales of EUR 17.5 million, EUR 23 million and EUR 32.1 million and automotive security glass with sales of EUR 15.4 million, EUR 22.4 million and EUR 150 30 million have been the most significant revenue contributors for the years 2008, 2009 and 2010, generating 43.5%, 45.2% and 46.1% and 38.3%, 44.0% and 43.1% of total revenue, respectively. Following research studies, the Chinese security glass market segments (bank, automotive refitting manufacturers) and Construction Glass Market are expected to continue to develop positively in the future. In particular, with the expected increase in consumer wealth and commercial activities, the commercial entities which demand bank security glass are also expected to expand both in number (e.g., increase of bank branches in rural areas and smaller cities) and in individual size (e.g., increase of operating surface area of post offices). In respect of these commercial entities, safety measures where security glass plays a major role are closely monitored and regulated by the government. Therefore, the Company hopes that the demand for the Group’s products, which are certified by the regulatory authorities, will increase accordingly. Similarly, an increase in the number of wealthy Chinese citizens and their concern for and awareness of safety and security for themselves and their families bodes well for an increase in demand for the Group’s automotive security glass or construction glass products. 14.2 Key Factors Affecting Results of Operations The Company believes that the following factors have either contributed materially to the development of the financial condition and results of operations of the Group during the period covered by the historical financial information included in the Financial Section of this Prospectus, or are expected to have a material influence on the Group’s financial condition and results of operations. 14.2.1 Changes in raw material prices The profitability of China Specialty Glass-Group’s business is affected by changes in costs of raw materials, in particular changes in the price of flat glass. The costs of purchasing flat glass collectively account for the majority of the operative Group subsidiary HWG-Ltd.’s total cost of sales. China is the largest normal flat glass producer in the world. 577 million weight boxes (one weight box equals 50 kg, or 10 square meters of 2 mm thick glass [source: Baidu, http://baike.baidu.com/view/1511663.htm from Taglist as of 23 July 2010]) of normal glass were produced in China from 1 January 2010 until 30 November 2010 (source: Icandata, http://www.icandata.com/data/201103/031GM3292011.html). This can be 151 translated to 28.85 million tons or 5.77 billion square meters of 2 mm thick flat glass. The basic raw material supply for bulletproof glass in China is sufficient. There were more than 4,000 specialty (technical) glass manufacturers in China in 2009 (source: p. 26 and 82 of Respect Marketing Research Report (“RMR Report”), 2010). There were more than 1,000 tempered glass manufacturers in China. In 2009, these manufacturers produced about 180 million square meters of tempered glass, 40 million square meters of laminated glass, 150 million square meters of insulating glass and more than 80 million square meters of surface-coated glass. Within the glass industry in China a specialty glass industry with a wide range of products has already developed, which can competently meet production demand from bulletproof glass enterprises (source: p. 26 and 82 of RMR Report, 2010). Therefore, the price of flat glass is expected to remain stable in the foreseeable future. To the extent that China Specialty Glass-Group is able to pass on higher raw material costs to its customers or to agree on certain price increases with them, its results of operation are not expected to be adversely affected. If the costs of raw materials decrease and China Specialty Glass-Group has to lower the price of its products accordingly, its results of operations are expected to be positively affected. Any significant change in raw material costs, and in particular for the purchase of flat glass, is expected to have a minor effect on China Specialty Glass-Group’s results of operations. 14.2.2 Changes in applicable tax rates of HWG-Ltd. For the financial years 2008 to 2010, HWG-Ltd. as operative company calculated its enterprise income tax (“EIT”) using the unified tax rate of 25% in 2008 and 2009 and 15% in 2010. In 2009, HWG-Ltd. was approved to be a national high-tech enterprise by the Ministry of Science and Technology. According to the Method for Ratifying and Managing High-tech Enterprises issued by the Ministry of Science and Technology, Ministry of Finance and National Taxation Bureau, HWG-Ltd. was granted, in April 2010, a preferential treatment on EIT, which was reduced to 15% from the original 25%. This exemption enabled HWG-Ltd. to improve its post tax profitability after 2009. As this change of tax status was granted by the local tax authority in April 2010, HWG-Ltd. used the 25% tax rate for the first three months in 2010 and 15% for the rest of the year. As the new tax rate applied retrospectively to 1 January 2010, the over-paid tax is treated as tax receivables. 152 14.2.3 Increase in labour costs The production of bulletproof glass products in China is quite labour-intensive and almost all of China Specialty Glass-Group’s work force is located in China. Average annual salaries of urban employees in the PRC increased significantly within the periods under review. This increase is also a result of the introduction of new labour law legislation in China that became effective as of 1 January 2008 and general shortage of skilled workers in China. The average labour remuneration of state-owned enterprises in urban areas in 2009 increased by 12% over 2008 while that of privately-owned enterprises in 2009 increased by 6.6% over 2008 (National Bureau of Statistics of China, http://www.stats.gov.cn/ tjfx/jdfx/t20100716_402657787.htm, http:// www.stats.gov.cn/was40/gjtjj_detail.jsp?channelid=19761&record=31). 14.2.4 Effects of currency fluctuations The financial statements of HWG-Ltd. (as the operative company of China Specialty Glass-Group) for the periods under review were prepared in EUR and CSG-AG’s consolidated financial statements for the short financial year 2010 as well as future consolidated financial statements will be prepared in EUR, while HWG-Ltd.’s operating currency is RMB, which is currently not a freely convertible currency. A devaluation of the RMB versus the EUR would therefore have an adverse foreign currency translation effect on China Specialty Glass-Group’s consolidated financial statements. As the value of RMB is controlled by PRC authorities, it is possible that foreign exchange policies of the PRC government could have a significant impact on foreign currency exchange rates. An increase in the value of RMB against the EUR would therefore increase China Specialty Glass-Group’s profitability measured in EUR while alternatively a decrease in the value of RMB against EUR would decrease China Specialty Glass-Group’s profitability measured in EUR. 14.2.5 Demand for bulletproof glass in China According to statistics from the China Architectural and Industrial Glass Association, the demand for bulletproof glass in China reached 1.196 million square meters in 2009, maintaining a growth rate of at least 25% annually for five years successively. In 2009, the actual output of bulletproof glass was 957,000 square meters, with the potential unfilled demand reaching 273,100 square meters. Furthermore, from the gap between the supply and demand in recent years, the growth speed of demand exceeded that of output. 153 From 2005 to 2009, the demand scale of bulletproof bank glass in China exceeded the scale of output. In 2006, the demand scale was 287,000 square meters, enjoying year-on-year growth of 33.49% and in 2007, the two figures were 371,000 square meters and 29.27% respectively. In 2008, the demand for bulletproof bank glass was 424,000 square meters and in 2009, the demand scale was 516,000 square meters, seeing a year-on-year growth of 21.7%. From 2005 to 2009, the bulletproof car market in China developed rapidly, increasing the demand for bulletproof automotive glass products. In 2005, the demand for bulletproof automotive glass was 159,000 square meters; in 2006, 189,000 square meters; in 2007, 223,000 square meters, witnessing year-on-year growth of about 18%; and in 2008, this figure reached 355,000 square meters, up by 59.19% compared with 2007; in 2009, the figure was 487,000 square meters, seeing a year-on-year growth of 37.18%. From 2005 to 2007, the bulletproof glass industry in China maintained swift growth. In 2007, the market size of bulletproof glass reached RMB 770 million (EUR 74 million). In 2008, the industry slowed its growth due to the financial crisis. In 2009, the growth of the bulletproof glass market in China reached 18.29%, with the total market size reaching RMB 974 million (EUR 103 million). Despite the significant impact of the financial crisis, the sales revenue of the industry is showing a positive growth trend. Hence, the ability to increase the profitability of the Group’s products will depend on its ability to expand its production capacity and market penetration in China. 14.3 Results of Operations The following discussion of the results of operations is based on the audited financial statements of HWG-Ltd. in accordance with IFRS, as endorsed for application in the EU as of 31 December 2008, 31 December 2009 and 31 December 2010 and the first quarter of 2011 (reviewed): 154 31 December (audited) Revenue 31 March (reviewed) 2008 2009 2010 2011 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR 40,216 50,910 69,564 16,441 11,454 Cost of sales -23,000 -28,032 -38,111 -8,850 -6,451 Gross Profit 17,216 22,878 31,453 7,591 5,003 Selling and distribution Expenses -1,205 -1,704 -2,277 -609 -441 Administrative expenses -848 -874 -1,038 -326 -190 Research and development -965 -1,384 -1,878 -391 -338 14,198 18,916 26,260 6,265 4,034 51 47 108 79 18 -104 -106 -110 -30 -22 Profit before income tax 14,145 18,857 26,258 6,314 4,030 Income tax expenses -3,545 -4,726 -4,006 -950 -685 Profit attributable to shareholders 10,600 14,131 22,252 5,364 3,345 2,229 -1,570 3,621 -2,345 2,325 12,829 12,561 25,873 3,019 5,670 Profit from operations Finance income Finance costs Other comprehensive income: Exchange Differences Total comprehensive income after tax 14.3.1 Revenues Revenues of HWG-Ltd., which is the operative company of China Specialty Glass-Group, are exclusively earned from the sales of security glass to banks and refitting automotive manufacturers and construction glass products to the construction industry. Revenues were EUR 40.2 million in the financial year 2008, as a result of an increase of 8% in the average selling price of bank security glass as well as an increase of 12.5% in the quantity of automotive security glass which was partially offset by a slight decreases in the quantity of bank security glass by 3.7% and of construction glass by 8.3%. In the financial year 2009, revenues increased further by 26.6% over the previous year to EUR 50.9 million. This was due to 4%, 11% and 26% increases in the average unit selling price of bank security glass, automotive security glass and construction glass, respectively, as well as increases in quantity of bank security glass and automotive security glass by 18.8% and 27.5%, respectively. These increases were partially offset by the significant decrease by 43.4% in quantity of construction glass sold. 155 In the financial year 2010, revenues increased further by 36.6% over the previous year to EUR 69.6 million. This was due to an increase in quantity of bank security glass by 74,000 square meters and automotive security glass by 13,000 square meters sold as well as an increase in average selling prices in all market segments. In the first quarter of 2011, revenues were EUR 16.4 million compared to EUR 11.5 million for the first three months of 2010 due to the company being able to increase both quantity and price of products sold. The Group’s customers are commercial entities and financial institutions such as refitting automobile manufacturers and state-owned banks which select security glass product suppliers such as the Group through bidding processes. The following table shows the changes in revenues according to segment for the financial years 2008, 2009 and 2010: 31 December (audited) Segments 31 March (reviewed) 2008 2009 2010 2011 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR Bank Security Glass 17,530 23,039 32,083 6,514 4,768 Auto Security Glass 15,448 22,354 29,971 7,940 5,222 Construction Glass 7,238 5,517 7,510 1,987 1,464 40,216 50,910 69,564 16,441 11,454 Bank Security Glass Revenues from bank security glass were EUR 17.5 million in 2008 and increased by 7.4% over the previous year (EUR 16.3 million). This increase was due to an increase in average unit selling price of 8% of HWG-Ltd. which was partially offset by a decrease in quantity by 3.7% to approximately 252,000 square meters during the year. In 2009, revenues from bank security glass increased strongly by 31.4% over the previous year to EUR 23.0 million. This increase was due to an increase in the average unit selling price of 4% of HWG-Ltd. together with an increase in quantity by 18.8% to approximately 299,000 square meters during the year. In 2010, revenues from bank security glass further increased strongly by 156 39.3% over 2009 to EUR 32.1 million, due to an increase in quantity sold by 24.1% to 371,200 square meters and a slight increase in average selling prices by 5,5%. In the first quarter of 2011, revenues from bank security glass were EUR 6.5 million compared to EUR 4.8 million in the first quarter of 2010. Automotive Security Glass Revenue from the automotive security glass segment rose from EUR 13.4 million in 2007 by 14.9% in 2008 to EUR 15.4 million. This increase in revenue was due to an increase in the quantity of automotive security glass sold by 12.5% to approximately 133,000 square meters. Revenue from the automotive security glass segment increased by 44.7% to EUR 22.4 million in 2009. This increase in revenue was due to an increase in the quantity of automotive security glass sold by 27.5% to approximately 169,000 square meters as well as an increase in its average unit selling price by 11% during the year. Revenue from the automotive security glass segment further increased by 34.1% to EUR 30 million in 2010, which was solely due to a rise in average selling prices by 17.3%, as quantities sold increased only slightly. In the first quarter of 2011, revenues from automotive security glass were EUR 7.9 million compared to EUR 5.2 million in the first quarter of 2010. Construction Glass Revenue from the construction glass segment declined from EUR 7.7 million in 2007 by 6.5% to EUR 7.2 million in 2008. This decrease in revenue was due to a decrease in the quantity of construction glass sold by 8.3% to approximately 666,400 square meters. Revenue from the construction glass segment in 2009 fell by 23.8% to EUR 5.5 million. This reduction in revenue was due to a decrease in the quantity of construction glass sold by 43.4% to approximately 377,400 square meters which was partially offset by an increase in its average unit selling price by 26% during the year. In 2010 revenue from the construction glass segment increased by 36.1% to EUR 7.5 million, which was solely due to a rise in average selling prices, as quantities sold fell slightly. 157 In the first quarter of 2011, revenues from the construction glass segment were EUR 2.0 million compared to EUR 1.5 million in the first quarter of 2010. 14.3.2 Cost of Sales 31 December (audited) 31 March (reviewed) 2008 2009 2010 2011 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR 6,514 4,768 3,836 2,915 60.1% 58.9% 61.1% Bank Security Glass Revenues 17,530 23,039 Cost of sales 10,354 13,313 Cost of sales/revenue (%) 59.1% 57.8% 32,083 19,274 Auto Security Glass Revenues 15,448 22,354 29,971 7,940 5,222 Cost of sales 6,964 10,350 13,456 3,629 2,394 Cost of sales/revenue (%) 45.1% 46.3% 44.9% 45.7% 45.8% 7,238 5,517 7,510 1,987 1,464 Construction Glass Revenues Cost of sales 5,682 4,369 5,381 1,385 1,142 Cost of sales/revenue (%) 78.5% 79.2% 71.7% 69.7% 78.0% 16,441 11,454 Total Revenues 40,216 50,910 69,564 Cost of sales 23,000 28,032 38,111 8,850 6,451 54.8% 53.8% 56.3% Cost of sales/revenue (%) 57.2% 55.1% Cost of sales of the operative company HWG-Ltd. mainly relate to costs of direct materials such as ordinary glass and organic materials, direct labour costs and manufacturing overheads. The overall ratio of cost of sales to revenue declined from 57.2% in 2008 to 55.1% in 2009. The decrease in the ratio of cost of sales to revenues was due to a 31.4% increase in revenues from the bank security glass segment and a 44.7% increase in revenues from the automotive security glass segment as well as the lower cost of sales to revenue ratio in these segments compared to the construction glass segment but was partially offset by the decrease in revenues from the construction glass segment due to a reduction 158 in sales quantity by 43.4%. Average prices for normal flat glass used for the production of bulletproof glass increased by approximately 14.3% in 2009, compared to the previous year. Cost of sales as a percentage of revenues was 78.5% in the construction glass segment in 2008 and 79.2% in 2009 as a result of decrease in sales quantity by 43.4%. In contrast, the ratio of cost of sales to revenues in the bank security glass segment fell slightly to 57.8% in 2009 compared to 59.1% in 2008 and that in the automotive security glass segment increased to 46.3% in 2009 compared to 45.1% in 2008. The overall cost of sales to revenue ratio declined from 55.1% in 2009 to 54.8% in 2010. The continued decrease in the ratio of cost of sales to revenues was due to an increase in average selling prices in all market segments. In 2010, the average prices for raw materials used for the production of security and construction glass increased by 8.8%. Cost of sales as a percentage of revenues was 79.2% in the construction glass segment in 2009 and 71.7% in 2010. In contrast, the ratio of cost of sales to revenues in the bank security glass segment increased slightly to 60.1% in 2010 compared to 57.8% in 2009 and that in the automotive security glass segment fell to 44.9% in 2010 compared to 46.3% in 2009. For the first three months of 2011, the overall cost of sales to revenue ratio was 53.8% compared to 56.3% for the first three months of 2010. 14.3.3 Selling and Distribution Expenses Selling and distribution expenses are principally comprised of transportation costs, salaries of sales personnel and after-sales personnel, motor vehicle expenses, travelling expenses and sales-related expenses. Selling and distribution expenses were TEUR 1,205 in 2008, which represents tight control over transportation costs compared to the 7.6% rise in revenues during the same period. In 2009, selling and distribution expenses rose by 41.4% over the previous year to TEUR 1,704, while revenues increased by 26.6%. This above-average increase in selling and distribution expenses mainly derives from the increase of transportation costs by 49.5%. This increase of transportation costs was caused by the increase in sales and also by HWG-Ltd. selling more to customers based further away from the production facility. It was also affected by the increases in salaries and social insurance expenses resulting 159 from enhanced marketing in the bank and automotive security glass segments. In 2010 selling and distribution expenses rose by 33.6% over the previous year to TEUR 2,277, mainly due to higher sales commissions and a 26% increase in transportation costs. The increase in transportation costs was caused by the increase in sales and also by HWG-Ltd. selling more to customers based further away from the production facility. It was also affected by increases in salaries by 51% resulting from enhanced marketing in the bank and automotive security glass segments. In the first quarter of 2011, selling and distribution expenses were TEUR 609 compared to TEUR 441 for the first quarter of 2010. The increase was due to the increase in sales. The ratio of selling and distribution expenses to revenues remained relatively stable over the reporting period as a whole. It was 3.0% in 2008, 3.3% in 2009, 3.3% in 2010 and 3.7% in the first quarter of 2011 as compared to 3.9% in the first quarter of 2010, respectively. 14.3.4 Administrative expenses Administrative expenses consist of salaries, entertainment expenses, motor vehicle expenses, travelling expenses and other office related expenses. Administrative expenses remained relatively stable over the period from 2008 to 2010, increasing marginally from TEUR 848 in 2008 to TEUR 874 in 2009 and further increasing to TEUR 1,038 in 2010, owing to an increase in salaries and number of employees, entertainment, depreciation and travelling expenses and partially offset by the decrease in motor vehicle expenses and communication expenses during the year. In the first quarter of 2011, administrative expenses were TEUR 326 compared to TEUR 190 in the first quarter of 2010. 14.3.5 Research and development expenses Research and development expenses consist mainly of salaries for employees in the R&D department. In 2009, research and development expenses rose 43.4% over the previous year from TEUR 965 to TEUR 1,384. Research and development expenses increased further in 2010 by 35.6% to TEUR 1,878 in line with sales. The additional expenses were mainly due to the development of new products. In the first quarter of 2011, research and development expenses were TEUR 391 compared to TEUR 338 in the first quarter of 2010. 160 14.3.6 Finance income and finance costs Finance income relates exclusively to interest on bank balances. In 2008, finance income was TEUR 51, falling marginally to TEUR 47 in 2009 and increasing to TEUR 108 in the financial year 2010 due to the higher level of bank balances. In the first quarter of 2011, finance income was TEUR 79 compared to TEUR 18 in the first quarter of 2010. The increase was due to interest on a loan granted to HWG-SC. Finance costs increased marginally from TEUR 104 in 2008 to TEUR 106 in 2009, due primarily to the increase in interest bearing bank borrowings and despite the fall in interest rates in 2009. Finance costs rose slightly in 2010 from TEUR 106 to TEUR 110 and were TEUR 30 in the first quarter of 2011 compared to TEUR 22 in the first quarter of 2010. Finance costs relate exclusively to short-term interest bearing bank loans. The effective interest paid on short-term loans was 8.89% in 2008, 5.44% in 2009 and 5.72% in 2010 and 5.31% in the first quarter of 2011. 14.3.7 Income tax Income tax increased by 33.3% in 2009 from TEUR 3,545 in the previous year to TEUR 4,726, corresponding to the rate of increase in profit before income tax, which also was 33.3% over the same period. The tax rate remained at 25% as in the previous year. In 2010, income tax decreased by 15.2% to TEUR 4,006. Due to HWG-Ltd. having been granted a preferential tax rate as a “High-Tech Enterprise”, the tax rate fell to 15% compared to 25% in 2008 and 2009. In the first quarter of 2011 income tax was TEUR 950, in line with the tax rate of 15%. 14.4 Statement of financial position data The following discussion relating to selected statement of financial position items is based on the audited financial statements of HWG-Ltd. in accordance with IFRS, as endorsed for application in the EU as of 31 December 2008, 31 December 2009 and 31 December 2010 as well as on the reviewed condensed interim financial statements of HWG-Ltd. in accordance with IFRS, as endorsed for application in the EU, for the three months ended 31 March 2011. 14.4.1 Assets The following table shows selected asset components of the statement of financial position: 161 31 March 2011 31 December (audited) 2008 2009 2010 (reviewed) TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR 2,224 2,119 2,839 2,689 - 687 751 712 753 - - - - - 1,133 1,083 3,060 5,090 Non-current assets Property, plant and equipment Lease prepayment for land-use rights Other assets Investment in a subsidiary Loan to related parties 33 166 - - 3,010 2,972 7,783 9,574 Inventories 1,990 2,356 1,591 2,238 Trade and other receivables 5,562 9,614 11,967 12,935 Related party receivables - - 71 133 Tax receivables - - 438 418 14,330 16,811 37,801 36,700 21,882 28,781 51,868 52,424 24,892 31,753 59,651 61,998 Deferred tax asset Current assets Cash and cash equivalents Total assets 14.4.2 Non-current assets Non current assets comprise primarily property, plant and equipment, lease prepayment for land-use rights, other assets, investment in HWG-Ltd.'s subsidiary HWG-SC, loans to related parties and also a deferred tax asset. 14.4.3 Property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment mainly consists of a building under a 30 year lease, production machineries and tools while furniture, fixture and office equipment mainly consists of office furniture and equipment. Up until 2009, the amounts in relation to the finance lease building were treated as payments in advance for building. In 2009 the original intention to buy the building, for which the purchase price had been paid in advance, was changed to a long term lease agreement, and the rentals were deemed to have been paid in advance. In July 2009 HWG-Ltd. decided to lease rather than purchase the building for which the advance payment had been made in the year 2007. As the lease is 162 a finance lease, the building is capitalized as a leasehold building from July 2009 onwards. In addition to the aforementioned lease, HWG-Ltd. also leases property under operating leases from related parties. Such property under operating leases is not disclosed in the statement of financial position. Property, plant and equipment amounted to TEUR 2,224 in 2008 and decreased mainly due to depreciation and translation adjustments despite additions to TEUR 2,119 in 2009. In 2010 property, plant and equipment increased by 34.0% to TEUR 2,839, the main reason being investments in new leasehold buildings and plant and machinery as well as increases due to translation adjustments exceeding depreciation. There were no disposals. At the end of the first quarter of 2011, Property, plant and equipment amounted to TEUR 2,689. 14.4.4 Lease prepayment for land-use rights This relates to the land use rights for which an advance payment had been made in the year 2007 as described above under section 14.4.3 “Other assets”. Following the conclusion of the lease agreement described above, which HWG-Ltd. determined to be an operating lease in respect of the land, as the term is relatively short compared to the useful life of the land, the advance payment was reclassified as lease prepayment for land-use rights. The prepayment is being amortized to income over the 30 years term of the lease. 14.4.5 Other assets Other assets relate to land use rights. In the financial year 2007 HWG-Ltd. had made an advance payment to acquire these rights from a related party. The legal title was not transferred to the company and in 2009, it was decided to change the intended purchase agreement into a lease. From 2009 onwards the land use rights are disclosed as a lease prepayment for land-use rights as described in section 14.4.4 “Lease Prepayment for land-use rights”. 14.4.6 Investment in a subsidiary In 2010 HWG-Ltd. invested in a subsidiary in Sichuan, which was without trading operations at 31 December 2010. 163 14.4.7 Loan to related parties In 2010 HWG-Ltd. granted a long term unsecured and interest bearing loan of TEUR 3,060 to its subsidiary for the financing of capital investments made by this subsidiary. At 31 March 2011, the amount of this loan was TEUR 2,924, the change being due to foreign exchange conversion. In the first three months of 2011, HWG-Ltd. granted a further unsecured interest bearing long term loan to Mr. Nang Heung Sze for the purpose of financing future investments in Sichuan. The amount of that loan was TEUR 2,166 at 31 March 2011. Both loans bear interest at 5.56% and have a five year term from the date of the granting of the loan. 14.4.8 Deferred tax asset The deferred tax asset arises from temporary differences between the financial reporting and the tax accounts of HWG-Ltd. These arose on sales recognition differences in the past which no longer occurred in 2010 or in the first quarter of 2011. Hence at 31 December 2010 and at 31 March 2011 there was no deferred tax asset. 14.4.9 Current assets Current assets include primarily inventories, trade and other receivables and cash and cash equivalents. 14.4.10 Inventories Inventories relate to raw materials and finished goods. 31 December (audited) Raw materials Finished goods 31 March 2011 2008 2009 2010 (reviewed) TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR 1,078 1,113 694 934 912 1,243 897 1304 1,990 2,356 1,591 2,238 Inventories were TEUR 1,990 in 2008, consisting of TEUR 1,078 in raw materials and TEUR 912 in finished goods. Inventories increased by 18.4% in 2009 to TEUR 2,356, principally due to a significant increase in finished goods. In 2010, inventories fell by 32.5% to 164 TEUR 1,591, which was mainly the consequence of the company modifying its supply arrangements in 2010 to purchasing in general just for one month's production in advance. At 31 March 2011 inventories amounted to TEUR 2,238. 14.4.11 Trade and other receivables Trade and other receivables were TEUR 5,562 in 2008. In 2008 other receivables included advance payments for inventory of TEUR 242. Trade receivables increased by 72.8% in 2009 to TEUR 9,614, while revenues increased by 26.6% during the same period. Trade and other receivables were TEUR 11,967 in 2010, which represents an increase of 24.5%, compared to 2009, and includes a deposit made in connection with supply arrangements to secure the purchase of raw materials of TEUR 748. At 31 March 2011 trade and other receivables amounted to TEUR 12,935. All trade and other receivables are non-interest bearing. Trade receivables are recognized at original invoice amounts, which represent their fair value at the time of initial recognition. Individual bad debt allowance is only accounted for if the receivable is finally judged to be uncollectible. 14.4.12 Related party receivable A related party receivable of TEUR 71 is disclosed at 31 December 2010. There was no related party receivable balance at 31 December 2008 or at 31 December 2009. The related party receivable was TEUR 133 at 31 March 2011. 14.4.13 Tax receivable A tax receivable of TEUR 438 is disclosed resulting from overpayment of tax in 2010. Tax receivables did not occur at 31 December 2008 or 31 December 2009. At 31 March 2011, the tax receivable amounted to TEUR 418, and the difference was due to foreign exchange translation. 14.4.14 Cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents increased year on year from TEUR 14,330 in 2008 to TEUR 16,811 in 2009 and to TEUR 37,801 in 2010 due to the profitability 165 of HWG-Ltd. At 31 March 2011 cash and cash equivalents amounted to TEUR 36,700. 14.4.15 Liabilities and Equity The following table shows selected liability and equity items: 31 March 31 December (audited) 2008 2009 2010 2011 (reviewed) TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR Interest-bearing bank borrowings 1,383 1,604 1,813 1,624 Trade and other payables 2,230 3,751 4,908 4,805 888 1,549 1,311 1,032 8,103 - 2,267 2,166 12,604 6,904 10,299 9,627 Share capital 424 424 1,393 1,393 Statutory reserves 213 213 724 724 Current liabilities Income tax payable Dividends payable Capital and reserves Foreign currency translation reserve 1,412 -158 3,463 1,118 10,239 24,370 43,772 49,136 Total equity 12,288 24,849 49,352 52,371 Total liabilities and equity 24,892 31,753 59,651 61,998 Retained earnings 14.4.16 Current liabilities Current liabilities comprise interest-bearing bank borrowings, trade and other payables, income tax payable and dividends payable. 14.4.17 Interest-bearing bank borrowings Short-term bank loans were TEUR 1,383 in the financial year 2008, a new bank loan facility of TEUR 1,383 having been entered into, while two short-term bank loans were fully repaid. In the financial year 2009, short-term bank loans increased by 16.0% over the previous year to TEUR 1,604. This was the result of short-term borrowing used to finance working capital. As of 31 December 2009, total short-term bank loans of TEUR 1,604 consisted of two bank loans. 166 In 2010 the short-term bank loans of previous year were repaid and two new short-term bank loans of TEUR 1,813 were obtained to finance working capital so that At 31 December 2010, short term bank loans amounted to TEUR 1,813. At 31 March 2011 short term bank loans amounted to TEUR 1,624. 14.4.18 Trade and other payables Trade and other payables increased from TEUR 2,230 in 2008 to TEUR 3,751 in 2009. This increase is in line with the increase in cost of sales due to the positive development of HWG-Ltd.’s business. In 2010, trade and other payables further increased to TEUR 4,908 and at 31 March 2011 were TEUR 4,805. Other payables contain payables for wages and salaries, Value Added Tax (“VAT”) payable and accrued expenses. Other payables and accruals were TEUR 554 in 2008, TEUR 649 in 2009 and TEUR 1,021 in 2010. The increase in 2009 was mainly due to bonus payments to key personnel and the sales-related employees and the main reason for the increase in 2010 was an increase in VAT payable, due to the increase in sales. At 31 March 2011 other payables and accruals were TEUR 966 and mainly related to VAT and payroll and accrued expenses. 14.4.19 Income tax payable In the financial year 2009, income tax payable increased by 74.4%, from TEUR 888 in the previous year, to TEUR 1,549 in line with the increase in net profit before tax by 33.3% and decreased to TEUR 1,311 in the financial year 2010 in line with the reduction of the applicable tax rate. The amount at 31 December 2010 includes TEUR 114 of withholding tax on dividends. At 31 March 2011, income tax payable amounted to TEUR 1,032. 14.4.20 Dividends payable Dividends payables amounted to TEUR 8,103 at 31 December 2008, TEUR Nil at 31 December 2009 and TEUR 2,267 at 31 December 2010. Due to currency exchange movement, dividends payable were TEUR 2,166 at 31 March 2011. 167 14.4.21 Capital and reserves As reflected in the above table, total equity was TEUR 12,288 in 2008. The share capital was TEUR 424. Equity was TEUR 24,849 in 2009, representing an increase of 102.2% over the previous year. This increase was due to the net profit of TEUR 14,131 made in 2009. Negative foreign exchange translation effects reduced the foreign currency translation reserve component by TEUR 1,570 in 2009 to TEUR -158. As of 31 December 2010, total equity was TEUR 49,352, as further profits of TEUR 22,252 increased reserves after deducting dividends of TEUR 2,339 and a transfer to statutory reserve of TEUR 511 in the amount of TEUR 19,402 and the share capital was increased from TEUR 424 to TEUR 1,393. Positive foreign exchange translation effects increased the foreign currency translation reserve component of equity by TEUR 3,621 to TEUR 3,463. As of 31 March 2011, total equity was TEUR 52,371, as further profits increased reserves and the share capital remained TEUR 1,393. 14.5 Cash flow statement The following discussion relating to selected cash flow items is based on the audited financial statements of the operative company HWG-Ltd. in accordance with IFRS, as endorsed for application in the EU, as of 31 December 2008, 31 December 2009 and 31 December 2010 and the reviewed financial statements for the three months ended 31 March 2011. 168 31 Dec. (audited) 31 March (reviewed) 2008 2009 2010 2011 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR 14,145 18,857 26,258 6,314 29 127 181 104 37 - 13 26 -79 -18 Finance costs 104 106 110 30 22 Finance income -51 -47 -108 6 14,227 19,056 26,467 6,375 Profit before income tax Adjustments Depreciation of property, plant and equipment Change in lease prepayment for land-use rights Operating profit before working capital changes (Increase) / decrease in inventories (Increase) / decrease in trade and other receivables (Increase) in receivable from related party 638 -300 1,054 -738 -156 1,190 -4,915 -1,025 -1,549 4,450 - - -122 - - 1,767 656 119 -568 14,602 15,608 27,030 4,207 7,803 51 47 108 79 18 -3,812 -4,107 -4,795 -1,177 -1,707 10,841 11,548 22,343 3,109 -574 -80 -2 Income tax paid Net cash generated from operating activities 6 4,077 -1,453 (Decrease) / increase in trade and other payables Cash generated from operations Finance income received 4,030 Cash flows from investing activities Acquisition of property, plant and equipment 6,114 -710 -59 Advance payment for leasehold buildings - -126 Granting of loan to related party - - -2,955 -2,288 - Investment in a subsidiary - - -1,133 - - Construction in progress - - -44 - - -710 -185 -4,706 -2,368 -2 - Cash used in investment activities Cash flows from financing activities Bank borrowings obtained Repayment of bank borrowings Finance costs paid Dividend paid Proceeds of share capital issue Net cash from financing activities Net increase in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period Foreign currency translation difference Cash and cash equivalents at end of period 1,516 1,686 1,796 - -1,526 -1,349 -1,796 -112 -104 -106 -110 -30 -5,611 -7,903 - - - 969 - - -5,725 -7,672 859 -142 -22 4,406 3,691 18,496 599 8,199 14,330 16,811 37,801 6,090 16,811 1,725 -1,210 2,494 -1,700 1,767 14,330 16,811 37,801 36,700 24,668 14.5.1 Cash flow from operating activities Cash flow from operating activities increased by TEUR 707 from TEUR 10,841 in 2008 to TEUR 11,548 in 2009 and increased by a further TEUR 10,795 to TEUR 22,343 in 2010. In the first three months of 2011, cash flow from operating activities was TEUR 3,109 compared to TEUR 6,114 in the first three months of 2010. 14.5.2 Cash flow from investing activities Investment activity in the period from 2008 to 2010 was related to acquisition of property, plant and equipment as well as the advance payment for the land use rights and building which in 2009 became the subject of the 169 -22 30 year lease. Furthermore, in 2010 investment in the capital of and granting a loan to HWG-Ltd.'s subsidiary HWG-SC led to outflows of TEUR 1,133 and TEUR 2,955 respectively. In the first three months of 2011, cash outflow from investing activities was TEUR -2,368 mainly due to the granting of a loan to Mr. Nang Heung Sze, as compared to TEUR 2 for the first three months of 2010. 14.5.3 Cash flow from financing activities Cash flow from financing activities decreased by TEUR 1,947 from a cash outflow of TEUR –5,725 in 2008 to a cash outflow of TEUR -7,672 in 2009. In 2010 there was a cash inflow of TEUR 859. In 2008, repayments of short-term bank loans (TEUR 1,526) and new loans given by banks (TEUR 1,516) and dividends paid to shareholders (TEUR 5,611) led to cash outflow from financing activities of TEUR -5,725. In 2009, cash outflows from financing activities amounted to TEUR -7,672. This is mainly due to new bank loans (TEUR 1,686), the repayment of bank loans (TEUR 1,349) and dividends paid to shareholders (TEUR 7,903). In 2010 cash inflow from financing activities amounted to TEUR 859 mainly due to the receipt of the proceeds of the capital increase of TEUR 969 less outflows from finance costs paid of TEUR 110. In the first three months of 2011, cash outflow from financing activities was TEUR 142 mainly due to the repayment of part of the bank loans. 14.5.4 Change in cash funds Cash funds totalled TEUR 14,330 at the end of 2008, TEUR 16,811 at the end of 2009 and TEUR 37,801 at the end of 2010. As of 31 March 2011 cash funds totalled TEUR 36,700. The effects of currency rate fluctuation had a negative impact on the converted EUR value of cash balances held primarily in RMB. 14.6 Critical Accounting Policies HWG-Ltd. has identified the following critical accounting policies which require its management to make assumptions about matters that were uncertain at the time those policies were applied and with respect to which management could reasonably have made different assumptions in the relevant period or with respect to which changes in the assumptions 170 reasonably likely to occur from period to period would have a material impact on the presentation of its financial condition, changes in financial condition or results of operations. Investors should read the following paragraphs in conjunction with the financial statements and interim financial statements, including the related notes, set out in the Financial Section of this Prospectus from F-1 onwards. Critical accounting estimates and judgment Estimates and judgments are continually evaluated and are based on historical experiences and other factors, including expectations of future events that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. HWG-Ltd. makes estimates and assumptions concerning the future. The resulting accounting estimates and assumptions that have a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next financial year are discussed below: Key sources of estimation uncertainty Income taxes HWG-Ltd. has exposure to income tax arising from its operations in the PRC. Significant judgment is required in determining the provision for income taxes. There are also claims for which the ultimate tax determination is uncertain during the ordinary course of business. HWG-Ltd. recognizes liabilities for expected tax issues based on estimates of whether additional taxes will be due. When the final tax outcome of these matters is different from the amounts that were initially recognized, such differences will impact the income tax expense and deferred tax provisions in the period in which such determination is made. Depreciation of property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment are depreciated on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. Management determines the estimated useful lives of property, plant and equipment to be within 5 to 30 years. Changes in the expected level of usage and technological developments could impact the economic useful lives and the residual values of these assets. Therefore, future depreciation charges could be revised. A 5% difference in the expected useful lives of the property, plant and equipment would not result in a significant change to HWG-Ltd.’s net profit for the respective financial years. 171 Inventories Inventories are measured at the lower of cost and net realizable value. In estimating net realizable values, management takes into account the most reliable evidence available at the times the estimates are made. Changes in these estimates could result in revisions to the valuation of inventories. Provisions The respective legislation in the PRC requires HWG-Ltd. to commit itself to remediate any environmental damage which may have been incurred. Management is of the opinion that no environmental damage has been caused by HWG-Ltd. and hence has not provided for this. Critical judgment made in applying accounting policies In the process of applying HWG-Ltd.’s accounting policies as described below, management is of the opinion that there are no instances of application of judgments which are expected to have a significant effect on the amounts recognized in the financial statements. Estimation of cost attributable to other assets (land use rights) and to property plant and equipment In 2007, HWG-Ltd. made an advance payment for land use rights and building, which it intended to purchase. The advance payment of € 1,801,000 was not attributed separately to land use rights and to the building at the time the advance payment was made. Management obtained a valuation report which stated the market value of the land use rights and the market value of the building. The total market value was above the total of the advanced payment made. Management then allocated the advanced payment pro rata the market valuation to the land use rights and the building. In 2009, HWG-Ltd. decided not to purchase the land use rights and building but to lease them and a lease agreement was concluded. Impairment of trade receivables HWG-Ltd.’s management assesses the collectability of trade receivables. This estimate is based on the credit history of HWG-Ltd.’s distributors and the current market condition. Management assesses the collectability of trade receivables at the statement of financial position date and makes the provision, if any. 172 Further details of the accounting policies pertaining to the financial statements of HWG-Ltd. are included in the Financial Section of this Prospectus from F-1 onwards. Contingencies Investment and Construction Project Contract As at 31 December 2010, the Group had capital commitments arising from an investment and construction project contract as follows: On 30 May 2010, HWG-Ltd. concluded a contract with the Management Committee of Guangdong – Wenchuan Industrial Park (the Management Committee) to invest and establish a glass production project and research and development base in Guangdong – Wenchuan Industrial Park, Sichuan, PRC. Capital contributions are planned in the amount of the total investment volume of the project which is RMB 0.3 billion (equivalent to approximately EUR 33 million at 31 March 2011 exchange rates). Apart from these capital contributions, the Group may be expected to pay annual taxes of more than RMB 18 million in connection with the contract between HWG-Ltd. and the Management Committee. However, the Group will benefit under the contract from tax advantages and subsidies. HWG-Ltd. agreed with its subsidiary HWG-SC that any investments arising from the project be conducted by the subsidiary, financed by loans from HWG-Ltd. Under the contract, the Group shall pay a deposit of RMB 50 million (equivalent to EUR 5.6 million) as a guarantee deposit for its obligation to fulfil the contract whilst the Management Committee will undertake to secure the land use rights for the land and subsequently transfer the usage rights at a preferential price to the Group for use to construct the base. This contract also contains the following potential penalties, which may result in contingencies for the Group: In the event of non-compliance of construction speed and production of the various phases or in the event of failure to make the proposed investment including the annual taxes, the Management Committee has the right to take back all the land use rights of the project free of charge. Group management expects the land use transfer price to be refunded in this eventuality. The Group may also be liable for compensatory damages if it is responsible for a breach of contract with adverse affects for the Management Committee. 173 Social insurance back payments According to PRC law, in particular, Chinese regulations for social insurance and housing funds, HWG-Ltd.’s operating companies are required to make contributions for the social insurance and for the housing funds to their employees. HWG-Ltd. has in the past not paid the full amount which should have been paid in respect of these contributions, but considers the risk for additional payments for prior periods to be not probable. As at 31 December 2010, HWG-Ltd. estimates that such a claim for additional payments would not exceed TEUR 264. As at 25 July 2010, Mr. Nang Heung Sze has undertaken an agreement with HWG-Ltd. according to which he would reimburse HWG-Ltd. for any losses incurred for such additional social insurance and housing funds payments. Tax-related contingent liabilities Various uncertainties exist relating to the following matters which could result in additional tax liabilities for the Group: · Depreciation was over-claimed by HWG-Ltd. in relation to residual values of property, plant and equipment in 2007. The additional tax payments if any which could arise from this matter are estimated to be in the region of TEUR 7. · Entertainment expenses claimed by HWG-Ltd. had exceeded the cap under the old and new EIT Law. The additional tax payments if any which could arise from this matter are estimated to be in the region of TEUR 47. Off-Balance Sheet and other Arrangements HWG-Ltd. does not have any off-balance sheet obligations or transactions. There are no other obligations or risks which were not reflected in the financial statements of HWG-Ltd. or disclosed in the notes to the financial statements. 174 15. MARKET AND INDUSTRY OVERVIEW 15.1 Introduction China Specialty Glass-Group develops, produces and sells specialty glass and related products under its “Hing Wah” brand. The Group distributes its products to customers across the domestic market in China through its own sales network and, to a lesser extent, through trading companies. China Specialty Glass-Group serves its customers in the banking, automotive (refitting manufacturers) and construction industries in China. The Group’s specialty glass products can be categorised into two main groups: security glass and construction glass. Security glass is divided into two segments according to its area of application: bank security glass and automotive security glass. Security glass products include bulletproof glass, bomb blast-resistant glass and intruder-resistant glass. Construction glass includes architecture laminated glass, architecture tempered glass, fire-resistant glass, hollow glass and electrically-controlled colour-changing glass. The sales figures of the last three years are shown in the table below: Sales (in EUR million ) 2008 2009 2010 As of total Bank security glass 17.5 23.0 32.1 46.1% Automotive security glass 15.4 22.4 30.0 43.1% Architechture tempered glass 4.2 3.6 4.4 6.3% Architechture laminated glass 2.1 1.4 1.8 2.6% Fire resistant glass 0.9 0.4 0.7 1.0% Hollow glass - - Electric-controlled colour-changing glass - 0.1 0.6 0.9% 40.2 50.9 69.6 100% Security glass Construction glass Total - China Specialty Glass Group sells its main product, i.e. bulletproof security glass, in the Bank and Automotive Security Glass Markets where it has a dominant market position in comparison to its closest competitor (China Specialty Glass-Group had 48.2%, the closest competitor had 5.5% market share in 2009; source: p. 104, RMR Report, 2010). Its construction glass products are sold at a price with a lower margin to the construction industry in China where competition is more intense and China Specialty Glass-Group has a relatively small market share. 175 Security glass, especially bulletproof glass, has been the Group’s major and most competitive product. It contributed 82.0%, 89.2% and 89.2% to HWG-Ltd.’s total revenue for 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively. It is sold mostly to the highly regulated Chinese banking industry and automotive refitting manufacturer industry. The banking industry is highly developed in coastal regions in China, where most of the Group’s products are sold. The following table shows the geographic distribution of sales over the last three years: Sales distribution 2008 2009 2010 Coastal regions + Beijing 84% 75% 78% Rest of China 16% 25% 22% 100% 100% 100% Total The past and the expected growth of security glass sales in the banking industry are driven primarily by the increase in the number of new bank branches and the continuous renovation of the old branches. The growth of security glass sales in the automotive refitting manufacturers industry is the result of the increasing demand for armoured vehicles both for civilian and governmental use. The Group’s other specialty glass products (construction glass) are sold mainly in the construction industry, which has benefited from the rapid growth of the Chinese commercial and residential real estate market. 15.2 Chinese economy Despite the worst global financial and economic crisis of the last seventy years, the Chinese economy has continued its growth during the last three years. One factor for this development is the economic stimulus package introduced by the Chinese government in late 2008. The International Monetary Fund (“IMF”) expects that China will continue its GDP growth in the near future with a modest inflation rate that is comparable to that of Germany. Forecast Average 1992-2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010 2011 2015 Annual GDP growth (%) 10.3 9.1 10.1 10.1 11.3 12.7 14.2 9.6 9.2 10.3 9.6 9.5 Inflation rate (%) 6.9 -0.8 1.2 3.9 1.8 1.5 4.8 5.9 -0.7 3.3 2.7 2.0 Inflation rate (%), Germany 2.1 1.5 1.0 1.7 1.5 1.6 2.3 2.6 0.4 1.1 1.4 2.0 Source: IMF, World Economic Outlook, October 2010; National Bureau of Statistics of China; Statistisches Bundesamt Deutschland 176 The rapid economic growth during the last three decades has lifted millions of Chinese citizens out of poverty. For urban residents, the disposable income has grown at an average annual growth rate of 12.1% between the years 2002 and 2009, while for rural residents in China the average annual growth rate amounted to 11.1%. For 2010, the disposable income for urban residents grew to an average RMB 19,109. This corresponds to an 11.3% growth in comparison to the disposable income available for the same period in 2009 (National Bureau of Statistics of China). Disposible Income (RMB) Urban Growth Rural Growth 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 CAGR 7,702.8 12.3% 8,472.2 10.0% 9,421.6 11.2% 10,493.0 11.4% 11,759.5 12.1% 13,785.8 17.2% 15,780.8 14.5% 17,175.0 8.8% 12.1% 2,475.6 2,622.2 2,936.4 3,254.9 3,587.0 4,140.4 4,760.6 5,153.0 11.1% 4.6% 5.9% 12.0% 10.8% 10.2% 15.4% 15.0% 8.2% Source: National Bureau of Statistics of China Since the 1990s, the rate of saving of Chinese private households has been fluctuating at around 20% of the GDP. In 2008, the rate of saving of private households amounted to about 23.4% of that year’s GDP. As the GDP growth rate has been around 10% each year since the 1990s, the Chinese private households’ rate of saving has increased at a similar pace (source: p. 10, BIS, Working Paper No. 312, Bank for International Settlement, June 2010). China’s minimalistic social welfare system and the inadequate healthcare system largely contribute to this phenomenon. On the other hand, the steady increase in the income level of the general population has been accompanied by a continuous increase in consumption. China’s retail market had a value of RMB 10.8 trillion in 2008 and has been growing at 15.3% annually since 1990 (source: China Statistical Yearbook 2009, National Bureau of Statistics of China). In 2009, this market increased to RMB 12.5 trillion (source: Understanding China’s Retail Market by Sheng Lu, China Business Review Online, CBR May-June 2010). In 2010, China’s retail market contributed RMB 15.5 trillion to the national economy (source: National Bureau of Statistics of China). The increase in wealth and disposable income in China is reflected in the increase in purchases of high-end luxury automobiles, especially those made in Germany, as well as luxury villas and apartments. The table below shows the sales of passenger cars including top-end luxury cars in China during the past five years: Car sales 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010 CAGR Total car sales (in thousand) 7,216 8,947 9,537 13,650 18,062 26% 315 688 1,075 967 NA 45% Top-end luxury cars Source: www.sohu.com/auto 177 Sales of luxury automobiles (also including top-end luxury cars) in China grew from 50,000 in the year 2002 to 450,000 in the year 2009, which corresponds to a compounded annual growth rate (“CAGR”) of around 37%. The global portion of luxury car sales in China increased from 0.9% in 2002 to 7.9% in 2009 according to China Auto News (http://qiche.com.cn/files/201007/22035.shtml as of 22 July 2010). China’s luxury car sales are likely to reach 530,000 units in 2010 and may increase to 1.1 million by 2015, which is predicted by J.P. Morgan and J.D. Power as quoted by Inautonews, an online automobile news site based in Chicago, USA (http://www.inautonews.com/luxury-car-sales-in-china-may-reach-11-mln-u nits-by-2015). Sales of luxury real estate in China increased by 8.2% of the average annual rate between 2006 and 2009. At the peak of the financial crisis in 2008, sales of luxury villas and apartments in terms of Gross Floor Area (“GFA”) were significantly affected and fell by 37% year-on-year. By 2009, sales of luxury real estate had recovered to the pre-crisis level. Although the latest statistics are not available for the total square meters of luxury real estate sold in China, the demand for such properties in 2010 was comparatively large: In the last quarter of 2010, the monthly price increase, compared to the same month in 2009, was between 8.5% and 11.9% for commercial real estate, between 7.2% to 11% for normal residential real estate and between 12.8% and 14.8% for luxury real estate. 2 Real estate, GFA (million m ) 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010 CAGR Luxury (Sold) 36.7 45.8 28.7 46.4 NA 8.2% Total (Sold) 618.6 773.5 659.7 937.1 1,043.0 14.0% Total (Completed) 558.3 606.1 665.4 702.0 760.0 8.0% Source: National Bureau of Statitstics of China To manage the flood of savings and the large amount of consumption-related financial transactions, both Chinese and foreign banks operating in China have expanded their service networks and offered more financial products to Chinese citizen than ever before. Most of the Chinese residents still deposit their savings and withdraw cash at the bank branches (bank cashiers) in their neighbourhood. Over 3,000 new bank branches were set up in China between 2007 and 2009. There were 193,000 domestic bank branches in China at the end of 2009 (source: p. 29, 30, Annual Report 2009, China Banking Regulatory Commission, June 2010). 178 15.3 Security glass market Security glass offers protection against physical attacks, be it weapon projectiles (bulletproof glass), bomb blasts (bomb resistant glass) or sharp heavy objects (intruder-resistant glass). It is used by the military in armoured vehicles and by government and commercial institutions in sensitive and high-risk facilities. Wealthy individuals demand security glass in armoured limousines and in luxury residences. Participants in this product market on the demand side are mostly the banking industry (especially for financial institution branches) and the automotive refitting manufacturers industry. In rare cases, security glass is used in the construction industry. 15.3.1 Market size Production capacity and annual output In 2009, the global bulletproof glass production capacity amounted to about ten million square meters. With the annual production capacity of 1.45 million square meters, China is globally a significant bulletproof glass producer with 14.5% of the global bulletproof glass production capacity. Country/region Worldwide Europe Japan North America China Rest Capacity (in thousand m2) 10,000 2,670 2,210 1,580 1,450 2,090 Of the total capacity 100% 26.7% 22.1% 15.8% 14.5% 20.9% Source: p. 69, RMR report, 2010 The table below shows the breakdown of the Chinese bulletproof glass market in terms of the product output and total output growth rate from 2005 to 2009. 2005 Year 2 2006 Of total Output breakup (in thousand m ) 2007 Of total 2008 Of total 2009 Of total Of total Banking 182 45.8% 259 49.3% 346 48.3% 368 47.5% 457 47.8% Automotive 143 36.0% 165 31.4% 213 29.7% 243 31.4% 314 32.8% Construction 2 Total output (in thousand m ) Growth rate 72 18.1% 101 19.2% 158 22.0% 163 21.1% 186 19.4% 397 100.0% 525 100.0% 717 100.0% 774 100.0% 957 100.0% 23.2% 32.2% 36.6% 7.9% 23.6% Source: p.71, 72, RMR report, 2010 Despite the global financial and economic crisis, the output of Chinese bulletproof glass has grown at an average annual rate of 24.5% over the last 179 five years. The total production output was around 717,000 square meters, around 774,000 square meters and around 957,000 square meters for 2007, 2008 and 2009, respectively. Nearly 50% of the bulletproof glass produced was used by the banking industry (Bank Security Glass Market). Geographically, the majority of the Chinese bulletproof glass output came from the coastal provinces of China, of which Guangdong province was the most active region (taken from 2009 output): Guangdong 66.25% Jiangsu 7.63% Beijing 6.79% Shangdong 3.76% Henan 3.34% Zhejiang 2.82% Anhui 1.88% Others 7.53% Source: p. 77, RMR report, 2010 Market demands The table below shows the market demand for bulletproof glass and the production output in China from 2005 to 2009 (all in thousand square meters). 2005 Year Production output Export Import 2006 397.0 20.4 16.3 Trade balance* 2007 525.0 25.6 18.6 2008 717.0 34.6 8.9 2009 774.0 34.9 5.4 957.0 42.3 8.2 -4.1 -7.0 -25.7 -29.5 Output available 392.9 518.0 691.3 744.5 922.9 Demand 458.0 588.0 761.0 951.0 1,196.0 Unmet demand 65.1 70.0 69.7 206.5 273.1 *Trade balance = (Import - Export) Source: General Administration of Customs of the People's Republic of China, 2010, cited through p. 78, RMR report, 2010; China Architectural and Industrial Glass Association, cited through p. 85, RMR report 180 -34.1 While the import of bulletproof glass into China stagnated over the last five years, there has been a steady increase in exports. However, relative to the total production output, exports have taken up only a negligible portion of the total production output. In 2009, exports made up only 4.4% of the total output. The Chinese bulletproof glass production output has increased at an average annual growth rate of 24.5%. However, the increase in production has not been able to keep pace with the increase in demand, which experienced an average annual growth of 27.5%. Growth in exports only exacerbated the demand-supply imbalance. In 2009, the demand for around 273,100 square meters of bulletproof glass in China was not met. Market volume Annual sales in both technical (specialty) glass and bulletproof glass and their growth in China are shown in the table below (in million EUR): Year Sales (technical glass) Growth Sales (bulletproof glass) Growth 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2,547.4 3,452.1 3,976.4 5,504.3 7,675.7 - 35.5% 15.2% 38.4% 39.4% 39.2 50.0 70.5 83.4 98.4 - 27.5% 41.0% 18.2% 18.0% Source: Architectural and Industrial Glass Association of China, 2010 cited through p. 80, RMR report, 2010; Exchange rates used were 9.5626 for 2005, 10.3212 for 2006, 10.76355 for 2007, 9.6433 for 2008, 9.80625 for 2009 Sales growth in bulletproof glass was slower in 2008 and 2009 while growth in technical (specialty) glass sales accelerated in the same period. In 2009, bulletproof glass sales reached EUR 98 million (RMB 965 million) and made up only 1.3% of the technical (specialty) glass market. 15.3.2 Market trends The table below shows the bulletproof glass production capacity growth forecast from 2010 to 2014 and the market demand in the same forecast period (in thousand square meters): Year 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 1,640 1,860 2,090 2,320 2,540 Banking 563 637 712 773 847 Automotive 602 745 871 1,007 1,121 Production capacity Demands from 257 312 376 442 508 Total demand Construction 1,422 1,694 1,959 2,222 2,476 Demand as % of capacity 86.7% 91.1% 93.7% 95.8% 97.5% Source: p. 111, 117, 118, RMR report, 2010 181 Bank security glass market Bulletproof glass installation in the large first-tier cities is widespread and still growing, whereas less than half of the bank branches in second- and third-tier cities or in rural areas are equipped with bulletproof glass. Additionally, although the bulletproof property of the security glass is normally guaranteed by the manufacturers for ten years, it is frequently replaced by the bank outlets earlier since the branches are often renovated every few years in order to make them more appealing to their customers and to stay competitive. New and existing bank branches are reliable sources of demand for bulletproof glass. Foreign banks are also increasing their presence in China to benefit from the growing consumer demand for quality banking service and one of the largest consumer markets in the world. The Company expects that some of the existing and some of the new branches will become customers for its bulletproof glass products in the years to come. The table below shows the expected newly-added and renovated bank branches from 2010 to 2014 in China: Year 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 Newly established branches from domestic banks 3,079 3,254 3,561 3,782 3,815 Branches to be renovated 18,032 18,815 20,106 21,379 22,132 Total outlets available (excl. foreign bank outlets) 18,032 18,815 20,106 21,379 22,132 Source: China Banking Regulatory Commission, Respect Marketing Research, 2009, cited through p. 114 RMR report The demand for bulletproof glass from the Chinese banking industry alone should reach around 712,000 square meters in 2012 (source: p. 114, RMR Report, 2010). Automotive security glass market The increase in the number of bank branches in China is accompanied by an increase in demand for secure means of transporting cash and other valuable goods (cash-in-transit vehicles), which leads to a further demand for bulletproof glass. Other types of vehicles equipped with bulletproof glass include police vehicles and military armoured personnel carriers. Furthermore, private luxury limousines are increasingly refitted to add security features. These include bulletproof or bomb blast-resistant windshields and side windows to provide protection to passengers. 182 The demand for bulletproof glass comes mainly from newly refitted vehicles that receive security features and from the after-sales service market for such vehicles, where armoured vehicles are repaired and serviced. According to the China Association of Automobile Manufacturers, about 7,500 armoured cars per annum are expected to be added to the existing fleet from 2010 to 2014. 120,000 vehicles were already equipped with bulletproof glass in China at the end of 2009. A significant portion of this large fleet of armoured vehicles (15% per annum on average) requires repair and renewal of their bulletproof glass (source: p. 116, RMR Report, 2010). 15.4 Construction glass market China is the largest normal flat glass producer in the world. 579 million weight boxes (one weight box equals 50 kg, or 10 square meters, of 2 mm thick glass) (source: Baidu, http://baike.baidu.com/view/1511663.htm from Taglist as of 23 July 2010) of normal glass were produced in 2009 (source: China Building Material Association. http://www.cbminfo.com/tabid/ 63/InfoID/327671/Default.aspx as of 10 February 2010). This can be translated into 28.95 million tons or 5.79 billion square meters of 2 mm thick flat glass. For the first 11 months in 2010, China had already produced 577 million weight boxes of normal flat glass according to icandata (http://www.icandata.com/data/201103/031GM3292011.html). Normal flat glass, when processed to add technical features, becomes specialty glass which includes insulating, architecture laminated, architecture tempered and surface-coated glass. The number of manufacturers capable of producing specialty glass in China has risen to approximately 4,000. There were more than 1,000 tempered glass manufacturers in China in 2009, which produced about 180 million square meters of tempered glass, 40 million square meters of laminated glass, 200 million square meters of insulating glass and more than 80 million square meters of surface-coated glass (source: National Bureau of Statistics of China, 2010 cited through p. 82, RMR Report, 2010). The presence of numerous manufacturers for specialty glass puts intense pressure on the product unit price. Windows (hollow glass), glass-containing doors (tempered or laminated glass), glass facades and partition glass walls are some of the products, for which specialty glass is used. The most common use of specialty glass products is as architecture glass for real estate and related decorations in the construction market. The amount of glass used for a new building is estimated to be around 20% of the GFA on average (source: “Development 183 Trends of Energy Saving Glass Products – An Analysis of Building Glass Market”, http://www.chinabmi.com/news/2010720/45762.html as of 20 July 2010). With an average of 46 million square meters GFA, specialty glass used for the luxury market segment of the Construction Glass Market alone could amount to some nine million square meters in 2009. There are numerous suppliers for such glass products and competition is intense. Demand for such products is considerable and the gross margin is significantly lower than that of security glass. In the construction glass segment, China Specialty Glass-Group focuses on specialty glass without security glass features such as bullet resistance, whereas bulletproof glass is attributed to the security bank glass or automotive security glass segment. Due to the limited production capacity and increasing focus on higher-margin security glass products, the Group has reduced its production and sales of lower-margin construction glass products over the last three years (see section 14.3.1 “Revenues”, sub-section “Construction Glass”). With the planned expansion in production capacity, in particular with the planned establishment of the new production site in the Sichuan province in the western region of China, the Group plans to use the new facilities to meet market demand for high-quality construction glass products in that region and to increase its production capacity for security glass products. After the devastating earthquake in Sichuan in 2008, the Chinese central government invested considerably in infrastructure and housing projects to rebuild the region. The reconstruction process in the region is expected to continue for the next five to six years. This emphasis on investments in the region is in line with the central government’s policy of accelerating the development of China’s western regions. 15.5 Sales and distribution Sales of security glass such as bulletproof glass to banking and financial institutions usually go through a bidding process. Public security organs of the government recommend qualified manufacturers, such as HWG-Ltd., whose products are certified by these organs or their related organizations, such as the Inspection and Testing Centre for Electronic Products for Security and Police Use under the Ministry of Public Security of China, to participate in such a bidding process. After the preliminary screening of all bidders, the customers (banks) visit selected bidders on-site and invite a limited number of bidders (at least three) to a final bidding process. The selection of the final 184 security glass supplier is carried out on a score-based valuation process, in which the manufacturer’s qualification and product license (certificates, 3C license, etc), production capacity, track record, liquidity, product insurance and other issues are compared and evaluated. The successful bidder is then asked to negotiate final contract terms and conditions. With regard to automotive security glass, there are a limited number of automobile refitting companies that convert vehicles with a normal chassis into vehicles for special transportation use such as cash-in-transit vehicles, police cars, military vehicles or armoured limousines. Bulletproof glass and related products are directly purchased by these companies from a few manufacturers such as HWG-Ltd. which offer the scale and capability to supply. Although there is no bidding process involved in product sales, the procurement of these companies focuses on those security glass suppliers with a 3C Certification. On the other hand, other specialty glass used in the construction industry is purchased on a project-by-project basis by the general constructors and their sub-contractors specialising in the installation of glass. Glass needed for a particular project is usually purchased en masse, which might include windows, doors and glass walls. The amount of glass products used in a construction project can be quite substantial, but only a limited amount of specialty glass is supplied by China Specialty Glass Group. Glass manufacturers, which are not only capable of providing a diversity of specialty glass products but also of delivering these products on a large scale, are preferred for architecture projects. The purchase of other specialty glass products in the construction industry is also based on a tender process. 15.6 Competition The specialty glass market is highly fragmented. Currently, there are more than 4,000 glass manufacturers in China capable of producing specialty glass in addition to normal flat glass (source: p. 82; RMR Report, 2010). There are no dominant players in this market and due to the lack of a clear product differentiation, competition is focused mainly on the price and to a lesser extent on the scale of production. 185 As a niche in the specialty glass market, the security glass market (bulletproof/bomb blast/intruder-resistant glass) is highly concentrated: In China there are only around 62 bulletproof glass producers and among them the top five producers amassed 63% of the total production output and commanded 59% of the total market share in 2009. Production Output (in thousand m 2) 2007 2008 2009 Market Share Beijing Mingdun Tongchuang Technology Co., Ltd. 43.0 43.0 45.0 4.6% Shenzhen Liaoyuan Glass Co., Ltd. 22.0 25.0 30.0 3.1% Zhangjiagang Xinyu Special Glass Products Co., Ltd. 17.0 18.0 20.0 2.1% Xiamen Xiangsheng Special Glass Co., Ltd. 11.0 14.0 16.0 1.6% China Specialty Glass (CSG) 394.0 407.0 491.0 50.4% Rest - - 355.0 36.4% - - 957.0 100% Sales (in RMB million) 2007 2008 2009 Market Share Beijing Mingdun Tongchuang Technology Co., Ltd. 49.5 51.0 54.0 5.5% Shenzhen Liaoyuan Glass Co., Ltd. 15.1 17.6 21.0 2.2% Zhangjiagang Xinyu Special Glass Products Co., Ltd. 15.4 16.7 17.4 1.8% 8.8 10.3 12.5 1.3% 331.0 357.9 469.9 48.2% Total Source: p. 104, RMR report, 2010 Zhejiang Meidun Protection Technique Co., Ltd. China Specialty Glass (CSG) Rest Total - - 399.2 41.0% - - 974.0 100% Source: p. 104, RMR report, 2010 This industrial concentration in the security glass market in China is the result of: · Government regulation: Sales of security glass are subject to licenses, 3C Certification and other related certifications from the Ministry of Public Security and other governmental agencies (see sections 17 “Business” and 16 “Regulatory Framework”). · Stringent customer requirements: End users of security glass such as banks impose requirements such as production scale, relevant qualifications, product insurance and the credit standing on manufacturers participating in the tender process. · Intense capital requirement: Development and production of security glass demands larger funds to install production facilities and to continuously innovate through investment in R&D. 186 Top Chinese competitors of the Group China Specialty Glass-Group has identified the top competitors in the Chinese domestic market for the main product of HWG-Ltd., i.e. bulletproof glass, according to their market share. These are: Beijing Mingdun Tongchuang Technology Co., Ltd.’s products are used for windscreens and side windows for high-speed trains, military vehicles, upgraded civilian vehicles, helicopters, personal body armour, bank transaction windows, flat panel displays and many others. The company’s revenues for the years 2007 to 2009 amounted to EUR 4.7 million, EUR 4.8 million and EUR 5.3 million, respectively (source: p. 123, RMR Report, 2010). Shenzhen Liaoyuan Glass Co., Ltd. specializes in producing bullet resistant glass, tempered glass, curved tempered glass, insulated glass, laminated glass, laminated art glass, electronic glass, etc. The company’s revenues for the years 2007 to 2009 amounted to EUR 1.4 million, EUR 1.7 million and EUR 2.2 million, respectively (source: p. 123, RMR Report, 2010). Zhangjiagang Xinyu Special Glass Products Co., Ltd. The products of the company are used in the construction, sanitation, automobile, home decoration, home appliance industry etc. The company’s revenues for the years 2007 to 2009 amounted to EUR 1.0 million, EUR 1.3 million and EUR 1.5 million, respectively (source: p. 123, RMR Report, 2010). Xiamen Xiangsheng Special Glass Co., Ltd. mainly produces various safety glass including tempered glass, laminated glass, insulated glass, curved glass, bullet resistant glass, fireproof glass, glue chip glass, sandblasting glass and other types of glass for furniture and construction purpose. The company’s revenues for the years 2007 to 2009 amounted to EUR 0.7 million, EUR 0.7 million and EUR 0.9 million, respectively (source: p. 123, RMR Report, 2010). 187 16. REGULATORY FRAMEWORK 16.1 PRC Legal System Overview The PRC legal system is based on the PRC Constitution and consists of written laws, regulations and directives. Decided court cases do not constitute binding precedents. The National People’s Congress of the PRC (“NPC”) and the Standing Committee of the NPC are empowered by the PRC Constitution to exercise the legislative power of the state. The NPC has the power to amend the PRC Constitution and to enact and amend primary laws governing the state organs, civil affairs and criminal offences and other matters. The Standing Committee of the NPC is empowered to interpret, enact and amend laws other than those required to be enacted by the NPC. The State Council of the PRC is the highest organ of state administration and has the power to enact administrative rules and regulations. Ministries and commissions under the State Council of the PRC are also vested with the power to issue orders, directives and regulations within the jurisdiction of their respective departments. Administrative rules, regulations, directives and orders promulgated by the State Council and its ministries and commissions must not be in conflict with the PRC Constitution or the national laws and, in the event that any conflict arises, the Standing Committee of the NPC has the power to annul such administrative rules and regulations enacted by the State Council and the State Council has the power to annul such directives, orders and regulations issued by its ministries and commissions. At the regional level, the people’s congresses of provinces and municipalities and their standing committees may enact local rules and regulations and the people’s government may promulgate administrative rules and directives applicable to their own administrative area. These local rules and regulations may not be in conflict with the PRC Constitution, any national laws or any administrative rules and regulations promulgated by the State Council. Some rules, regulations or directives may be enacted or issued at the provincial or municipal level or by the State Council of the PRC or its ministries and commissions in the first instance for experimental purposes. After sufficient experience has been gained, the State Council may submit 188 legislative proposals to be considered by the NPC or the Standing Committee of the NPC for enactment at the national level. The power to interpret laws is vested by the PRC Constitution in the Standing Committee of the NPC. According to the Decision of the Standing Committee of the NPC Regarding the Strengthening of Interpretation of Laws passed on 10 June 1981, the Supreme People’s Court has the power to give general interpretation on application of laws in judicial proceedings apart from its power to issue specific interpretation in specific cases. The State Council and its ministries and commissions are also vested with the power to give interpretation of the rules and regulations which they promulgated. At the regional level, the power to give interpretation of regional laws is vested in the regional legislative and administration organs which promulgate such laws. All such interpretations carry legal effect. PRC Judicial System The People’s Courts are the judicial organs of the PRC. Under the PRC Constitution and the Law of Organisation of the People’s Courts of the People’s Republic of China, the People’s Courts comprise the Supreme People’s Court, the local people’s courts, military courts and other special courts. The local people’s courts are divided into three levels, namely, the basic people’s courts, intermediate people’s courts and higher people’s courts. The basic people’s courts are divided into civil, criminal and administrative divisions. The intermediate people’s courts have divisions similar to those of the basic people’s courts and, where the circumstances so warrant, may have other special divisions (such as intellectual property divisions). The judicial functions of the people’s courts at lower levels are subject to the supervision of people’s courts at higher levels. The people’s procuratorates also have the right to exercise legal supervision over the proceedings of people’s courts of the same and lower levels. The Supreme People’s Court is the highest judicial organ of the PRC. It supervises the administration of justice by the people’s courts of all levels. The people’s courts adopt a two-tier final appeal system. A party may, before the taking effect of a judgment or order, appeal against the judgment or order of the first instance of a local people’s court to the people’s court at the next higher level. Judgments or orders of the second instance at the next higher level are final and binding. Judgments or orders of the first instance of the Supreme People’s Court are also final and binding. If, however, the Supreme People’s Court or a people’s court at a higher level finds an error in 189 a final and binding judgment which has taken effect in any people’s court at a lower level, a retrial of the case may be conducted according to the judicial supervision procedures. If the president of a people’s court at any level finds a definite error in a legally effective judgment or written order of his court and deems it necessary to have the case retried, he shall refer it to the judicial committee for discussion and decision. The PRC civil procedures are governed by the Civil Procedure Law of the People’s Republic of China (the “Civil Procedure Law”) adopted on 9 April 1991 with amendment effective on 1 April 2008. The Civil Procedure Law contains regulations on the institution of a civil action, the jurisdiction of the people’s courts, the procedures in conducting a civil action, trial procedures and procedures for the enforcement of a civil judgment or order. All parties to a civil action conducted within the territory of the PRC must comply with the Civil Procedure Law. A civil case is generally heard by a court located in the defendant’s place of domicile. The jurisdiction may also be selected by express agreement by the parties to a contract provided that the jurisdiction of the people’s court selected has some actual connection with the dispute, that is to say, the plaintiff or the defendant is located or domiciled, or the contract was executed or implemented in the jurisdiction selected, or the subject-matter of the proceedings is located in the jurisdiction selected. A foreign national or foreign enterprise is accorded the same litigation rights and obligations as a citizen or legal person of the PRC. If any party to a civil action refuses to comply with a judgment or order made by a people’s court or an award made by an arbitration body in the PRC, the aggrieved party may apply to the people’s court to enforce the judgment, order or award. The right to apply for such enforcement is limited to two years. A party seeking to enforce a judgment or order of a people’s court against a party who or whose property is not within the PRC may apply to a foreign court with jurisdiction over the case for recognition and enforcement of such judgment or order. A foreign judgment or ruling may also be recognised and enforced according to the PRC enforcement procedures by the people’s courts in accordance with the principle of reciprocity or if there exists an international or bilateral treaty with or acceded to by the foreign country that provides for such recognition and enforcement, unless the people’s court considers that the recognition or enforcement of the judgment or ruling will violate fundamental legal principles of the PRC or its sovereignty, security or social or public interest. 190 Arbitration and Enforcement of Arbitral Awards The Arbitration Law of the PRC (the “Arbitration Law”) was promulgated by the Standing Committee of the NPC on 31 August 1994 and came into effect on 1 September 1995. It is applicable to, amongst other matters, trade disputes involving foreign parties where the parties have entered into a written agreement to refer the matter to arbitration before an arbitration committee constituted in accordance with the Arbitration Law. Under the Arbitration Law, an arbitration committee may, before the promulgation by the PRC Arbitration Association of arbitration regulations, formulate interim arbitration rules in accordance with the Arbitration Law and the PRC Civil Procedure Law. Where the parties have by an agreement provided arbitration as a method for dispute resolution, the parties are not permitted to institute legal proceedings in a people’s court. Under the Arbitration Law, an arbitral award is final and binding on the parties and if a party fails to comply with an award, the other party to the award may apply to the people’s court for enforcement. A people’s court may refuse to enforce an arbitral award made by an arbitration committee in case of mistakes, in applying law, an absence of material evidence or irregularities concerning the arbitration proceedings, the jurisdiction or the constitution of the arbitration committee. A party seeking to enforce an arbitral award of a foreign affairs arbitration body of the PRC against a party who or whose property is not within the PRC may apply to a foreign court with jurisdiction over the case for enforcement. Similarly, an arbitral award made by a foreign arbitration body may be recognised and enforced by the PRC courts in accordance with the principles of reciprocity or any international treaty concluded or acceded to by the PRC. In respect of contractual and non-contractual commercial-law-related disputes which are recognised as such for the purposes of the PRC law, the PRC has acceded to the Convention on the Recognition and Enforcement of Foreign Arbitral Award (“New York Convention”) adopted on 10 June 1958 pursuant to a resolution of the Standing Committee of the NPC passed on 2 December 1986. The New York Convention provides that all arbitral awards made by a state which is a party to the New York Convention are to be recognised and enforced by other parties to the New York Convention subject to their right to refuse enforcement under certain circumstances including where the enforcement of the arbitral award is against the public policy of the state to which the application for enforcement is made. It was declared 191 by the Standing Committee of the NPC at the time of the accession of the PRC that (1) the PRC would only recognise and enforce foreign arbitral awards on the principle of reciprocity and (2) the PRC would only apply the New York Convention in disputes considered under PRC laws to be arising from contractual and non-contractual mercantile legal relations. 16.2 The General Principles of the Civil Law The General Principles of the Civil Law were adopted by the National People’s Congress on 12 April 1986 and came into force on 1 January 1987. The Civil Law is formulated for the purpose of protecting the lawful civil rights and interests of citizens and legal persons as well as correctly adjusting civil relations. The General Principles of the Civil Law consist of eight different chapters: General Principles, Law of Persons and Entities, Civil Juristic Acts, Law of Agency, Law of Obligations, Civil Liability, Limitation of Action and Conflict of Laws. Chinese civil law is subject to certain fundamental principles set out in the first chapter. Inter alia, all parties in a civil law relationship are to enjoy equal legal positions and all civil law activities are to abide by the principle of voluntariness. Pursuant to the principle of good faith, all persons are to act honestly without causing harm to others. In the following chapters, the Principles set out general rules on the obligations of contractual and non-contractual parties and the concept of damages. The Principles also contain rules regarding the law of agency: Individuals and legal entities may authorize agents to act on their behalf within the scope of their authority. The principal is to bear all liabilities as a result of the agents’ acts so incurred. 16.3 The Opinions of the Supreme People’s Court on Several Issues concerning the Implementation of the General Principles of the Civil Law (for Trial Implementation) The Opinions of the Supreme People’s Court on Several Issues concerning the Implementation of the General Principles of the Civil Law (For Trial Implementation) were adopted and became effective on 26 January 1988. They serve to implement the General Principles of the Civil Law. 16.4 Laws Regarding Social Standards Laws and Regulations Relating to Social Welfare China's social security system provides people with social welfare, a special care and placement system, social relief, housing services and social 192 insurance. Thereby social insurance represents the heart of China’s social security system. It consists of five different parts: pension contribution, unemployment insurance, basic medical insurance, work-related injury insurance and maternity insurance (details are subject to the different legal requirements in various provinces). In addition, the housing funds are required to be paid for all employees. In regard to pension contribution, unemployment insurance and basic medical insurance the responsibility should be carried by the employer and the employee together whereas the responsibility for work-related injury insurance and maternity insurance rests with the employer. The employer has to pay for his own contributions and deduct the applicable contributions of the employees from their salaries and remit them to the responsible institutions. A variety of laws and regulations concerning the legal system of social security, such as the PRC Labour Contract Law, Interim Regulations on the Collection and Payment of Social Insurance Premiums, Regulations on Work Injury Insurance, Regulations on Unemployment Insurance, Decision of the State Council on Establishing Unified Basic Pension Contribution System for the Staff and Workers in Enterprises, Measures for Maternity Insurance of the Staff and Workers in Enterprises and the Regulations on Housing Funds have come into force. Any employer who violates the regulations concerning the social welfare of the employee, i.e. failure to pay the social insurance contributions and housing funds or the retaining of the payment of the employee's portion, may be ordered by the PRC labour tax and/or housing funds administration authority to make the required payments within a designated period of time. Moreover, a liability for penalties may also arise from the described conduct. Any failure to pay social insurance premiums or housing fund contributions by the employer also entitles the employee to terminate the employment. PRC Labour Contract Law The PRC Labour Contract Law (the “Labour Contract Law”), which came into effect on 1 January 2008 and supplements the PRC Labour Law which has been in effect since 1 January 1995, has a certain impact on all existing and future employment relationships under PRC law. The Labour Contract Law imposes severe consequences for non-compliance with the conclusion of employment contracts in written form. Should an employer fail to conclude a written employment contract with an employee for a period of one month to one year after the actual commencement of 193 work, the employer must pay the employee twice the salary for the relevant months. After more than one year after the actual commencement of work, an unfixed-term of contract is deemed to have been concluded. Employer and employee may include in their employment contract provisions on confidentiality concerning commercial secrets of the employer and confidential issues relating to intellectual property according to the Labour Contract Law. Non-competition obligations for up to two years after termination or expiration of the contract may be included in the employment contract or a confidentiality agreement, if the employee is senior manager, senior technician or is subject to a confidentiality obligation and if the parties agree on a compensation. The employer is to pay economic compensation to the employee on a monthly basis during the non-competition obligation period after termination or expiration of the contract. The PRC Labour Contract Law also provides additional reasons for the termination of employment contracts. For example, the employee may now terminate the employment if the employer fails to pay social insurance premiums for the employee if the rules and regulations for the employee are in breach of laws and regulations and damage the employee’s rights and interests, or if the contract was concluded due to a deception by the employer. The regulations on business–related dismissal have been concretized and, social criteria regarding the question as to which employees are to be dismissed have been introduced by the PRC Labour Contract Law. In case of termination by mutual agreement, compensation must be paid only if the agreement was proposed by the employer. In case of expiration of a fixed-term employment contract, compensation must also be paid except for the case that the employee does not agree to renew the contract even when the employer proposes to keep or improve the conditions stipulated in the current contract. The amount of the compensation is to be a one-month salary per year of employment with a maximum “monthly salary” of three times the average monthly salary as determined by the competent local government and a maximum of twelve years of employment. Before the effectiveness of the PRC Labour Contract Law, there was no cap on the amount of “monthly salary” for the purpose of calculating the compensation. The PRC Labour Contract Law also provides that if an employer terminates an employment contract in violation of laws and an employee demands to continue to perform such a contract, the employer is to continue to perform the employment contract. If the employee does not want to continue to 194 perform the employment contract or the performance of the employment contract has become impossible, the employer is to pay the employee damages in the amount of twice the severance payment. On 18 September 2008, the State Council issued the Implementing Rules and made further explanations on several important issues of the PRC Labour Contract Law. For example, the Implementing Rules emphasize that the employer and the employee are not to agree on any additional termination reasons in the employment contract apart from the following circumstances as stipulated in the PRC Labour Contract Law under which the employment contract terminates automatically: the employment term expires, the employee has reached the statutory retirement age or has retired using the pension to which an entitlement under the law accrued, the employee is dead or is declared dead or missing by the people's court, the employer is declared bankrupt in accordance with the law, the employer's business license is revoked, the employer is ordered to be closed or shut down, the employer enters into voluntary winding-up, or other circumstances occur as may be prescribed in laws and administrative regulations. Furthermore, the Implementing Rules designate the calculation method of the monthly salary of an employee for the calculation of statutory severance payments. I.e. such monthly salary is to be calculated on the basis of the total amount of the remuneration of the employee for the last twelve months including monthly salaries, bonuses, allowances and subsidies for that period. 16.5 Laws and Regulations concerning Use of Bulletproof Glass by Financial Institutions The People’s Bank of China together with the Ministry of Public Security promulgated a Provisional Regulation on the Security of Business Place and Cashbox of Financial Institutions (Yinfa [1998] No. 588) (“Provisional Security Regulation”) on 7 December 1998. The Provisional Security Regulation took effect on 1 January 1999 and is currently in force. According to the Provisional Security Regulation, the counters where cash transactions, security transactions and settlement accountant are carried out in the business place of all financial institutions at and above the county level shall be equipped with the 1.2-meter high bulletproof glass. On 22 September 2004, the Regulations on Level of Risk and Classification of Protection for Banking Business Place were promulgated by the Ministry of Public Security and became effective on 1 December 2004. According to these regulations, if the bulletproof glass is embedded as the transparent protective screen in the entrance door of the cash transaction area, the 195 specification of such bulletproof glass shall be subject to Chinese GA165-1997 Industrial Standard. 16.6 Governmental Regulations in Product Sales and Distribution The bulletproof glass falls in the category of the protective security products. According to the Management Methods for the Protective Security Products promulgated by the General Adminstration of Quality Supervision, Inspection and Quarantine of the PRC and the Ministry of Public Security of the PRC on 16 June 2000 and effective on 1 September 2000, the production and the sales of the bulletproof glass shall be registered with the competent provincial public security authority. The application for the production registration shall be accompanied, amongst other things, with the test report issued by the designated test organization. Any failure to complete the registration will be ordered to rectify within a prescribed period by the public security authority at and above the county level and may cause a penalty of up to RMB 10,000.00, where there is any illegal income, i.e. the income from the manufacture and sales of the bulletproof composite glass, the fine would be up to RMB 30,000.00. Since 2001, China has adopted the compulsory certification system and has drawn up a List of Products Required for China Compulsory Certification (the “Product List”) in order to protect the life and health of human being and animal and the environment. A new Regulation Concerning Management of Compulsory Product Certification (“3C Regulation”) was promulgated by the State Administration of Quality Supervision, Inspection and Quarantine of the PRC on 3 July 2009 and took effect on 1 September 2009 to replace the old regulation. Based on the 3C Regulation, for products that appear on the Product List the basic safety certification which is called China Compulsory Certification (“3C Certification”) shall be obtained and they shall be marked with CCC before they are delivered, sold, imported or used in any business activities. State Administration for Certification and Accreditation of the PRC is the competent authority to implement and supervise the compulsory certification system. On 12 July 2006, State Administration for Certification and Accrediation promulgated the Implementation Rules for the Compulsory Certification of Safety Glass (CNCA-04C-028:2006), according to which the glass products for construction and automobile including the laminated glass, hollow glass and tempered glass are required to obtain the compulsory certification. The certification procedure for safety glass comprises a sample product test, initial workshop inspection and supervision after the certification release. Accordingly, the validity of the above certifications shall 196 be maintained by regular supervision. One year after the issuance of the certification, the validity of such certification shall be subject to the qualification notice of annual inspection. 16.7 Company Law The Standing Committee of the PRC National People's Congress passed amendments to the Company Law concerning enhanced corporate governance, greater protection of shareholders and an easing of restrictions on the management and operation of companies registered in the PRC on 27 October 2005 and the modified PRC Company Law came into force on 1 January 2006. All companies with the legal form of limited liability and joint-stock limited company registered in the PRC including foreign-invested companies, to the extent not provided in FIE Regulations (see below), are subject to the altered PRC Company Law. The PRC Company Law demands of all directors and supervisors to be loyal and diligent towards the company. A liability arises for damages in case a director, supervisor or senior manager commits a violation of the laws, the administrative regulations or the Articles of Association whilst performing his/her duties. Unlawful acts of a director, supervisor, senior manager or third party which either harm the company’s or the shareholders’ interests entitle a shareholder to take legal actions. 16.8 Investment Regulations, Distribution and Transfer Restrictions FIE Regulations The establishment of foreign-invested enterprises in the PRC (“FIE”) need the approval of the Ministry of Commerce ("MOFCOM") or its local counterpart depending on its total amount of investment in order to be established in the PRC. After such establishment, any material corporate changes in the foreign-invested enterprise, such as capital increase or reduction, change of business scope, share transfer, or other, are also subject to approval by the MOFCOM or its local counterpart. For certain industries, the approval of the ministry with responsibility for that industry is required as a prerequisite to apply for the approval of the MOFCOM or its local counterpart. The establishments of foreign-invested enterprises and all corporate changes only become valid when they are approved by the responsible approval authority, i.e. MOFCOM or its local counterparts, and registered with the competent registration authority, i.e. the State Administration for Industry and Commerce (“AIC”) or its local counterpart. 197 Certain material changes to corporate matters of foreign-invested enterprises become valid when they are approved by MOFCOM or its local counterpart. Regulations on Foreign Exchange Under Chinese law foreign currency exchange regulation is primarily governed by the following rules: · the Foreign Currency Administration Rules (1996), as amended (1997 and 2008), or the "Exchange Rules"; and · the Administration Rules of the Settlement, Sale and Payment of Foreign Exchange (1996), or the "Administration Rules” Under the Exchange Rules, the Renminbi is convertible for current account items, including the distribution of dividends, interest payments, trade and service-related foreign exchange transactions. Conversion of Renminbi for capital account items, such as direct investment, loans, investment for securities and repatriation of investment, however, is still subject to the approval of SAFE or its local counterparts. According to the Administration Rules, foreign-invested enterprises in China are only entitled to buy, sell and/or remit foreign currencies at those banks authorised to conduct foreign exchange business after providing valid commercial documents and, in case of capital account item transactions, obtaining approval from SAFE or its local counterparts. Capital investments outside of China by foreign-invested enterprises in China are also subject to limitations, which include approvals by SAFE and other relevant government authorities. SAFE Notice No. 142 on Conversion of Foreign Capital in Foreign-Invested Enterprises On 29 August 2008, SAFE published the Circular on Issues Concerning Improvement of the Administration of Payment and Settlement of Foreign Currency Capital of Foreign-Invested Enterprises, also known as Notice no. 142, which regulates the process of foreign currency capital verification by foreign invested enterprises in China. Notice no. 142 is one of a number of measures recently implemented by China’s regulators seeking to prevent the use of funds of foreign-invested enterprises in China and may have significant consequences for foreign investors due to its potential impact on acquisitions and investments in China carried out via foreign-invested enterprises. A critical share of foreign-invested 198 enterprises in China denominates their registered capital in a foreign currency and will typically convert their registered capital into Renminbi. This converted capital is then used to develop their enterprise in China. In accordance with Notice no. 142, RMB funds converted from the foreign currency capital should only be used for purposes within the approved business scope of the foreign-invested enterprise and not for domestic equity investment unless specifically provided for. In general, only investment-type companies and private equity funds have the business scope to make equity investment; other types of foreign-invested enterprises, such as manufacturing companies, are prevented by Notice no. 142 from converting its foreign capital into Renminbi to make equity investment. Furthermore, Notice no. 142 prohibits the use of RMB funds to purchase domestic real estate for any purpose other than its own use, unless the enterprise is licensed as a real estate enterprise. In M&A transactions, the settlement of the purchase consideration denominated in foreign currency must be effected via an exclusive foreign currency account approved by the local branch of SAFE. Furthermore, the use of FIE’s registered capital settled in RMB may not be changed without SAFE’s approval, and may not in any case be used to repay RMB loans if the revenues of such loans have not been used. Stock Option Plans On 25 December 2006 the People's Bank of China issued the Administration Measures on Individual Foreign Exchange Control, and the Implementation Rules were issued by SAFE on 5 January 2007, both of which became effective on 1 February 2007. Under these two regulations, any stock option plans of an overseas listed company in which citizens of the PRC participate are subject to the approval by SAFE or its authorised branch. On 28 March 2007, SAFE issued the Operational Guidelines on Foreign Exchange Administration Concerning Participation of Individuals in Stock Purchase Plans and Stock Option Plans of Overseas Listed Companies or "Notice No. 78", according to which PRC employees that are granted stock options by an overseas listed company shall, through a PRC agent or PRC subsidiary of such overseas listed company, complete certain approval procedures and transactional foreign exchange matters with SAFE. SAFE Regulations Relating to Offshore Investment by PRC Residents The Notice on Issues relating to the Administration of Foreign Exchange in Fund-raising and Reverse Investment Activities of Domestic Residents Conducted via Offshore Special Purpose Companies ("Notice No. 75") was 199 issued by SAFE on 21 October 2005. It became effective on 1 November 2005. SAFE also issued internal implementing rules from time to time to guide the implementation of laws and regulations on foreign exchange, including detailed directives on the registration of a special purpose vehicle outside the PRC that is directly established or indirectly controlled by a PRC resident for the purpose of carrying out offshore equity financing with the assets or equity interests they hold in PRC enterprises ("SPV"). As such implementing rules are amended frequently and may or may not be publicly available, the interpretation and practice concerning foreign exchange administration in different locations are subject to uncertainty. As laid down in Notice No. 75 each PRC resident who has ultimate control over a SPV must complete the overseas investment foreign exchange registration procedures with the relevant local SAFE branch. This obligation applies to PRC residents which can be legal entities established in the PRC or individuals who are PRC identity card holders, PRC passport holders or individuals who habitually reside in the PRC for reasons related to economic interests. The registration has to be handled prior to establishing or assuming control of a SPV. An amendment to the registration with the local SAFE branch is required to be filed by any PRC resident that directly or indirectly holds interests in that offshore SPV upon either the injection of equity interests or assets of an onshore enterprise to the SPV, or the completion of any overseas fundraising by such SPV. In the case of any material change involving a change in the capital of the SPV, an amendment to the registration with the local SAFE branch is also required to be filed by the respective PRC resident. Relevant material changes include: (i) an increase or decrease in the company’s capital, (ii) a transfer or swap of shares, (iii) a merger or division, (iv) a long-term equity or debt investment or (v) the provision of a guarantee to third parties. Any failure to comply with the registration procedures pursuant to Notice No. 75 may result in restrictions being imposed on the foreign exchange activities of the relevant onshore company including the payment of dividends and other distributions to its offshore parent or affiliate and the capital inflow from the offshore entity, and may also subject relevant PRC residents to penalties under PRC regulations. 200 foreign exchange administration Dividend Distribution The distribution of dividends paid by wholly foreign owned enterprises is regulated mainly by the following provisions: · the Wholly Foreign Owned Enterprise Law (1986), as amended in 2000; and · the Wholly Foreign Owned Enterprise Law Implementation Rules (1990), as amended in 2001. Thereby dividends paid by foreign-invested enterprises in China may only be paid out of their possibly gained accumulated profits. The payment is subject to the PRC accounting standards and regulations. Wholly foreign-owned enterprises in China are obliged to set aside 10% of the profit after tax as reported in its PRC statutory financial statements to the statutory common reserve fund in each year, except where the fund has reached 50% of the wholly foreign-owned enterprise’s registered capital, and certain amounts out of its accumulated profits each year for bonus and welfare funds. These funds are not distributable as cash dividends. According to Chinese Company Law, before distributing dividends, subsidiaries of wholly foreign-owned enterprises in China are also obliged to set aside 10% of the profit after tax as reported it its PRC statutory financial statements to the statutory common reserve fund in each year, except where the fund has reached 50% of the company’s registered capital. The Enterprise Income Tax Law and its implementing rules, both came into effect on 1 January 2008, stipulate that dividend payments from foreign-invested enterprises ("FlE") to their foreign shareholders will be subject to a 10% withholding tax unless the country where the foreign shareholder is incorporated has concluded a tax treaty with China that provides for a lower withholding tax rate. Under the double taxation treaty between China and Hong Kong, if a beneficiary of dividends is a Hong Kong resident holding directly at least 25% in a tax resident company located on the Mainland of China, the 5% withholding tax is to be applied. The EIT Law has introduced the concept of tax resident enterprise ("TRE") defined as an enterprise which is established in the PRC under the PRC laws and regulations, or which has its de facto management body in the PRC. TREs will be subject to PRC EIT for their worldwide income, including income received from its subsidiaries; distribution of dividends to the non-TRE that 201 were generated by a TRE prior to 1 January 2008 will be exempted from corporate income tax, while distribution of dividends to the non-TRE that were generated by a TRE after 1 January 2008 will be subject to 10% PRC withholding tax. In accordance with art. 4 of the Implementing Rules of the EIT Law, "de facto management body" refers to the management body that exercises essential management and control over the enterprise. As a result, if a holding company located outside the PRC was actually managed by a management body in China, the overseas company would be regarded as a TRE and subject to EIT in the PRC for its worldwide income. 16.9 Regulations on Overseas Listing In 2006, six PRC regulatory agencies, including the MOFCOM, and the CSRC passed the Regulations on Mergers and Acquisitions of Domestic Enterprises by Foreign Investors, or the M&A Provisions. The regulations became effective on 8 September 2006. The M&A Provisions, as amended on 22 June 2009 require an offshore special purpose vehicle (“SPV”) controlled directly or indirectly by PRC companies or individuals for the purpose of offshore listings of the interests in a domestic company that it actually owns, to obtain the approval of the CSRC prior to such offshore listing and trading. On 21 September 2006; the CSRC published the procedures specifying documents and materials required to be submitted to it by SPVs seeking CSRC approval of their overseas listings. However, substantial uncertainty remains regarding the scope and applicability of the M&A Provisions to overseas listings of offshore SPVs. 16.10 PRC Tort Liability Law The Tort Liability Law of the PRC was adopted by the National People’s Congress’ Standing Committee on 26 December 2009 and came into force on 1 July 2010. The Tort Liability Law is formulated for the purpose of protecting the legal rights and interests of civil subjects, defining tort liability, preventing and sanctioning acts of tort. The “civil rights” are personal and property rights including the right to live, right to health, right of name, right of reputation, right of honour, portraiture right, right to privacy, autonomy in marriage, guardianship, ownership, usufruct, real rights granted by way of security, copyright, patent, rights to exclusive use of trademarks, right of discovery, equity interest and right of inheritance. According to the Tort Liability Law, the infringee is entitled to seek tort liability on the part of the tortfeasor and in the event that the property of the tortfeasor is insufficient to pay for his or her tort liability and administrative or criminal liability for the 202 same act, he or she first and foremost assumes his or her tort liability. According to the Tort Liability Law, the liability is mainly assumed through the cessation of the infringing act, the removal of obstacle, the elimination of danger, the restitution of property, the restitution of original state, the compensation for loss, formal apology and the elimination of adverse effect and restoration of reputation. Under the Tort Liability Law, the employer is to be liable for the damages caused by its employees to others in the course of performing work duties. A manufacturer is to be liable for any damages caused due to its defective products. A manufacturer is also to be held liable for any pollution of environment caused unless it can prove that there is no causation between its acts and the damages caused or there are statutory reasons for it not to assume all or part of the liability. 16.11 PRC Product Liability Law The principal law governing product liability is the Product Quality Law, which was promulgated on 22 February 1993 and amended on 8 July 2000. The Product Quality Law defines a product as commodity sold following the processing or manufacturing. Thus, an item qualifies as product under the Product Quality Law if it meets two main criteria: first, it must have been produced for sale and secondly, it must have been processed or manufactured. The first criterion excludes such items which have not been circulated for public consumption. In such case, the producer is not liable under the Product Quality Law. Pursuant to the Product Quality Law, a producer shall have the following obligations: · be responsible for the quality of products it produces; · not produce products banned from production according to State laws or decrees; · not fake the place of origin or fake or use the names and addresses of other producers; · not fake or without authorization use quality marks such as certification marks and fine quality product marks; · not adulterate products or pose fake products as genuine or shoddy products as good or non-standard products as standard; · ensure that the marks on the products or the packaging of the products are true; and 203 · ensure that, for products that are easily broken, inflammable, explosive, toxic, erosive or radioactive and products that cannot be handled upside down in the process of storage or transportation or for which there are other special requirements, the package thereof meets the corresponding requirements, carries warning marks or warnings written in Chinese or points of attention in handling in accordance with the relevant state provisions. Pursuant to the Product Quality Law, a seller shall have the following obligations: · a check-for-acceptance system for stock replenishment is to be adopted to examine quality certificates and other labels of such stock; · measures are expected to be adopted to keep products for sale in good quality; · lose-effect and defective or deteriorated products are expected not to be sold; · products must be sold with labels that comply with the relevant provisions; · the seller must not forge the origin of a product or falsely use the name and address of another producer; · the seller must not forge or falsely use another producer’s authentication marks, marks of famous/premium brand names or other product quality marks; and · the seller must not mix impurities or imitations into products, substitute a fake product for a genuine one, a defective product for a high-quality one, or pass off a substandard product as a qualified one. Violations of the Product Quality Law may result in the imposition of administrative fines. In addition, the business operator may be ordered to suspend its operations and its business license may be revoked. Criminal liability may be incurred in serious cases. According to the Product Quality Law, if damages are done to a person or the properties of others due to the defective products, the victims may claim compensation either from the producers or sellers. If the responsibility rests with the producers and the compensation is paid by the sellers, the sellers 204 have the right to recover their losses from the producers. If the responsibility rests with the sellers and the compensation is paid by the producers, the producers have the right to recover their losses. 16.12 Protection of Consumer Rights and Interests The Law on Protection of Consumer Rights and Interests that was adopted on 31 October 1993 by the National People’s Congress’ Standing Committee and came into effective on 1 January 1994, is formulated for the protection of the legitimate rights and interests of consumer and sets out standards of behavior which business operators must observe in their dealings with consumers, including the following: · Business operators are expected to, in their supply of commodities and services to consumers, fulfil their obligations stipulated in the Law on Product Quality and other laws and regulations concerned; · Business operators are expected to guarantee that the commodities and services they supply meet the requirements for personal or property safety. As to commodities and services capable of harming personal or property safety, business operators are expected to give the consumers truthful explanation and clear warnings, and shall explain or indicate the correct ways of using the commodities or receiving services as well as the methods of preventing damage; · Business operators are expected to provide consumers with authentic information concerning their commodities or services, and may not make any false and misleading propaganda. Business operators are expected to give truthful and definite replies to inquiries from consumers about the qualities of the commodities or services they supply and the operation methods thereof; · Business operators are expected to indicate their real names and marks. Business operators who lease counters or grounds from others are expected to indicate their own real names and marks; · Business operators are expected to guarantee the quality, functions, usage and term of validity which the commodities or services they supply should possess under normal operation or acceptance, unless the defects of the commodities or services were known to the consumers when they purchased the commodities or services; · Business operators who are under the obligation of repair or replacement 205 or refund of commodities, or other responsibilities in accordance with regulations of the State or agreements with consumers are expected to carry out such obligations correspondingly according to such regulations or agreements, and may not deliberately delay or unreasonably refuse to do so; · Business operators announcements, may not, through entrance hall bulletins format and contracts, other notices, methods and documents, impose unfair or unreasonable rules on consumers or reduce or evade their civil liability for infringement of legitimate rights and interests of consumers. Such contents in format contracts, notices, announcements, entrance hall bulletins and other methods and documents are invalid. Violations of the Law on Protection of Consumer Rights and Interests may result in the imposition of administrative fines. In addition, the business operator may be ordered to suspend its operations and its business license may be revoked. Criminal liability may be incurred in serious cases. According to the Law on Protection of Consumer Rights and Interests, a consumer whose legitimate rights and interests are infringed upon when purchasing or using commodities may demand compensation from the seller concerned. In case the liability is on the manufacturers or other sellers who supplied the commodities to the said sellers, the said sellers, after paying the compensations to the consumer, have the right to recover the compensations from the manufacturers or the other sellers. Consumers or other victims suffering personal injuries or property damage resulting from defects of commodities may demand compensations either from the sellers or from the manufacturers. If the liability is on the manufacturers, the sellers are expected to, after paying the compensations to the consumer, have the right to recover the compensations from the manufacturers; if the liability is on the sellers, the manufacturers, after paying compensation, have the right to recover the compensations from the sellers. 16.13 PRC Competition and Antitrust Laws Under the Chinese Anti-Unfair Competition Law that was promulgated on 2 September 1993 and became effective on 1 December 1993, business operators may not use the following unfair methods in their business transactions which can damage other competitors: 206 · to feign registered trademarks of others; · to use the specific name, package, decoration of famous or noted commodities, or use a similar name, package, decoration of famous or noted commodities, which may confuse consumers in distinguishing the commodities from the famous or noted commodities; · to use the name of another enterprise or the personal name of another person and thereby causing customer confusion relating to the commodity and the other enterprise’s or person’s commodity; · to feign or pretend to hold a certificate of attestation, mark of fame and high qualification, to feign a certificate of place of origin of the commodities, which may cause misunderstanding or false perception of the qualification of the commodities. Violations of the Anti-Unfair Competition Law may result in the responsibility for compensation, the imposition of administrative fines, and, in serious cases, revocation of business license and criminal liability. The Anti-monopoly Law of the People’s Republic of China was promulgated on 30 August 30 2007 and became effective on 1 August 2008. According to the anti-monopoly law, the operators are not expected to take such monopolistic conducts as executing monopolistic agreements among business operators, abusing a dominant market positions and concentrating other business operators to eliminate or restrict competition. Violations of the Anti-monopoly Law may result in the responsibility for compensation and the imposition of the administrative penalties. 16.14 PRC Environmental Law Environmental Protection Law The Environmental Protection Law adopted on 26 December 1989 by the National People’s Congress’ Standing Committee provides the legal framework on environmental protection. Units that cause environmental pollution and other public hazards are expected to incorporate steps and measures of environmental protection into their plans and establish a responsibility system for environmental protection. These units are expected to adopt effective measures to prevent and control the pollution and harms 207 caused to the environment by waste gas, waste water, waste residues, dust, malodorous gases, radioactive substance, noise, vibration and electromagnetic radiation generated in the course of production, construction or other activities. Installations for the prevention and control of pollution at a construction project are expected to be designed, built and commissioned together with the principal part of the project. No permission is to be given for a construction project to be commissioned or used, until its installations for the prevention and control of pollution have been examined and considered compliant with the standard by the competent department of the environmental protection administration having examined and approved the environmental impact statement. The administration department of environmental protection of the State Council implements unified supervision and management of the national environmental protection work, and establishes the national standards for environmental protection bureaus at pollutant discharge, while the or above the county level are responsible for the environmental protection work within their respective jurisdictions. Law on the Prevention and Control of Pollution from Environmental Noise The Law on the Prevention and Control of Environmental Pollution by Noise, adopted on 29 October 1996, came into effect on 1 March 1997. Pursuant to this law, any new construction project, expansion, or reconstruction project that discharges pollutants into the air are subject to the regulations of State on environmental protection of construction projects. Industrial enterprises that produce environmental noise pollution due to the use of permanent equipment in the course of industrial production are expected to report to the competent administrative department for environmental protection of the local government at or above the county level the types and quantity of its equipment that produces environmental noise pollution, the noise level produced under normal operation and the facilities installed for prevention and control of such pollution, and to provide technical information relating to the prevention and control of noise pollution. Any industrial enterprise that intends to make a substantial change in the types or quantity of the equipment that produces environmental noise pollution, in the noise level of facilities for prevention and control of such pollution shall submit a report without delay and take prevention and control measures as it should. Units that produce environmental noise pollution are to take measures to control it and pay fees for excessive emission of such pollution according to the regulations of the State. 208 Law on the Prevention and Control of Atmospheric Pollution The Law on the Prevention and Control of Atmospheric Pollution, adopted on 29 April 2000 by the National People’s Congress’ Standing Committee, is effective as of 1 September 2000. Pursuant to this law, the environmental protection authorities above county level can regulate the prevention of air pollution. The environmental protection department of the State Council formulates the national air environmental quality standards and the local provincial governments formulate the local standards if there are no applicable national air environmental quality standards. The local provincial governments can also delineate more specific local standards. Enterprises which emit smoke into the air must comply with the national and relevant local air environmental quality standards. If the smoke emitted exceeds these quality standards, the relevant enterprises must rectify their actions within a limited timeframe, and the environmental protection authority at county level can impose a penalty. Law on the Prevention and Control of Environmental Pollution by Solid Waste According to the Law on the Prevention and Control of Environmental Pollution by Solid Waste amended and effective as of 1 April 2005, producers, distributors, importers and users of a product are responsible for the prevention and control of the solid wastes it generates or discharges. Law on the Prevention and Control of Water Pollution The Law on the Prevention and Control of Water Pollution was adopted on 11 May 1985 and amended on 15 May 1996 and 28 February 2008, respectively, and the last amendment became effective on 1 June 2008. According to this law, the environmental protection department of the State Council governs the national waste discharge standards and the local provincial governments promulgate more specific local waste discharge standards. The discharge of waste must comply with both the national and local waste discharge standards. Enterprises which discharge waste into water must pay a treatment fee. If the waste discharged exceeds the national or local waste discharge standards, the relevant enterprises must pay a higher waste treatment fee. The environmental protection department has the right to order the enterprises which severely pollute water to correct their actions by reducing their waste discharge within a stipulated time period or order the enterprises to stop production or be closed. 209 16.15 PRC Tax Laws Enterprise Income Tax ("EIT") Law Pursuant to previous PRC tax regulations, the general enterprise income tax rate for foreign-invested enterprises (“FIEs”) was 33%, comprising 30% national and 3% local income tax. In some special zones and regions, the applicable tax rate could vary and thus even be as low as 15% or 24%. Manufacturing FIEs with a term of operation longer than ten years – following previous tax law regulations – were usually entitled to a tax holiday of two years which began in the first profitable year after the compensation of previous losses. This period of full exemption followed a three-year term of 50% tax exemption. The Chinese EIT Law, which came into effect on 1 January 2008, provides for a unified tax rate for foreign-invested as well as domestically owned companies. The EIT Law stipulates that the 15% tax rates in special zones and regions will be increased gradually to 25% in the next five years. According to the tax Circular Guofa (2007) No. 39, for FIEs originally enjoying a tax rate of 15% based on laws and regulations issued by the central government, the transitional tax rates for 2008-2012 are expected to be 18%, 20%, 22%, 24% and 25%, respectively. Furthermore, the EIT Law provides that tax holidays for FIEs will not be available to newly established FIEs. However, a grandfathering period will be granted to FIEs which were approved prior to the promulgation of the EIT Law. If tax holidays have not started due to losses, they are to be deemed to commence from the beginning of 2008, i.e. tax holidays can only be utilised until 2012. Pursuant to art. 27 and 30 of the EIT Law, tax incentives may be granted to qualified high new tech enterprises (“HNTEs”), research and development activities and income derived from technology transfer. Concerning qualified high/new tech enterprises, the tax rate can be reduced to 15%. As the Implementing Rules of the EIT Law state, qualified income derived from technology transfer within the amount of RMB five million per year are to be exempted from EIT and the portion exceeding RMB five million are to be subject to EIT at a half-reduced rate. An additional 50% of the qualified research and development expenses incurred for development of new technologies, new products and new work crafts can be deducted before tax for EIT calculation purposes. On 14 April 2008, the Ministry of Science and Technology (“MST”), the Ministry of Finance (“MOF”) and the State Administration of Taxation (“SAT”) 210 issued the Measures for the Recognition of HNTE (the “HNTE Measures”). Pursuant to art. 10 of the HNTE Measures, an enterprise is expected to - in order to be recognized as a HNTE – comply with the following conditions: The applicant is a tax resident enterprise registered in the PRC for more than one year; Its products (services) fall within the prescribed scope of the "Category for High/New Tech Sectors Specifically Supported by the State"; The enterprise owns the core proprietary intellectual property ("IP") right for its products and services. According to the HNTE Measures, core IP rights refer to certain IP that is registered by a Chinese enterprise (excluding Hong Kong, Macau and Taiwan). This IP must have been obtained by self-development, transfer, gift, acquisition or other methods within the previous three years. Such IP also includes those rights obtained through exclusive licensing for periods of more than 5 years. The guidance for the EIT Law further provides additional guidance on what qualifies as core IP. Under these rules, core IP include inventions, new models, new appearance designs that are not a mere change in patent and shape, software copyrights, patents of IC design and new species of plants. The Guidance on Recognition of HNTE jointly issued by the MST, MOF and SAT on 8 July 2008 (the "HNTE Guidance") also provides that in case of "exclusive licensing”; the Chinese HNTE applicant must hold the worldwide rights to exclusively use the IP. Furthermore, according to the HNTE Guidance, in case of "exclusive licensing", the technology provider must be excluded from using the licensed technology; The enterprise is consistently engaged in research and development activities. The total amount of research and development expenses in the latest 3 fiscal years or actual operating years (in case the enterprise is not older than three years) must reach not less than a certain percentage of its total turnovers in the same period (6% if the annual sales are less than RMB 50 million, 4% if the annual sales are above RMB 50 million but less than RMB 200 million and 3% if the annual sales are above RMB 200 million). Moreover, the research and development expenses incurred within the PRC are expected to be no less than 60% of the total research and development expenses. Furthermore, only 80% of the research and development contract payment for outsourced research and development activities can be treated as research and development expenses under the HNTE Guidance; The income generated from its high and new technological products or 211 services exceeds 60% of the total annual income; The number of research and development staff with a bachelor and above degree is not less than 30% of the total number of employees of the enterprise and the number of research and development staff is not less than 10% of the total number of employees of the enterprise; The enterprise fulfils the following criteria set out by the HNTE Guidance: 1. the research and development organization and management ability of the enterprise; 2. the ability to industrialise the technical results; 3. the number of core intellectual property rights; 4. the growth of sales and total assets. The detailed calculation methods of the above indexes are provided by the HNTE Guidance. An applicant shall have a total score of above 70 (the full score is 100) regarding these indexes in order to pass the test. Value Added Tax ("VAT") VAT is to be paid by enterprises and individuals which sell goods, provide taxable services (repair, maintenance and processing) in the PRC or import goods into the PRC. There are two different categories of VAT taxpayers to which different tax rates and calculation methods apply: general and small-scale taxpayers. In case of general taxpayers the VAT resembles the balance between the output-VAT amount and the input-VAT amount incurred. The VAT rate is normally 17%. Regarding certain categories of goods a lower tax rate of 13% applies. Goods and services of a small-scale taxpayer are subject to a lower VAT rate than general taxpayers: According to the amended PRC Value Added Tax Tentative Regulations which came into effect on 1 January 2009, the VAT rate applicable to small-scale taxpayers was reduced from 4-6% to 3%. A small scale VAT taxpayer is a manufacturer who has annual taxable sales of less than RMB 500,000 or a distributor or retailer who has annual taxable sales of less than RMB 800,000. A deduction on the paid input VAT charged on imported or domestically purchased materials from the payable amount of output VAT is not possible, however. 212 Usually, enterprises are entitled to an "exemption, credit and refund" of VAT. The exported goods are decisive for these exceptions. Thus, the export of goods can be exempted from VAT, the Input VAT can be used as credit against output VAT and the negative balance, if any, will be refunded to the enterprise. Moreover, the exported products determine the VAT refund rates which are frequently changed by the PRC Government. 16.16 Patent and Trademark Protection Patent Prosecution The patent system of the PRC follows the principle of "first to file". Should more persons file a patent application for the same invention, the person who had filed the first application will be granted the patent. An invention in this context must be categorized as an absolute novelty in order to be patentable. Any prior written or oral publication, demonstration or use before filing the patent application therefore prevents an invention from being patented in the PRC. Hong Kong, Taiwan and Macau have independent patent systems. Thus, patents issued in the PRC are not enforceable in these countries. The three different types of patents known under PRC patent law are invention patents, utility model patents and design patents. New technical schemes being made with regard to the shape or structure of the product or a combination of the two which are suitable for utilisation are protected by utility model patents. Inventions protected by invention patents or utility model patents must be new, creative and have a practical approach, whereas a design patent is granted if the invention relates to the new design of the shape or the pattern of the product or a combination of the two. An invention for which a design patent is rendered must serve two purposes: firstly, it must create an aesthetic feeling and, secondly, it must be suitable for industrial use. A PRC invention patent is valid for 20 years. This period begins on the date the patent application was filed. Patents for a utility model and design patents are valid for 10 years from the initial date on which the patent application was filed. Patent applications must be filed at the State Intellectual Property Office (“SIPO”) in Beijing. According to the PRC patent law, patent rights take effect on the date when SIPO makes the announcement granting the patent rights to the patentee. The patentee is to pay an annual fee beginning with the year in which the patent right was granted. If the patentee fails to pay the annual fee, the patent right will cease from the expiration of the time limit within which the annual fee is 213 expected to be paid. Inventions Made by Employees Patentable inventions made by employees working in China are subject to art. 16 PRC patent law and art. 76 to 78 of the implementing rules of the PRC patent law which regulate compensation through payments of bonus and remuneration for inventions made by the employee in the course of their employment. Accordingly, the company which entitles to the invention have to pay an appropriate bonus and remuneration to the employee for the invention. In this respect, the company and the employee can agree in the employment contract on the amount of bonus and remuneration payments for inventions made by the employee. If there are no agreements providing any bonus and remuneration for invention or no waiver in this regard and if the company does not provide any internal rules on how to determine the bonus and remuneration for inventions, the employee is entitled to demand a bonus of no less than RMB 3,000.00 for an invention patent and RMB 1,000.00 for a utility model as well as for a design patent within three months after publication of the patent. In addition, the employee can demand remuneration of 2.0% of operating profits derived from exploiting an invention patent as well as a utility model patent and 0.2% of operating profits derived from exploiting a design patent. If the company licenses the patent to third parties, the employee can demand 10% of the licensing fees. Besides bonus and remuneration payments, an employee can demand that his name is displayed in the patent documents. Patent Enforcement In case of an infringement of a patent, the patent holder who believes the patent is being infringed may either file a civil legal suit or file an administrative complaint with a provincial or municipal office of SIPO. Before instituting any legal proceedings or during the proceedings itself, a PRC court may issue a preliminary injunction upon the patent holder’s or an interested party’s request. Either the loss suffered by the patent holder arising from the infringement or the benefit gained by the infringing party makes up the compensation for damages of infringement. Since the exact determination of the damages is difficult to achieve in this manner, damages may be ascertained in the range between one and three times the licence fee under a contractual licence. In case the determination of damages is not possible, statutory damages ranging from RMB 10,000.00 to RMB 1,000,000.00 may be requested. The burden of proof that the patent is being infringed rests 214 with the patent holder. Only when a holder of a manufacturing process patent alleges infringement of such a patent, the alleged infringing party has the burden of proving that there has been no infringement. Compulsory Licence Pursuant to the Patent Law, SIPO will grant a compulsory licence in case that · an invention or utility model, for which a patent right has been granted, brings important technical advance of considerable economic significance in relation to another invention or utility model, for which a patent right was granted earlier, and · the exploitation of the later invention or utility model depends on the exploitation of the earlier invention or utility model. Moreover, a compulsory licence can be granted in a few other limited cases, such as an occurrence of a national emergency or any extraordinary state of affairs or if the public interest requires so. International Patent Treaties The PRC has signed all major intellectual property conventions such as the Paris Convention for the Protection of Industrial Property, Madrid Agreement on the International Registration of Marks and Madrid Protocol, Patent Cooperation Treaty, Budapest Treaty on the International Recognition of the Deposit of Micro-organisms for the Purposes of Patent Procedure and the Agreement on Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property Rights (“TRIPs”). The patents which are national rights are escorted by a large degree of international co-operation under the Patent Cooperation Treat (“PCT”) to which China is a signatory as well. Under the PCT, applicants in one country can seek patent protection for an invention simultaneously in a number of other member countries by filing a single international patent application. The pending patent application does not constitute any guarantee that a patent will be granted, and even if granted, the scope of a patent may not be as broad as the subject of the initial application. Trademarks In 1982, the PRC Trademark Law was published, followed by the PRC Trademark Implementing Regulations in 1988, and was amended on 27 October 2001. As noted above, the PRC is a signatory to the Madrid Agreement and the Madrid Protocol. These agreements provide a mechanism 215 whereby an international registration has the same effect as an application for registration of the mark made in each of the countries designated by the applicant. The registration and administration of trademarks is done by the PRC Trademark Office for the whole of China. In regard to trademarks the "first-to-file" principle applies as well. The PRC Trademark Office is to examine the trademark which has been applied for registration based on the relevant trademark laws and regulations. If the application is in line with the relevant laws and regulations, the PRC Trademark Office will make a preliminary examination and approval of that trademark and will publicly announce it. Any person may file an opposition to a trademark which has been given preliminary examination and approval within three months from the day it was publicly announced. If no opposition is filed after the period of public announcement expires, the registration is to be granted. According to the PRC Trademark Law, the duration of trademark rights are expected to be ten years, counted from the date of registration and it is renewable. The protection of the trademark rights starts from the registration date and is limited to the registered trademark and the designated goods/services thereof. An infringement of the exclusive right to use a registered trademark is committed pursuant to PRC Law, in case of: · a use of a trademark that is identical with or similar to a registered trademark in respect of the same or similar commodities without the authorisation of the trademark registrant; · a sale of commodities infringing upon the exclusive right to use the trademark; · counterfeiting or making, without authorisation, representations of a registered trademark of another person, or sale of such representations of a registered trademark as were counterfeited, or made without authorisation; · changing a registered trademark and putting commodities on which the changed registered trademark is used into the market without the consent of the trademark registrant; and · otherwise infringing upon the exclusive right of another person to use a registered trademark. 216 In case of an infringement of the trademark, the owner who believes its trademark is being infringed has the following options: The trademark owner has the possibility to provide its trademark registration certificate and other relevant evidence to the State or Local Administration for Industry and Commerce (the “AIC”). After the presentation of the evidences the AIC decides if it is going to launch an investigation. The AIC can order the party committing the infringement to immediately cease the infringing behaviour, seize and destroy the representations of the trademark in question and impose a fine. Should the trademark owner be unsatisfied with the AIC’s decision, it may apply to have the decision reconsidered. Moreover, the trademark owner may take civil proceedings directly with the court. Civil redress for trademark infringement includes: · injunctions; · requiring the infringing party to take steps to mitigate the damage (i. e., print notices in newspapers); · damages (i. e. compensation for the economic loss and injury to reputation as a result of trademark infringement suffered by the trademark holder); whereby the amount of compensation is calculated according to either the gains acquired by the infringing party from the infringement during the infringement, or the loss suffered by the trademark owner including expenses incurred by the trademark holder to deter such infringement. In case of problems arising with the determination of the gains acquired by the infringing party from the infringement, or the loss suffered by the trademark owner, the court may elect to award compensation of not more than RMB 500,000.00; and · if the case is so serious as to constitute a crime, the trademark owner may lodge a complaint with the relevant public security organ. 16.17 Legislation on Land in the PRC Land in the PRC is either state-owned or collectively owned, depending on the location of the land. Land in urban areas of a city or town is state-owned, whereas land in rural areas of a city or town and rural land is, unless otherwise specified by law, collectively owned. The state has the right to reclaim land in accordance with law if required for the benefit of the public. Although all land in the PRC is owned by the state or by collectives, private individuals and businesses and other organizations are permitted to hold, 217 lease and develop land for which they are granted or allocated with land use rights. In April 1988, the constitution of the PRC was amended by the National People’s Congress to allow for the transfer of land use rights for value. In December 1988, the Land Administration Law of the PRC was amended to permit the transfer of land use rights for value. Under the Interim Regulations of the People’s Republic of China on Grant and Transfer of the Right to Use State-owned Urban Land (“Interim Regulations on Grant and Transfer”) promulgated in May 1990, local governments at or above county level have the power to grant land use rights for specific purposes and for a definite period to a land user pursuant to a contract for the grant of land use rights against payment of a grant premium. All local and foreign enterprises are permitted to acquire land use rights unless otherwise provided by law. The state may not reclaim lawfully granted land use rights prior to expiration of the term of grant. If the public interest requires repossession by the state of the land under special circumstances during the term of grant, compensation will be paid by the state. A land grantee may lawfully transfer, mortgage or lease its granted land use rights to a third party for the remainder of the term of grant. Upon expiration of the term of grant, renewal is possible subject to the execution of a new contract for the grant of land use rights and payment of a premium. If the term of the grant is not renewed, the land use rights and ownership of any buildings erected on the land will revert to the state without compensation. After land use rights relating to a particular area of land have been granted by the state, the party to whom such land use rights have been granted may transfer, lease or mortgage such land use rights, unless a restriction is imposed, for a term not exceeding the term which has been granted by the state. A transfer involves the vesting of the land use rights by the transferor in the transferee during the term for which such land use rights are vested in the transferor. A lease, on the other hand, does not involve a transfer of such rights by the lessor to the lessee. Furthermore, a lease, unlike a transfer, does not usually involve the payment of a premium. Instead, rent is payable during the term of the lease. Land use rights cannot be transferred, leased or mortgaged if the provisions of the land grant contract, with respect to the prescribed period and conditions of investment, development and use of the land, have not been complied with. In addition, different areas of the PRC 218 have different conditions which must have been fulfilled before the respective land use rights can be transferred, leased or mortgaged. All transfers, mortgages and leases of land use rights must be evidenced by a written contract registered with the relevant local land bureau at municipality or county level. Upon a transfer of land use rights, all rights and obligations contained in the contract pursuant to which the land use rights were originally granted by the state are deemed to be incorporated as part of the terms and conditions of such transfer, depending on the nature of the transaction. Real property that has not been registered and a title certificate which has not been obtained in accordance with the law cannot be transferred according to art. 37 of the PRC Law on Administration of Urban Real Estate (the “Urban Real Estate Law”). Under art. 38 of the Urban Real Estate Law, if land use rights are acquired by means of grant, the following conditions must have been met before the land use rights may be transferred: (i) the premium for the grant of land use rights must have been paid in full in accordance with the land grant contract and a land use rights certificate must have been obtained; (ii) investment or development must have been made or carried out in accordance with terms of the land grant contract; (iii) more than 25% of the total amount of investment or development must have been made or completed; and (iv) where the investment or development involves a large tract of land, conditions for use of the land for industrial or other construction purpose must have been confirmed. According to the PRC Law on Land Administration, adopted by the National People’s Congress on 25 June 1986, and amended on 28 August 2004, land in rural and suburban areas, unless stipulated by laws as owned by the State, is collectively owned by rural residents. Land collectively owned by rural residents is contracted to and operated by members of the respective collective economic entity for uses such as plantation, forestry, livestock husbandry or fishery productions. Before any land collectively owned by rural residents is contracted to a unit or individual not from the collective economic entity, it must be agreed by at least two-thirds of the members of the villager committee meeting or at least two-thirds of the villager representatives, and be submitted to the people’s government at the township level for approval. The land use rights of collectively owned land must not be granted, assigned or leased to any party for any non-agricultural uses. 219 According to the PRC Law on Land Administration, a state-owned land use right certificate will be issued by the competent land resource authority at or above the county level to evidence a private individual, businesses and other organizations which are entitled to use the state-owned land. With regard to the house ownership registration, since 1997, several regulations have been enacted but were replaced by the Housing Registration Method which was promulgated on 15 February 2008 and took effect on 1 July 2008. According to the Housing Registration Method, the ownership, change of ownership and mortgage of ownership of a house are to be registered with the competent Administration for Real Estate at or above the county level. The holder of the land use right and the owner of the house erected on the land are expected to be consistent. The house ownership certificate will be issued to a private individual, businesses and other organizations which have ownership of the house. In most areas in the PRC, state-owned land use right and the house ownership certificate are the two essential certificates to prove the right to the land and the house erected on such land. Nevertheless, some cities in China combine two certificates into one certificate, i.e. real estate title certificate to cover both the state-owned use right and the ownership for the house erected on the land either with the merge of the two different authorities into one organ or the mutual agreement reached by the two different authorities. 220 17. BUSINESS 17.1 Overview The China Specialty Glass-Group develops, produces and sells specialty glass under its “Hing Wah” brand. The Group distributes its products to customers in the Chinese domestic market directly through its own sales network. The China Specialty Glass-Group considers itself to be one of the leading manufacturers in China for security glass, a class of specialty glass used primarily for personal protection against physical violence and forced intrusion, for the Chinese banking security and automotive security industry. It also provides various specialty glass products for the Construction Glass Market. For security-glass products which are required by the Chinese banking security and automotive security industry, the Group is a dominant player both in terms of production output and market share (source: p. 104, RMR Report, 2010). The Group provides technical consultation and installation guidance to its customers in connection with sales. China Specialty Glass-Group’s current production facility is located in Guangzhou, Guangdong Province, in southern China, and is operated by the Group’s wholly-owned subsidiary HWG-Ltd, which is currently the Group’s only operating company. The Group’s new production facility in Sichuan, which is to be operated by HWG-SC, is currently under construction and is expected to commence production in the second half of 2011 and to reach maximum production capacities in about two years’ time. China Specialty Glass-Group’s major products, which are sold under its “Hing Wah” brand, are categorized into two groups: security glass which includes bulletproof glass and intruder-resistant glass; and construction glass which includes laminated glass, tempered glass, fire-resistant glass, hollow glass and electrically-controlled colour-changing glass. The Group’s security glass is used in places where cash or valuable goods are traded, such as banks, jewellery stores, securities brokerage houses, postal services and insurance companies (“Bank Security Glass Market”). The Group’s security glass is also used for armoured vehicles which offer security and safety to their passengers such as cash-in-transit vehicles for banks, police vehicles, military personnel carriers and armoured limousines (“Automotive Security Glass Market”). In addition, the Group provides its construction glass products to the construction industry where they are used for windows, doors, curtain walls (outer covering of buildings of which the outer walls are non-structural and merely protect the building from the 221 weather) or internal decorations in commercial buildings and private houses (“Construction Glass Market”). The Group has sold its products since 1994 and its end customers are exclusively commercial enterprises: banks in the Bank Security Glass Market, refitting automobile manufacturers in the Automotive Security Glass Market, and construction service providers in the Construction Glass Market. For the distribution of the Group’s products, the Group currently relies on its own sales network in China. The sales of HWG-Ltd., which is currently the Group’s only wholly-owned operative subsidiary, increased from EUR 40.2 million in 2008 to EUR 50.9 million in 2009 and to EUR 69.6 million in 2010, corresponding to an average annual growth rate of 31.7% during this period. The net profits increased from EUR 10.6 million in 2008 to EUR 14.1 million in 2009 and to EUR 22.3 million in 2010, corresponding to an average annual growth rate of 45.6%. The majority of the sales was generated by its security glass which is sold in two markets: The Bank Security Glass Market with sales of EUR 17.5 million, EUR 23.0 million and EUR 32.1 million for 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively; and the Automotive Security Glass Market with sales of EUR 15.4 million, EUR 22.4 million and EUR 30.0 million for the years 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively. These sales correspond to 43.5%, 45.2% and 46.1% and 38.3%, 44.0% and 43.1% of total revenue for these years, respectively. The Company believes that the Chinese security glass markets (Bank Security Glass Market and Automotive Security Glass Market) and the Construction Glass Market will continue to develop positively in the future. In particular, with the expected increase in consumer wealth and commercial activities, the commercial entities which require security glass are also expected to grow both in number (e.g. increase of bank branches in rural areas and smaller cities) and in individual size (e.g. increase of operating surface area of post offices). In these commercial entities, security measures are closely monitored and regulated by the government. Demand for the Group’s products which are certified by the regulatory authorities is expected to increase accordingly. Similarly, an increase in the number of wealthy Chinese citizens and their concern for and awareness of safety and security for themselves and their families bodes well for the increase in demand for the Group’s automotive security glass or construction glass products. The Company intends to increase production and sales of the Group’s glass products to meet this growing demand. 222 17.2 History HWG-Ltd. began its production in 1994 with its first corporate predecessor Guangzhou HingWah Auto Glass Industry Co., Ltd., which was founded in Guangzhou, China, as a joint Chinese-foreign enterprise. Its name was changed in 1999 to Guangzhou HingWah Glass Industry Co., Ltd. to better reflect the broader product range. In 2008, HWG-Ltd.’s ownership was transferred to HWG HK-Holding and HWG-Ltd. became a wholly foreign owned enterprise (“WFOE”) within the meaning of PRC law. HWG-Ltd. has offered specialty glass products since its inception. In 1996, HWG-Ltd. started to develop its proprietary bulletproof glass at the request of the Chinese Ministry of Public Security. In 1997, HWG-Ltd. launched the first “Made-in-China” bulletproof glass in China. The Group started using its “Hing Wah” brand in 2005. 17.3 Strengths The Group considers the following competitive strengths as essential for its future growth: · Industry pioneer, strong market presence and well-recognized brand in China: HWG-Ltd. started to produce and sell its proprietary security glass products for the Automotive Security Glass Market through its corporate predecessor Guangzhou HingWah Auto Glass Industry Co., Ltd. in 1997. Prior to 1997, the security glass industry with regard to bulletproof glass practically did not exist in China and automobiles containing bulletproof glass were mostly imported. The Company’s CEO, Mr. Nang Heung Sze, commenced production of specialty glass in 1985 and in 1994 the corporate predecessor of HWG-Ltd. was established. Due to his experience in the Chinese public security system and the production of specialty glass, Mr. Nang Heung Sze was able to identify market trends and developed the first “Made-in-China” bulletproof automotive glass to meet the market demand for mobile and secure delivery of cash to bank branches, thus becoming the pioneer of this emerging niche industry in China. With Mr. Nang Heung Sze´s experience of over 25 years of product development and manufacturing, the Group has gained an extensive knowledge about production processes, market development trends as well as valuable experience in sales and distribution of its various specialty glass products, especially bulletproof glass products, in 223 different market segments in China. As the pioneer in this new industry in China and supported by the local governments, HWG-Ltd. quickly gained the first-mover advantage and established itself as the premier bulletproof glass supplier for the Automotive Security Glass and the Bank Security Glass Markets. China Specialty Glass-Group’s products are presently sold in about two-thirds of all provinces and regions in China. The Group believes that its products are well-received by its past and present customers, and its “Hing Wah” brand is well-recognized by its customers and peers. · Largest bulletproof glass manufacturer in China benefitting from economies of scale, extensive distribution channels and strong customer loyalty: The China Specialty Glass-Group was the largest bulletproof glass manufacturer in China in 2009 in terms of production capacity, production output and revenues (source: p. 103 – 105, RMR Report, 2010). Its closest competitor with regard to the bulletproof glass is only a fraction of its size. The Company believes that with the establishment of the Group’s production facility in Chengdu, Sichuan Province, as well as the upgrading and expansion of the production capacity in the Group’s current production site in Guangzhou, the Group can secure its leading position in the security glass industry over the next years. The Company believes that the Group’s size as the largest producer in this industry offers a significant advantage over its competitors and enables the Group to benefit from economies of scale by sourcing raw materials more cost-efficiently through large quantity purchases. With the envisaged enlargement of the production capacity, the Company further believes that the Group can react more quickly to market demand surges and produce substantial volumes at short notice. This future capability is expected to offer the Group a further competitive advantage in bids for large-scale projects in the security glass markets, especially the Construction Glass Market. The Company believes that with sales representatives located in different provinces and regions outside of Guangzhou covering 19 provinces and regions in China and with sales forces frequently present at the sites of the Group’s clients, it has a reliable sales and distribution network in the security glass industry in China. Following further expansion of this distribution network coupled with the planned production site closer to the Group’s present and future customers, the Company furthermore 224 believes that it is well-positioned to identify and meet its clients’ present and future needs. The planned expansion into selected Asian countries is expected to intensify the Group’s reach to international customers as well. The Company is of the opinion that its high-quality brand products, pre-sales customer service and enlarged production capacity are convincing arguments to secure the loyalty of the Group’s customers. Numerous repeat purchases seem to underpin this assessment. · Cost-efficient production, effective cost control and profitable operation: The Company believes that the Group has competitive advantages with regard to the production process especially in production cost control. As a constantly reliable and credit-worthy client, the Group was able to secure favourable and mutually beneficial delivery terms from its raw material suppliers. The Company believes that the planned increase in the Group’s production volume and the resulting increase in demand for raw materials should result in better supply terms for the Group. The Group has consistently implemented a professional equipment maintenance regime, thus reducing production stoppage and the amount of defective products. Furthermore, the Group has focused on production and sales of lucrative bulletproof glass and related products over the years. The Company believes that these and other measures (see below) have contributed and will continue to contribute to the Group’s profitable operation. · Focus on a regulated product segment benefitting from government policies and restrictive regulations: The Group is focused on the Chinese security glass market, which is highly regulated, especially the Bank Security Glass Market. The Chinese central government institutions at and sets out above security country standards level, for including all a financial compulsory requirement for installing bulletproof glass above counters where cash transactions, security transactions and settlements are carried out. The central government and the local governments stipulated that only certified bulletproof glass producers are allowed to tender for and supply such products. As a significant bulletproof glass producer in China, the Company believes that the Group is well-positioned to benefit from these policies and regulations. The Group’s first bulletproof automotive glass was developed under the auspices and at the request of the Ministry of Public Security of China in 1996 and was first sold in 1997. Since then its 225 bulletproof products have been regularly certified by the relevant government agencies whose certification is essential for being included in any purchase tender process. The Group’s bulletproof glass is used by most of the banks in China. The Company believes these policies and regulations provide the Group with a competitive advantage and will support its planned growth in this industry. · Strong product innovation capability: In the view of the Company, the Group has a dedicated R&D team and a fruitful academic research collaboration network in the security glass industry in China. The Group’s R&D team has already developed several innovative products and introduced them to the Chinese market. In 2008 HWG-Ltd. introduced a bomb blast-resistant glass product, and in 2009 it launched an electrically-controlled colour-changing glass product for the Construction Glass Market. In 2010 HWG-Ltd. introduced an intruder-resistant glass product for the security glass market. The Company believes that continuous improvements in products already introduced to the market could also contribute to defending and consolidating the Group’s market position. The Company further believes that consolidating its R&D activities into the new R&D centre at the Group’s production site in Guangzhou (to be established after this initial public offering) and increasing R&D expenditures will accelerate the development of new products and production technologies. The Company firmly believes that a dedicated R&D capability is essential to securing the Group’s growth and profitability in the long run. In 2009 HWG-Ltd. was also qualified as a “National High-tech Enterprise” under PRC tax law. According to this HWG-Ltd. is qualified for a reduction in income tax from 25% to 15% from January 2010 on, which has lifted the Group’s post tax profitability levels. · Experienced management team with industrial expertise and extensive business network in China: The Group’s management team and especially the Controlling Shareholder and CEO of the Company, Mr. Nang Heung Sze, have extensive experience in the security glass industry and maintain a reliable business network in this industry and in the product application markets. Mr. Nang Heung Sze has over 25 years of operational experience in the specialty glass market. He is the Chairman of Guangdong Province Mingnan Chamber of Commerce, the Vice-chairman 226 of Guangdong Province Returned Overseas Association and Founding Chairman of Shishi Shilang Research Society. He was named “Outstanding Entrepreneur of Chinese Harmonious Society” in 2008 and was awarded the “Prize for Scientific and Technological Contribution” by Guangdong Province Returnee Association in 2007, as well as an honorary doctorate by the Hong Kong Academy of Science in 1999. Mr. Nang Heung Sze’s son, the Company’s Chief Operating Officer (COO), Mr. Chun Li Shi, is a member of the Consultive Committee of the Liwan District of Guangzhou. The Company’s Chief Financial Officer, Mr. Chi-Hsiang Michael Lee, has over 19 years of professional financing and accounting experience, having worked for international firms such as Summit International Capital Advisory, American Express Business & Tax Services, KPMG LLP and PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP in China and the United States of America. Inter alia, he was managing partner of Summit International Capital Advisory, manager at KPMG LLP (Los Angeles) and director at PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (China). The key management team members of the Group’s operative subsidiary HWG-Ltd. Mr. Chao Zhou, Mr. Chun Li Shi and Mrs. Xue Yan Wang have been with HWG-Ltd. between three and thirteen years. They all have extensive experience and expertise regarding specialty glass, especially bulletproof glass. 17.4 Strategy The Company believes that the following strategic objectives and their implementation will drive its future growth: · Profit from the growth of the Chinese security glass market by expanding the China domestic sales network and strengthening the Hing Wah brand and in mid-range scope from market diversification through international expansion As a relatively young industry, the Chinese security glass industry has grown at an average annual rate of 24.5% from 2004 until 2009 (source: p. 72, RMR Report, 2010). Based on market demands and capacity forecasts, the Group expects this growth to continue in the foreseeable future (source: p. 111, RMR Report, 2010). As the dominant player in this niche market, the Company intends to further expand the Group’s 227 domestic sales network in order to benefit from this growth. Currently, the Group covers 19 provinces and regions in China with its sales representatives. The Company intends to expand the presence of the Group’s sales teams in China by covering the provinces or regions that are currently not actively served by the Group and by covering those that are already served by the Company more densely. This expansion of its sales network is expected to put the Group closer to its existing and prospective customers, thus meeting their requirements even better and increasing the attractiveness of the Group’s product offers. The Company believes this expansion will significantly increase the awareness of the Hing Wah brand and the Group’s product sales. The Company intends to introduce the Group’s competitive products into the international security glass market in order to gradually reduce the Group’s dependency on the Chinese market. The initial phase will focus on the export of selected security glass products of the Group through domestic trading companies specialized in product export and on certain Asian countries. This shall be followed by sales through existing local sales networks. · Expand production capacity and participate in consolidation of the Chinese security glass industry and growth in western and central regions in China: Transportation costs in the security glass market and the Construction Glass Market are significant, especially for long-distance delivery. So far, the Group has focused on more developed provinces and regions close to the Group’s current production site in Guangzhou, Guangdong Province. Sales in Guangdong Province alone contributed approximately 45% to HWG-Ltd.’s total revenue in 2010. The Company thinks that the future demand for the Group’s products in these more developed regions and provinces is far from saturated, and therefore intends to consolidate its position there. The Company intends to increase the Group’s production capacity and efficiency in its current production site in Guangzhou by upgrading the production equipment and automating its production process while reducing the dependency on increasingly costly personnel and availability of skilful workers. The Company also intends to use the Group’s Guangzhou facility to expand its market presence in selected Asian countries. It aims to attract international customers through high-quality products, larger scale of production and competitive pricing. 228 The Company believes that the future sales growth will increasingly be generated in regions and provinces in China where the Group currently has a competitive disadvantage due to the long distance that separates HWG-Ltd.’s present production site from its potential new customers. Any major player in this market needs to establish production sites closer to potential end customers in order to benefit from market growth. The Company plans to take a major step in this direction by establishing a new production site in the city of Chengdu, Sichuan Province. The new facility is currently under construction and is expected to commence production in the second half of 2011 and reach maximum production capacities in about two years’ time, pending receipt of the necessary and additional approvals from the relevant authorities. It is expected to add maximum production capacities of around 800,000 square meters for security glass products or around 2.8 million square meters for construction glass products per annum. The products produced there are expected to mainly serve the Group’s current and future customers in the western and central regions and provinces in China. The Company has deliberately selected Chengdu as its new production site in order to benefit from significant savings in production costs (direct labour, electricity and water), from the support of the local government policies and most importantly, from the significant future growth in the regions around Sichuan Province, in particular in the Construction Glass Market. In 2009, the construction area in Sichuan was 262 million square meters, a 9.9% growth compared to 2008 (Bureau of Statistics, Sichuan Provincial Government: http://www.sc.stats.gov.cn/Select.asp?Tag=F9005zxtjxx/201003/t20100 319 _110379.html). As a comparison, in the same period Guangdong Province, which is far more developed, had only 242 million square meters in construction area and a 7.5% annual growth (Bureau of Statistics, Guangdong Provincial Government. http://www.gdstats.gov.cn/tjfx/t20100303_77820.htm). In 2010, the construction area in Sichuan increased to 291 million square meters, a 10.9% growth compared to 2009 (http://www.sc.stats.gov.cn/Select.asp?Tag=F9005zxtjxx/201101/t2011 0130_135095.html). To the Company’s knowledge, there are several large float glass suppliers (to provide the Group with raw material) within short driving distance from the Company’s new production site, but there are only a few small specialty glass manufacturers in the region. The large specialty glass manufacturers for construction glass focus on either 229 high-end or high-volume bulk glass products (which, in the Company’s opinion, make up only 3% and 12% of the total product sales, respectively). Hence there is a large demand for the majority of medium-end and diversified glass products where the Company believes to have competitive advantages. Additionally, the Company intends to expand the Group’s production capacities and improve access to experienced personnel and local markets in other parts of China through acquisition of smaller competitors. · Focus on higher-margin products and product innovation in the security glass market as well as in the lower-margin Construction Glass Market: The Company intends to expand the presence of the Group in the security glass niche market which is characterized by the absence of a large number of competitors and a high unit-selling price for products. As the pioneer of the first “Made-in-China” bulletproof glass for the automotive security glass and the bank security glass industry, the Group prides itself on being an industry innovator in China. In 2008, the Group brought the first bomb blast-resistant glass to the Chinese market. The Company intends to continue this tradition of innovation and introduce new and competitive products to the market in years to come. The Group is continuing to improve its products that are already on the market by adding new features or enhancing product performance. The Group’s bulletproof glass has changed in thickness over the years and other features have been added such as resistance to bomb blast without sacrificing the main character of the glass, namely, bullet resistance. The Company believes that product innovation and continuous product improvements are essential to secure customer loyalty and the Group’s market position. In contrast to the security glass market which is characterized by a low product volume but a high profit margin, the Construction Glass Market demands a high product volume and variety at a lower profit margin. To optimize the Utilization Rate of its production facilities and gain benefits from large-scale raw material purchases, the Company plans that the Group continues to serve this comparatively low-margin product segment without losing its main focus on the security glass market in the near future. 230 · Strengthen R&D capacity and capability: The Company considers the innovation of the Group’s R&D capability and capacity to be essential for its future growth and its ability to continue to dominate in the high-margin Bank Security Glass and Automotive Security Glass Markets. Therefore, it intends to expand the Group’s R&D activities and increase the annual expenditures for R&D, which were EUR 1.9 million in 2010. The Company intends to establish a separate R&D centre at the Group’s production site in Guangzhou and to increase the number of the Group’s R&D staff. The Group’s R&D activities are expected to focus on introducing new products such as multi-resistant security windows and interlocking secure doors, a specially designed door system that offers additional security features over normal doors to the market. The R&D team intends to bring forth innovations that improve production efficiency and cut production costs. To complement its own R&D efforts, the Group continues to co-operate with established universities and professional colleges in China, i.e. Sun Yat-Sen University and Guangdong University of Technology. These collaborations are expected to provide the Group with access to academic and industrial expertise in China. 17.5 Products The Group was the pioneer in developing and producing security glass in China. The Company believes that high quality, the required certification by the competent government authorities and a broad range characterize its products. The Group sells its main product, bulletproof security glass, in the Bank and Automotive Security Glass Markets where the Group has a dominant market position in comparison to its closest competitor (in 2009, China Specialty Glass-Group had a 48.2% market share, while its closest competitor had a 5.5% market share, according to RMR Report, 2010, p. 104) and can often command a premium on the selling price. The Group’s products sold under its “Hing Wah” brand are categorized into: 1) security glass comprising bank and automotive security glass. Products in this category consist mainly of bulletproof glass and variations thereof; and 2) construction glass which includes architecture laminated glass, architecture tempered glass, fire-resistant glass, hollow glass and electrically-controlled colour-changing glass etc. At HWG-Ltd.’s production site, normal flat glass is treated (e.g. physically, to produce tempered glass) or directly combined in two or more layers with 231 chemical resin in between (laminated glass). An introduction to specialty glass When glass is a subject of discussion in everyday life, the term “glass” is mostly used for normal flat glass or float glass, which is a sheet of glass made by floating molten glass on a bed of molten metal. This method gives the sheet a uniform thickness and very flat surfaces. Windows are typically made out of flat glass. Float glass presently constitutes 90% of the normal flat glass used in the world. China has been the largest flat glass producer in the world for the last twenty years (source: China Building Material Daily, 17 May 2010). Transparent, but still creating a physical barrier, normal glass is hard but brittle and cannot be used in many demanding applications without being processed beforehand. These processed glass products are known as specialty glass. A single sheet of glass can be treated with heat or chemicals to become tempered glass. Such glass shatters when broken into small fragments instead of sharp shards (as normal glass would), making it less likely to cause personal injury. Depending on how it is treated, tempered glass may have other desirable features. For instance, it may collapse at much higher temperature than normal glass (fire-resistant glass). Tempered glass has a higher strength than normal glass but is more fragile: it may break upon a slight impact or scratch. Several sheets of glass combined can offer other desirable application features which a single sheet of glass, normal or processed, can not. For instance, two sheets of glass separated by a sealed metal frame (to create a space in between), make up the so-called hollow glass which offers good insulation against heat transmission and noise and is widely used in modern or high-end buildings. When two or more sheets of normal or processed glass are chemically “glued” together (laminated), the resulting glass can have the following properties: it can prevent bullets from penetrating it (bulletproof glass), it can withstand the blast of a bomb (bomb blast-resistant glass) or it can withstand the blow of sharp or heavy objects (intruder-resistant glass). Simple laminated glass is also used for windows and doors because of its safety feature: upon impact, laminated glass will crack but not break. Specialty glass used in the security glass application mostly consists of specially laminated types of glass such as bulletproof or bomb blast-resistant 232 glass. It is flat, large and heavy and thus designed mainly for use at fixed locations as protective glass walls in the building, or dividing walls or windows in bank branches (bank security glass), jewellery stores and other protective locations. It can also be made lighter in weight and curved in desired shapes to be used in armoured limousines or military vehicles. This latter application is sold in the so-called “Automotive Security Glass Market”. In terms of volume of glass used, markets where security glass is used are very small, thus they are niche markets. Most of the glass, normal or specialty, is used in the construction industry (or market). 17.5.1 Bank and Automotive Security Glass Products Bulletproof Glass Bulletproof or bullet-resistant glass is usually constructed using polycarbonate thermoplastic or layers of normal glass. China Specialty Glass-Group’s bulletproof glass has the appearance and clarity of standard glass but offers effective protection from small arms fire. The Group applies organic interlayer chemical material such as PVB and PC plate to high-quality glass. The Group offers a broad range of bulletproof glass products to meet the specifications of its customers. The Group’s bulletproof glass filters ultraviolet light and reduces the transmission of sound and heat. The Group’s flat bulletproof glass, being thicker and thus heavier, is primarily used in fixed installation such as banks, postal offices, insurance companies, jewellery stores, luxury villas and business buildings. The Group’s lighter bulletproof glass, which is shaped and curved using proprietary processing technology in accordance with clients’ specifications, is mostly used in cash-in-transit vehicles, armoured limousines, police vehicles and military personnel carriers. The Group’s flat bulletproof glass size ranges from 10x10cm to 220x490cm and offers protection against shots from rifles and pistols. These products are produced according to the GB17840-1999 Chinese National Standard and the Chinese GA165-1997 Industrial Standard. For the fiscal years 2008, 2009 and 2010, the Group generated EUR 17.5 million, EUR 23.0 million and EUR 32.1 million respectively in revenue through bank bulletproof glass sales, which contributed 43.5%, 45.2% and 46.1% to the total sales in 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively. Bulletproof automotive glass is produced according to clients’ specifications. 233 In 2008, 2009 and 2010, the Group generated EUR 15.4 million, EUR 22.4 million and EUR 30.0 million in revenue through auto security glass sales, which contributed 38.3%, 44.0% and 43.1% to the total sales in 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively. With minor modifications, bulletproof glass can be endowed with additional performance properties such as resistance to bomb blast. Such security glass products are covered by the Group’s bulletproof glass product category. Intruder-resistant Glass Intruder-resistant glass is similar to bulletproof glass in structure and in the production process except that glass used for the former undergoes a chemical tempering process before the lamination step. Intruder-resistant glass is capable of withstanding the forceful impact of heavy objects such as an axe or hammer. Although the glass surface suffers visible damage upon repeated impact, the integrity of the glass as a whole remains intact. The Group started producing and selling a small amount of intruder-resistant glass products in 2010, which contributed insignificantly to the Group’s total revenue. These products were used as curtain walls for banks and as glass counters for banks and jewellery stores. The Group believes that further architectural applications of the Group’s intruder-resistant glass include windows, glass doors and curtain walls for toll booths, gas stations, luxury villas, museums, shopping malls and commercial buildings. In 2010 the Group successfully developed intruder-resistant glass products for automotive application. These products have the thickness of normal auto glass and weigh less than bulletproof glass. They are the only intruder-resistant glass products in China that passed the most stringent laboratory and field tests conducted by the National Public Security Authority and Police Electronic Equipment Testing Center in 2010. The automotive application of the Group’s intruder-resistant glass includes police vehicles, cash-in-transit cars and private limousines. The Group's intruder-resistant glass is produced in accordance with the Chinese National Standard GA 844 – 2009, issued by the China Public Security Authority. 234 17.5.2 Products for the Construction Glass Market Architecture tempered and semi-tempered glass Tempered glass is a glass that has been processed by means of controlled thermal treatment to increase its strength in comparison to normal glass. This treatment process creates balanced internal stresses which provide the glass with increased strength and thermal stability. When it breaks, tempered glass usually shatters into small fragments instead of sharp pieces, making it less likely to cause severe personal injury. As a result of its safety, thermal stability and strength, China Specialty Glass-Group’s tempered glass is used in various demanding applications such as glass doors, glass facades, partition walls, glass furniture and glass partition walls to protect people from heat and cold. Semi-tempered glass is also called reinforced glass. It has a different surface stress from tempered glass. Its strength level is 1.6 to 2 times higher than that of normal glass, whereas it is 4 to 5 times higher for tempered glass, in accordance with the Chinese National Standard GB/T9963-1998. Semi-tempered glass has good thermal stability. It also has a better smoothness and lighter transmittance than tempered glass and is more similar to normal glass in this respect. The Group’s tempered glass is created by putting normal glass through a furnace that heats it above its annealing point of about 720°C. The glass is then rapidly cooled with an air stream, while the inner portion remains free to flow for a short time period. Since any cutting, grinding, sharp impacts or even scratches after this process will cause the tempered glass to shatter, any cutting or grinding of the glass must be completed before the tempering. The size of the Group’s tempered glass ranges from 30x30cm to 244x800cm and has a thickness ranging from 4mm to 25mm for tempered and 4mm to 10mm for semi-tempered glass. These products are produced according to the GB/T9963-1998 Chinese National “Tempered Glass” Standard and the GB17841-1999 Chinese National “Tempered and Semi-tempered Curtain Wall Glass” Standard. For the fiscal years 2008, 2009 and 2010, HWG-Ltd. generated EUR 4.2 million (RMB 42.5 million), EUR 3.6 million (RMB 34.2 million) and EUR 4.0 million (RMB 36.0 million), respectively, in revenue through tempered glass sales, which contributed 10.4%, 7.1% and 5.8% to the total sales in 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively. 235 Architecture laminated glass When two or more layers of normal or tempered glass with a polyvinyl butyral (PVB) resin film as interlayer in the middle are pressed together at high temperature and under high pressure, the result is laminated glass. While the chemical resin’s glue-like property keeps the layers of glass bonded even when broken by force, its high strength prevents the glass from breaking into large sharp pieces. This typically produces a "spider web" cracking pattern when the force applied is not enough to completely pierce the glass. As such, laminated glass is used in areas where safety is of a major concern. When the glass is physically or chemically treated or when chemical additives are applied in the interlayer, the resulting laminated glass possesses other desirable properties such as fire resistance, better heat or sound insulation or the capacity to act as ultraviolet light filter. Laminated glass products of the Group are sold in the construction industry as windows or doors, sunshades, ceilings, curtain or glass walls, glass furniture, shop windows and aquaria, where safety is a primary concern. Bulletproof glass, a special type of laminated glass which has been strengthened against violent impact, is used primarily for security purposes in markets such as the banking market and the market for special automobiles (see section 17.5.1 “Bank and Automotive Security Glass Products”). The size of the Group’s laminated architecture glass ranges from 30x30cm to 220x330cm with thickness ranging between 6.38mm to 40mm. These products are produced according to the GB9962-1999 Chinese National Standard. In 2008, 2009 and 2010, HWG-Ltd. generated EUR 2.1 million (RMB 21.6 million), EUR 1.4 million (RMB 13.2 million) and EUR 1.8 million (RMB 16.4 million) in revenue from the sale of laminated glass, which contributed 5.2%, 2.7% and 2.6% to the total sales in 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively. Fire-resistant glass China Specialty Glass-Group produces fire-resistant glass by means of both chemical and thermal tempering processes. Thermally-tempered glass is immersed in a bath of molten potassium, which is a chemical element with the symbol K (elemental potassium is a soft silvery-white metallic alkali metal that oxidizes rapidly in air and is very reactive with water), caesium 236 (caesium is a chemical element with the symbol Cs; it is a soft, silvery-gold alkali metal with physical and chemical properties similar to those of rubidium and potassium) salts, and sodium (sodium is a metallic element with the symbol Na; it is a soft, silvery-white, highly reactive metal and is a member of the alkali metals) ions in the thin glass surface and is exchanged with potassium and caesium ions creating a surface compression. The Group’s single layer fire-resistant glass offers fire protection that is 6 to 12 times higher than that of ordinary glass and 1.5 to 3 times higher than that of normal tempered glass with the same thickness according to the Chinese National Standard GB15763.1-2001. After 60 to 180 minutes of exposure to a flame at 1,000°C, fire-resistant glass remains intact (source: verification report dated 7 May 2009, National Centre for Quality Supervision and Testing of Fire Building Materials in accordance with the China National Standard GB15763.1-2001). The Group’s fire-resistant glass retains the light transmission characteristics of normal glass and is insensitive to ultraviolet radiation. This type of glass of the Group can be processed into other products such as laminated glass or hollow glass. The Group’s fire-resistant glass can be installed in luxury buildings, hotels, shopping malls, libraries and museums in fireproof walls, doors, windows and alleyways. The Group produces fire-resistant glass with sizes ranging from 30x30cm to 244x500cm. It is produced according to the GB15763.1-2001 Chinese National Standard. The Group’s fire-resistant glass is classified under the product category architecture tempered glass and contributed insignificantly to the Group’s total sales in 2008, 2009 and 2010. Compound fire-resistant glass The Group’s compound fire-resistant glass is composed of two or more layers of thermally-tempered glass with fire-resistant resin filling the space between glass layers. Exposed to fire, the fire-resistant resin gradually becomes froth; it expands and becomes even carbonized. This change effectively reduces the heat transfer across the glass, thus forming a protective layer against the fire and the resulting heat. In addition to its fire-resistance property and light transparency identical to normal glass, the Group’s compound fire-resistant glass also offers noise reduction similar to laminated glass. The Group’s compound fire-resistant glass can be installed in luxury buildings, hotels, shopping malls, libraries and museums in fireproof walls, doors, windows and alleyways as well as in machine rooms, laboratories and 237 control rooms. The Group produces compound fire-resistant glass with sizes ranging from 10x10cm to 240x330cm. It is produced according to the GB15763.1-2001 Chinese National Standard. In 2008, 2009 and 2010, HWG-Ltd. generated EUR 0.9 million (RMB 9.4 million), EUR 0.4 milion (RMB 5.0 million) and EUR 0.7 million (RMB 6.0 million) in revenue through compound fire-resistant glass sales, which contributed 2.2%, 0.8% and 1.0% to the total sales in 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively. Hollow glass China Specialty Glass-Group’s hollow glass is usually composed of two layers of thermally-tempered glass separated by an aluminium alloy isolation frame to create a hollow space in the middle which is filled with a drying agent (molecular sieve) and inert gas. It is sealed by a chemical sealant. Hollow glass provides insulation against noise and frost. Hollow glass is widely used in buildings at locations where high mechanical strength and safety are required, e.g. for glass doors, architectural curtain walls, façades, glass furniture and partition walls which are subject to extreme temperature or weather changes. The Group produces hollow glass with sizes ranging from 20x20cm to 220x350cm. The thickness of the aluminium frame ranges from 6mm to 18mm, and the maximum thickness of the hollow glass is typically below 60mm. It is produced according to the GBT1944-2002 Chinese National Standard. Electrically-controlled colour-changing glass China Specialty Glass Group’s electrically-controlled colour-changing glass is made by sandwiching a liquid crystal film (this refers to a chemical substance in a state of matter that has properties between those of a conventional liquid and those of a solid crystal; such chemical substances are widely used in electronic displays) between two sheets of glass. In resting state or under electric current passing through the liquid crystal, electrically-controlled colour-changing glass can be switched from a transparent to an opaque appearance. Used as part of a window, this enables a quick switch from clear vision to complete privacy. Electrically-controlled colour-changing glass is used for the windows of high-end vehicles, high-speed bullet 238 trains, hotels, airliners, yachts, laboratories, operating rooms, bedrooms, living rooms, meeting rooms, security and sensitive areas, banks, jewellery stores, display boxes etc. The Group’s products are currently used in selected government buildings. The Group produces electrically-controlled colour-changing glass with a size ranging from 20x20cm to 100x300cm. Thickness ranges from 6mm to 18mm. It is produced according to the Group’s QB/XHDZ-2003 Standard. The Group generated EUR 0.1 million and EUR 0.6 million in revenue through electrically-controlled color-changing glass sales in 2009 and 2010, respectively. Production of this product started in July 2009. 17.5.3 New products in development The Group continues to develop innovative products to meet the market demands. As far as automotive products are concerned, the Group will further improve its original slim intruder-resistant glass products in order to minimize its production cost to an affordable level, reduce the thickness of products and explore low-end applications such as anti-theft purpose. Moreover, the Group continues to develop an innovative product, “warm glass”, which is applied to the windshield of motor vehicles. Warm glass can generate a certain amount of heat by itself without any filament in order to protect the glass surface against any fog or frost and thus improves the safety of car driving. At the same time the Group will explore the suitability, economy and safety of current intruder-resistant glass products in the range of construction and counter intruder-resistant glass products. As a result, the abovementioned products can be applied further to the financial services industry, gold and jewellery industry, supermarkets as well as public usage. For the aspect of decorating glass products the Group plans to innovate illuminating glass and electrical control multi-colour-changing glass. Illuminating glass is installed with a light source so that it can have sight-seeing and multi-colour-changing illumination glass is functions. developed Electrically-controlled upon the current electrically-controlled single-colour-changing glass and has the effect of various colour changes. The Group is actively developing new building glass products integrating solar photovoltaic technology. 239 17.6 Customers China Specialty Glass-Group sells its security glass products through its own sales network directly to its end customers in the bank and security automotive industry. Its major customers for bank security glass are domestic and foreign banks in China and for automotive security glass refitting automobile manufacturers. In the Construction Glass Market, construction service providers are the customers of the Group. The five top customers from the years 2008 to 2010 are listed below (number in brackets refers to the customer’s previous year’s ranking): 2008 TEUR N o. Customer Market Segment Sales % of Total Sales 1 2 3 4 5 Customer A (1) Customer B (2) Customer D (4) Customer H (8) Customer E (5) Top five customers Automotive Automotive Automotive Automotive Automotive 1,940 1,919 1,325 1,199 1,187 7,570 4.8% 4.8% 3.3% 3.0% 3.0% 18.8% 40,216 100% Total sales 2009 TEUR N o. Customer Market Segment Sales % of Total Sales 1 2 3 4 5 Customer A (1) Customer D (3) Customer L (7) Customer B (2) Customer H (4) Top five customers Automotive Automotive Automotive Automotive Automotive 2,544 1,756 1,701 1,693 1,711 9,405 5.0% 3.4% 3.3% 3.3% 3.4% 18.5% 50,910 100% Total sales 2010 No. 1 2 3 4 5 Customer Customer A (1) Customer B (4) Customer D (2) Customer L (3) Customer H (5) Top five customers Market Segment Automotive Automotive Automotive Automotive Automotive Total sales 240 TEUR Sales % of Total Sales 3,520 2,599 2,580 2,406 2,216 13,320 5.1% 3.7% 3.7% 3.5% 3.2% 19.2% 69,564 100% 17.6.1 Bank Security Glass Security measures in domestic and foreign banks in China are highly regulated. According to Article 5.3.7 of the Regulation of Levels of Risk and Protection of Bank Operational Premises issued by the Ministry of Public Security of China on 22 September 2004 (effective on 1 December 2004), bank branches must meet certain security standards with respect to their business places. This explicitly includes the installation of bulletproof glass in accordance with the Chinese National Standard GA165 in the service area of the branch where cash transactions take place (see section 16 “Regulatory Framework”). The Company believes that the Group is the preferred provider of this type of security glass to banks throughout China, especially in the well-developed coastal regions and provinces. The Group’s customers in this market segment include the branches of China’s state-owned banks, inter alia, Bank of China, China Construction Bank, Industrial and Commercial Bank of China, Agricultural Bank of China and Bank of Communication, as well as the branches of other large Chinese local banks, such as China Merchants Bank, Guangdong Development Bank, Shenzhen Development Bank, Postal Saving Bank of China and Shanghai Pudong Development Bank, and of HSBC Holdings. Furthermore, the Group’s bank security glass is also acquired by other banks, such as Hang Seng Bank, Citibank and Bank of East Asia, through distributors or decorations companies. Each bank has its own purchasing policy which differs from that of other banks. Some banks or branches place their orders for the Group’s bulletproof glass centrally through their provincial or regional headquarters and then distribute the products to their local branches. Others place their orders directly through their local branches. Although the total value of the product sales to the bank industry is large, the volume of each order is relatively small in comparison to that of the security automotive market. In addition to selling its security glass to newly opened bank branches, the Group also sells its security glass to branches that have already installed bulletproof glass and tend to replace it sooner than product guarantees warrant, thus providing a reliable source of future repeated sales for China Specialty Glass-Group in this market. HWG-Ltd. normally provides a credit line of between 30 and 60 days to its customers in this market. It grants longer credit lines to its long-term customers while requiring pre-payment of a deposit and payment of the 241 balance upon delivery from new customers. 17.6.2 Automotive Security Glass Automotive security glass such as bulletproof glass is mainly used in armoured vehicles. In contrast to the mass production of normal passenger or other types of vehicles, armoured vehicles are mostly refitted on a normal chassis and produced in limited numbers. However, they have a comparatively shorter life cycle, and therefore, more armoured vehicles are needed in the same time frame than normal vehicles. This is mainly due to the heavy armour that adds extra weight and the over-loading during normal operation, which accelerates the wear and tear of a vehicle. The Company estimates there are about 28 refitting automobile manufacturers in China, of which 20 are China Specialty Glass-Group’s customers. Most of the Group’s past and current customers among refitting automobile manufacturers continue to purchase automotive security glass from the Group. The Group’s clients in this market segment include Chongqing Dima Industry Co., Ltd, Double Star (Shanghai) Co. Inc., Jiangxi Jiangling Motor Vehicle Group Ltd. and Beijing Johnson Security Ltd. The credit line to the Group’s specialist transport clients is normally 30 to 60 days. 17.6.3 Construction Glass Demand for China Specialty Glass-Group’s products in this market segment is project-related and originates mainly from the general contractors, installers and occasionally is the result of the recommendation of local design institutes. Demand in this market tends to be large and placement orders also tend to be quite sizeable, thus only enterprises with sufficient capacity can compete successfully. Additionally, construction glass demands are quite diverse. Demands on capacity and product diversity pose a challenge to the Group in terms of balancing product mix (low margin vs. selected high margin products) and overall capacity distribution, but also offer a good opportunity for product innovation and future growth. The Group does not sell its products directly to real estate developers; instead, its products are provided to general contractors or sub-contractors who are specialized in certain aspects of the construction process and recruited by the real estate developers on a project-by-project basis. These general contractors, sub-contractors or construction service providers specialized in glass are the Group’s direct customers. They include Shenzhen 242 Guochang Metal Manufactory and Guangzhou Changhong Glass Manufactory. The credit line for the Group’s clients among construction service providers is normally between 30 to 60 days. 17.7 Sales and Distribution In China, the Group’s end customers mainly are commercial entities, while retail sales (to private persons) only contribute insignificantly to the Group’s total revenue. The Group does not actively export its products to overseas markets but sells to unaffiliated traders or trading companies which export them to overseas markets. However, the Company believes its products, mainly automotive security glass, are used as components of its end customers’ finished products which are exported abroad. Sales and service implementation The Group sells its products directly through its own sales representatives. Indirect sales through unaffiliated traders or trading companies contributed merely 2.7%, 2.5% and 3.0% to the total sales for 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively. The Group has sales representatives located in different provinces and regions outside Guangzhou covering 19 provinces and regions in China. Each sales representative outside of Guangzhou has to organise himself. Most of them work from home. For the year 2010, the average number of sales representatives employed by China Specialty Glass-Group in its marketing and sales department was 64 (see also section 17.12 “Employees”). China Specialty Glass-Group’s sales representatives who cover 19 different provinces and regions outside Guangzhou are responsible for all product categories within their defined regions or territories. The Group’s sales representatives and regional sales employees maintain direct contacts with the Group’s regional customers who may need pre- and after-sale advisory services. In addition to providing technical consultation to the Group’s customers, these representatives also offer guidance in product installation and actively market the Group’s products to existing and potential customers. Loyalty, motivation and competence of its sales representatives are essential for the increase of the Group’s product sales. In addition to their normal salary, the sales representatives participate in product sales by a bonus scheme. Regular technical and product training and sales briefings are 243 conducted. Sales representatives have the freedom to negotiate the sales prices for the Group’s products within pre-defined price ranges and product specifications. The Group holds sales meetings twice a year with attendance of all its sales representatives to review past performances, identify market trends and revise sales strategies if necessary. The Group’s products are available throughout China. The bulk of the sales occur in coastal provinces and major cities such as Beijing and Shanghai. Over 60% of the total sales of the Group in 2010 are made in the southern part of China and in major cities such as Beijing, Shanghai and Chongqing: Shipment and logistics Finished products are brought to the Group’s end customers by a preferred logistics company and to a lesser extent by other local logistics companies. There are several such companies located within a short distance from the Group’s production site in Guangzhou. Raw materials are usually delivered by the suppliers. 244 All liabilities as a result of product damage or loss during transportation are borne by the logistics partners of the Group. Since 21 December 2008 the Group engages one preferred logistics company to transport all of its products. The Group engages other logistics companies in case the preferred logistics company is not able to fulfil its contractual obligations. Products that have passed quality control can be packaged and released to the care of logistics providers. The Group calculates a rate of about 3% (of the total product volume) to be damaged or unqualified (according to specifications agreed between the Company and the client) products. The Company believes that this rate is within the reasonable and acceptable range in the industry. 17.8 Marketing China Specialty Glass-Group’s security glass is a special product in a niche market. It has been sold primarily to banks (their branch offices) and a limited number of refitting automobile manufacturers. The Group’s marketing activities are focused on the existing clients who have the need to replace older glass (due to renovation, repair) or order glass to satisfy new demand (i.e. for new branches, new vehicles). To acquire new customers, the Group’s sales representatives identify potential customers and make direct contact to introduce the Group’s products. As the largest security glass manufacturer in China, HWG-Ltd. is well known in this market (source: p. 103 – 105 RMR Report 2010). The Group frequently obtains new customers through favourable referrals from its existing customers. HWG-Ltd. attends trade fairs and product exhibitions to present the Group’s products. The Group is frequently invited to attend the annual “Security Technology and Product Exhibition and Trade Conference” organized by central and provincial Ministries of Public Security, “National Invention Fair” and “China Building and Decoration Fair” organized by China Trade and Patent Office, and Chinese Building Material Association. HWG-Ltd. also maintains a close relationship with local architecture design institutes whose recommendations for glass products are crucial to being included in the construction project purchase bidding processes. The marketing expenses of the Group were around RMB 300,000 per annum for the years 2008, 2009 and 2010. 245 Recognition of products Since 1994, HWG-Ltd.’s products have been purchased by customers throughout China. HWG-Ltd. has received the following acknowledgements and awards: · "Gold Prize for New Technical Products" awarded during the National Invention Fair in September 1997 · "Prize for Excellent Products" during the China Building & Decoration Fair in July 1998 · "Second Prize for Advance in Science and Technology" by Guangzhou city government in August 1998 · "Prize for Practical Application of Invention" by Guangzhou city government in October 1998 · "National Prize for Supplier Most Recommended by its Customers" in November 1999 · "Double Top Quality Enterprise" in November 1999, · "Top Chinese Brand of the Century" in January 2000 · "Emerging High-tech Enterprise of City Guangzhou" in December 2003 · "National Products of Reliable Quality" and "National Enterprise Providing Quality Service to Satisfied Customers" in May 2003 · "Third Prize for Advance in Science and Technology in Liwan District" in 2005 • 2010 First-tier supplier, awarded by Industrial and Commercial Bank of China · "Top 100 Brands in Guangdong Province" and "Top 20 Most Respected Brands by Customers in Guangdong Province" in 2010 17.9 Production With the normal flat glass as the starting raw material, the Group’s production process for specialty glass consists of several initial steps that are commonly used for the production of all of its products. Subsequent steps 246 differ from one another depending on what kind of end products are to be produced. Initially treated glass is thermally treated to create tempered glass or laminated and then chemically coated to generate bulletproof glass etc. These processes are shown in the following graphic with regard to bank security glass (flat bulletproof glass), automotive security glass (bulletproof curve glass) and construction glass (architecture tempered glass, architecture laminated glass, compound fire-resistant glass and fire-resistant glass): Bullet proof glass Bullet proof curved glass Architecture tempered glass Architecture tempered laminated glass Compound fire resistant glass Fire resistant glass Polycarbonate coating Lamination Heat bending Lamination Polycarbonate coating Toasting Cleaning Resin injection Edge smoothing Screen printing Thermal tempering Thermal tempering Glass combination Chemical tempering Lamination Cleaning Cleaning Cleaning Cleaning Cleaning Cleaning Edge smoothing Shaping Shaping Edge smoothing Edge smoothing Edge smoothing Edge smoothing Shaping Shaping Shaping Shaping Normal float glass Production process Shaping: Glass is cut by a glass cutting machine in order to modify the raw normal glass into the required shapes and sizes of the end products. Edge smoothing: Edges of glass are filed to create a smooth surface. Cleaning: A cleaning machine removes the glass split, fine glass powder and dust from the glass surface after the shaping process. Lamination: Two or more layers of glass sandwich a chemical binding material such as PVB between them and are pressed together at high temperature and under high pressure. Polycarbonate coating: The glass is coated with polycarbonate, a type of 247 polymer characterized by its resistance to high temperature and physical impact and certain optical properties. After coating, the glass is left to dry for 24 hours. Screen printing: The edge of the glass is coloured and shaded as specified by the clients. Thermal tempering: The glass is placed onto a roller table and passed through a furnace that heats it above its annealing temperature of about 720°C. The glass is then rapidly cooled with an air stream to create balanced internal and surface stresses in the glass. Chemical tempering: The glass is toughened by ion-exchange of thin glass surface in a molten potassium or caesium bath. The hot glass is then rapidly cooled. The strength of chemically toughened glass is comparable to that of thermally-tempered glass. Heat bending: Flat glass is bent into a curved shape by a bending mould after the glass was roasted at 580°C to 640°C. Resin injection: Within the space between glass layers a fire-resistant chemical resin is injected which then contracts and solidifies to generate a Compound Fire-resistant Glass. Glass combination: PVB or other organic resin materials are inserted in the space between (two or more) layers of clean flat glass under controlled temperature and humidity. Capacity Production output for most of the production processes is limited by the number of workers available with the exception of the lamination and (both chemical and thermal) tempering parts of the process where essential equipment such as high-pressure presses or pressured ovens is used. Size and number of glass plates that can be processed simultaneously are limited by the capacity of this equipment. Therefore, the Company believes that the capacity of “pressured ovens” from the lamination process and “toughening furnaces” from the tempering process restrict the production output (the maximum production capacity is based on a production of 24 hours per day, 26 working days per month and 12 months per annum). The Company intends to use part of the Offering Proceeds to purchase additional equipment and install new production lines in its current production facility in Guangzhou, China. Furthermore, the Company intends to use the proceeds 248 to establish a new production facility in Chengdu, Sichuan Province, China. The new production facility is expected to increase the Group’s total output substantially. Quality assurance The Group is committed to quality and its products are closely monitored and controlled throughout the entire production process. The Company believes that this quality control system enables it to reduce unnecessary production stoppage and minimize the amount of waste products, which contributes directly to the reduced costs of goods produced. The Group has established and applied a quality management system for manufacturing and sales in line with ISO 9001:2008 (ISO being a standard for quality management systems set by the International Organization for Standardization), which was certified by TÜV SÜD Management Service GmbH in 2008, valid until 2012 (prior to this, a certification under ISO 9001:2000 was supplied by TÜV SÜD Management Service GmbH in 2000). 17.10 Procurement and Supply The Group purchases raw materials, which consist mostly of normal flat glass and chemical materials, from local suppliers in Guangzhou or imports these through Chinese trading companies. Although the Group tries to avoid relying on a single supplier for the supply of its raw material, it has established reliable long-term relationships with some of its suppliers; in particular four of the top five suppliers have been among the top five since 2008 (see tables below; numbers in parenthesis refer to the supplier’s previous year’s ranking): 249 2008 TEUR No. Supplier 1 Supplier A (1) 2 Supplier F (6) 3 Supplier B (2) 4 5 Material Purchased Amount % of Total Purchase 5,652 28.5% 4,200 21.2% Normal Glass 3,606 18.2% Supplier D (4) Normal Glass 3,089 15.6% Supplier E (5) Armored membrane Normal Glass SGP film, PVB film, ink 1,712 8.6% Top five customers 18,259 92.1% Total purchase 19,826 100% 2009 TEUR No. Supplier 1 Supplier A (1) 2 Supplier F (2) 3 4 5 Material Purchased Amount % of Total Purchase 8,898 37.7% SGP film, PVB film, ink 6,225 26.3% Supplier E (5) Armored membrane 2,897 12.3% Supplier I (9) PC plate 2,876 12.2% Supplier B (3) Normal Glass 2,070 8.8% Top five customers 22,966 97.2% Total purchase 23,629 100% Normal Glass 2010 TEUR No. Supplier 1 Supplier A (1) 2 Supplier F (2) 3 Supplier I (4) 4 5 Material Purchased Amount % of Total Purchase 11,861 29.7% 7,900 19.8% PC plate 4,035 10.1% Supplier E (3) Armored membrane 3,738 9.4% Supplier B (5) Normal Glass 2,655 6.7% Top five customers 30,188 75.7% Total purchase 39,879 100% Normal Glass SGP film, PVB film, ink Normal flat glass Normal flat glass is the critical raw material for the production of the Group’s specialty glass products. China is the global leader in production of normal 250 flat glass. China produced 579 million weight boxes of normal flat glass in 2009 (source: China Building Material Association), corresponding to approximately 50% of the global production. About 84% of the normal flat glass produced in China is float glass (China Building Material Daily, 17 May 2010). For the first 11 months in 2010, China had already produced 577 million weight boxes of normal flat glass according to icandata (http://www.icandata.com/data/201103/031GM3292011.html). There is an ample supply of normal flat glass in the regions where the Group’s production facilities are located. To assure the quality of normal glass purchased and to minimize the delivery cost, the Group has selected four major normal glass suppliers in the Guangdong province. These suppliers collect raw glass materials from the normal flat glass manufacturers. These glass suppliers and their subsuppliers are qualified through the ISO9000 standard and have also proven throughout the years to be capable of delivering normal glass with the various stringent specifications required by the Group. Delivery is normally fulfilled three to five days after the order. Purchase costs for normal flat glass made up 57.7%, 48.0% and 49.4% of the total material costs and 49.7%, 40.5% and 44.4% of the cost of goods sold for the years 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively; therefore, the unit purchase price of flat glass has a direct impact on the Group’s financial performance. The average purchase price paid by HWG-Ltd. was RMB 46.4, RMB 53.0 and RMB 61.8 (EUR 4.6, EUR 5.6 and EUR 6.9, respectively) per square meter in 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively. Currently, flat glass is purchased at an average price of RMB 60.9 per square meter, which has been relatively stable since the beginning of the year. The Group has not used any hedging arrangements to minimize the price fluctuation in flat glass purchase costs and does not intend to install such measures in the near future. Chemical materials The Group acquires polyurethane (“PU”, a polymer consisting of a chain of organic units joined by urethane; polyurethanes are widely used in various industrial applications; in specialty glass, they are used as high performance adhesives and sealants), SentryGlas® Plus film (SGP, SentryGlas® is a trademark of DuPont), polyvinyl butyral (“PVB”, a resin usually used for applications that require strong binding, optical clarity, adhesion to many surfaces, toughness and flexibility), chemical resins or additives and 251 Polycarbonate (“PC”, a particular group of thermoplastic polymers with interesting features such as temperature resistance, impact resistance and optical properties) plates to transform normal glass into specialty glass products. Some of these materials (PU, SGP and PVB) are imported via import agencies or trading companies or directly through the domestic sales offices of foreign suppliers (for PC). The average (purchase) unit price for various chemical materials has evolved differently over the last three years: For example, the average PC plate unit price in 2008 was at RMB 732 (EUR 72) /square meter, then fell back to a level in 2009 of RMB 562 (EUR 59) /square meter, finally peaked at RMB 737 (EUR 82) /square meter in 2010. During the same period, the average unit price for PVB changed from RMB 40 (EUR 3.8) /square meter in 2007 to RMB 53 (EUR 5.9) /square meter in 2010. Chemical material purchase costs amounted to 35.1%, 43.2% and 49.3% of total material costs for 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively. The major vendors of chemical materials include Shenzhen Xinhuali Trading Co., Limited, Zhejiang Armor Security Technology Co., Limited, Xiamen Xinhengfa Import Export Co., Limited and Huntsman Chemical Trading (Shanghai) Co., Limited. Electricity HWG-Ltd. has a backup power supply to provide enough electricity for limited production. In Guangzhou municipality, any electrical power outage is normally announced ahead of time via the media. 17.11 Research and Development China Specialty Glass-Group considers production process improvement and product innovation as essential for its future growth and profitability. Here, the Group’s Research and Development capability plays a central role. The Group’s R&D team, which has the task of continuously re-designing and developing existing and new products, pioneered the bulletproof glass industry in China in the past and has introduced new and improved products to the Chinese market. Expenditure on research and development amounted to EUR 1 million, EUR 1.4 million and EUR 1.9 million in the financial years 2008, 2009 and 2010, respectively. The Group’s R&D team currently consists of six employees, not including 252 additional employees involved in the R&D activities of the Group. Four of them have received engineering training and five of them have university or college degrees. This team is responsible for the development of the Group’s new products, improvement of existing products, design and implementation of the Group’s current and new production technologies and processes. Product Development Process The Group’s new products and product improvements are derived from three sources: · New product and design concepts emerge from the discussions between the Group’s sales representatives and the customers or through market research. Customers’ specific requests, product concepts or specifications are translated into product prototypes with materials and production process known to the Group. · The R&D team creates new product designs based on knowledge and experience with existing materials or hereunto unused materials to explore new combinations and applications, for example, a combination of the safety feature of laminated glass with colourful design of cloth material to create safe decorating glass. · The R&D team also designs and develops new products based on requests or specifications from the governments in China. Bulletproof glass was the result of such a product design and development process. The Group’s R&D team designs and develops new products or tries to improve existing products in close coordination with the Group’s sales, procurement and finance departments with the intention that the new or improved products meet the customers’ preferences and price expectations. On the other hand, the team also develops the products with the production process suitability in mind so the new products can be produced efficiently and at lower costs if possible. Production technology and process improvement The Group’s R&D team is entrusted with the improvement of the production process, in particular with increasing its efficiency and lowering production costs. The team has designed and implemented some automated processes at HWG-Ltd.’s current production site. The new automated process line is expected to not only reduce the number of workers required for production (in light of increasing labour costs, this translates into saving direct labour 253 costs), but also to increase productivity through reduction of waste products. New products under development The Group’s R&D team is developing several new products to address market demands, for instance, the new decoration glass with safety features and bulletproof glass with a bulletproof steel frame and security glass with an acoustic feature and automotive security glass with an anti-surface condensation feature. New Research and Development Centre The Company intends to use parts of the issue proceeds to install a separate Research and Development Centre at the Group’s production site in Guangzhou. It is planned to install a small-scale production line in the centre so that a new product can be entirely developed and tested during the whole design and development process: from product conception to pilot production. This centre should be equipped with modern testing equipment and facilities so that the Group’s R&D staff can independently test and analyze the performance of new products or new production processes. It is planned that the centre shall have an independent procurement process so that new or entirely novel materials can be sourced and their innovative and proprietary applications in security and construction glass products tested. The Group also intends to develop new products jointly with its current and future clients in the centre. The Group’s current R&D team has already collaborated closely with its academic development partners from local universities and colleges such as Sun Yat-Sen University and Guangdong University of Technology. Such research and development activities are organized between the Group and its academic development partners on a no charge basis; in particular the local universities and colleges do not receive any compensation from the Group. Collaborations such as these shall be deepened and expanded to other research and academic institutions in China. The Group plans to house about 26 researchers, including consultants from universities and the industry, in this new Research and Development Centre. 17.12 Employees As of 31 March 2011, China Specialty Glass-Group employed 479 employees. Since 31 March 2011, there has not been a substantial change in the number of employees of the Group. 254 With regard to the development of the number of the employees within the Group in the past, the tables below contain a breakdown of HWG-Ltd.’s personnel according to category as an average number for the past three years ended on 31 December as well as a breakdown of the Group’s personnel as an average number for the period from 1 January until 31 March 2011. Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 Average number HWG-Ltd. of employees of Management and administration Sales Production Total 467 464 441 36 91 340 467 39 83 342 464 46 64 331 441 Time period from 1 January until 31 March 2011 Average Number of employees of the China Specialty Glass-Group 456 Management and administration Sales Production Total 52 57 347 456 All of the employees employed by the Group work in Guangzhou, PRC, with the exception of sales personnel in various other cities in the PRC. Recruitment The personnel department of the Group is mainly responsible for employee recruitment. The employees and managers in the personnel department approach local governmental or private employment agencies for potential employees. Additionally, local professional schools and colleges are also targeted for better qualified and better educated labour force members. In contrast to other years’ normal practice in recruitment, the Group decided in 2010 to recruit a large group of technical college students shortly before their graduation to 1) replace those workers who did not return to work, 2) train them to take over more challenging technical and management positions and 3) prepare them for senior level technical and managerial 255 positions in the production site which is under construction in Chengdu, Sichuan. Employee training and further education The Group provides its new employees with pre-employment training which includes basic information on the Company’s culture, operational safety and standards, product quality and personnel and career development issues. Some employees also undergo on-the-job training which includes work flow, management methodology and technical skills. Selected employees are also given special training in order to be qualified for special production or development skills; an official certificate is issued to the employee after the completion of the training. To assist career development of promising employees and raise the educational level of its workforce, the Group provides partial financial support to selected employees for external training. In return, these employees are committed contractually to serve the Group for a specified period of employment. 17.13 Insurance HWG-Ltd. has concluded a product liability insurance agreement covering products for two of its brands. However, this policy is limited to a maximum compensation of RMB 1.2 million (approximately TEUR 134 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) for a single case with a cap of RMB 300,000 (approximately TEUR 33 at 31 March 2011 average exchange rate) for a body injury per person or property damage in each single case, and a maximum of cumulative compensations of RMB 2.4 million (approximately TEUR 267 at 31 March 2011 average exchange rate). The excess costs of product liability (a guarantee for the bulletproof performance of ten years is provided to customers) are covered by HWG-Ltd. Apart from this insurance, the Group does not maintain any business insurance coverage (see section 3.1.19 “China Specialty Glass-Group may have insufficient insurance to cover its potential risks”). 17.14 Material Contracts 17.14.1 Lease Agreements China Specialty Glass-Group has in place a number of lease agreements for office premises and for a plant (see section 17.15 “Property, Plant and Equipment”). 256 17.14.2 Loan Agreements China Specialty Glass-Group has in place the following loan agreements: HWG-Ltd. entered into a RMB 7,400,000 (approximately TEUR 801 at 31 March 2011 closing exchange rate) loan agreement with the Guangzhou Tianpingjia sub-branch of the Industry and Commerce Bank of China in September 2010 for a one-year-term. The purpose of entering into this agreement is to finance HWG-Ltd’s purchase of raw materials in production. Interest is payable monthly at an interest rate of 5.841% per annum. The loan is secured by two separate joint and several guarantees respectively provided by Mr. Nang Heung Sze, Mr. Chun Li Shi and a mortgage provided by Guangzhou Property Management Center. In addition, HWG-Ltd. also entered into a RMB 8,600,000 (approximately TEUR 931 at 31 March 2011 closing exchange rate) loan agreement with the Guangzhou Tianpingjia sub-branch of the Industry and Commerce Bank of China in September 2010 for a one year term. The purpose of entering into this loan agreement is to finance HWG-Ltd’s purchase of raw materials for production. Interest is payable monthly at an interest rate of 5.841% per annum. The loan is secured by two separate joint and several guarantees respectively provided by Mr. Nang Heung Sze, Mr. Chun Li Shi and a mortgage provided by Guangzhou Property Management Center. 17.14.3 Project Investment and Construction Agreement On 30 May 2010, HWG-Ltd. entered into a project investment and construction contract with the Management Committee of Guangdong – Wenchuan Industrial Park (“Management Committee”) for a project in the Sichuan Province on a piece of land of 300 Mu (Mu is a Chinese unit of measurement, 300 Mu correspond to around 200,001 square meters) with a proposed total investment of RMB 300 million (approximately EUR 32.5 million at 31 March 2011 exchange rate). To implement this agreement, the Group set up HWG-SC with an initial capital contribution of RMB 2 million (approximately EUR 0.2 million at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) and in October 2010, contributed another RMB 8 million (approximately EUR 0.9 million at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) into HWG-SC. HWG-SC has made several investments in connection with the project investment and construction (see section 17.17 “Investments”). Under the contract, HWG-Ltd. guarantees a certain investment and tax commitment and undertakes to meet various deadlines for the different plant construction phases. Non-compliance can entitle the Management Committee to repatriate the 257 respective land use right free of any compensation. According to the contract, the land grant premium for the respective land is to be paid by the Management Committee on behalf of HWG-Ltd. HWG-Ltd. is neither allowed to transfer the land use right within 10 years after full repayment of such land grant premium to the Management Committee nor to mortgage the land use right within 3 years of this event without consent of the Management Committee. The Management Committee issued a letter dated 18 October 2010 to HWG-Ltd. stating that the project had been delayed due to the change of urban planning and the new site had been determined and HWG-Ltd. should commence the project as soon as possible. 17.14.4 Exclusive Distributorship Agreement On 27 May 2011, HWG-Ltd. concluded an exclusive distributorship agreement with the Saint-Gobain Group, an industrial group with its headquarters in Courbevoie, France, which produces a range of construction and high-performance materials (“Saint-Gobain”), specifically with the group company Miroiteries du Rhin SAS, Bennwihr, France. According to this agreement, Saint-Gobain grants China Specialty Glass-Group the right to exclusively distribute various glass products of Saint-Gobain, which are listed in an annex to the agreement (the “Exclusive Products”), in China. With regard to certain other products of Saint-Gobain (the “Non-exclusive Products”, together with the Exclusive Products the “Saint-Gobain Products”), the agreement contains a non-exclusive distribution right. HWG-Ltd. purchases the Saint-Gobain Products at the respective purchase prices determined in an annex to the agreement. The purchase prices are to be renegotiated on a yearly basis. In addition, Saint-Gobain agrees to carry out and pay for certain marketing measures, e.g. the establishment of showrooms in China for the Saint-Gobain Products, technical training for HWG-Ltd. sales personnel and assistance in training of product installation. The agreement specifies that as consideration for the granted exclusivity, HWG-Ltd. will pay Saint-Gobain an aggregate amount of EUR 17.0 million, of which EUR 6.0 million are to be paid upfront if the planned IPO of CSG-AG takes place by 31 August 2011 and the remaining amount in various instalments over a period of six years. After certain periods of time, initially three years, Saint-Gobain is entitled to transform the exclusive distribution right granted to China Specialty Glass-Group into a non-exclusive one if a certain minimum purchase volume has not been met by the Group. The agreement has a term of ten years. Inter alia, it can be terminated by 258 either party if China Specialty Glass-Group and Saint-Gobain-Group fail to agree on the purchase prices which are renegotiated on a yearly basis. 17.15 Property, Plant and Equipment 17.15.1 Property and Plant None of the companies of the Group hold real estate title certificates, land use rights certificates or real estate ownership certificates. At present, the operating company of the Group, HWG-Ltd., leases land with a total area of 30,114.27 square meters and buildings on this land with a total construction area of 23,257.53 square meters at West and North of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou, PRC. This land and these buildings are subject to 8 real estate title certificates and one land use right certificate. One of these real estate title certificates was issued in the name of Mr. Chun Li Shi by Guangdong Provincial Government on 24 June 2008 (registered under Yuefangdizhengzi No. C6608548), while 7 real estate title certificates were issued in the name of Guangzhou Property Management Center, a company wholly owned by Mr. Chun Li Shi, by Guangdong Province Government on 6 December 2006 (registered under Yuefangdizhengzi No. C5090341, Yuefangdizhengzi No. C5083868, Yuefangdizhengzi No. C5086336, Yuefangdizhengzi No. C5090343, Yuefangdizhengzi No. C5090342, Yuefangdizhengzi No. C5090340 and Yuefangdizhengzi No. C5090339) and the land use right certificate was issued in the name of Guangzhou Property Management Center by Guangzhou Municiple Government on 20 June 2005 (registered under Huiguoyong (2004) No. 678.), all for the purpose of industrial factory building and supporting facilities. During the period of nationwide land reform at the beginning of 2000, Guangzhou Property Management Center’s predecessor, Guangzhou City Liwan District Qianjin Glass Factory, was granted a piece of land (including office and factory buildings on it) on which it had operated since the 1970s. The official blueprint of the land was provided by the previous owner, a state-owned enterprise, and was included in the application for the land use right by Guangzhou City Liwan District Qianjin Glass Factory. After the land use right was granted to the company by Guangdong Provincial government in January 2002, Guangzhou Municipal Land Resource and Building Administration carried out an independent measurement of the land which resulted in a difference of 53 square meters from the land area indicated in the submitted blueprint. These “uncounted” 53 square meters need to be added to the land use right (now with a total of 7,256 square meters) and a 259 proper application formality has to be executed – this is indicated in the land use right certificate granted on 19 May 2003. The right to use the land was for 50 years. This land and all the buildings on it were leased to HGW-Ltd. by Guangzhou Qianjin City Liwan District Glass Factory on 20 December 2003 and the leases were registered and approved by the relevant government authorities on 22 April 2010. As the relevant area was relatively small, the formalities to correct this difference were complex and Guangzhou Property Management Center intended to acquire the land use right on an adjacent piece of land, the company plans to use the process of acquiring the new land use right to solve the 53 square meters issue as suggested by the competent authority. However, as of the date of this Prospectus, the necessary legal formalities with respect to the area of 53 square meters which belongs to the land where four-story office premises and a plant are located have not been officially completed by Guangzhou Property Management Center. In addition, the necessary legal formalities have not been completed with respect to another piece of land of 9,416 square meters which is allocated to Guangzhou Property Management Center by the relevant land resource authority. According to the PRC laws, the land and the buildings on the land may not be leased if the legal formalities have not been completed. In case of a violation, a penalty can be imposed on the lessor, the income (i.e. the rental) can be confiscated by the competent land resource authority and the lessor can be ordered to cease the illegal leasing activity. Guangzhou Property Management Center’s sole shareholder Mr. Chun Li Shi has undertaken to complete the formalities as soon as possible. Further, an undertaking to bear all administrative and civil liabilities arising from the failure to go through the formality with respect to the allocated land has been made by Mr. Chun Li Shi. In addition, there is a Resolution Letter on the Inspection and Acceptance of the Construction Project Planning issued by Guangzhou Municipal Urban Planning Bureau on 28 May 2010, according to which the three-story building on the allocated land is accepted as a temporary plant and is allowed to be used for 2 years. 17.15.2 Lease Agreements The lease of the land and buildings by HWG-Ltd. subject to the certificates listed in the table below is based on three lease agreements with Guangzhou Property Management Center, a company wholly owned by Mr. Chun Li Shi, 260 and one lease agreement with Mr. Chun Li Shi. Guangzhou Property Management Center and Mr. Chun Li Shi are the lessors of the following buildings, the particulars of which are set out as follows: Name of Certificate Location Usage of Building Construction Area (square meters) Sharing Land Area (square meters) 7,256.03 1 F1, Zibian Building 1, No. 6, West of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou Real Estate Title Certificate issued to Guangzhou Property Management Center office 399.13 2 F2, Zibian Building 1, No. 6, West of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou Real Estate Title Certificate issued to Guangzhou Property Management Center office 372.15 3 F3, Zibian Building 1, No. 6, West of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou Real Estate Title Certificate issued to Guangzhou Property Management Center office 336.47 4 F4, Zibian Building 1, No. 6, West of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou Real Estate Title Certificate issued to Guangzhou Property Management Center office 328.88 5 Zibian Building 2, No. 6, West of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou Real Estate Title Certificate issued to Guangzhou Property Management Center plant 3,324.26 6 Zibian Building 3, No. 6, West of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou Real Estate Title Certificate issued to Guangzhou Property Management Center plant 1,311.13 7 Zibian Building 4, No. 6, West of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou Real Estate Title Certificate issued to Guangzhou Property Management Center plant 4,345.51 8 Zibian Building 1, No. 80, North of Hougang Street, Qingcha Road, Baiyun District, Guangzhou Real Estate Title Certificate issued to Mr. Chun Li Shi plant 6,287 6,203.31 9 No. 6, West of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou Land Use Right Certificate issued to Guangzhou Property Management Center plant and warehou se 6,553 9,416 7,238.93 According to the lease agreements between HWG-Ltd. and Guangzhou Property Management Center with respect to the above No. 1-4 properties, the rent for the office premises is RMB 9,600.00 (approximately TEUR 1 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month. The term of the lease expires on 31 March 2017. 261 According to the lease agreement between HWG-Ltd. and Guangzhou Property Management Center with respect to the above No. 5-7 properties, the rent for the plant is RMB 18,000.00 (approximately TEUR 2 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month. The term of the lease expires on 31 March 2017. According to the lease agreement with respect to the above No. 8 property, completed in April 2010, between HWG-Ltd. and Mr. Chun Li Shi, which replaced the previous lease agreement of July 2009, the rent for the plant is as follows: RMB 8,000 (approximately EUR 870 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month from 1 April 2010 to 30 June 2010; RMB 10,000 (approximately TEUR 1 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month from 1 July 2010 to 30 June 2011; RMB 12,000 (approximately TEUR 1 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month from 1 July 2011 to 30 June 2012; RMB 13,000 (approximately TEUR 1 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month from 1 July 2012 to 30 June 2013; RMB 20,000 (approximately TEUR 2 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month from 1 July 2013 to 30 June 2014; RMB 25,000 (approximately TEUR 3 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month from 1 July 2014 to 30 June 2019; RMB 35,000 (approximately TEUR 4 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month from 1 July 2019 to 30 June 2024; RMB 55,000 (approximately TEUR 6 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month from 1 July 2024 to 30 June 2029; RMB 80,000 (approximately TEUR 9 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month from 1 July 2029 to 30 June 2034; RMB 104,525 (approximately TEUR 11 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month from 1 July 2034 to 30 June 2039. The term of the lease expires on 31 March 2039. According to PRC law, the lease term may not exceed 20 years. If it exceeds twenty years, the period in excess is invalid. Therefore, the term of the lease with respect to the No. 8 property expires on 31 March 2030 and the lease is invalid after 1 April 2030. However, the parties can conclude a new contract for the time after 31 March 2030. The rental payments under this agreement have been paid in advance until 2039. According to the lease agreement between HWG-Ltd. and Guangzhou Property Management Center with respect to the above No. 9 property, the rent for the plant and warehouse is RMB 5,000.00 (approximately EUR 540 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month. The term of the lease expires on 28 May 2012. This lease agreement is invalid under PRC law because the leased land is land allocated and not granted by the authorities with the result that it cannot be subjected to a lease under PRC law. However, the competent property management authority has accepted the registration of 262 the lease agreement. According to a rental valuation report issued by an independent third party, the terms of the lease agreements are not at arm’s length due to the family relationship of Mr. Chun Li Shi and Mr. Nang Heung Sze, the Controlling Shareholder of the Company. The agreed rental prices are lower than the current market price. 17.15.3 Equipment The Group’s plant, property and equipment also include technical assets and machinery used in the manufacturing process as well as computers and office equipment used in the supporting facilities and offices. As of 31 March 2011, these assets amounted to a net value of TEUR 3,590. These assets are not encumbered with mortgages and pledges. As of the date of this Prospectus, no material changes with regard to the Group’s property, plant and equipment have occurred. 17.16 Intellectual Properties 17.16.1 Patents of HWG-Ltd. HWG-Ltd. has been granted six utility model patents and applied for the registration of two invention patents. The registration of the invention patents with the Chinese Intellectual Property Office (“SIPO”) is still pending and the applied two invention patents are now under the substance examination by SIPO. If no due cause is found to reject the application after the substance examination, SIPO will decide to grant the patent right for the inventions by issuing the certificate of patent for invention. SIPO will register and announce the granting at the same time. The patent right for invention comes into effect as of the date of the announcement. The registered and applied patents and the relevant information thereon are presented in the tables below. 263 Patent Certificates of HWG-Ltd. Patent certificate Utility Model Patent Certificate for windows with bulletproof, the function burglar proof Date of Application No. ZL 200820206059.6 of Date of Granting 25 December 21 October 2008 2009 10 October 2008 19 August and tamper proof Utility Model Patent Certificate for ZL 200820201663.X vacuum bag for glass 2009 Utility Model Patent Certificate for ZL 200820201743.5 13 October 2008 bulletproof glass for self-defence 2009 Utility Model Patent Certificate for safety door with 19 August ZL 200920052078.2 4 March 2009 16 December electronically 2009 controlled interlock with the function of bulletproof and anti-tail Utility Model Patent Certificate for 201020206582.6 21 May 2008 29 December bulletproof glass with function of 2010 bullet absorption Utility Model Patent Certificate for 201020222951.0 10 June 2010 29 December intruder-resistant composite glass 2010 Application of Patents of HWG-Ltd. Name of applied invention patents Date of Application No. Date of Granting Glass hot bending techniques 200810219267.4 20 November 2008 Pending Production 200810218998.7 10 November 2008 Pending and equipment techniques of laminated glass 17.16.2 Trademarks of HWG-Ltd. HWG-Ltd. currently owns one registered trademark which previously belonged to Mr. Nang Heung Sze (registration no. 3553453). It was transferred to HWG-Ltd together with a second trademark (registration no. 4483251) pursuant to an agreement between HWG-Ltd. and Mr. Nang Heung Sze of 12 June 2010. The transfer of the first trademark became effective under PRC law with its registration with the Trademark Bureau of State Administration of Industry and Commerce on 13 April 2011, whereas the registration of the transfer of the second trademark is still pending. With regard to these two trademarks, Mr. Nang Heung Sze and HWG-Ltd. had in the past concluded trademark licence contracts 264 and a supplemental agreement, according to which HWG-Ltd was entitled to exclusively use the trademarks (see section 22 “Related Party Transactions”). The relevant information on the two trademarks is shown below: Trademark 1) Registration No. Issued by Validity Period Registered by 3553453 Trademark Bureau of State AIC 28 June 2005 27 June 2015 Mr. Nang Heung Sze Class 19 1) 4483251 Trademark Bureau of State AIC 14 April 2008 13 April 2018 Mr. Nang Heung Sze Class 19 2) Products Covered Includes: plate glass for building, glass material, glass steel ceiling, bath cubicles (not of metal), alabaster glass, building glass, glass granules for road marking, insulating glass, window glass (except for automotive glass), window glass for building, safety glass. 2) Includes: plywood, granite, paving asphalt, bath cubicles (not of metal); busts of stone, concrete or marble, safety glass, insulating glass, alabaster glass, ceramic tile, pottery kiln tool HWG-Ltd. has also filed an application for registration of a self-owned trademark, not used until now, with the Trademark Bureau of State Administration of Industry and Commerce on 7 March 2008. This application was accepted by the Trademark Bureau of State Administration of Industry and Commerce on 24 March 2008, but has not been publicly announced yet. Further, HWG-Ltd. has mandated a trademark agent to apply for an additional class of trademark registration for this trademark. Information on the trademark for which HWG-Ltd. has applied for registration is set out below: Trademark Application number 6584168 Application date 7 March 2008 265 Acceptance of application 24 March 2008 Application office Trademark Bureau of State Administrati on of Industry and Commerce Covered products Class 19: alabaster glass, building glass, glass granules for road marking, insulating glass, window glass (except for automotive glass), window glass for building, safety glass, Coated glass,glass mosaic, glass construction materials (not including sanitary facilities) 17.16.3 Domains of China Specialty Glass-Group The Group has registered the following internet domains: 17.17 · 兴华玻璃.中国 (Chinese characters) · http://www.csglass.net · http://www.csg-ag.de · http://www.csg-ag.com · http://www.chinaspecialtyglass.de · http://www.chinaspecialtyglass.com · http://www.china-specialty-glass.de · http://www.china-specialty-glass.com · http://www.chinaspecialtyglass-ag.de · http://www.chinaspecialtyglass-ag.com · http://www.china-specialty-glass-ag.de · http://www.china-specialty-glass-ag.com · http://www.specialtyglass.de · http://www.specialty-glass.de · http://www.china-glass.de · http://www.china-glass-ag.de · http://www.china-glass-ag.com Investments Since the Company was founded in 2010, it has not carried out any principal investments and it is currently not carrying out any principal investments either. The Company has not made firm commitments on future investments. HWG-Ltd., as the currently sole operative company of the Group, has made the following principal investments over the last three financial years: 266 Item Advance payment for leasehold land use rights Advance payment for leasehold buildings Leasehold buildings Plant and machinery Subsidiary Total 2008 million EUR - 2009 million EUR - 2010 million EUR - - 0.1 - 0.7 0.7 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.3 0.6 The investments in 2008 and 2009 relate predominantly to purchases of plant and machinery. In 2010 HWG-Ltd. invested in a subsidiary, HWG-SC, incorporated in Chengdu City, Sichuan Province, China, as well as in construction and renovation works of the Guangzhou plant. On 30 May 2010 HWG-Ltd. concluded a contract with the Management Committee of Guangdong – Wenchuan Industrial Park (the “Management Committee”) to invest and establish a glass production project and research and development base in Guangdong – Wenchuan Industrial Park, Sichuan, PRC. In this context, capital contributions are planned in the amount of the total investment volume of the project which is RMB 0.3 billion (equivalent to EUR 32.5 million at 31 March 2011 exchange rates). Of the amount invested RMB 2 million (approximately EUR 0.2 million at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) were paid as capital contribution to set up HWG-SC. In addition, HWG-Ltd. made capital investments of EUR 0.62 million for construction work on leasehold buildings and plant and machinery in Guangzhou. In October 2010, another RMB 8 million (around EUR 0.92 million) were contributed by HWG-Ltd. into HWG-SC. In late 2010, HWG-SC invested RMB 25 million (approximately EUR 2.8 million) as an advance payment in the context of a bidding process for land use rights, RMB 8 million (around EUR 0.92 million) for construction work and RMB 3 million (approximately EUR 0.34 million) as design/greening scheme fees. In the first three months of 2011, no significant capital investments were made by the Group. The Group plans to continue with its investments in its new Sichuan production facility and has capital commitments of approximately EUR 33 million in connection with this project. Neither HWG-Ltd. nor the Group currently have investments that are in progress. In 2011 HWG-Ltd. made a firm commitment to conclude an exclusive distributorship agreement with the industrial group Saint-Gobain with a 267 volume of EUR 17 million (see Section 17.14.4 “Exclusive Distributorship Agreement”). Apart from this commitment neither HWG-Ltd. nor the Group have made any other firm commitments to make material future investments. 17.18 Environment The manufacturing of specialty glass involves the storage of certain chemical materials and glass which are hazardous to the environment and the health of employees if not handled properly. The Group also carries out glass cleaning and chemical tempering processes which involve discharge of waste water and to a much lesser extent, toxic chemicals. Although the waste water is recycled, it is unavoidable that small amounts of waste water have to be discarded from time to time. Glass particles, broken glass and pieces of glass that are too small to be used are collected and sold to normal glass manufacturers to be recycled. Additionally, operating equipment results in noise. An operating company is required to hold certain environmental permits, to obtain approval of an environment impact assessment report (“EIAR”) and to pass environmental protection inspection acceptance for its activities and facilities. HWG-Ltd. has to provide an EIAR to the Guangzhou Baiyun Environmental Protection Bureau (“Guangzhou Baiyun EPB”) to present the potential environmental impact caused by the operation and the measures it will take in order to avoid such impact. The operating company has to obtain approval from Guangzhou Baiyun EPB with respect to the EIAR and based on this approval it has to pass the inspection and acceptance formalities with regard to its environmental protection facilities by Guangzhou Baiyun EPB before its operation. With regard to an intended expansion of its production scale, HWG-Ltd. is to prepare a further EIAR to the Guangzhou Baiyun EPB and obtain the approval from the Guangzhou Baiyun EPB. After all the above procedures, the environmental permits, i.e. wastage discharge permits, are expected to be issued by the Guangzhou Environmental Protection Supervision Office. HWG-Ltd. prepared a Construction Project Environmental Impact Report Form in April 2005 and obtained the approval from Guangzhou Baiyun Environmental Protection Bureau, based on which the environmental protection facilities of HWG-Ltd. passed the examination and were accepted by Baiyun Environmental Protection Bureau. HWG-Ltd. has obtained the Pollutant Discharge Permit which is valid until 31 December 2015. 268 The waste discharged by HWG-Ltd. includes hazardous substance. HWG-Ltd. has concluded a waste disposal contract with Guangzhou Huanhui Technology Co. Ltd. on 18 May 2010, according to which the hazardous solid waste produced by HWG-Ltd. will be handled by the qualified professional company. This contract was renewed in May 2011 with a term of one year until 15 May 2012. Apart from that, based on the confirmation by the management of HWG-Ltd., all measures required in the EIAR in 2005 have been taken by HWG-Ltd. With regard to expansion of production scale in Guangzhou, HWG-Ltd. has commissioned a qualified institution, which has prepared a new environmental impact assessment report. This report was approved by the competent authority. 17.19 Legal Proceedings Neither the Company nor its subsidiaries are currently, nor have they been in the last twelve months, the subject of any governmental, legal or arbitration proceedings (including any such proceedings which are pending or threatened of which the Company is aware) which may have, or have had in the recent past significant effects on the Group’s financial position or profitability. 269 18. GENERAL INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY 18.1 Formation, Entry in the Commercial Register, Company Name and Registered Office The Company is a stock corporation under German law headquartered in Gruenwald near Munich, Germany. It is registered with the commercial register of the local court of Munich under HRB 185783 and under the name of China Specialty Glass AG. The Company’s business address is An den Roemerhuegeln 1, 82031 Gruenwald, Germany, phone +49 89 189 42 5227. The Company was founded on 10 May 2010 as a shelf company by Blitzstart Holding AG under the name of China Specialty Glass AG headquartered in Gruenwald near Munich and registered with the commercial register of the local court of Munich on 18 May 2010. After the acquisition of the shelf company by Luckyway Global Group Limited, a BVI investment company incorporated under the laws of the British Virgin Islands, with its business address at Road Town Tortola, British Virgin Islands, and owned and controlled by Mr. Nang Heung Sze, on 26 May 2010, the General Shareholders’ Meeting of the Company on 30 June 2010 decided to increase the registered share capital from EUR 50,000.00 by EUR 15,000,000.00 to EUR 15,050,000.00 through the issuance of an aggregate of 15,000,000 shares against contributions in kind. The acquisition of the shelf company and the subsequent amendment of the Company’s Articles of Association on 26 May 2010 and 27 May 2010 are considered as the economic new incorporation (wirtschaftliche Neugründung) of the Company, due to which Luckyway Global Group Limited is regarded as the founder of the Company (the “Founding Shareholder”). As a holding company the Luckyway Global Group Limited has no other function. Due to the contribution of all shares in HWG HK-Holding into the Company on 22 November 2010, Luckyway Global Group Limited, Quick Reach Group Limited, Expert Intelligence Global Limited, Sea Dragon Investments Limited and Hong Kong Investments Group Limited (the latter four companies together the “HW Investors”) acquired all shares in the Company which were issued due to the aforementioned capital increase. The capital increase became legally effective with its entry into the commercial register of the local court of Munich on 22 November 2010. Following the entry of this capital increase an IPO of the Company in connection with an additional capital increase against cash contributions was planned for December 2010. 270 However, the Company decided to postpone the planned IPO to a later stage in a more favourable capital market and IPO environment. Upon registration of the capital increase Luckyway Global Group Limited and the HW Investors held all shares of the Company, of which 11,194,957 shares (74.39%) were held indirectly by Mr. Nang Heung Sze through Luckyway Global Group Limited, and of which 735,568 shares (4.89%) were held indirectly by Mr. Ching Hoi Sze through Quick Reach Group Limited, 524,928 shares (3.49%) were held indirectly by Mr. Hung Hui Ke through Expert Intelligence Global Limited, 1,694,034 shares (11.26%) were held indirectly by Mr. Yan Kong Wong through Sea Dragon Investments Limited and 900,513 shares (5.98%) were held indirectly by Mr. Chi Mang Cheung through Hong Kong Investments Group Limited, who were together with Mr. Nang Heung Sze the indirect shareholders of HWG HK-Holding prior to the capital increase. The Supervisory Board appointed new members of the Management Board on 26 May 2010 (subject to exemption from the prohibition of multiple representation laid down in sec. 181 BGB). Mr. Nang Heung Sze, Mr. Chun Li Shi and Mr. Chi Man Wong were appointed members of the Management Board, while the former member of the Management Board resigned from office. Mr. Chi Man Wong was replaced by Mr. Chi-Hsiang Michael Lee who was appointed by the Supervisory Board on 13 October 2010 after Mr. Chi Man Wong was removed from his office on 13 October 2010. At the same time, new Supervisory Board members were elected. On 10 June 2010, the Company applied for the amendment of the Articles of Association to be entered into the commercial register of the local court of Munich. 18.2 Company Object Pursuant to sec. 2 of the Company’s Articles of Association, the Company’s object is the management of companies and the administration of interests in companies, in particular companies active in the business fields development, construction, manufacture and distribution of various types of glass and other glass products as well as of parts and components thereof. 18.3 Financial Year and Term of the Company The calendar year (i.e. 1 January through 31 December) is also the financial year (Geschäftsjahr) of the Company. The first financial year 2010 was a short financial year (Rumpfgeschäftsjahr). There is no limitation on the duration (Dauer der Gesellschaft) of the Company. It is formed for an 271 indefinite term. 18.4 Group Structure and Recent Corporate Developments of the Group China Specialty Glass-Group is composed of the ultimate holding company CSG-AG based in Gruenwald near Munich, Germany, the intermediate holding company Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited ( “HWG HK-Holding”) based in Hong Kong, Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd. (“HWG-Ltd.”) which is the operating company of the Group and located in Guangzhou City, PRC, and the currently dormant company Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Co., Ltd. (“HWG-SC”). CSG-AG is the direct holding company of HWG HK-Holding which was incorporated under the laws of Hong Kong and operates as an intermediate holding company. HWG HK-Holding is the direct holding company of HWG-Ltd. of which HWG HK-Holding holds all shares. HWG-Ltd. holds all shares in HWG-SC. HWG HK-Holding, HWG-Ltd. and HWG-SC are collectively referred to as “HWG HK-Group”. HWG HK-Group and the Company are collectively referred to as “China Specialty Glass-Group” or “the Group”. The following table provides an overview of the current shareholding structure of the China Specialty Glass-Group as of the date of the Prospectus. China Specialty Glass AG Ultimate holding 1) "CSG-AG" or "Company" Listing entity "China Specialty Glass-Group" or "Group" 100% 2) Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Ltd Intermediate holding "HWG HK-Holding" 100% Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co. Ltd Operational entity 3) "HWG-Ltd" 100% Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Industry Co. Ltd3) Subsidiary "HWG-SC" Incorporated in 1) Germany, 2) Hong Kong and 3) China (PRC) 272 "HWG HK-Group" 18.4.1 China Specialty Glass AG and Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited The China Specialty Glass-Group emerged from HWG HK-Group and the acquisition of all shares of HWG HK-Holding by CSG-AG in November 2010. However, historically the business of China Specialty Glass-Group reached back to the establishment of HWG-Ltd. in 1994, which was incorporated into HWG HK-Group in 2008 and thus became a wholly foreign owned enterprise under PRC law. HWG HK-Holding was incorporated by GNL07 Limited with limited liability in Hong Kong under the laws of Hong Kong on 26 July 2007. The address of registered office is Room 1503, 15/F, Office Tower, Convention Plaza, 1 Harbour Road, Wan Chai, Hong Kong. On 3 October 2007, Mr. Nang Heung Sze acquired one subscriber share from GNL07 Limited for a consideration of Hong Kong Dollar (“HKD”) 1. On the same date, a total of 9,999 shares of HKD 1 each were issued and allotted, credited as fully paid to Mr. Nang Heung Sze and as a result, HWG HK-Holding was owned 100% by Mr. Nang Heung Sze. Prior to the establishment of HWG HK-Holding several share purchase agreements were concluded as follows. On 8 November 2006, an agreement was entered into among Mr. Nang Heung Sze, HWG-Ltd. and Mr. Chi Mang Cheung. On the same date, another agreement was entered into among Mr. Nang Heung Sze, HWG-Ltd. and Mr. Yan Kong Wong. On 20 December 2006, an agreement was entered into among Mr. Nang Heung Sze, HWG-Ltd. and Mr. Ching Hoi Sze and on 22 December 2006, an agreement was entered into among Mr. Nang Heung Sze, HWG-Ltd. and Mr. Hung Hui Ke (together the “Sale and Purchase Agreements”). Except for the contracting parties, the terms of the Sale and Purchase Agreements are substantially the same. Under the terms of the Sale and Purchase Agreements, HWG-Ltd. would undergo a reorganisation to streamline the group structure in preparation for an overseas listing. A Hong Kong company would be established and hold 100% equity interest in HWG-Ltd. and an ultimate holding company would be established outside of China as a listing vehicle for HWG-Ltd. After establishment of the Hong Kong company, Mr. Nang Heung Sze agreed to transfer 6.0%, 11.3%, 4.9% and 3.5% equity interest in the proposed Hong Kong company to Mr. Chi Mang Cheung, Mr. Yan Kong Wong, Mr. Ching Hoi Sze and Mr. Hung Hui Ke or their respective nominees at the consideration of 273 RMB 9.0 million, RMB 17.0 million, RMB 7.35 million and RMB 5.25 million respectively, based on the net asset value (including the other assets) of HWG-Ltd. as of 2005. Such considerations were fully paid by Mr. Chi Mang Cheung, Mr. Yan Kong Wong, Mr. Ching Hoi Sze and Mr. Hung Hui Ke to Mr. Nang Heung Sze. It was agreed that Mr. Chi Mang Cheung, Mr. Yan Kong Wong, Mr. Ching Hoi Sze and Mr. Hung Hui Ke would not be involved in the operation of HWG-Ltd. On 30 April 2010, the authorised share capital of HWG HK-Holding was increased from HKD 10,000 to HKD 1,000,000 by the creation of 990,000 new shares of HKD 1 each. In order to implement the transactions under the Sale and Purchase Agreements, on the same date, a total of 3,459 shares of HKD 1 each were issued and allotted at par value as to (i) 808 shares to Hong Kong Investments Group Limited; (ii) 1,520 shares to Sea Dragon Investments Limited; (iii) 660 shares to Quick Reach Group Limited; and (iv) 471 shares to Expert Intelligence Global Limited. Upon completion of such allotment, HWG HK-Holding was held as to 74.3% by Mr. Nang Heung Sze, 6% by Hong Kong Investments Group Limited, 11.3% by Sea Dragon Investments Limited, 4.9% by Quick Reach Group Limited and 3.5% by Expert Intelligence Global Limited. Mr. Chi Mang Cheung, Mr. Yan Kong Wong, Mr. Ching Hoi Sze and Mr. Hung Hui Ke are the beneficial owners of Hong Kong Investments Group Limited, Sea Dragon Investments Limited, Quick Reach Group Limited and Expert Intelligence Global Limited respectively (the “HW Investors”). In November 2010, HWG HK-Group was integrated into China Specialty Glass-Group. By doing so, CSG-AG acquired all shares in HWG HK-Holding by means of a capital increase from EUR 50,000.00 by EUR 15,000,000.00 to EUR 15,050,000.00 through the issuance of an aggregate of 15,000,000 shares against contributions in kind. By the contribution of all shares of HWG HK-Holding into CSG-AG, Luckyway Global Group Limited and the HW Investors acquired all shares in CSG-AG which were issued due to the aforementioned capital increase (see section 18.1 “Formation, Entry in the Commercial Register, Company Name and Registered Office”). The capital increase against contributions in kind became legally effective with its registration with the commercial register of the local court of Munich on 22 November 2010. 274 With the implementation of the capital increase of CSG-AG the shareholder structure of CSG-AG was as follows: Shareholding in CSG-AG Name (as of 30 September 2010)* Luckyway Global Group Limited 74.39% Quick Reach Group Limited 4.89% Expert Intelligence Global Limited 3.49% Sea Dragon Investments Limited 11.26% 5.98% Hong Kong Investments Group Limited * For further information on the shareholder structure after the IPO see section 21 “Shareholder Structure (before and after the Offering)”. 18.4.2 Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd. and Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Co., Ltd. HWG-Ltd. was incorporated on 24 October 1994 as a sino-foreign joint venture company under the laws of the People’s Republic of China by Guangzhou Property Management Center (70%) and Hong Kong Chung Hwa Enterprises Development Co. (“HK Chung Hwa”) (30%). As of the time of its establishment, HWG-Ltd. was registered with the Guangzhou Administration of Industry and Commerce (“AIC”) under the registration number Gongshangqiheyuesuigzi no. 02536 with a registered capital of HKD 4,000,000.00 and the business name Guangzhou HingWah Auto Glass Industry Co., Ltd. with the business address at Nantougang, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou City, PRC. Currently, HWG-Ltd. is registered with Guangzhou AIC under the registration number 440101400046237 and under the name of Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd. and has its registered address in F1, Zibian Building 1, No. 6, West of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou City, PRC. After the capital increase from HKD 4,000,000.00 (approximately EUR 0.4 million) by HKD 10,000,000.00 (approximately EUR 1 million) to HKD 14,000,000.00 (approximately EUR 1.4 million) through the issuance of new shares to its sole shareholder HWG HK-Holding against cash contributions became legally effective with approval from Liwan BOFTEC on 3 March 2010 and registration with the Guangzhou AIC on 8 June 2010, the current registered capital of HWG-Ltd. is HKD 14,000,000.00 275 (approximately EUR 1.4 million) which is fully paid in. Further, until present date HWG-Ltd. has set aside RMB 6,129,545.07 (approximately EUR 0.7 million) into the statutory reserve fund which shall reach 50% of its registered capital. On 15 January 2008, HWG-Ltd. became a wholly foreign owned enterprise by the share transfers from its initial shareholders Guangzhou Property Management Center which held 70% of the shares and HK Chung Hwa which held 30% of the shares to HWG HK-Holding. The restructuring in the ownership of HWG-Ltd. was executed by Mr. Nang Heung Sze together with his son Mr. Chun Li Shi who directly or indirectly controlled Guangzhou Property Management Center and HK Chung Hwa as well as HWG HK-Holding. At the time of the share transfer from Guangzhou Property Management Center and HK Chung Hwa to HWG HK-Holding, Mr. Nang Heung Sze held all shares in HWG HK-Holding and Mr. Chun Li Shi who is the son of Mr. Nang Heung Sze held 100% of the shares in Guangzhou Property Management Center and Mr. Zhefen Li held 100% of the shares in HK Chung Hwa as trustee for Mr. Nang Heung Sze. HWG-Ltd. was formed for a certain period of time. Its business term will expire on 24 December 2017. According to the PRC laws and Articles of Association of the company, after the business term of the company expires, the company may be dissolved or continue to exist, if the shareholders' meeting adopt a resolution with a two-third majority. As of the date of the Prospectus, China Specialty Glass-Group plans to extend the business term after expiration. HWG-SC is registered with Chengdu Jintang AIC under the registration number 510121000016747 and located in Chengdu-A’ba Industrial Development Zone, Huaikou Town, Jintang County, Chengdu City, PRC. The company was established on 25 May 2010 as a private limited liability company under PRC law by HWG-Ltd. HWG-SC has no operational trading business yet, although it has invested in property, plant and equipment, land use rights and design rights, and has assumed liabilities for its investments and commitments in respect of its planned investments. Mr. Nang Heung Sze is appointed as legal representative of HWG-SC. The business scope of HWG-SC is the production and processing of all kinds of glass product and sales of its products (excluding the business scope which is prohibited or limited by the PRC laws, regulations and administrative stipulations and which is subject to the approval or license). 276 18.4.3 Other Companies of the Controlling Shareholder Apart from Guangzhou Property Management Center, HK Chung Hwa, HWG HK-Holding, HWG-Ltd. and HWG-SC, Mr. Nang Heung Sze (“Controlling Shareholder”) and his son Mr. Chun Li Shi directly or indirectly controlled the following companies with a business scope similar to HWG-Ltd: Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited Guangzhou Xing Wah Glass Products Co., Ltd., Guangzhou Xing Yun Industry Co., Ltd., Guangzhou Shiweishi Security Technology Stock Co., Ltd., Guangzhou Yaoxiang Decoration Co., Ltd. and Xi’an Mamen Security Technology Co., Ltd. Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited (previously “Xing Hua Holdings (HK) Ltd.”) was incorporated in Hong Kong on 13 October 1999. Subsequently, Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Ching Hoi Sze acquired one subscriber share from each of the company’s two founding shareholders and became its directors. In October 1999, Mr. Nang Heung Sze was issued and allotted shares so that his shareholding rose to 99.9%, while 0.01% was held by Mr. Ching Hoi Sze. In December 2009, Mr. Ching Kwan Li replaced Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Ching Hoi Sze as director of Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited and in February 2010 acquired all of their shares, thus becoming the only shareholder. Guangzhou Xing Wah Glass Products Co., Ltd. (previously “Guangzhou Xing Wah Bullet-proof Glass Co., Ltd.”) was established in 2001 by HWG-Ltd. and Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited as a sino-foreign joint venture and became a wholly foreign owned enterprise in 2003 after the transfer of all shares from HWG-Ltd. to Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited Mr. Nang Heung Sze directly or indirectly held from 1994 to 2010 up to 100% shares in HWG-Ltd. and from October 1999 to February 2010 up to 99.9% shares in Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited In addition, Mr. Nang Heung Sze and his son Mr. Chun Li Shi have been members of the management of the company since its establishment until present date. In 2010, the company applied for the closure of its business which was approved in March 2010. The deregistration of the company was completed in September 2010 with the receipt of the Notice for Acception of the Deregistration. Guangzhou Xingyun Industry Co., Ltd. (previously “Guangzhou Xingyun enterprise Co., Ltd.”) was incorporated in 1992 as a private limited liability company under PRC law by Mr. Nang Heung Sze who held 90% of the shares and Li Xianli who held 10% of the shares. On 30 December 2002, the company’s business licence was revoked for not attending the annual inspection for the year 2001. Thus, the Company ceased to exist on 277 30 December 2002. Mr. Nang Heung Sze was a member of the management and the legal representative of the company until the business licence was revoked. Guangzhou Shiweishi Security Technology Stock Co., Ltd. (previously “Guangzhou Xing Wah Industry Company Limited by Shares”) was established by Mr. Nang Heung Sze and other initial shareholders on 21 February 2005 with Mr. Nang Heung Sze holding 48.6% of the shares. Mr. Nang Heung Sze transferred all his shares to Ms. Shanshan Li in 2007. Until the share transfer, Mr. Nang Heung Sze was the chairman of the management board and legal representative of the company. On 26 May 2010, Ms. Shanshan Li transferred her shareholding to a third party and was removed from her position of legal representative. The above changes were registered. Guangzhou Yaoxiang Decoration Co., Ltd. was incorporated in 1998 by Mr. Chun Li Shi who held 40% and a third party who held 60% of the shares. Until 2005 Mr. Chun Li Shi was also the company’s director. The company was deregistered in December 2007. It did not commence operational business and was dormant until its deregistration. Xi’an Mamen Security Technology Co., Ltd. was established on 6 August 2001 as a wholly foreign owned enterprise by Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited, the sole shareholder until present date. Mr. Nang Heung Sze held from October 1999 to February 2010 up to 99.9% shares in Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited In addition, Mr. Nang Heung Sze as chairman and his son Mr. Chun Li Shi as director were members of the management board until September 2007. 18.5 Development of the Group’s Business The development of the Group’s business from 1994 until the date of this Prospectus can be summarised as follows: · 1994: Formation of HWG-Ltd. · 1996/1997: Innovation of bulletproof glass for automobiles · 1998: Innovation of fire-resistant glass · 1999: Name of HWG-Ltd. changed into present one · 2003: Recognised as high-tech enterprise in Guangzhou City · 2004: Premises of HWG-Ltd. relocated to present site 278 · 2008: HWG HK-Holding became the sole shareholder of HWG-Ltd. Hing Wah was recognised as famous trademark in Guangzhou Recognised as Top 100 enterprises with strong development potentiality in China Recognised as the Designated Provider of Glass with High Technology for Construction in China · 2009: Recognised as Top 30 Enterprises in Glass Industry in Guangdong Rewarded as Top 10 brands for specialized glass in Guangdong · 2010: Capital increase of HWG-Ltd. from HKD 4 million by HKD 10 million to HKD 14 million Acquisition of CSG-AG by Luckyway Global Group Limited and capital increase of CSG-AG from EUR 50,000.00 by EUR 15,000,000.00 to EUR 15,050,000.00 by contributing all shares in HWG HK-Holding into CSG-AG. Establishment of HWG-SC 18.6 Announcements; Paying and Depositary Agent As laid down in the Company’s Articles of Association (Satzung) announcements of the Company will be - as long as not otherwise provided by law - published in the electronic version of the German Federal Gazette. The publication of the annual financial statements and the interim financial statements will take place on the website of the Company. Besides the availability of the accounting documentation in the enterprise register (Unternehmensregister), the Company will publish notices concerning the date and the website address at which the accounting will be available to the public. Announcements which concern the approval of the Prospectus by the German Federal Financial Supervisory Authority (Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht – BaFin) or amendments to the Prospectus will be published – in accordance with in the provisions of the German Securities Prospectus Act (Wertpapierprospektgesetz - WpPG) – in the form the Prospectus provides for, i.e., on the website of the Company (www.csg-ag.de). Copies of the Prospectus will be available at the offices of 279 VISCARDI AG, Brienner Str. 1, 80333 Munich, Germany and biw Bank für Investments und Wertpapiere AG, Hausbroicher Str. 222, 47877 Willich, Germany. Paying agent and depositary agent in Germany is biw AG. 280 19. INFORMATION ON THE CAPITAL OF THE COMPANY AND APPLICABLE PROVISIONS 19.1 Registered Share Capital; Authorised Capital 19.1.1 Registered Share Capital and Shares The registered share capital of the Company amounting to EUR 15,050,000.00 is comprised of 15,050,000 ordinary no-par value shares (Stückaktien). Each of the shares has a calculated value of EUR 1.00. The Company’s share capital has been fully paid in. To allow biw AG to fulfil its retransfer obligation vis-à-vis Luckyway Global Group Limited from the securities loan described in section 25.3 “Securities Loans and Greenshoe Option”, it is intended that an according capital increase against cash contribution will take place. Up to 6,000,000 shares shall be issued from the Authorised Capital 2010/I and the issued shares shall be subscribed by biw AG. The capital increase is expected to be resolved by the Management Board and approved by the Supervisory Board on or around 20 June 2011 with the then existing shareholders waiving their subscription rights. The application for registration of the capital increase is expected to be submitted with the commercial register of the local court (Amtsgericht) of Munich on 4 July 2011. It is expected that registration and effectiveness of the capital increase will take place on 11 July 2011. Upon registration of the capital increase with the commercial register, the shares from the capital increase will be transferred to Luckyway Global Group Limited. Assuming that the maximum number of shares is issued, the share capital of the Company after the capital increase will amount to EUR 21,050,000.00 consisting of 21,050,000 no par value shares with a calculated value of EUR 1.00 per share. 19.1.2 Development of the Registered Share Capital Between the foundation of the Company and the date of the present Prospectus, the Company’s share capital has developed as follows: The Company was established as a shelf company on 10 May 2010 with a share capital of EUR 50,000.00 and registered with the commercial register of the local court of Munich on 18 May 2010. In the context of the economic new incorporation (wirtschaftliche Neugründung) on 27 May 2010, the 281 Articles of Association of the Company were changed but not the amount of the share capital. On 30 June 2010, the extraordinary shareholders’ meeting (außerordentliche Hauptversammlung) EUR 50,000.00 by resolved an to aggregate increase amount the of share capital from EUR 15,000,000.00 to EUR 15,050,000.00 in return for contributions in kind. The capital increase took place through the issuance of an aggregate of 15,000,000 new ordinary no-par value bearer shares, each with a calculated value of EUR 1.00. The capital increase was entered in the commercial register of the local court of Munich on 22 November 2010. 19.1.3 Authorised Capital In accordance with the Company’s Articles of Association (Satzung), the Management Board is authorised to increase the share capital of the Company with the approval of the Supervisory Board for a period of five years starting with the registration of this authorization in the commercial register once or several times by up to EUR 7,525,000.00 through the issuance of up to 7,525,000 new no-par value bearer shares in cash or in contributions in kind (“Authorised Capital 2010/I”). The Management Board is further authorised, in each case with the consent of the Supervisory Board, to provide that the subscription right of the shareholders is excluded. An exclusion of the subscription right, however, is only permitted in the following cases: · if the new shares are issued to acquire companies, shares in companies or parts of companies: · for fractional amounts. The Management Board is to decide with the consent of the Supervisory Board on the content of the rights to and the conditions of the issuance of the shares. 19.2 General Form, general Representation and general Transferability of Shares Each share has one vote at the General Shareholders’ Meeting. There are no voting rights restrictions. The shares are represented by one or more global certificates without dividend coupons. The shares are deposited with Clearstream Banking AG, Frankfurt/Main, as securities clearing and depository bank. The Company´s Articles of Association constitute that 282 shareholders are not entitled to be issued with share certificates, unless requested by the regulations of the stock exchange on which the shares are listed. The determination of the form and substance of the shares, e.g. the form of the global certificate, as well as the dividend and renewal coupons is carried out by the Management Board and is subject to the approval of the Supervisory Board. The Securities Identification Number (WKN) of the shares is A1EL8Y, the International Securities Identification Number (ISIN) is DE000A1EL8Y8 and the Ticker Symbol is 8GS. The shares are freely transferable in accordance with legal requirements for bearer shares. Except for the restrictions set forth under section 8.11 “Market Protection Agreements (Lock-Up)”, there are no prohibitions with respect to the disposal or the transferability of the shares of the Company. 19.3 General Provisions relating to Profit Allocation and Dividend Payments, to a Liquidation of the Company and to Subscription Rights as well as General Provisions governing Changes in the Share Capital 19.3.1 Provisions relating to Profit Allocation and Dividend Payments According to German law, shareholders may participate in the profits of a stock corporation. This participation is determined on the basis of the respective interests of the shareholders in the share capital. The articles of association of a stock corporation may however provide for another profit allocation. Distributions of dividends on shares for a given financial year are generally determined by a process in which the Management Board and Supervisory Board submit a proposal to the annual General Shareholders’ Meeting held in the subsequent financial year and such annual General Shareholders’ Meeting adopts a resolution. If Luckyway Global Group Limited holds an effective or, depending on the presence at the General Shareholders’ Meeting, a factual majority of the voting rights present or represented at the meeting, it may exercise further influence on the utilisation of the Company’s profits and/or the dividends’ policy. German law provides that a resolution concerning dividends and distribution 283 thereof may be adopted only if the Company’s unconsolidated financial statements show net retained profits. In determining the profit available for distribution, the result for the relevant year must be adjusted for profits and losses brought forward from the previous year and for withdrawals from or transfers to reserves. Certain reserves are required by law and must be deducted when calculating the profit available for distribution. In the event that the annual financial statements (Jahresabschluss) account for a balance sheet profit (Bilanzgewinn) in the future, the Management Board (Vorstand) and Supervisory Board (Aufsichtsrat) intend to propose a profit distribution among the shareholders. The Company intends to distribute profits if and to the extent it is covered by the annual net income (Jahresüberschuss) which is shown in the respective annual financial statements (Jahresabschluss). The remaining profits, if any, are to be booked into retained earnings and be used to finance the further development of the Company’s business and its internal growth. Future dividend distributions will depend on several factors. Foremost the results of operations of the Company will be decisive. Besides the financial situation of the Company, its need for financing and the legal, tax and regulatory environment will influence the dividend payments as well. Dividends on shares resolved by the annual General Shareholders’ Meeting are paid annually, shortly after the annual General Shareholders’ Meeting, in compliance with the rules of the respective clearing system. Dividend payment claims by shareholders are subject to a three-year statute of limitations. Upon expiry of the three-year period the Company is no longer obliged to make the dividend payment to the respective shareholder. Details concerning any dividends resolved by the annual General Shareholders’ Meeting and the respective paying agents specified by the Company will be published in the electronic version of the Federal Gazette (elektronischer Bundesanzeiger). 19.3.2 Provisions relating to a Liquidation of the Company The liquidation of the Company unless it is determined by insolvency proceedings or other reasons as described in the German Stock Corporation Act (Aktiengesetz) must be decided upon at the General Shareholders’ Meeting (Hauptversammlung). The resolution to liquidate the Company must be adopted with a majority of at least 75% of the share capital represented. The assets remaining after satisfying of all of the Company’s liabilities will be distributed pro rata among its shareholders. The German Stock Corporation 284 Act (Aktiengesetz – AktG) provides certain protections for creditors which must be observed in the event of liquidation. 19.3.3 Provisions relating to Subscription Rights According to the German Stock Corporation Act (Aktiengesetz – AktG), every shareholder is generally entitled to subscription rights to any new shares issued within the framework of a capital increase, including convertible bonds, bonds with warrants, profit-sharing rights or income bonds. A minimum subscription period of two weeks has to be provided for the exercise of such subscription rights. Furthermore, such subscription rights are freely transferable and may be traded on German stock exchanges within a specified period prior to the expiration of the subscription period. The General Shareholders’ Meeting may pass a resolution excluding subscription rights, if at least 75% of the share capital represented adopts the resolution. To exclude subscription rights, the Management Board must also make a report available to the shareholders justifying the exclusion and demonstrating that the Company’s interest in excluding the subscription rights outweighs the shareholders’ interest in keeping them. The exclusion of subscription rights upon the issuance of new shares is permitted, in particular, if the Company increases the share capital against cash contributions, if the amount of the capital increase does not exceed 10% of the existing share capital and the issue price of the new shares is not significantly lower than the market price of the Company’s shares. 19.3.4 Provisions governing Changes in the Share Capital German law provides that for an increase of the share capital a resolution of the General Shareholders’ Meeting (Hauptversammlung) which has to be adopted with a majority of at least 75% of the share capital represented at the meeting is needed, unless the articles of association require a different majority. Also permitted is the creation of authorised share capital. The Management Board is hereby authorised to increase the share capital of the Company with the approval of the Supervisory Board (see section 19.1 “Registered Share Capital; Authorised Capital”). Besides, the shareholders may create conditional capital for purposes of issuing (i) shares to holders of convertible bonds or other securities carrying 285 a right to subscribe for shares, (ii) shares serving as consideration in the case of a merger with another company, or (iii) shares intended to be offered to executives and employees, provided that in each case a resolution is adopted by a three-fourths majority of the share capital represented at the adoption of the resolution. The nominal amount of the conditional capital created for purposes of issuing shares to executives and employees may not exceed 10% of the share capital existing at the time the resolution is adopted. The total nominal amount of conditional capital may not exceed 50% of the share capital (at the time the General Shareholders’ Meeting adopts the resolution). Resolutions adopted to reduce the share capital require a 75% majority of the share capital represented at the adoption of the resolution. 19.4 Takeover Offers, Exclusion of Minority Shareholders (Squeeze-Out) and Shareholding Notification Requirements 19.4.1 Mandatory Takeover Offers The Company as a stock corporation (Aktiengesellschaft) which is listed on a regulated market within the meaning of art. 4, para. 1 no. 14 of the Directive 2004/39/EC is – in accordance with the provisions of the German Securities Acquisition and Takeover Act (Wertpapiererwerbs- und Übernahmegesetz — WpÜG ) – considered as a so-called target company (Zielgesellschaft) if a public offer is launched (öffentliches Erwerbs- oder Übernahmeangebot) to acquire part or all of the Company’s shares. In such cases the Management Board (Vorstand) is obliged to refrain from any actions that could result in the frustration of the public takeover bid. In addition, the Management Board (Vorstand) has (Aufsichtsrat) to to work in prepare cooperation and with announce the a Supervisory detailed Board statement (Stellungnahme) concerning the public takeover bid. Under the German Securities Acquisition and Takeover Act any party whose voting rights reach or exceed the threshold of 30% of the voting rights of the Company after admission to listing has to publish this fact, including the percentage of the voting rights held, within seven calendar days via Internet and over an electronic financial news service. Unless an exemption is granted, the party subsequently has to submit a mandatory public tender offer to all shareholders of the Company. 286 19.4.2 Squeeze-out of Minority Shareholders and Integrations The General Shareholders’ Meeting can, pursuant to the provisions of German Stock Corporation Act, at the request of a shareholder holding 95% of the share capital (“Principal Shareholder”), pass a resolution concerning the transfer of the shares of the remaining minority shareholders to the Principal Shareholder. The minority shareholders will in return receive a payment of an appropriate cash settlement. Decisive for the actual amount which is paid to the minority shareholders is “the Company’s situation” at the time the resolution was passed. The amount of the cash settlement must reflect “the Company’s situation” and is based on the full value of the Company, which is determined using the capitalized earnings value calculation (Ertragswertberechnung). The registration of the resolution of the General Shareholders’ Meeting on the squeeze out in the commercial register automatically leads to the transfer of the minority’s shares to the Principal Shareholder. Furthermore, a bidder that holds 95% of the voting share capital of a target company within the meaning of the German Securities Acquisition and Takeover Act (Wertpapiererwerbs- und Übernahmegesetz — WpÜG) after a public takeover or mandatory bid may file an application with the regional court in Frankfurt/Main to issue a court order that transfers the remaining voting shares in return for an adequate compensation. This application has to be filed within a period of three months following the expiration of the acceptance period. A resolution by the General Shareholders’ Meeting is not a precondition for this. The compensation offered has to correspond to the compensation offered in connection with the takeover or mandatory bid and is deemed an appropriate settlement if the bidder has acquired shares from 90% of the share capital addressed by the bid. The provisions relating to the stock corporation law squeeze-out do not apply during the takeover law squeeze-out procedure which is initiated by the bidder. These rules may only apply again after a binding court ruling with respect to the squeeze-out proceedings has been issued. The integration (Eingliederung) of a corporation is subject to a resolution of the General Shareholders’ Meeting. Precondition to such integration is that at least 95% of the shares of the Company to be integrated are held by the future principal company. The former shareholders of the integrated company can claim a suitable settlement. This compensation must generally be granted in the form of shares of the principal company. The amount of the settlement is calculated using 287 a “merger value ratio” (Verschmelzungswertrelation) between the two companies, i.e. the exchange ratio that would be deemed to be appropriate in the event of a merger of the two companies. 19.4.3 Disclosure of Shareholdings in Listed Companies, Reporting and Notification Requirements in Relation to Share Ownerships The German Securities Trading Act (Wertpapierhandelsgesetz — WpHG) requires that anyone who acquires, sells or in some other way reaches, exceeds or falls below 3%, 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 50% or 75% of the voting rights in an issuer whose country of origin is Germany must immediately but no later than within four trading days after the individual or company is aware or should have been aware of the respective changes in voting rights notify the issuer and at the same time the BaFin. The notice can be drafted in either German or English and either sent in writing or via telefax. The notice must include, amongst other things, the individual or entity’s address, the share of voting rights held and the date of reaching, exceeding or falling below the respective threshold. As a domestic issuer, the Company must publish such notices immediately but no later than within three trading days after receiving them via media outlets, including those which one can assume will disseminate the information throughout the EU and in the non-EU contracting parties to the Agreement on the EEA. The Company must also transmit the notice to BaFin and to the electronic Company Register (elektronisches Unternehmensregister) for storage. There are exceptions to the notice requirement: trading activities of investment services enterprises involving up to 5%of voting rights, shares held solely for clearing and settlement purposes or held in safekeeping for short periods of time and acquisitions and sales made for market making purposes. In connection with the disclosure requirements, the German Securities Trading Act (Wertpapierhandelsgesetz — WpHG) contains various provisions to ensure that shareholdings are allocated to the person who actually controls the voting rights attached to the shares. For example, shares belonging to a third party are allocated to a party required to report if the reporting party controls the third party. Similarly, shares held by a third party on behalf of a party required to report, or held by an entity controlled by the party required to report, are allocated to the party that is required to report. If a shareholder willfully fails to file a notice or provides false information, the shareholder is excluded from exercising the rights attached to its shares (including voting and dividend rights) for the duration of the delay. If the failure relates specifically to the share of voting rights held and 288 the shareholder acted willfully or was grossly negligent, the shareholder is generally not permitted to exercise the administrative (voting) rights attaching to its shares for a period of six months after it files the necessary notification. In addition, a fine may be imposed for failure to comply with the notification obligation. Moreover, under the German Securities Trading Act (Wertpapierhandelsgesetz — WpHG), any person who directly or indirectly holds financial or other instruments that grant the holder the unilateral right under a legally binding agreement to acquire previously issued voting shares of an issuer whose country of origin is the Federal Republic of Germany is subject to a notification obligation if the sum of the shares they can so acquire, together with any voting right stakes they may already hold in the issuer or which are attributable to them, reaches, exceeds or falls below any of the thresholds of 3%, 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 50% or 75%. With regard to this any holder of a financial or other instrument not covered by the aforementioned option provision (sec. 25 WpHG), who makes an acquisition of already issued shares crossing the respective notification thresholds of 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 50% or 75% possible, is required to file a notification. To “make possible” covers, in particular, a transfer of risk to the option holder. In case of options and similar transactions, even cash settled, the trigger event has to be considered to have taken place. For calculation of the thresholds all financial and other instruments are added together. Furthermore, the German Securities Trading Act (Wertpapierhandelsgesetz — WpHG) requires any shareholder whose holdings reach or exceed the 10% threshold or a higher threshold to notify the issuer of the aims being pursued with the acquisition of the voting rights and the origin of the funds used for the acquisition within 20 trading days of the date on which the respective threshold is met or exceeded. Once this information is received, and even if no information is received, the issuer has to publish it in the form discussed above, or give notice that the disclosure requirement was not met, within no more than three trading days. The issuer’s articles of association may stipulate that the shareholders are not subject to a notification obligation, but this is not the case for the Company’s Articles of Association. In addition, under the German Securities Acquisition and Takeover Act (Wertpapiererwerbs- und Übernahmegesetz — WpÜG), anyone whose voting rights reach or exceed 30% of the voting shares of the Company is obligated to disclose this fact and the percentage of voting rights held within seven calendar days over the internet and over an electronic financial news service 289 and thereupon, unless granted an exemption, to launch a public mandatory offer to all holders of shares in the Company. The German Securities Acquisition and Takeover Act (Wertpapiererwerbsund Übernahmegesetz — WpÜG) contains a number of provisions intended to ensure that share ownership is correctly attributed to the person who actually controls the voting rights conferred by the shares. Shareholders who fail to disclose that their holdings meet or exceed the 30% threshold or fail to make a public mandatory offer are prohibited from exercising the rights conferred by these shares (including voting rights and the right to receive dividends) until the failure has been remedied. Breaches of the duty of disclosure are also punishable by a fine. 19.4.4 Disclosure of Transactions by Persons Exercising Executive Responsibilities at a Listed Company According to the provisions of the German Securities Trading Act (Wertpapierhandelsgesetz – WpHG) any person discharging managerial responsibilities (“Executives”) within a company, whose shares are admitted to trading or for whose shares admission to trading on a domestic organised market has been requested, is obliged to disclose the purchase and sale of the company’s shares and related financial instruments whenever the value of such transactions amounts to EUR 5,000.00 or more within a calendar year. Executives are, amongst others, members of the Management Board of Supervisory Board or any other Executives who are authorised to make decisions on material corporate matters on behalf of the company and who have regular access to insider information. The notification obligation also applies to natural persons who are closely related to the Executives of the company such as spouses, registered civil partners, children for whom the Executive is liable for maintenance, or relatives who, at the time of the purchase or sale of the company’s shares, have shared the household for at least a year. Furthermore, legal entities and other organisations are also subject to the notification obligation regarding the purchase or sale of the company’s shares (i) if the Executives or persons who are closely related to the Executives discharge managerial responsibilities in such legal entities and organisations, (ii) or the Executives or persons who are closely related to the Executives directly or indirectly control the legal entity or the other organisations, (iii) or if the legal entities or other organisations were set up for the benefit of the Executives or persons who are closely related to the Executives or the economic interests of the legal entity, (iv) or the other organisations are substantially equivalent to those of the Executives or 290 persons who are closely related to the Executives. Notification of the purchase or sale must be made within five business days of the trade date to the company and the German Federal Financial Supervisory Authority (Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht – BaFin). This means that the notification must be received by both company and BaFin no later than on the fifth business day following the trade date (excluding the trade date). When the company receives the notification, the company is required to publish the notification without undue delay and the proof of publication must be forwarded to BaFin without undue delay. The company also has to submit the notification to the business register without undue delay, following the publication of the notification. 291 20. INFORMATION ON THE GOVERNING BODIES OF THE COMPANY 20.1 Overview The governing (Vorstand), the bodies of the Supervisory Company Board are the (Aufsichtsrat) Management and the Board General Shareholders’ Meeting (Hauptversammlung). The powers of the corporate bodies are governed by the German Stock Corporation Act (Aktiengesetz – AktG) and the Articles of Association of the Company (Satzung). Additionally, the rules of procedure of the Management Board (Geschäftsordnung des Vorstands) apply. The Management Board and the Supervisory Board shall cooperate trustfully for the interests of the Company. The Management Board conducts the company’s business in compliance with the applicable laws, the Articles of Association of CSG-AG and the rules of procedure of the Management Board. The rules of procedure may set out a list of matters which require the prior consent of the Supervisory Board. If the Supervisory Board refuses to declare its consent, the Management Board can ask the General Shareholders’ Meeting to resolve this matter, but in general the General Shareholders’ Meeting is not authorised to issue any instructions to the Management Board. The Management Board moreover represents the Company in dealings with third parties. The Management Board is controlled by the Supervisory Board. To enable the Supervisory Board to carry out its monitoring functions the Management Board is obliged to report regularly to the Supervisory Board on matters of current business operations and future business planning at least on a quarterly basis. Any matters involving subsidiaries and/or affiliates which could have a material effect on the Company’s position must be reported to the Chairman of the Supervisory Board (Vorsitzender des Aufsichtsrats). The Management Board and the Supervisory Board work independently from each other. Membership in both bodies at the same time is not permitted, i.e. members of the Management Board must not at the same time be members of the Supervisory Board and vice versa. In addition, a member of the Supervisory Board must not be in an executive position of any of the Company’s subsidiaries (also outside Germany). The Supervisory Board advises the Management Board and is responsible for appointing and dismissing the members of the Management Board. The Supervisory Board is not entitled to engage in managing activities, however. 292 In dealings between members of the Management Board and the Company itself, the Supervisory Board represents the Company. To ensure an effective control of the Management Board the Supervisory Board is entitled to request special reports from the Management Board at any time. The members of the Management Board as well as the Supervisory Board must apply the due care of a prudent and conscientious manager in performing their duties. Therefore the members of the governing bodies must take into account the interests of the Company, its shareholders, employees and creditors in all their actions. It is moreover required from the members of the Management Board to consider the concept of equal treatment and equal information of shareholders. In case of a breach of duty the members of the Management Board as well as of the Supervisory Board are jointly and severally liable to the Company for damages. In case of a breach of duty committed by the members of the Management Board or the Supervisory Board which leads to damages suffered by the Company only the Company itself is entitled to raise a claim against the members whereas shareholders cannot take direct actions against the members of the governing bodies. Thus given normal circumstances the Company will claim compensation itself. In specific cases, the Management Board can also be held personally liable by third parties, e.g. non-payment of social security charges, damages resulting from tort, incorrect statements in connection with corporate transactions. The German Stock Corporation Act further contains an exemplary list of acts which directly trigger the Management Board’s liability, e.g. in case of the repayment of contributions to the shareholders or the unlawful distribution of the Company’s assets. In the event of claims against the Supervisory Board the Company will be represented by the members of the Management Board and in case of claims against the Management Board the Supervisory Board will take over the representation. Pursuant to a decision of the German Federal Supreme Court (Bundesgerichtshof) the Supervisory Board is obliged to raise any enforceable claim for compensation against the Management Board unless significant reasons relating to the Company’s welfare render the assertion of such a claim unadvisable. If a compensatory claim is not pursued by the respective body, the General Shareholders’ Meeting can resolve with a simple majority to enforce the right for compensation. Shareholders whose capital collectively represents 10% or more of the Company’s share capital or EUR 1,000,000.00 may request the appointment of a representative who is to enforce the claim for compensatory damages. At the time the application is filed shareholders whose capital constitutes 1% or more of the Company’s 293 share capital or a notional value of the share capital of at least EUR 100,000.00 may ask for the assertion of the compensatory claim in their own name before the Regional Court (Landgericht) at the Company’s registered domicile for the enforcement of claims for compensation. Certain preconditions have to be fulfilled for the admission of such a claim. The shareholders must have unsuccessfully demanded from the Company to raise the claim, combined with setting of an appropriate deadline for taking action. Facts must indicate that the Company has suffered damages from impropriety or gross violation of the law or of the articles of association. The right to take action itself remains with the Company at any time. Thus pending approval or action proceedings of the shareholders are rendered inadmissible if the Company takes legal action. The German Stock Corporation Act stipulates that the Company cannot in advance limit or fully release the personal liability of the members of the Management Board for breaches of duty in the performance of their official tasks. The Company can waive its claim for damages for a breach of duty, or it can propose an agreement on such claims only if more than three years have passed since the date on which the claim arose. This is subject to the approval of the General Shareholders’ Meeting and a minority of at least 10% of the shareholders can block such a resolution. 20.2 Management Board 20.2.1 General provisions on the Management Board The Management Board legally represents the Company in court and in dealings with third parties and bears the sole responsibility for managing the day-to-day business of the Company. The Company´s Articles of Association determine that the Management Board consists of one or more members. The Management Board of the Company currently consists of three members. Members of the Management Board are appointed by the Supervisory Board. The maximum period for such a nomination is five years. The Supervisory Board may nominate a member of the Management Board as chairman and another member as deputy chairman. The members of the Management Board are appointed for a maximum term of five years and this term can be renewed for consecutive further periods of up to five years each. The appointment of a member can be revoked by the Supervisory Board prior to the expiration of his or her term in office for good cause, such as a gross breach of fiduciary duties or if the General Shareholders’ Meeting passes a no-confidence resolution in relation to the respective member. Revocations of 294 appointments are immediately effective until a court issues a ruling on the missing of the cause for the revocation in question. According to the Company’s Articles of Association, the Company is legally represented by the members of the Management Board. In case only one member exists, the Company is legally represented by the sole member. In case the Management Board is composed of two or more members, the Company is legally represented by two members jointly or by one member together with a commercial attorney-in-fact (Prokurist). The Supervisory Board may also grant sole power of representation to individual or all members of the Management Board and exempt them from the obligations pursuant to sec. 181 alternative 2 of the German Civil Code (Bürgerliches Gesetzbuch – BGB). Sec. 112 of the German Stock Cooperation Act remains unaffected. The Supervisory Board has granted Mr. Nang Heung Sze sole power of representation and has granted Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi exemptions to the restrictions of sec. 181 alternative 2 of the German Civil Code by means of a resolution dated 26 May 2010. Mr. Chi-Hsiang Michael Lee was also granted exemptions to the restrictions of sec. 181 alternative 2 of the German Civil Code by means of the resolution of the Supervisory Board according to which he was appointed member of the Management Board in October 2010. The rights and obligations of the Management Board of the Company are specified in the German Stock Corporation Act, in the Company’s Articles of Association, the Rules of Procedure of the Management Board and the service contracts of the members of the Management Board. Further, the Management Board has to consider the German Corporate Governance Code, which is mandatory for companies listed in the Regulated Market in Germany. Neither the shareholders nor the Supervisory Board members may issue binding directions to the Management Board regarding the management of the Company. Thus, the Management Board has a strong independent position within the Company. However, the powers of the members of the Management Board may be limited by e.g. the Company’s Articles of Association or by Rules of Procedure of the Management Board by stipulating that certain matters require the consent of the Supervisory Board or the shareholders in General Shareholders’ Meeting. Such limitations do not, however, affect the validity of the actions of the Management Board vis-à-vis third parties but the Management Board might be liable internally in relation to the Company. 295 The internal organization of the Management Board of the Company is specified in Rules of Procedure. These rules determine the areas of responsibility of the whole Management Board, of the Chairman of the Management Board and the individual Management Board members. It also contains regulations on the meetings of the Management Board as well as the relationships between the Management Board and the Supervisory Board and includes a list of activities which require the consent of the Supervisory Board. The Management Board passes resolutions by a simple majority provided no other majorities are stipulated by law, the Company’s Articles of Association or the Management Board’s rules of procedure. 20.2.2 The Members of the Company’s Management Board Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi were nominated as members of the Management Board by a resolution of the Supervisory Board of 26 May 2010 taking immediate effect for a term of five years. Mr. Chi Man Wong who was also nominated as member of the Management Board by resolution of the Supervisory Board on 26 May 2010 left his office in October 2010 after the Supervisory Board resolved in October 2010 to revoke the appointment of Mr. Chi Mang Wong as member of the Management Board with immediate effect and to appoint Mr. Chi-Hsiang Michael Lee as new member of the Management Board. The following table lists the current members of the Management Board and their current areas of responsibility: Name Age Initially Appointed in Term Expires in Responsibility Mr. Nang Heung Sze 51 2010 2015 CEO 30 2010 2015 COO 43 2010 2013 CFO 施能响 Mr. Chun Li Shi 施纯力 Mr. Chi-Hsiang Michael Lee 296 Mr. Nang Heung Sze Mr. Nang Heung Sze is the Chief Executive Officer (CEO) of the Company and he is also the sole director of HWG HK-Holding as well as the indirect founder of HWG-Ltd. In 1997, HWG-Ltd. produced the first piece of “Made-in-China” bulletproof glass which was jointly developed with the Guangdong Provincial Public Security Department. For this product, Mr. Sze was granted the patent certificate. For this reason, he was awarded an honorary doctorate by Hong Kong Academy of Sciences. He has extensive experience in bulletproof glass manufacturing and administration. He is the Chairman of Guangdong Province Mingnan Chamber of Commerce, the vice-chairman of Guangdong Province Returned Overseas Association and the Founder Chairman of Shishi Shilang Research Society. Over the last five years, Mr. Nang Heung Sze was a member of the administrative, management and supervisory bodies or partner of the following companies or partnerships outside of the China Specialty Glass-Group: · Luckyway Global Group Limited: Director from May 2010 until present date · Ma Men Holding (HK) Limited: Director from October 1999 to 23 December 2009 · Xi’an Mamen Security Technology Co., Ltd.: Director from August 2001 to September 2007 · Guangzhou Shiweishi Security Technology Stock Co., Ltd.: Director and chairman from February 2005 to September 2007 · Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Products Co., Ltd.: Director from March 2001 to September 2010 (deregistration of this company) Mr. Chun Li Shi Mr. Chun Li Shi who is the Chief Operating Officer (COO) of the Company studied business management at the Management Development Institute, Singapore, and graduated with a diploma in 2000. Furthermore, Mr. Chun Li Shi graduated from Hong Kong Open University in 2006 with a MBA degree in business administration. He joined the Group in 2001 and was responsible for 297 the sales department and the administrative department as head of the departments. He also worked in the production department and was appointed as general manager of HWG-Ltd. in 2004. He is a member of the committee of Chinese People’s Political Consultative Conference, Liwan District, Guangzhou. Over the last five years, Mr. Chun Li Shi was a member of the administrative, management and supervisory bodies or partner of the following companies or partnerships outside of the China Specialty Glass-Group: · Guangzhou Property Management Center: Sole Director from 5 December 2007 until the present date · Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Products Co., Ltd.: Director and chairman from June 2003 to September 2010 (deregistration of this company) · Xi’an Mamen Security Technology Co., Ltd.: Director from August 2001 to September 2007 · Guangzhou Shiweishi Security Technology Stock Co., Ltd.: Director from February 2005 to September 2007 Mr. Chi-Hsiang Michael Lee Mr. Chi-Hsiang Michael Lee is the Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”) of the Company and joined the Group in October 2010. He obtained a Bachelor of Science, Finance and Business Economics degree from the University of Southern California, Marshall School of Business, Los Angeles, USA, in 1990 and was awarded a Master of Accounting degree from the University of Southern California, Leventhal School of Accounting, Los Angeles, in 1999. Mr. Lee is a Certified Public Accountant (California, USA) and member of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA). Mr. Lee has more than 19 years’ professional working experience as senior business manager and auditor. He started his career at American Express Business & Tax Services in Los Angeles in 1991 before joining the international auditing firm KPMG, Los Angeles, in 1994 where he worked as a manager until 2002. From 2002 until 2005, Mr. Lee worked as a director at PriceWaterhouseCoopers (PWC) in the greater China area and from 2005 until September 2010, he was a managing partner at the international consulting firm Summit International Capital Advisory in Shanghai, China. He served as a member of the managing board of the public listed (Frankfurt Stock Exchange) Sino International Logistic Company NV from 2006 to May 2010. 298 Over the last five years, Mr. Lee has been a member of an administrative, management and supervisory body or partner of the following companies or partnerships outside of China Specialty Glass-Group: · Summit International Capital Advisory: managing partner from 2005 until September 2010 · Sino International Logistic Company NV: member of the managing board from 2006 to May 2010 Apart from Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi who is the son of Mr. Nang Heung Sze there is no family relationship between the members of the Management Board. 20.2.3 Compensation of the members of the Management Board The compensation is paid pursuant to the different employment agreements of the several members of the Management Board with the Company and the Group, respectively. The members of the Management Board receive salaries on an annual basis. These salaries consist of monthly payments and certain additional social benefits. The tables below provide an overview over the gross remuneration and the social benefits paid to the current members of the Management Board for the financial year 2010 and 2011 (expected): Compensation in 2010 Name Annual Salary Social Securities Others total Sze, Nang Heung € 18,182.48 € 311.26 € 1,346.85 € 19,840.59 Shi, Chun Li € 16,162.21 € 527.40 € 1,346.85 € 18,036.46 Lee, Chi Hsiang Michael € 13,254.06 €0 €0 € 13,254.06 For his services in the financial year 2010, Mr. Chi Man Wong who is still employed by the Group received around EUR 44,000 from the Group which also includes his compensation as member of the Management Board during his term of office. 299 Compensation in 2011 (expected) Name Annual Salary Social Securities Others total Sze, Nang Heung € 18,038.68 €0 €0 € 18,038.68 Shi, Chun Li € 16,034.38 € 580.84 € 6,680.99 € 23,296.21 Lee, Chi Hsiang Michael € 80,171.92 €0 €0 € 80,171.92 The members of the Management Board are insured up to a certain amount under a directors and officers insurance (D & O insurance) against claims arising in connection with their conduct as members of the Management Board. The premiums of this insurance are to be borne by the Company. In accordance with the German Stock Corporation Act the insurance contains a deductible of at least 10% of the damage caused that amounts to at least one and a half times the fixed yearly income of the Management Board member. Other remuneration than set out above are not provided by the Company or the Group to the members of the Management Board. 20.2.4 Shareholding and Options Apart from Mr. Nang Heung Sze who indirectly holds 11,194,957 shares (74.39%) of the Company through Luckyway Global Group Limited none of the members of the Management neither holds directly nor indirectly shares, stock options or stock appreciation rights in the Company. 20.2.5 Conflicts of Interest Potential conflicts may arise from Mr. Nang Heung Sze’s (indirect) shareholdings in the Company since he has personal interests in the development of the value of the shares in the Company. In this respect, further conflicts may arise from the family relationship between Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi on the one hand and the Company on the other hand and they may not decide in the Company’s best interests. Similar conflicts of interests exist and may arise in the future with regard to other related party transactions involving or affecting Mr. Nang Heung Sze or Mr. Chun Li Shi (see section 22 “Related Party Transaction”). 300 Otherwise, there are no potential conflicts of interests between any duties of the members of the Management Board and their private interests or other duties. 20.3 Supervisory Board 20.3.1 General provisions on the Supervisory Board As stated in the Company´s Articles of Association, the Supervisory Board consists of three members. The members are appointed by the General Shareholders’ Meeting in compliance with the statutory requirements of the German Stock Corporation Act. The term of each Supervisory Board member expires at the end of the annual General Shareholders’ Meeting that resolves on the exoneration of the actions of the Supervisory Board Members (Entlastung) for the fourth fiscal year following commencement of the member’s term of office. The fiscal year in which the term commences is not included. Each member of the Supervisory Board can be re-elected. The General Shareholders’ Meeting can provide for a shorter term of office. A successor to any Supervisory Board Member retiring prior to the expiration of his or her term is appointed for the remainder of the term of the departed Supervisory Board Member. A substitute member may be appointed together with a member of the Supervisory Board. The substitute member replaces the Supervisory Board member in the event of his or her departing before the end of his/her term. The term of office of the substitute member expires upon the election of a successor for the departed member, but no later than the expiry of the term of office of the departed member of the Supervisory Board. Pursuant to the Company´s Articles of Association, any member or substitute member of the Supervisory Board may resign without providing a reason, by giving one month’s notice to the chairman of the Supervisory Board or to the Management Board. The Supervisory Board appoints a chairman and a deputy chairman from among its members. Should the chairman or the deputy chairman leave office prior to the expiration of his or her scheduled term of office, the board must elect a new chairman or deputy chairman for the departing chairman’s or deputy chairman’s remaining term of office. The chairmen or, if unable to attend, the deputy chairman, is obligated to convene and conduct the meetings of the Supervisory Board. The Supervisory Board is not entrusted with the day-to-day business and 301 therefore cannot set binding directives for the Management Board. However, according to the Rules of Procedure for the Management Board, certain transactions are subject to the Supervisory Board’s consent. The Supervisory Board is responsible for appointment of the members of the Management Board and can revoke them for good cause such as gross breach of fiduciary duties. The most important tasks of the Supervisory Board is the advice, control and supervision of the business operated by the Management Board. This advisory and supervisory role covers all the activities of the Management Board. In assessing the Management Board’s activities, the Supervisory Board is not limited to the assessment of the legitimacy of the activities but its supervision also includes the appropriateness and economic consequences of the activities. In order to enable the Supervisory Board to fulfil its tasks, the Management Board is obliged to report to the Supervisory Board on a regular basis. The Supervisory Board (and each of its members) can request a report from the Management Board to the Supervisory Board on the transactions of the Company, on legal and business relations with affiliated companies and on the course of business of these companies, in so far as they are of economic importance to the Company. Every member of the Supervisory Board is entitled to review these reports. The Supervisory Board can also arrange for special audits and investigations of the work of the Management Board, in particular the examination of certain transactions and the books of the Company. The Supervisory Board has a limited right of representation. It represents the Company in legal transactions and in the event of legal disputes with members of the Management Board. Furthermore, the Supervisory Board represents the Company together with the Management Board in the event of an action to challenge a General Shareholders’ Meeting resolution brought by a shareholder. The members of the Supervisory Board are jointly responsible for performing their duties. Certain tasks can be assigned to a committee or to individual members of the Supervisory Board. The Supervisory Board has to consider the German Corporate Governance Code, which is mandatory for companies listed in the Regulated Market in Germany. 302 The members of the Supervisory Board are guided by the interests of the Company. They represent neither solely the shareholders nor the employees and must therefore consider the interests of the Company in their decisions and actions. The interests of the Company include the interests of the shareholders and the workforce and, to a certain extent, the interests of the public. The members of the Supervisory Board act entirely independently and on their own account. The Supervisory Board may adopt rules of procedure by way of a resolution. Such rules may define the rights and obligations of committees that the Supervisory Board can appoint from among its members and to whom the board can delegate responsibilities. The Supervisory Board must hold a meeting twice in each half of the calendar year. Resolutions of the board are generally passed in meetings. Pursuant to the Company´s Articles of Association, resolutions may be passed without a meeting in writing, by telephone, in text form, in electronic or another comparable form, especially by videoconference or in a combination of all the abovementioned procedures, provided that the chairman of the Supervisory Board so determines in an individual case. According to the German Stock Corporation Act the Supervisory Board is quorate if at least three members of the Supervisory Board participate in a vote on a resolution. The Supervisory Board adopts resolutions by a simple majority of the votes cast, unless a different majority is required by law or the Company´s Articles of Association. 20.3.2 The Members of the Company’s Supervisory Board By means of the deed of incorporation (Gründungsurkunde) the founder of the Company has elected Mr. Matthias Beer, Ms. Randi Mette Selnes and Ms. Edith Blum as members of the first Supervisory Board of the shelf company. All of the aforementioned members of the first Supervisory Board who had been appointed until the end of the General Shareholders’ Meeting deciding about the formal exoneration of the actions of the Supervisory Board for the short fiscal year 2010 resigned from their offices on 26 May 2010 by way of a resignation declaration dated 10 May 2010. The General Shareholders’ Meeting elected Mr. Helmut Meyer, Mr. Xin Yong Shi and Mr. Shun Yao Huang as members of the Supervisory Board on 27 May 2010. Mr. Shun Yao Huang resigned from his office as member of the Supervisory Board by resignation letter in October 2010. The General 303 Shareholders’ Meeting held on 29 October 2010 elected Mr. Volker Schlegel as member of the Supervisory Board. Mr. Helmut Meyer, Mr. Xin Yong Shi and Mr. Volker Schlegel were re-elected in the General Shareholders’ Meeting held in May 2011. Therefore, the following members of the Supervisory Board are currently in office: Age Initially Appointed in Term Expires in Mr. Helmut Meyer 62 2010 2016 Chairman Mr. Xin Yong Shi 50 2010 2016 Deputy Chairman Mr. Volker Schlegel 69 2010 2016 Member Name Responsibility Mr. Helmut Meyer Mr. Helmut Meyer is the Chairman of the Supervisory Board. Mr. Helmut Meyer studied economics at the University of Hamburg, Germany, and graduated in 1976. He began his career at Allgemeine Deutsche Philips GmbH, Hamburg, in 1977 as Assistant Controlling. From 1978 until 1989 Mr. Meyer worked for AEG, Hamburg, Division Shipbuilding, Aircraft and Special Equipment, in various positions, ultimately as CFO Division Marine Technology. Between 1990 and 1994 Mr. Meyer worked as CFO and as Personnel Director for STN Systemtechnik Nord GmbH, Bremen, Germany, a company that developed and produced electronic equipment for ships, aircraft and military vehicles. In the subsequent years 1995 – 2003 Mr. Meyer served as CFO for one and CEO for another company of the Siempelkamp Group, an international supplier of equipment in the field of plant engineering, nuclear technology and foundry markets. Between 2003 and 2009 Mr. Meyer was CFO and Personnel Director of DEUTZ AG, Cologne, Germany. Since 2009, he works as a management consultant and board member in small- and medium-sized industrial companies. Over the last five years, Mr. Meyer was a member of the administrative, management and supervisory bodies or partner of the following companies or partnerships outside of the China Specialty Glass-Group: 304 · DEUTZ AG: CFO and Personnel Director 2003 – 2009 Mr. Xin Yong Shi Mr. Xin Yong Shi is the Deputy Chairman of the Supervisory Board. Mr. Xin Yong Shi graduated from Wuhan Building Material Industry College with a degree in Inorganic Material Engineering (Glass) in 1982. Since graduating, Mr. Xin Yong Shi has been occupied continually with scientific work at the China Building Materials Academy in Beijing and has been a member of various technical committees. Over the last five years, Mr. Xin Yong Shi has not been a member of the administrative, management and supervisory body or partner of a company or partnership outside China Specialty Glass-Group. Mr. Volker Schlegel Mr. Volker Schlegel is a member of the Supervisory Board. Mr. Volker Schlegel studied law and economics at the Universities in Bonn, Freiburg and Cologne, Germany. He began his career in Foreign Ministry of German federal government in 1972 (in the Political and the Economic department). From 1978 until 1982 Mr. Schlegel worked for KHD Humboldt Wedag in Cologne and Bochum as the Head of Central Marketing. Between 1982 and 2008 Mr. Schlegel had various diplomatic functions and responsibilities for the German government as the Head of the Economic Department in the German embassy in Iran and the USA; in the Foreign Ministry as the Director for Cabinet and Parliament Affairs; as the German Ambassador in Singapore; as Head of the German embassies in Senegal, Mali, Bahamas, Belize and Jamaica; he also was Under-Secretary of State in the government of the State of Hamburg. Since 2009, he works as a legal counsel for foreign trade and export control at Luther Rechtsanwaltsgesellschaft mbH. He offers advice to clients in their commercial activities in the USA and Asia. Over the last five years, Mr. Schlegel was a member of the administrative, management and supervisory bodies or partner of the following companies or partnerships outside of the China Specialty Glass-Group: · Management Engineers GmbH + Co. KG: Member of the Advisory Board from 2000 until present date 305 · Migosens GmbH: Member of the Advisory Board from 2009 until present date 20.3.3 Compensation of the Members of the Supervisory Board As stated in the Company´s Articles of Association, compensation for the members of the Supervisory Board is to be constituted by the General Shareholders’ Meeting. For members who only belong to the Supervisory Board for part of the fiscal year, the compensation is determined for a proportionate period of time. Fixed compensation is due and payable at the end of the fiscal year. The members of the Supervisory Board will receive compensation for the financial year 2010 and the following years. The amount for the short financial year 2010 was determined by a resolution of the General Shareholders’ Meeting in May 2011: Member Helmut Meyer Xin Young Shi Shun Yao Huang Volker Schlegel Appointed on Compensation 27 May 2010 EUR 35,000.00 27 May 2010 EUR 20,000.00 27 May 2010¹ EUR 10,995.76 29 October 2010 EUR 4,067.80 ¹ Term ended on 29 October 2010. For 2011 the General Shareholders’ Meeting has determined a compensation of EUR 30,000.00 per Supervisory Board member. The chairman of the Supervisory Board shall receive an additional EUR 20,000.00, i.e. a total compensation of EUR 50,000.00. The members of the Supervisory Board are insured up to a certain amount under the current directors and officers insurance against claims arising in connection with their conduct as members of the Supervisory Board. The premiums of this insurance are borne by the Company. A deductible regarding a percentage of the damage caused to be borne by the respective member of the Supervisory Board is not contained in the insurance. In addition, the members of the Supervisory Board are to be reimbursed for their expenses and the amount of VAT which may be due on their remuneration, provided that they are entitled to charge the Company VAT and that they exercise this right. 306 The Company declares that no additional remuneration or benefits are paid by the issuer or its subsidiaries. 20.3.4 Shareholding and Options None of the members of the Supervisory Board has a direct or indirect share ownership or any options over such shares in the Company. 20.3.5 Conflicts of Interest As Luther Rechtsanwaltsgesellschaft mbH is acting as legal adviser to the Underwriters in connection with the Offering, a conflict of interest may arise between the duties of Mr. Volker Schlegel as member of the Supervisory Board and his activities as legal counsel of Luther Rechtsanwaltsgesellschaft mbH. There are no potential further conflicts of interests between any duties of the members of the Supervisory Board and their private interests or other duties. 20.4 Certain Information on the Members of the Supervisory Board and the Management Board None of the members of the Management Board and the Supervisory Board has been convicted of criminal fraud or other fraudulent activities during the five years prior to the date of this Prospectus. The members of the Management Board and the Supervisory Board, in their capacity as members of administrative, management or supervisory bodies or members of senior management of other companies, were not affected by the insolvency or liquidation of any such company. Moreover, the members of the governing bodies have investigative not been processes subject and/or of any penalties preliminary or fines investigations imposed by or public authorities (including any professional organizations or other professional associations). Nor has any court of law, during the last five years prior to the date of this Prospectus, held them to be unfit for any activity as a member of an administrative, management or supervisory body of a company that has issued securities (issuer) or as a member of the management or Management Board of an issuer. The Company has not granted loans to the members of the governing bodies or assumed guarantees or warranties in respect of them. Except as otherwise stated in section 22 “Related Party Transaction” the members of the Management Board and the Supervisory Board were not and are not involved in any transactions outside of the normal business operations, or in any other 307 unusual transactions during the time for which financial reports were provided in this Prospectus. Apart from Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi who is the son of Mr. Nang Heung Sze none of the members of the Management Board and the Supervisory Board is a member of the same family. None of the members of the Supervisory Board has been appointed or employed elsewhere based on a contract or other such agreement between the relevant member and a third party. There are no service agreements between the Company, its subsidiaries and any of the members of the governing bodies under which a member would receive benefits from the Company or its subsidiaries on the termination of his or her activity. Members of the Management Board and the Supervisory Board may be contacted at the Company’s business address at An den Roemerhuegeln 1, 82031 Gruenwald, Germany. 20.5 General Shareholders’ Meeting The General Shareholders’ Meeting is held at the Company’s registered office, in another German city which has a stock exchange or in a German city with more than 250,000 inhabitants. According to the German Stock Corporation Act, the meeting must be convened thirty days before the meeting itself. The invitation to the general shareholder’s meeting has to be published in the electronic version of the German Federal Gazette at least thirty days before the day of the meeting or at least thirty days before notice of attendance has to be given, excluding the day of the invitation and the day of the meeting or the day notice of attendance has to be given. Shortly after the convocation of the General Shareholders’ Meeting the Company must publish certain information on their website such as the content of the invitation, an illustration if no resolution is concluded in regard to a certain point of the agenda, the documents available in the meeting, the total amount of shares and of the voting rights, including separate information on the different total amounts concerning the varying classes of shares and - if necessary - the formulas needed to vote by proxy or to issue a postal vote. The Company´s Articles of Association regulate that shareholders who want to attend the meeting and exercise their voting rights within the meeting must register six days prior to the General Shareholders Meeting, not counting the day of the meeting and the day the registration is received. The 308 registration must be made to the Company under the address announced in the convocation. The registration has to be issued in text form (sec. 126b German Civil Code), either in German or English. Shareholders must provide proof regarding their eligibility to participate in the General Shareholders’ Meeting. In this regard, a special confirmation of shareholding by the custodian bank is required and sufficient. With regard to such shares which are not deposited with a custodian bank, this special confirmation of shareholding may also be provided by a German notary or credit institution. The special confirmation of shareholding has to be submitted in text form (sec. 126b BGB), either in German or English. This document must refer to the 21st day prior to the meeting and must be submitted to the company via the address stated in the convocation at least six days prior to the meeting. The day of the General Shareholders’ Meeting and the day on which the registration is received is not to be counted. Details on the proof of eligibility, the issue of admission tickets and registration have to be announced in the convocation. The voting rights may be exercised by proxy. The German Stock Corporation Act and the Company´s Articles of Association state that if the shareholder empowers more than one person, the Company may reject one or more of the so-empowered persons. Each no-par value share carries one vote at the General Shareholders’ Meeting of the Company. Neither German law nor the Company´s Articles of Association restrict the rights of foreign shareholders or shareholders who are not domiciled in Germany to hold shares or to exercise the voting rights attached to them. The General Shareholders’ Meeting adopts resolutions regarding, in particular: · the appointment of members of the Supervisory Board; · the appropriation of the retained earnings (Bilanzgewinn); · the formal approval of acts of the members of the Management and Supervisory Board; · the appointment of the auditor; · amendments to the articles of association; · capital procurement and capital reduction measures; · the appointment of auditors to control the formation and management of the Company and 309 · the liquidation of the Company. Measures of the Management Board can only be subject to a decision of the General Shareholders’ Meeting if the Management Board requests such decision. Unless otherwise stipulated by mandatory statutory provisions or provisions of the Company´s Articles of Association, resolutions of the shareholders’ meeting may be adopted by a simple majority of the votes cast. If statutory provisions in non-mandatory form require a majority of the capital represented, a simple majority of the capital represented at the adoption of the resolution is sufficient. Principally, this also applies to resolutions amending the Company´s Articles of Association and to capital increases and capital reductions, unless a different majority is required by law. Stock corporation law constitutes that resolutions of fundamental importance must be passed by a majority of at least three-quarters of the registered share capital represented at the meeting. In such cases, the stipulated majority exceeds the majority prescribed by the Company´s Articles of Association. Resolutions of fundamental importance include the following: · amendments to the Company’s Articles of Association; · capital increases excluding shareholders’ subscription rights; · capital reductions; · the creation of authorised or conditional capital; · the transfer of the Company’s entire assets (Übertragung des gesamten Gesellschaftsvermögens) and reorganizations as laid down in the German Transformation Act (Umwandlungsgesetz) such as mergers (Verschmelzungen), spin-offs (Spaltungen) or transfer of the Company’s assets and transformations of the Company’s corporate legal form (Formwechsel); · the conclusion of inter-Company agreements (in particular control agreements and profit pooling agreements) and · the dissolution of the Company. The General Shareholders’ Meeting may be called by the Management Board, the Supervisory Board or by shareholders holding an aggregate of at least 5% of the registered share capital. The Supervisory Board must call a 310 General Shareholders’ Meeting if the best interests of the Company require so. The General Shareholders’ Meeting must be held within the first eight months of each fiscal year. 20.6 Corporate Governance The German Corporate Governance Code (the “Code”) contains provisions concerning shareholders and the General Shareholders’ Meeting of German companies listed on a stock exchange. The regulations of the Code also relate to the Management Board, the Supervisory Board and to transparency, accounting policies and auditing. Although there is no obligation under German law to comply with the recommendations and suggestions of the Code, sec. 161 of the German Stock Corporation Act requires the Management Board and the Supervisory Board of a listed company to make an annual declaration that it follows and will follow the recommendations of the Code or which of the recommendations were or will not to be followed. In the last case the declaration must include the reasons for not following the Code. The declaration has to be published on the company’s website. The Company has not intentionally complied with the recommendations and suggestions contained in the Code yet because it has so far not been listed on any stock exchange and therefore the Code did not apply to the Company. Once the Company is granted admission to trade on the regulated market of the Frankfurt Stock Exchange, the Company is required to annually issue and publish a declaration in compliance with sec. 161 of the German Stock Corporation Act. As required the Company will make the declaration continuously available on its website. The Management Board and the Supervisory Board of the Company identify with the goals of the Code to foster responsible and transparent corporate management and control, oriented to a sustained increase in Company value. The members of governing bodies declare that they will mainly follow the recommendations and suggestions of the Code. Details will be subject to an agreement between the Management Board and the Supervisory Board. Since all members of the Management Board of the Company are mainly located outside of Germany it will be difficult for them to act in compliance with the German standards for corporate governance (see section 3.1.8 “The Management Board of the Company Is Not Experienced with German Legal 311 Requirements for Listed Companies and Has No German Language Skills and Only One Member of the Management Board Speaks English Fluently. In addition, the Group Currently only Has Small Finance and Accounting Departments with Limited Experience. Furthermore, the Group Currently Does Not Have a Comprehensive Risk Management System or Comprehensive System of Internal Control”). The Management Board of the Company will receive training and constant legal advice on its duties arising from the Corporate Governance Code and of its duties vis-à-vis the Supervisory Board arising from the German Stock Corporation Act. The Supervisory Board is aware that – because of the linguistic differences and the geographical distance – it may be more difficult to fulfil its supervisory duties arising from the German Stock Corporation Act, for example with regard to the duties stated in sec. 111 of the German Stock Corporation Act. The Company refrains from the implementation of an audit committee and a remuneration committee. 312 21. SHAREHOLDER STRUCTURE (BEFORE AND AFTER THE OFFERING) The Company was founded on 10 May 2010 as a shelf company by Blitzstart Holding AG and was acquired by Luckyway Global Group Limited on 26 May 2010 (see section 18.1 “Formation, Entry in the Commercial Register, Company Name and Registered Office”). Prior to the IPO, the Company increased the registered share capital from EUR 50,000.00 by EUR 15,000,000.00 to EUR 15,050,000.00 through the issuance of an aggregate of 15,000,000 shares against contribution in kind. Due to the contribution of all shares in HWG HK-Holding into the Company in November 2010, Luckyway Global Group Limited, Quick Reach Group Limited, Expert Intelligence Global Limited, Sea Dragon Investments Limited and Hong Kong Investments Group Limited which are the sole shareholders of HWG HK-Holding acquired all shares of the Company which were issued due to the aforementioned capital increase and of which 11,144,957 shares were issued to Luckyway Global Group Limited (which as Founding Shareholder already held 50,000 shares), 735,568 shares were issued to Quick Reach Group Limited, 524,928 shares were issued to Expert Intelligence Global Limited, 1,694,034 shares were issued to Sea Dragon Investments Limited and 900,513 shares were issued to Hong Kong Investments Group Limited (see section 18.4 “Group Structure and Recent Corporate Developments of the Group”). The capital increase became legally effective with its entry into the commercial register of the local court of Munich on 22 November 2010. The following table presents an overview of the Company’s shareholder structure before and after the implementation of the Offering based on the information provided to the Company: 313 Shareholder Shareholding Before implementation of the Offering After implementation of the Offering with full implementation of the capital increase and excluding exercise of the Greenshoe Option After implementation of the Offering with full implementation of the capital increase and full exercise of the Greenshoe Option Shares (in %) Shares (in %) Shares (in %) 11,194,957 74.39 11,194,957 53.18 10,525,491 50.00 Quick Reach Group Limited 735,568 4.89 735,568 3.49 691,580 3.29 Expert Intelligence Global Limited 524,928 3.49 524,928 2.49 493,537 2.34 1,694,034 11.26 1,694,034 8.05 1,592,730 7.57 900,513 5.98 900,513 4.28 846,662 4.02 0 0.00 6,000,000 28.50 6,900,000 32.78 15,050,000 100.00 21,050,000 100.00 21,050,000 100.00 Luckyway Global Group Limited Sea Dragon Investments Limited Hong Kong Investments Group Limited Free Float Total 314 22. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS A party is considered to be related to China Specialty Glass-Group if the party as at the time of the transaction, directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries controls, is controlled by, or is under common control with China Specialty Glass-Group, has an interest in China Specialty Glass-Group that gives it significant influence over China Specialty Glass-Group, has joint control over China Specialty Glass-Group, is an associate of China Specialty Glass-Group, is a joint venture in which China Specialty Glass-Group is a venturer, is a member of the key management personnel of China Specialty Glass-Group or of any parent company of China Specialty Glass-Group, or is a close family member of any such member of key management personnel or of any individual who directly or indirectly controls, is controlled by or is under common control with China Specialty Glass-Group. China Specialty Glass-Group maintains business relationships with related parties. The following business or legal relationships exist from 1 January 2008 to the date of this Prospectus or existed in this period between companies of China Specialty Glass-Group and related parties. In the view of the Company they were entered on normal market terms and conditions and concluded at arm’s length, except as expressly stated below. In addition to the companies of the Group and the members of the Management Board and the Supervisory Board of the Company, the following persons and entities are considered to be related parties to the Group within the period under review. Related Party (natural person) Relation to China Specialty Glass-Group Mr. Nang Heung Sze CEO and indirect major shareholder of the Company through Luckyway Global Group Limited which holds 70.67% of the Company’s shares as at the date of the Prospectus; director of HWG-Ltd. from 10/1994 until 12/2000 and from 09/2004 until 01/2008 as well as director of HWG HK-Holding from 07/2007 until present date. Mr. Chun Li Shi Member of the Management Board and son of Mr. Nang Heung Sze as well as director of HWG-Ltd. from 09/2004 until present date. 315 Related party (legal entity) Relation to China Specialty Glass-Group Guangzhou Property The shares were held by Mr. Nang Heung Sze (100%) and were transferred Management Center to Mr. Chun Li Shi on 1 March 2006 who is until present date the sole shareholder of Guangzhou Property Management. HK Chung Hwa The shares are indirectly held by Mr. Nang Heung Sze (100%). Ma Mr. Nang Heung Sze held 99.9% of the shares and sold/transferred all his Men Holdings (HK) Limited shares to a non-related third party on 23 February 2010. Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Products Subsidiary which had been wholly owned by Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited and was deregistered on 20 September 2010 after voluntary winding-up. Co.,Ltd. Xi’an Mamen Subsidiary wholly owned by Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited. Security Technology Co., Ltd. Luckyway Global Mr. Nang Heung Sze holds 100% of the shares. Group Limited In 2010 and 2011, related party transactions refer to the Company and for the years 2008 and 2009 related party transactions refer to HWG-Ltd. 22.1 Lease Agreements On 22 April 2010 Guangzhou Property Management Center, a company wholly owned by Mr. Chun Li Shi, and HWG-Ltd. concluded two lease agreements which replaced a lease agreement concluded between these parties on 20 December 2003. According to the lease agreement of 2003, HWG-Ltd. rented office premises located at Zibian Building 1, No. 6, West of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou with a total area of 1,436.63 square meters, a plant located at Zibian Building 2, No. 6, West of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou with a total area of 3,324.26 square meters, a plant located at Zibian Building 3, No. 6, West of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou with a total area of 1,131.13 square meters as well as a plant located at Zibian Building 4, No. 6, West of Hougang Street, Guanghai Road, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou with a total area of 4,345.51 square meters. The rent for the plant and the office premises was RMB 18,000.00 (approximately TEUR 2 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) and RMB 9,600.00 (approximately TEUR 1 at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) per month, respectively. The term of the lease was 10 years from 1 January 316 2004 to 31 December 2013. The two new lease agreements of 2010, which replaced the lease agreement of 2003, changed the terms and conditions, inter alia, the term of the lease and the rent for the buildings leased, and a third lease agreement was concluded in 2010 between Guangzhou Property Management Center and HWG-Ltd. (for details see section 17.15.2 “Lease Agreements”). In the view of the company, all the abovementioned lease agreements were not concluded on an at arm’s length basis but on better terms for HWG-Ltd. based on a comparison of current rental rates. This results from the family relationship of Mr. Nang Heung Sze, the Controlling Shareholder of the Company, and his son Mr. Chun Li Shi. On 22 April 2010, HWG-Ltd. entered into a lease agreement with Mr. Chun Li Shi which also replaced a previous lease agreement of 2009, according to which HWG-Ltd. rented a plant located at Zibian Building 1, No. 80, North of Hougang Street, Qingcha Road, Baiyun District, Guangzhou with a total area of 6287 square meters. The lease agreement was concluded for 30 years from July 2009 to 30 June 2039. The original prepayment in 2007 was RMB 18,751,554 (EUR 1,801,000), which was requalified in the financial statements in 2009 to a lease prepayment. The lease agreement of 2010, which replaced the lease agreement of 2009, changed the terms and conditions, inter alia, the term of the lease and the rent for the buildings leased (for details see section 17.15.2 “Lease Agreements”). These lease agreements between HWG-Ltd. and Mr. Chun Li Shi are not on an at arm’s length basis. According to a rental valuation report issued by an independent third party, the rental payments to be paid under the lease agreements are lower than current rental rates, which is due to the family relationship of Mr. Sze, the Controlling Shareholder of the Company, and his son Mr. Chun Li Shi. 22.2 Credit Guarantees Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi respectively provided a joint and several guarantee on 18 August 2009 with a ceiling amount of RMB 20,000,000 (approximately EUR 2.2 million at 31 March 2011 exchange rate) to secure the loans from 21 August 2009 to 31 December 2014 by HWG-Ltd. from Tianpingjia Sub-branch, Guangzhou, Industrial and Commerce Bank of China. In this respect, HWG-Ltd. took two short-term loans (one year) in the total amount of RMB 16,000,000 (approximately EUR 1.7 million) on 16 August 2009 and 8 September 2009, both of which were secured by the guarantees of Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi as well as additionally secured by Guangzhou Property Management Center with its 7 real estate 317 title certificates from 21 August 2009 to 31 December 2014 and from 9 September 2009 to 31 December 2014, respectively. Both loans were repaid in September 2010. In September 2010, HWG-Ltd. has again taken out two short-term loans (one year) in the total amount of RMB 16,000,000 from Tianpingja Sub-branch, Guangzhou, Industrial and Commerce Bank of China both of which are also secured by the guarantees provided by Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi as well as by a mortgage provided by Guangzhou Property Management Center. The guarantees by Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi as well as the mortgage by Guangzhou Property Management Center were and have been provided on an at arm’s length basis, respectively. 22.3 Undertakings Mr. Nang Heung Sze has undertaken an agreement for no consideration with HWG-Ltd. according to which he would reimburse HWG-Ltd. for any losses incurred for any additional social insurance and housing funds payments which may be levied in respect of prior periods. Mr. Nang Heung Sze has given an undertaking for no consideration that he would take all responsibility for any damages or negative influence which may be caused to HWG-Ltd. by his failure to make a registration under the “Notice of the State Administration of Foreign Exchange on Relevant Issues concerning Foreign Exchange Administration for Domestic Residents to Engage in Financing and in Return Investment via Overseas Special Purpose Companies”, known as SAFE Notice 75. Mr. Chun Li Shi has given an undertaking for no consideration to bear any administrative and civil liabilities in respect of land allocated to Guangzhou Property Management Center, on which buildings are located that are leased by HWG-Ltd., for which the necessary legal formalities have not been completed. These undertakings were not given on an at arm’s length-basis, due to Mr. Nang Heung Sze being the Controlling Shareholder of the Company and Mr. Chun Li Shi being his son. 22.4 Licence Agreements In 2005, Mr. Nang Heung Sze concluded a trademark licence contract with HWG-Ltd. According to this contract, one trademark was licensed to HWG-Ltd. and HWG-Ltd. was entitled to use the licensed trademark for the 318 time period from 1 July 2005 until 27 June 2015. This agreement was registered with the Trademark Office of the State Administration for Industry and Commerce, China. In 2008, Mr. Nang Heung Sze concluded another trademark licence contract with HWG-Ltd. According to this contract, one trademark was licensed to HWG-Ltd. and HWG-Ltd. was entitled to use the licensed trademark for the time period from 20 April 2008 until 30 April 2018. The licence for both trademarks is not subject to any royalties or license fees (for further information see section 17.16.2 “Trademarks of HWG-Ltd.”). On 29 March 2010, Mr. Nang Heung Sze concluded a further supplementary agreement with respect to the above two trademark license contracts with the Company, according to which the license form was changed from the general license to the exclusive license and the royalties for the abovementioned two license agreements were explicitly exempted. The supplementary agreement also stipulated that Mr. Nang Heung Sze should transfer the two trademarks at 50% of the assessed value to HWG-Ltd. before 2012. Neither the trademark licence contracts nor the supplementary agreement were concluded on an at arm’s length basis but on better terms for HWG-Ltd., due to Mr. Nang Heung Sze being the Controlling Shareholder of the Company. 22.5 Trademark Transfer Agreement On 12 June 2010, Mr. Nang Heung Sze concluded two trademark transfer contracts with regard to the two trademarks mentioned above with HWG-Ltd., according to which the two trademarks are transferred to HWG-Ltd. without any consideration (see section 17.16 “Intellectual Properties”). The transfer of one of these trademarks (Registration no. 3553453) became effective on 13 April 2011 with its registration with the Trademark Bureau of State Administration of Industry and Commerce whereas the registration of the transfer of the other trademark (Registration no. 4483251) is still pending. The trademark transfer contracts were not concluded on an at arm’s length basis, but on better terms for HWG-Ltd, due to Mr. Nang Heung Sze being the Controlling Shareholder of the Company. 22.6 Other Transactions According to the management of HWG-Ltd., there were unsecured and interest free loans granted by Mr. Nang Heung Sze to HWG HK-Holding in the 319 amount of HKD 4,000,000 in 2008 in order to pay the purchase price for the shares in HWG-Ltd. There were no written agreements with regard to the loans. On 31 October 2007 and 5 November 2007, HWG HK-Holding respectively concluded a share transfer agreement with HK Chung Hwa and Guangzhou Property Management Center according to which HWG HK-Holding acquired 30% and 70% shareholding in HWG-Ltd. respectively held by HK Chung Hwa and Guangzhou Property Management Center with the consideration of HKD 1,200,000 and HKD 2,800,000. The share transfer was approved by Liwan BOFTEC on 2 January 2008 and registered with Guangzhou AIC on 15 January 2008 (see section 18.4.2 “Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd. and Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Co., Ltd.”). The Company issued new shares against contributions in kind by a resolution of the Shareholders’ Meeting on 30 June 2010. Due to the contribution of all shares in HWG HK-Holding into the Company in November 2010, Luckyway Global Group Limited, Quick Reach Group Limited, Expert Intelligence Global Limited, Sea Dragon Investments Limited and Hong Kong Investments Group Limited acquired all shares in the Company which were issued due to the aforementioned capital increase (see section 18.4 “Group Structure and Recent Corporate Developments of the Group”). On 1 December 2010 HWG-Ltd., Mr. Nang Heung Sze and HWG-SC concluded a loan agreement under which HWG-Ltd. agreed to lend to Mr. Nang Heung Sze the amount of RMB 33 million for the time period from 1 December 2010 to 1 December 2015 for the purpose of a capital transfer by Mr. Nang Heung Sze. Included in the loan is the amount of RMB 6 million used by HWG-Ltd. to repay to Mr. Nang Heung Sze RMB 6 million borrowed previously by HWG-Ltd. All parties agreed to transfer all rights and duties under this loan of RMB 27 million to HWG-SC. The lent capital together with all interest due shall be returned to HWG-Ltd. directly by HWG-SC before the repayment deadline. Mr. Nang Heung Sze has guaranteed that HWG-SC returns the lent capital plus interest to HWG-Ltd. when due and payable. In March 2011 HWG-Ltd., Mr. Nang Heung Sze and HWG-SC concluded a similar loan agreement under which HWG-Ltd. agreed to lend to Mr. Nang Heung Sze the amount of RMB 20 million for the time period from 23 March 2011 to 25 March 2016. All parties agreed to eventually transfer all rights and duties under this loan of RMB 20 million to HWG-SC. The lent capital together with all interest due shall be returned to HWG-Ltd. directly by HWG-SC before the repayment deadline. Mr. Nang Heung Sze has guaranteed that HWG-SC 320 returns the lent capital plus interest to HWG-Ltd. when due and payable. These two loan agreements were not concluded on an at arm’s length basis, due to HWG-Ltd. and HWG-SC acting as companies of the Group and Mr. Nang Heung Sze being the Controlling Shareholder of the Company. In April 2011 Luckyway Global Group Limited and the Company concluded an agreement about advance payments to a third party under which Luckyway Global Group Limited shall pay on behalf and for the account of the Company without exception all fees incurred by the Company’s fulfilling the arrangements and requirements of the IPO to any intermediary, starting from the day of its establishment and until the Company has successfully concluded the IPO. All fees covered by Luckyway Global Group Limited shall be paid back by the Company by means of a single payment within thirty days after the completion of the IPO. The Company is not required to pay any interests nor any other additional costs. The agreement was not concluded on an at arm’s length basis, due to Luckyway Global Group Limited being one of the Current Major Shareholders of the Company. 321 23. TAXATION IN GERMANY The following sections describe some important German tax principles that may become relevant with respect to the acquisition, holding or the transfer of shares. This description neither purports to be a comprehensive nor a concluding description of all conceivable German tax considerations in this field. The summary is based upon the German tax law in effect as of the date of the issuance of this Prospectus, including double taxation treaties between Germany and other countries. It should be taken into account that the legal provisions may change, possibly also with retroactive effect. Prospective purchasers of the Shares are advised to consult their tax advisors as to the tax consequences of the acquisition, holding, transfer, donation and inheritance of shares. The same applies with respect to the provisions regarding the refund of German withholding tax (dividend withholding tax, Kapitalertragsteuer). Only such individual tax advisors will be able to consider sufficiently the particular tax situation of the individual shareholder. 23.1 Taxation of Corporations Profits earned by (Körperschaftsteuer) corporations are subject to corporate income tax at a rate of 15%, plus a solidarity surcharge (Solidaritätszuschlag) of 5.5% thereon (resulting in a total tax liability of 15.825%). In addition, corporations are subject to trade tax (Gewerbesteuer) with respect to profits from trade or business (Gewerbeertrag) generated in a permanent business establishment in Germany. This tax arises at varying rate up to 18%, depending on the local tax rate (Hebesatz) of the relevant municipality. Dividends received by a company from domestic or foreign corporations are generally tax-exempt. However, 5% of the dividends are considered non-deductible business expenses and as such are subject to taxation. The same applies to profits derived from the sale of shares in a corporation. Losses in connection with the sale of shares are not deductible. The German company is likely to receive tax losses and have tax loss carry forwards due to the tax exemption of dividends and capital gains as well the costs incurred in the first years without possible earnings. For trade tax purposes, the tax exemption described above depends on whether a company has held 15% of the registered share capital (Grund- oder Stammkapital) of the distributing corporation at or since the beginning of the relevant tax assessment period. In the case of corporations resident in another EU member state a participation of 10% is sufficient. 322 As the dividend distributions to the Company are received from a holding company outside the European Union 15% of the registered share capital need to be held and 95% of this dividend income is exempt from German trade tax only (i) to that extent that the profit of foreign holding results from dividend distributions from its subsidiaries in the same business year and (ii) if the subsidaries qualify as ordinary operating companies in terms of the trade tax participation exemption regime which includes inter alia manufacturing, processing or assembly of tangible property, trade other than with related parties who make profits from such trade that is taxable in Germany and which excludes inter alia raising and lending capital and profit distributions from other companies and (iii) if the Company is able to prove these requirements towards the German Tax Authorities when it applies for such exemption. Otherwise dividend distributions from HWG HK-Holding to the Company are fully taxable for Trade Tax purposes for the Company. The deduction of interest expenses may be limited according to the rules of the so-called interest ceiling (Zinsschranke). Loss carry-forwards may be carried forward indefinitely, but can be set off with taxable income in full only up to an amount of EUR 3 million. 40% of the income exceeding this threshold is taxable at the abovementioned tax rates (so-called minimum taxation (Mindestbesteuerung)). Unused tax loss carry-forwards and carried forward interest as well as current losses and non-deductible interest expenses accrued up to the transfer will be forfeited entirely if a change of control occurs, i.e., if through transfers as from 2008 more than 50% of the subscribed capital or the voting rights of the company are transferred to a single acquirer (including parties related to the acquirer) within a period of five years. If within a period of five years more than 25%, but not more than 50%, of the subscribed capital or of the voting rights of the corporation are transferred to one acquirer, the existing current tax losses and tax loss carry-forwards will be forfeited in that proportion which corresponds to the percentage of shares or voting rights transferred. Only share transfers effected after 2007 will be taken into account. However, due to recent changes in German tax law the loss carry-forward might not be forfeited entirely, if the hidden reserves of the company match the tax losses and tax loss carry-forwards, respectively. This, however, can only be confirmed for each year retrospectively. 323 23.2 Taxation of Shareholders 23.2.1 Taxation of Dividends Withholding Tax When distributing the dividends the Company must generally withhold a withholding tax in the amount of 25% on the amount of dividends approved for distribution, plus a solidarity surcharge of 5.5% on the amount of withholding tax (resulting in a total amount of 26.375% to be withheld). As far as amounts of the tax deposit account (steuerliches Einlagekonto) are deemed utilised for the distribution, no withholding tax will have to be levied. Dividends to a shareholder who is a tax resident of Germany, can be distributed by the German disbursing agent without deducting withholding tax if the shareholder has submitted to the disbursing agent a certificate of non-assessment (Nicht-Veranlagungs-Bescheinigung) issued by the relevant local tax office or a withholding exemption certificate (Freistellungsauftrag), to the extent the exemption amount shown on this certificate is not yet used up. Where dividends are distributed to a corporation domiciled in another member state of the European Union subject to the Parent-Subsidiary Directive dated 23 July 1990 withholding tax may be waived upon application and provided that additional requirements are met. The same applies with respect to dividends paid to a permanent establishment situated in another Member State of the European Union of a German parent company. The withholding tax rate for distributions to other non-resident shareholders may be reduced (generally to 15%) provided the shareholder benefits from a double taxation treaty between its country of residence and Germany. In such cases the difference between the total amount withheld and the amount of withholding tax applicable pursuant to the double taxation treaty is refunded upon application by the Federal Central Office of Taxation (Bundeszentralamt für Steuern). Forms for the refund procedure may be obtained from Bundeszentralamt für Steuern, Hauptdienstsitz Bonn-Beuel, An der Küppe 1, 53225 Bonn, Germany (http://www.bzst.bund.de) as well as from German embassies and consulates. Irrespective of the application of a double taxation treaty, two fifths of the total amount withheld and paid to the tax office is refunded by the Federal Central Office of Taxation to corporations subject to limited taxation in Germany upon application. 324 Taxation of Shareholders Resident in Germany Shares as Private Assets of Individuals If an individual who is a tax resident of Germany holds shares as non-business (private) assets, the tax liability with respect to the dividend is generally discharged by the withholding tax and the solidarity surcharge made by the disbursing agent (located in Germany). Expenses actually incurred in connection with private investment income are not deductible. The total private investment income is only decreased by a lump sum deduction (Sparer-Pauschbetrag) of EUR 801.00 (EUR 1,602.00 for married couples filing jointly). The shareholder may apply for an individual tax assessment on the basis of his personal income tax rate instead of flat taxation, if this results in a lower tax burden for him. Expenses actually incurred must not be deducted in this case either except for the lump sum deduction. Church tax (if any) is generally charged by means of assessment. However, the shareholder may apply for a withholding of church tax already by the disbursing agent, so that the church tax liability is discharged as well. Shares as Business Assets of Corporations Dividends received by corporations tax resident in Germany are generally exempt from taxation. However, 5% of the dividends are considered non-deductible business expenses and as such are taxable. Actual business expenses directly related to dividends are generally deductible. For trade tax purposes, the wide exemption of dividends from tax described above depends on whether the corporation receiving the dividend has held 15% of the registered share capital of the Company at the beginning of the relevant tax assessment period; otherwise the full dividend is subject to trade tax. The tax withheld by the Company is credited against the corporate income tax liability of the corporation receiving the dividend; overpayments of withholding tax are refunded. The same applies to the solidarity surcharge which accrues in addition to the corporate income tax. Dividend payments for which amounts out of the contribution account for tax purposes (steuerliches Einlagekonto) are deemed utilised are subject to tax only to the extent the payment exceeds this contributed equity. Shares as Business Assets of Individuals If an individual who is a tax resident of Germany holds the shares as business assets, 60% of the dividends are subject to income tax at the progressive income tax rate. In addition, solidarity surcharge of 5.5% on the 325 income tax is levied. The tax withheld by the corporation is credited against the individual income tax liability; overpayments of withholding tax are refunded. The same applies to the solidarity surcharge. Only 60% of the business expenses having an economic nexus to the dividends are tax-deductible. In addition, the dividends are subject to trade tax which is credited against the personal income tax liability of the shareholder by means of a lump-sum method. The dividends are exempt from trade tax if the shareholder held at least 15% of the share capital of the Company at the beginning of the relevant tax assessment period. Dividend payments for which amounts out of the contribution account for tax purposes (steuerliches Einlagekonto) are deemed utilised are subject to tax only to the extent the payment exceeds this contributed equity. Shares as Assets of Partnerships If the shareholder is a partnership, personal income tax or corporate income tax (plus solidarity surcharge) is assessed at the level of the respective partner. The taxation of the dividend is subject to the rules described above depending on whether the partner is a corporation or an individual and in each case to the extent such partner participates in the partnership. If the partnership is subject to trade tax, dividends are also subject to trade tax at the level of the partnership. If the partner of the partnership is an individual, the trade tax will be credited pro-rata against the partner’s personal income tax liability by means of a lump-sum method. Shares as Assets of Certain Enterprises of the Financial and Insurance Sector Subject to fulfilment of the prerequisites of the Parent-Subsidiary Directive of the European Union, the tax exemptions regarding dividends on shares held by individuals or corporations do not apply to certain enterprises of the financial and insurance sector. Dividends on shares held by banks (Kreditinstitute) or financial services institutions (Finanzdienstleisungsinstitute) and allocable to the trading book (Handelsbuch) and dividends on shares acquired by financial enterprises (Finanzunternehmen) for the purpose of deriving gain from short-term proprietary trading (Eigenhandel) are subject to corporate income tax (plus solidarity surcharge) in the full amount. Both cases apply to the respective institutions and enterprises within the meaning of the German Banking Act (Kreditwesengesetz), the latter applies as well to banks, financial services institutions and financial enterprises domiciled in another Member State of 326 the European Union or another Member State of the European Economic Area Treaty. If the shareholder held at least 15% of the share capital of the Company the dividends may be exempt from trade tax. Dividends on shares that are deemed investments held by life insurance or health insurance companies and shares held by pension funds are subject to corporate income tax and trade tax in the full amount. Taxation of Non-Resident Shareholders Dividends to shareholders who are not resident in Germany (individuals or corporations) will generally be subject to German taxation. If the shares are held as business assets in Germany (i.e. via a German permanent business establishment or fixed base or as business assets for which a permanent representative has been appointed) the principles described above in relation to the taxation of shareholders resident in Germany similarly apply. Withholding tax (and solidarity surcharge) withheld and paid to the German tax authorities will be credited against the income tax liability and the solidarity surcharge of the shareholder or refunded in case of an overpayment. In all other cases, the withholding of withholding tax (possibly reduced by double taxation treaties) discharges any tax liability of the shareholder in Germany with respect to the dividends. 23.2.2 Taxation of Capital Gains Taxation of Shareholders Resident in Germany Shares as Private Assets of Individuals If the shareholder is an individual who holds the shares as non-business (private) assets, the taxation of capital gains from shares acquired after 31 December 2008 will be subject to personal income tax (plus solidarity surcharge thereon) irrespective of any holding period. The domestic disbursing agent (bank, financial services institution, securities trading enterprise, securities trading bank) conducting the sale of such shares on account of the shareholder must withhold a withholding tax of 25% (plus 5.5% solidarity surcharge; resulting in a total withholding of 26.375%) from the capital gains from the sale of shares acquired after 31 December 2008. The amount withheld generally discharges the personal income tax 327 liability and the solidarity surcharge of the shareholder. However, the shareholder may apply for an individual tax assessment regarding its income from capital investments if this results in a lower tax burden for him. Income from capital investments is only decreased by a lump sum deduction of EUR 801.00 (EUR 1,602.00 for married couples filing jointly); expenses actually incurred are not deductible. Church tax (if any) is generally charged by means of assessment. The shareholder may, however, apply for a withholding of church tax already by the disbursing agent, so that the church tax liability is discharged as well. Shares as Business Assets of Corporations Capital gains from shares held by a corporation subject to unlimited taxation in Germany (e.g., limited liability corporations) are generally not subject to a withholding tax. The capital gains are generally exempt from corporate income tax and trade tax. However, 5% of capital gains are considered non-deductible business expenses and as such are subject to corporate income tax (plus the solidarity surcharge) and trade tax if the shares belong to a German permanent business establishment. As a result, 95% of such capital gains are effectively exempt from taxation. Losses from the sale of shares or any other reductions of profits related to the sold shares generally do not qualify as deductible business expenses. Shares as Business Assets of Individuals Capital gains from shares held by individuals as business assets are generally not subject to withholding tax if they constitute income of a German business establishment and the shareholder has declared this towards the disbursing agent on a form officially prescribed. In case that withholding tax and solidarity surcharge are withheld, such withholding does not discharge the tax liability of the shareholder, but will be credited against the personal income tax liability and the solidarity surcharge of the shareholder or will be refunded in case of an overpayment. 60% of the capital gains from the sale of shares are subject to personal income tax (plus solidarity surcharge) and to trade tax if the shares belong to a German permanent business establishment. Trade tax is credited against the shareholder’s personal income tax burden by means of a lump-sum method. Only 60% of the losses from the sale of shares and 60% of expenses having an economic nexus thereto may be claimed as tax deductions. 328 Shares as Assets of Partnerships If the shareholder is a partnership, personal income tax or corporate income tax (plus solidarity surcharge) on the capital gain is assessed at the level of the respective partner. Capital gains are generally taxed according to the principles as described above with respect to the taxation of a corporation or an individual as shareholder which would apply if the shareholder held the shares in the Company directly. Capital gains from the sale of shares, if attributed to a German permanent business establishment of the partnership, are subject to trade tax at the level of the partnership. To the extent the partners are corporations, 95% of the capital gains are exempt from trade tax. To the extent the partners are individuals, 60% of capital gains are subject to trade tax. In such a case, trade tax is credited against the shareholder’s personal income tax liability by means of a lump-sum method. Shares as Assets of Certain Enterprises of the Financial and Insurance Sector As in the case of dividends, the partial tax exemptions for individuals and corporations do not apply to capital gains from shares held by certain enterprises of the financial and insurance sector (see the cases described above under section 23.2.1 “Taxation of Dividends” in the relevant subsections). This concerns shares allocable to the trading book of banks and financial services institutions, shares acquired by finance enterprises for the purpose of deriving gain from short-term proprietary trading and shares held as investments held by life insurance or health insurance companies and shares held by pension funds. Taxation of Non-Resident Shareholders Capital gains derived by shareholders not resident in Germany from shares held as business assets in Germany (i.e., via a German permanent business establishment or a fixed base or business for which a permanent representative has been appointed in Germany) are taxed in Germany according to the principles described above with respect to the taxation of shareholders resident in Germany. Besides, capital gains derived by shareholders not resident in Germany are subject to taxation in Germany only if the shareholder or — in the case of a gratuitous transfer — his or her legal predecessor held a direct or indirect 329 participation of at least 1% in share capital of the Company at any point in time during the five years immediately preceding the sale of the shares. In general, the double taxation treaties between Germany and other countries provide for exemption from German taxation and assign the right of taxation to the shareholder’s country of residence. In the case of taxation in Germany, 5% of the capital gains are subject to corporate income tax and the solidarity surcharge if the shareholder is a corporation; if the shareholder is an individual, 60% of the capital gains will be subject to income tax (plus solidarity surcharge thereon). Losses from the sale of shares and expenses having an economic nexus thereto are not or only in a limited way deductible according to the principles described above. 23.2.3 Inheritance and Gift Tax The transfer of shares by inheritance or gift is subject to German inheritance and gift tax, only if: a) the decedent, donor, heir, beneficiary, or any other beneficiary maintains his or her residence, habitual abode, place of business, or registered domicile in Germany at the time of the transfer, or is a German citizen who has spent no more than five consecutive years outside of Germany without maintaining a residence in Germany; b) the shares are — irrespective of the personal requirements as listed under a) — held as business assets for which a permanent business establishment is maintained in Germany or for which a permanent representative has been appointed in Germany; or c) the decedent, at the time of accrual of the inheritance, or the donor, at the time of the donation, either individually or collectively with related parties, holds, directly or indirectly, at least 10% of the registered share capital of the Company. Special provisions apply to German citizens (and family members belonging to their household) without residence and habitual abode in Germany, but employed by a legal body under public law in Germany. The few inheritance and gift tax double taxation treaties entered into by Germany generally provide that German inheritance or gift tax will be assessed only in case a) and, subject to certain limitations, in case b). 330 23.3 Other Taxes No other German taxes (value-added tax (Umsatzsteuer), capital transfer tax (Kapitalverkehrsteuer) or similar taxes) are assessed on the purchase, acquisition, or sale, or other transfer of shares. However, a taxable person under the German Value Added Tax Act may waive the exemption from value added tax for transactions concerning shares if the transaction is entered into with another taxable person for purposes of his business. No wealth tax (Vermögensteuer) is currently assessed in Germany. 331 24. TAXATION IN LUXEMBOURG The information given in this Prospectus concerning taxation in the Grand Duchy of Luxembourg is solely of a general nature. The laws in force in Luxembourg as of the date of this Prospectus form the basis for the presented information. The summary is subject to any change in law that may take effect after such date. The information does not represent a comprehensive description of all of the tax considerations that might be relevant to an investment decision. To give preliminary information is its only purpose. In neither case should the information be intended to be, nor should it be construed to be, legal or tax advice. It is a description of the essential material Luxembourg tax consequences with respect to the shares in the Company (hereafter referred to in this section as “the shares”) and may not include tax considerations that arise from rules of general application or that are generally assumed to be known to shareholders. It is recommended that prospective investors in the shares should consult their professional advisors with respect to particular circumstances, the effects of state, local or foreign laws to which they may be subject and as to their tax position. The residence concept used under the respective headings applies for Luxembourg income tax assessment purposes only. The present section refers to Luxembourg tax law and/or concepts only. Thus any references in the following passage to a tax, duty, levy impost or other charge or withholding of a similar nature relate solely to Luxembourg tax law and/or concepts. It should be kept in mind that a reference to Luxembourg income tax encompasses corporate income tax (impôt sur le revenu des collectivités), municipal business tax (impôt commercial communal), a solidarity surcharge (contribution au fonds pour l’emploi), as well as personal income tax (impôt sur le revenu) generally. Corporate shareholders may further be subject to net wealth tax (impôt sur la fortune) as well as other duties, levies or taxes. Corporate income taxes, municipal business tax, net wealth tax as well as the solidarity surcharge invariably apply to most corporate taxpayer’s resident of Luxembourg for tax purposes. For the year 2010, the corporate income tax rate is 21.84% (including the 4% solidarity surcharge). The municipal business tax rate is 6.75% (for a company having its statutory seat in Luxembourg City). As a result, a Luxembourg fully-taxable resident company is subject to corporate income tax and municipal business tax at the current aggregate rate of 28.59% (if the statutory seat is in Luxembourg City). On the other side individual tax payers are generally subject to personal income tax (with a top marginal rate of 332 38%) and the solidarity surcharge (2.5%) (the top effective marginal rate would thus be 38.95%). Should an individual taxpayer act in the course of the management of a professional or business undertaking, municipal business tax may apply under certain circumstances as well. 24.1 Taxation of Income Derived from and Capital Gains Realized on the Shares held by Luxembourg Residents 24.1.1 Individual Holders of Shares Resident individuals shareholders who receive dividends and other payments derived from the shares and act in the course of the management of either their private wealth or their professional / business activity, are subject to income tax at the progressive ordinary rate (with a top effective marginal rate of currently 42.14%). A tax credit is granted for foreign withholding taxes. Precondition is that the tax credit does not exceed the corresponding Luxembourg tax. Under current Luxembourg tax laws, 50% of the gross amount of dividends received from EU resident companies covered by art. 2 of the Parent-Subsidiary Directive 90/435/EEC or from non-resident capital companies resident in a state having concluded a double tax treaty with Luxembourg and fully liable to a tax which corresponds to Luxembourg’s corporate income tax by resident individuals is exempt from income tax. Resident individual shareholders who receive capital gains realised on the disposal of the shares and who act in the course of the management of their private wealth are not subject to income tax, unless said capital gains qualify either as speculative gains or as gains on a substantial participation. Capital gains are deemed to be speculative gains and are subject to income tax at ordinary rates (with a top effective marginal rate of 42.14%) if the shares are disposed of within 6 months after their acquisition or if their disposal precedes their acquisition. A participation is deemed to be substantial where a resident individual shareholder holds, either alone or together with his spouse and/or minor children, directly or indirectly at any time within the 5 years preceding the disposal, more than 10% of the share capital of the Company. Capital gains realised on a substantial participation more than 6 months after the acquisition thereof are subject to income tax according to the half-global rate method, (i. e. the average rate applicable to the total income is calculated according to progressive income tax rates and half of the average rate is applied to the capital gains realised on the substantial participation). The top effective marginal rate is currently 21.07%. A disposal may include a sale, an exchange, a contribution or any other kind of 333 alienation of the shares. Capital gains realised on the disposal of the shares by resident individual shareholders, who act in the course of their professional / business activity, are subject to income tax at ordinary rates. Taxable gains are determined as being the difference between the price for which the shares have been disposed of and the lower of their cost or book value. 24.1.2 Luxembourg Resident Corporate Holders A Luxembourg fully-taxable resident company which receives dividends and other payments derived from the shares has to pay an income tax, unless the conditions of the participation exemption regime, as described below, are satisfied. Luxembourg tax laws provide that 50% of the gross amount of dividends received by a Luxembourg fully-taxable resident company is exempt from income tax. Precondition is that the dividends are received from EU resident companies covered by art. 2 of the Parent-Subsidiary Directive 90/435/EEC or from non-resident capital companies resident in a state having concluded a double tax treaty with Luxembourg and fully liable to tax which corresponds to Luxembourg’s corporate income tax. A tax credit is further granted for foreign withholding taxes, provided it does not exceed the corresponding Luxembourg tax. Under the participation exemption regime, dividends derived from the shares by a Luxembourg fully-taxable resident company may be exempt from income tax if cumulatively (i) it has held or commits itself to hold the shares for an uninterrupted period of at least 12 months, (ii) during this uninterrupted period the shares represent a participation of at least 10% in the share capital of the Company or a participation of an acquisition price of at least EUR 1,200,000.00 and (iii) the dividend is put at its disposal within such period. Liquidation proceeds are assimilated to a received dividend and may be exempt under the same conditions. Any expenses in direct economic relationship with the dividends received and any value reduction of the shares following the dividend distribution will not be deductible up to the amount of the dividends exempt. Shares held through a fiscally transparent entity are considered as being a direct participation proportionally to the percentage held in the net assets of the transparent entity. Capital gains realised by a Luxembourg fully-taxable resident company on the shares are subject to income tax at ordinary rates, unless the conditions of the participation exemption regime, as described below, are satisfied. Taxable gains are determined as being the difference between the price for 334 which the shares have been disposed of and the lower of their cost or book value. Under the participation exemption regime, capital gains realised on the shares by a Luxembourg fully-taxable resident company may be exempt from income tax if cumulatively (i) it has held or commits itself to hold the shares for an uninterrupted period of 12 months and (ii) during this uninterrupted period of 12 months the shares represent a participation of at least 10% in the share capital of the Company or a participation of an acquisition price of at least EUR 6,000,000.00. Capital gains realised on the shares will remain taxable up to the aggregate amount of expenses in direct economic relationship with the shares including any value reduction of the shares that have reduced the taxable basis of the company prior to the disposal of the shares. Shares held through a fiscally transparent entity are considered as being a direct participation proportionally to the percentage held in the net assets of the transparent entity. A minimal EUR 1,500 taxation would be levied on all unregulated collective undertakings for which the sum of financial assets, securities and cash at bank represent more than 90% of total assets. 24.1.3 Tax Exempt Holders of Shares Holders of Shares who are private asset holding companies governed by the law of 11 May 2007, undertakings for collective investment subject to the law of 30 March 1988 and/or the law of 20 December 2002 or specialized investment funds governed by the law of 13 February 2007 are exempt from income tax in Luxembourg. Dividends derived from and capital gains realized on the shares are thus not subject to income tax in their hands. 24.2 Taxation of Income Derived from and Capital Gains Realized on the Shares by Luxembourg Non-residents Individual shareholders, who are non-residents of Luxembourg and who have neither a permanent establishment nor a permanent representative in Luxembourg to which or whom the shares are attributable are not subject to Luxembourg income tax. Corporate shareholders which are non-resident but have a permanent establishment or a permanent representative in Luxembourg, to which the shares are attributable, have to include any income received on the shares including any capital gain realized on the sale, disposal or redemption of 335 shares, in their taxable income for Luxembourg tax assessment purposes. The same regulations apply to individuals, acting in the course of the management of a professional or business undertaking, who have a permanent establishment or a permanent representative in Luxembourg, to which the shares are attributable. The difference between the sale, repurchase or redemption price and the lower of the cost or book value of the shares sold or redeemed forms the taxable gains. 24.3 Other Taxes 24.3.1 Net Wealth Tax Luxembourg net wealth tax of 0.5% per year will not be levied on the shares unless (i) the shareholder is a corporate entity resident in Luxembourg other than an undertaking for collective investment governed by the amended law of 20 December 2002, a securitisation company governed by the law of 22 March 2004, a company subject to the law of 15 June 2004 on venture capital vehicles, a specialised investment fund governed by the law of 13 February 2007, or a family wealth management company governed by the law of 11 May 2007, or (ii) the shares are attributable to an enterprise or part thereof which is carried on through a permanent establishment or a permanent representative in Luxembourg of a corporate entity. Furthermore, in case of a Luxembourg fully taxable resident company or a permanent establishment of a company covered by art. 2 of the amended EU Parent/Subsidiary Directive, or of a company resident in a state having a tax treaty with Luxembourg, or of a company resident in the European Economic Area other than an EU Member State, the shares may be exempt from net wealth tax for a given year, if the shares represent at the end of the year preceding the fixing date a participation of at least 10% in the share capital of the company or a participation of an acquisition price of at least EUR 1.2 million. 24.3.2 Registration Taxes and Stamp Duties The issuance of the shares and the disposal of the shares are both not regulated by a Luxembourg registration tax or stamp duty. 24.3.3 Inheritance Tax and Gift Tax Should an individual holder of shares who is a resident of Luxembourg for tax purposes die, the shares are included in his or her taxable basis for inheritance tax purposes. 336 A gift or donation of the shares can be subject to a gift tax; if the gift is recorded in a Luxembourg notarial deed. 337 25. UNDERWRITING 25.1 Underwriting Agreement Shortly after the date of this Prospectus, the Company, the Greenshoe Shareholders, Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi and the Underwriters will enter into an underwriting agreement (the “Underwriting Agreement”) regarding the sale and the offer of the Offered Shares in the course of the Offering. Subject to the fulfilment of certain terms and conditions set out in the Underwriting Agreement, the Company agrees to offer for subscription 6,000,000 shares from a capital increase of the Company at the calculated value of EUR 1.00 per share to biw AG and the Underwriters agree to procure investors for up to 6,000,000 shares in the Company. The Underwriting Agreement further relates to the offer of up to 900,000 Greenshoe Shares in connection with a potential over-allotment. To ensure timely delivery of the shares to the investors, the Founding Shareholder will provide biw AG with 6,000,000 no-par value ordinary bearer shares (the “Delivery Shares”) each with a calculated value of EUR 1.00 and with full dividend rights from and including the financial year 2011 by way of a securities loan free of charge (the “Delivery Shares”). Against payment of the Offer Price the investors will receive the Delivery Shares. biw AG will then subscribe for an equivalent number of new shares at the lowest issue price of EUR 1.00 on or around 4 July 2011 to be issued from the authorised capital against cash consideration. After the Delivery Shares have been delivered to the investors against payment of the Offer Price, biw AG will pay the difference between the Offer Price received from the investors and the lowest issue price (less agreed commissions and expenses) to the Company. If the Greenshoe Option is exercised, the Underwriters will pay the Offer Price received from the investors for the Greenshoe Shares to the Greenshoe Shareholders (less agreed commissions and expenses) after expiry of the Greenshoe Option. 25.2 Commissions The Company and the Greenshoe Shareholders will pay the Underwriters a 338 commission of 4.5% of the gross proceeds from the Offering (including the Greenshoe Option), which means the number of Offered Shares finally sold multiplied by the Offer Price. Moreover, an additional commission of up to 0.5% of the gross proceeds from the Offering (including the Greenshoe Option) may be paid to the Sole Global Coordinator by the Company and the Greenshoe Shareholders if the Company so decides at its free discretion. The commission is owed by the Company and the Greenshoe Shareholders on a pro-rata basis in line with the portion of the gross proceeds attributable to them. 25.3 Securities Loans and Greenshoe Option Luckyway Global Group Limited will enter into a securities loan agreement under which it grants to biw AG a total number of 6,000,000 no-par value bearer shares (Inhaber-Stückaktien) by way of securities loan free of charge. The purpose of the securities loan is to facilitate timely delivery of up to 6,000,000 shares in the Company to the investors. With regard to a potential Over-allotment, up to 900,000 no par value ordinary bearer shares from the holdings of the Greenshoe Shareholders (the “Greenshoe Shares”) will be granted to biw AG by way of a securities loan. The Greenshoe Shares will be provided by the Greenshoe Shareholders in the amount as set out in the following table: Greenshoe Shareholders No. of provided Luckyway Global Group Limited 669,466 Quick Reach Group Limited 43,988 Expert Intelligence Global Limited 31,391 Sea Dragon Investments Limited 101,304 Hong Kong Investment Group Limited 53,851 Total 900,000 339 Greenshoe Shares With regard to the Greenshoe Shares, the Greenshoe Shareholders will grant biw AG the option to acquire up to 900,000 shares of the Company from the Greenshoe Shareholders against payment of the Offer Price less agreed commission and other costs (the “Greenshoe Option”). The Greenshoe Option expires 30 calendar days after the commencement of trading of the Existing Shares. 25.4 Termination The Underwriting Agreement provides that the Underwriters may terminate the Underwriting Agreement under certain circumstances, even after the shares have been delivered. Such circumstances include in particular a material adverse change. The following constitutes such a material adverse change: · any significant impairment or foreseeable significant impairment, or a material adverse change in the prospects, consolidated financial position, or results of operations of the Company or its affiliates have arisen since the reference dates (Stichtage) and which have not been disclosed in the Prospectus; · a significant change in the management structure of the Company; · a complete or partial suspension of trading on the Frankfurt, London, New York Stock Exchange or any other major Stock Exchange or a promulgation of a general moratorium on the commercial banking activities in Frankfurt, London, New York or any other major market or not insignificant disruptions in securities settlement, paying or depository services in Europe; · a detrimental change in the national or international financial, political, industrial, economic or general legal conditions or capital markets conditions or currency exchange rates or significant outbreaks or escalation of militant or terrorist activities; · any changes in the share capital of the Company or any of its affiliates; · any material change in the long-term debt of the Company or any of its affiliates. 340 If the Underwriting Agreement is terminated before the shares have been delivered, the offering will not take place. In such case, any allotments to investors will become invalid and investors will have no claim for delivery. Claims relating to any subscription fees paid and costs incurred by any investor in connection with the subscription are governed solely by the legal relationship between the investor and the institution to which the investor submitted its purchase order. Investors who have engaged in short sales of shares will bear the risk of not being able to fulfil their delivery obligations in connection with such sale. 25.5 Indemnification The Company, the Greenshoe Shareholders as well as Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi have agreed in the Underwriting Agreement to indemnify and hold harmless the Underwriters and their directors, officers, partners and employees, any affiliate of the Underwriters and each person who may be deemed to control the Underwriters (each an “Indemnified Person”) against any losses, claims, damages, liabilities, charges, expenses or demands (or actions in respect thereof) (“Losses”) to which such Indemnified Person may become subject and which arise out of, or in relation to, or in connection with: · any breach by the Company, the Greenshoe Shareholders or Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi of any of their respective representations and warranties pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement or any other non compliance with any of their obligations under the Underwriting Agreement; · any untrue statement of a material fact contained in the Prospectus or any other marketing document or any omission to state therein a material fact required to be stated therein necessary to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading; or · any other Losses in connection with the Offering for which the Underwriters are not liable. In each such case, the Company, the Greenshoe Shareholders or Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi will in addition reimburse each Indemnified Person for any reasonable and properly documented legal or other expenses incurred by such Indemnified Person in connection with investigation or defending any such action or claim including with respect to an alleged 341 breach, alleged untrue statements, or an alleged omission as such expenses are incurred. 25.6 Other Relationships Occasionally either the Underwriters or their affiliates may be involved in transactions or the performance of services for the Company in the ordinary course of business. 342 26. RECENT DEVELOPMENTS AND OUTLOOK Since June 2010, the PBC, China’s central bank, has significantly revalued the Chinese currency Renminbi against the US Dollar. Since the beginning of 2011, the Renminbi has strengthened its position against the US dollar by 1.7% (as of 31 May 2011). Since the successful completion of the final test of the Group’s intruder-resistant glass products for automotive application conducted by the Chinese Public Security Authority Testing Center last December, the Group has started to supply the new product to five of the initial six OEMs (out of 12 selected by the Ministry of Public Security of PRC to produce new police patrol vehicles) whose vehicles were ready to undergo the practical tests. According to the discussion during an official meeting held on 2 December 2010, 150,000 police patrol cars in China are intended to be equipped with intruder-resistant glass within the next three to five years. As the sole supplier of this type of glass in China, the Group hopes to receive the majority of if not the entire purchase orders from the selected (qualified) automobile manufacturers. Instead of refitting automotive manufacturers to whom the Group normally supplies its bulletproof glass, the Group plans to select large automobile manufacturers (OEM) to supply these police patrol cars thus becoming the Group’s new customers. This group of new customers may include Dongfeng Toyota, Dongfeng Nissan, Shenlong Auto, Brilliance Auto, Zhengzhou Auto, Zhong Xing Auto and Shanghai General Motor. The Group also expects the demand for intruder-resistant glass in architectural applications to increase in the near future. In accordance to a decree issued by the Public Security Department in Changsha (provincial capital city of Hunan Province, provincial population 57 million in 2008) in 2010, major shopping plaza, supermarket and jewellery stores above certain size are required to install intruder-resistant glass in their counters in Changsha city in 2011. The Public Security Department of Guizhou (provincial capital city of Guizhou Province, provincial population 34 million in 2008) also issued an official notice which required all financial institutions to promote and invest in the use of high quality security products. In this notice, the use of intruder-resistant glass produced by the Group was specifically mentioned as one of the two sole suppliers of this type of glass. The Group believes that these currently limited and localized mandatory uses of the Group’s intruder-resistant glass products are only the beginning of an eventually nationwide use of its new products as the Ministry of Interior Security of 343 China is closely monitors the progress of application of these products and the benefits they deliver. Thus the Group expects that the demands for architectural intruder-resistant glass in China will grow significantly. In the past, the Group mainly supplied its construction glass products to its customers as supplements to its security glass products. With the security glass as the Group’s main focus with large profit margin, the construction glass products were sold mostly below the market price although the Group could still extract sufficient profit from their sales. Because the Group will increasingly supply construction glass products to the market as its Sichuan production site being constructed, it is strategically important for the Group to provide its construction glass products at market price or at a premium. Accordingly, the Group has started to adjust the unit selling price of the Group’s construction glass products such as tempered glass to the prevailing market price. The Group’s subsidiary in Sichuan, HWG-SC, has started the construction of the new production facility in Chengdu since the opening ceremony in November 2010. The first phase of the construction and production is expected to be completed within this year and the second phase of the construction and production by 2012. Production upon the completion of the first phase will focus on the selected intruder-resistant glass products to meet the immediate market demand for these products. On 27 May 2011, HWG-Ltd. concluded an exclusive distributorship agreement with the industrial group Saint-Gobain which is headquartered in Courbevoie, France (see section 17.14.4 “Exclusive Distributorship Agreement”). Between 31 December 2010 and the date of this Prospectus, no significant changes with regard to the financial condition and the trading and the market position of the China Specialty Glass-Group have occurred. 344 GLOSSARY 3C Certification China Compulsory Certification, a new product compulsory regulation promulgated by the State Administration of Quality Supervision, Inspection and Quarantine of the PRC to protect the life and health of human being and animal, and the environment 3C Regulation PRC Regulation Concerning Management of Compulsory Product Certification Administration Rules the Administration Rules of the Settlement, Sale and Payment of Foreign Exchange (1996) AIC Administration for Industry and Commerce AktG German Stock Corporation Act (Aktiengesetz) Arbitration Law Arbitration Law of the PRC Authorised Capital 2010/I The Management Board is authorised to increase the share capital of the Company with the approval of the Supervisory Board for a period of five years starting with the registration of this authorization in the commercial register once or several times by up to EUR 7,525,000.00 through the issuance of up to 7,525,000 new no-par value bearer shares in cash or in contributions in kind. Automotive security glass Security glass for the refitting of vehicles in the automotive sector Automotive Security Glass Market The market where security glass manufactured by the Group is used for armoured vehicles which offer security and safety to their passengers such as cash-in-transit vehicles for banks, police vehicles, military personnel carriers and armoured limousines BaFin German Federal Financial Supervisory (Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht) Bank security glass Security glass which improves the security of fixed locations, e.g. bank branches or jewellery stores Bank Security Glass Market The market where security glass manufactured by the Group is used; at locations where cash or valuable goods are traded such as banks, jewellery stores, securities brokerage houses, postal service and insurance companies BGB German Civil Code (Bürgerliches Gesetzbuch) biw AG biw Bank für Investments und Wertpapiere AG, Willich, Germany Bulletproof glass Specially laminated glass which can prevent small arm projectile from penetrating it, thus protecting the person behind Caesium Caesium is a chemical element with the symbol Cs. It is a soft, silvery-gold alkali metal with physical and chemical properties similar to those of rubidium and potassium CAGR Compounded Annual Growth Rate CEO Chief Executive Officer CEST Central European Summer Time 345 Authority CFO Chief Financial Officer China Specialty Glass-Group China Specialty Glass AG, together with its direct and indirect subsidiaries Civil Procedure Law Civil Procedure Law of the PRC Code German Corporate Governance Code Company See “CSG-AG”. Construction glass Specialty glass for use as windows, doors, curtain walls or internal decorations in commercial buildings and private houses Construction Glass Market The market where the glass manufactured by the Group is used as windows, doors, curtain walls or internal decorations in commercial buildings and private houses Controlling Shareholder Mr. Nang Heung Sze COO Chief Operating Officer CSG-AG China Specialty Glass AG, Gruenwald, Germany CSRC China Securities Regulatory Commission CSSF Commission de Surveillance du Secteur Financier (Luxembourg Commission for the Supervision of the Financial Sector) Current Major Shareholders Luckyway Global Group Limited, Quick Reach Group Limited, Expert Intelligence Global Limited, Sea Dragon Investments Limited and Hong Kong Investments Group Limited Curtain Wall A curtain wall is an outer covering of a building of which the outer walls are non-structural and merely keep out the weather Delivery Shares 6,000,000 no-par value bearer shares from a securities loan free of charge granted by Luckyway Global Group Limited to biw AG Design Patent A type of industrial design right granted on the ornamental design of a functional item Double Taxation Double taxation is the imposition of two or more taxes on the same income (in the case of income taxes), asset (in the case of capital taxes), or financial transaction EEA European Economic Area EIAR Environment Impact Assessment Report EIT Enterprise Income Tax Exchange Rules The Foreign Currency Administration amended (1997 and 2008) Exclusive Products Various glass products produced by Saint-Gobain for which the Group has an exclusive distribution right Executives Within the meaning of the German Securities Trading Act any person discharging managerial responsibilities Existing Shares The share capital of 15,050,000 no-par value bearer shares of the Company at the time of the approval of the Prospectus External Information Industry, market and customer data as well as calculations 346 Rules (1996), as taken from industry reports, market research reports, publicly available information and commercial publications FIE Foreign Invested Enterprise Founding Shareholder Luckyway Global Group Limited as the founder of the Company GDP Gross domestic product GFA Gross Floor Area (in square meters) is a term commonly used in real estate market. It usually indicates the floor area inside the building and includes the external walls Grant Thornton Grant Thornton GmbH Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft Greenshoe Option The option granted by the Greenshoe Shareholders to biw AG to purchase the Greenshoe Shares from the Greenshoe Shareholders at the Offer Price less the agreed commission and other costs Greenshoe Shareholders Luckyway Global Group Limited, Quick Reach Group Limited, Expert Intelligence Global Limited, Sea Dragon Investments Limited and Hong Kong Investment Group Limited Greenshoe Shares Up to 900,000 no-par value bearer shares from the holdings of the Greenshoe Shareholders to be provided by the Greenshoe Shareholders to biw AG, prior to the allotment of the Offered Shares, for a potential over-allotment by way of a securities loan free of charge Group See “China Specialty Glass-Group”. Guangzhou Baiyun EPB Guangzhou Baiyun Environmental Protection Bureau Guangzhou Property Management Center Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center (previously Guangzhou City Liwan District Qianjin Glass Factory) HGB German Commercial Code (Handelsgesetzbuch) HK Chung Hwa Hong Kong Chung Hwa Enterprises Development Co. HKD Hong Kong’s currency, Hong Kong Dollar HNTE Guidance The Guidance on Recognition of HNTE HNTE Measures Measures for the Recognition of HNTE HNTEs High New Technology Enterprises, a category of companies in the PCR that are engaged in the areas of technology or product developments encouraged by the government, thus would be qualified to enjoy special tax and other incentive treatments from the central or local governments Hollow Glass Two or more layers of glass with vacuumed or inert gas filled space in the middle HW Investors Quick Reach Group Limited, Expert Intelligence Global Limited, Sea Dragon Investments Limited and Hong Kong Investments Group Limited HWG HK-Holding Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited HWG-Ltd. Guangzhou HingWah Glass Industry Co. Ltd. HWG-SC Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Co., Ltd. IFRS International Financial Reporting Standards 347 IMF International Monetary Fund Interim Regulations on Grant and Transfer Interim Regulations of the People’s Republic of China on Grant and Transfer of the Right to Use State-owned Urban Land Interlocking Door A specially designed door system that offers additional security features over normal doors Intruder-resistant Function of withstanding blows from normal sharp objects thus offering protection against violence or forced entry IP Intellectual property IPO Initial Public Offering ISO9001 ISO9001 is a standard for quality management systems set by the International Organization for Standardization Joint Bookrunners VISCARDI AG, biw AG Joint Lead Managers VISCARDI AG, biw AG Labour Contract Law PRC Labour Contract Law Land Use Rights These are the rights to utilize a certain piece of land. Land in China belongs to the State; only rights to use are issued to private enterprises or private citizens Liquid Crystal Liquid crystal is a chemical substance in a state of matter that has properties between those of a conventional liquid and those of a solid crystal. Such chemical substance is widely used in electronic display Liwan BOFTEC The Bureau of Foreign Trade and Economic Cooperation of Guangzhou Municipal Liwan District M&A Provisions PRC Provisions for the Acquisitions of Domestic Enterprises by Foreign Investors Management Committee Management Committee Industrial Park MOF Ministry of Finance of the PRC MOFCOM Ministry of Commerce of the PRC, responsible for administration of China’s foreign trade, foreign investment and economic cooperation MST Ministry of Science and Technology of the PRC Mu Chinese unit of measurement, 300 Mu corresponds to around 200,001 square meters NDRC National Development and Reform Commission of the PRC New York Convention Convention on the Recognition and Enforcement of Foreign Arbitral Award Non-exclusive Products Certain glass products produced by Saint-Gobain for which the Group has a non-exclusive distribution right Notice No. 75 Notice on Issues relating to the Administration of Foreign Exchange in Fund-raising and Reverse Investment Activities of Domestic Residents Conducted via Offshore Special Purpose Companies NPC National People’s Congress of the PRC Offer Terms The number of Offered Shares, the price range and the offering period, collectively 348 of Guangdong – Wenchuan Offered Shares Up to 6,900,000 no-par value bearer shares (lnhaber-Stückaktien) of China Specialty Glass AG, each with a calculated value of EUR 1.00 and carrying full dividend rights for the financial year 2011; consisting of the Delivery Shares and the Greenshoe Shares Offering Up to 6,900,000 no-par value bearer shares for the purpose of the public offering in Germany and Luxembourg and private placement in certain other jurisdictions Offer Price Offer price for the Offered Shares Over-allotment Investors may be allotted up to 900,000 Shares of the Company originating from a securities loan free of charge that was granted by the Greenshoe Shareholders (a maximum of 15% of the total number of Delivery Shares being allocated), in addition to the maximum total of 6,000,000 Delivery Shares of the Company being offered, as a stabilisation measure PBC People’s Bank of China, China’s central bank PC Polycarbonate is a particular group of thermoplastic polymers with interesting features such as temperature resistance, impact resistance and optical properties PCT Patent Cooperation Treaty, is an international patent law treaty providing a unified procedure for filing patent applications to protect inventions in each of its contracting states Photovoltaic Method to create voltage (thus electric current) in a material upon exposure to light. A term commonly used in solar energy sector Potassium Potassium is a chemical element with the symbol K. Elemental potassium is a soft silvery-white metallic alkali metal that oxidizes rapidly in air and is very reactive with water PRC People’s Republic of China Principal Shareholder Within the meaning of the German Stock Corporation Act a shareholder holding 95% of the share capital Product List List of Products Required for China Compulsory Certificate Prospectus Directive The prospectus directive 2003/71/EC Provinces Province is a translation of sheng (Chinese: 省), which is an administrative division of Chinese central government. There are currently 22 Provinces in China plus Taiwan. At the same level as the Provinces, five (5) Autonomous Regions (Chinese: 自治区) are populated by Chinese minorities, and four (4) central government directly-controlled Municipalities (Chinese: 直辖市): they are Beijing, Shanghai, Tianjing and Chongqing Provisional Security Regulation Provisional Regulation on the Security of Business Place and Cashbox of Financial Institutions (Yinfa [1998] No. 588) PU Polyurethane is any polymer consisting of a chain of organic units joined by urethane. Polyurethanes are widely used in various industrial applications. In specialty glass, they are used as high performance adhesives and sealants 349 PVB Polyvinyl butyral is a resin usually used for applications that require strong binding, optical clarity, adhesion to many surfaces, toughness and flexibility. R&D Research and Development Refitting Automobile A normal automobile being modified to have additional features Relevant Member State Each Member State of the European Economic Area that has implemented the Prospectus Directive RMB China’s currency, Renminbi RMR Report Research Report on China Bulletproof Glass Industry” from Respect Market Research Inc. SAFE State Administration of Foreign Exchange, in charge of governing China’s foreign exchange market activities and managing the nation’s exchange reserves Saint-Gobain The Saint-Gobain Group Saint-Gobain Products Various glass products produced by Saint-Gobain for which the Group has an exclusive distribution right and certain other products for which the Group has a non-exclusive distribution right Sale and Purchase Agreements The Share Purchase Agreements concluded between Mr. Nang Heung Sze, HWG-Ltd. and Mr. Chi Mang Cheung on 8 November 2006, between Mr. Nang Heung Sze, HWG-Ltd. and Mr. Yan Kong Wong on the same date, between Mr. Nang Heung Sze, HWG-Ltd. and Mr. Ching Hoi Sze on 20 December 2006 and between Mr. Nang Heung Sze, HWG-Ltd. and Mr. Hung Hui Ke on 22 December 2006 SAT State Administration of Taxation of the PRC Security Glass Specialty glass used primarily for personal protection against physical violence and forced intrusion SIPO State Intellectual Property Office of the PRC Sodium Sodium is a metallic element with a symbol Na. It is a soft, silvery-white, highly reactive metal and is a member of the alkali metals. Sole Global Coordinator VISCARDI AG Specialty Glass Normal flat glass that is processed to remove some of the disadvantages of normal glass and add more desirable features SPV Special Purpose Vehicle Stabilisation Period The period during which stabilisation measures may be taken in order to support the initial exchange price, if necessary; from the date the Existing Shares list for trading until no later than 30 calendar days after such date Tax Arrangement Arrangement concluded between the Mainland China and the Hong Kong Special Administrative Region, the purpose of which is to avoid a double taxation of income Tempered Glass Thermally or chemically treated glass that is stronger than normal glass but also safer to use TEUR Thousand Euros 350 Tort Liability Law PRC Tort Liability Law Transaction The Offering and the listing of the Company’s shares TRE Tax Residence Enterprise TRIPs Trade-related Aspects of Intellectual Property Rights Underwriters VISCARDI AG, biw AG Underwriting Agreement Underwriting Agreement regarding the sale and the offer of the Offered Shares in the course of the Offering concluded between the Company, the Greenshoe Shareholders, Mr. Nang Heung Sze and Mr. Chun Li Shi and the Underwriters Urban Real Estate Law PRC Law on Administration of Urban Real Estate USD Currency of United States of America, US Dollar US Securities Act The U.S. Securities Act of 1933, as amended Utility Model Patent A registered right which confers exclusive protection on technical inventions with respect to the functional aspect of a product due to the inventive shape, structure or combination of shape and structure Utilization Rate The ratio between actual production output and the available production capacity in the same year VAT Value Added Tax VISCARDI VISCARDI AG, Munich, Germany Weight Box A unit measure commonly used in China for bulky product like glass. One weight box of glass equals 50 kg, or 10 square meters of 2 mm thick glass. Wertpapierprospektgesetz German Securities Prospectus Law WFOE Wholly Foreign Owned Enterprise WpPG German Securities (Wertpapierprospektgesetz) WTO World Trade Organization 351 Prospectus Act FINANCIAL SECTION Table of Contents Financial statements of GUANGZHOU HING WAH GLASS INDUSTRY CO., LTD. for the financial years ended 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010 in accordance with IFRS as endorsed for application by the EU (audited)....................................... F-2 Interim financial statements of GUANGZHOU HING WAH GLASS INDUSTRY CO., LTD. for the three months to 31 March 2011 in accordance with IFRS as endorsed for application by the EU (reviewed) ..................................................... F-58 Consolidated financial statements of CHINA SPECIALTY GLASS AG for the short financial period 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 in accordance with IFRS as endorsed for application by the EU (audited)..................................... F-73 Interim condensed consolidated financial statements of CHINA SPECIALTY GLASS AG for the three months to 31 March 2011 in accordance with IFRS as endorsed for application by the EU (reviewed) ................................................... F-128 Financial statements of CHINA SPECIALTY GLASS AG for the short financial period 10 May 2010 to 31 December 2010 in accordance with German GAAP (audited)....................................................................................................... F-144 F-1 Financial statements of GUANGZHOU HING WAH GLASS INDUSTRY CO., LTD. for the financial years ended 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010 in accordance with IFRS as endorsed for application by the EU (audited) F-2 Statement of Comprehensive Income Note Revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Finance income Finance costs Research and development costs Profit before taxation Taxation Net profit Other comprehensive income: Currency translation differences Total comprehensive income 3 4 5 5 6 7 Profit attributable to: owners of the parent Total comprehensive income attributable to: owners of the parent Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR 40,216 (23,000) 50,910 (28,032) 69,564 (38,111) 17,216 (1,205) (848) 51 (104) (965) 14,145 (3,545) 10,600 22,878 (1,704) (874) 47 (106) (1,384) 18,857 (4,726) 14,131 31,453 (2,277) (1,038) 108 (110) (1,878) 26,258 (4,006) 22,252 2,229 12,829 (1,570) 12,561 3,621 25,873 10,600 14,131 22,252 12,829 12,561 25,873 The comparability is also effected by movements in the relative value of the functional currency (RMB) compared to the presentational currency (EUR). The annexed notes form an integral part of and should be read in conjunction with these financial statements. F-3 Statement of Financial Position Note 2008 TEUR 2009 TEUR 2010 TEUR Assets Non-current Property, plant and equipment Lease prepayment for land-use rights Other assets Investment in a subsidiary Loan to subsidiary Deferred tax asset 8 9 10 11 11 12 2,224 753 33 3,010 2,119 687 166 2,972 2,839 751 1,133 3,060 7,783 Current assets Inventories Trade and other receivables Related party receivables Tax receivable Cash and bank balances 13 14 15 7 16 1,990 5,562 14,330 21,882 24,892 2,356 9,614 16,811 28,781 31,753 1,591 11,967 71 438 37,801 51,868 59,651 17 17 17 17 424 213 1,412 10,239 424 213 (158) 24,370 1,393 724 3,463 43,772 12,288 24,849 49,352 888 2,230 1,383 8,103 12,604 24,892 1,549 3,751 1,604 6,904 31,753 1,311 4,908 1,813 2,267 10,299 59,651 Total assets Equity and liabilities Capital and Reserves Share capital Statutory reserve Foreign currency translation reserve Retained earnings Current liabilities Corporate income tax payable Trade and other payables Interest-bearing bank borrowings Dividends payable to related parties 7 18 19 20 Total equity and liabilities The statements of financial position at 31 December 2008 and 31 December 2010 are materially affected by dividends payable to related parties. This has the effect of materially increasing total equity and liabilities at those reporting dates. The comparability is affected by movements in the relative value of the functional currency (RMB) compared to the presentational currency (EUR). The annexed notes form an integral part of and should be read in conjunction with these financial statements. F-4 Statement of Changes in Equity Balance at 1 January 2008 Share Statutory Translation Retained Total Capital Reserve Reserve Earnings Equity TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR (Note 17) (Note 17) (Note 17) (Note 17) 424 213 (817) 7,742 7,562 Total comprehensive income - - 2,229 10,600 12,829 Dividends (Note 19) - - - (8,103) (8,103) 424 213 1,412 10,239 12,288 - - (1,570) 14,131 12,561 Balance at 31 December 2009 424 213 (158) 24,370 24,849 Share issue 969 - - - 969 Balance at 31 December 2008 Total comprehensive income Total comprehensive income - - 3,621 22,252 25,873 Dividends (Note 19) - - - (2,339) (2,339) Transfer to Statutory Reserve - 511 - (511) - Balance at 31 December 2010 1,393 724 3,463 43,772 49,352 In 2008 dividends of EUR 8,103,000 were declared. In 2009 no dividends were declared. In 2010 dividends of EUR 2,339,000 were declared. As the share capital is not divided up into shares, and is held by one shareholder, no subdivided figure of dividends per share can be given. The comparability is affected by movements in the relative value of the functional currency (RMB) compared to the presentational currency (EUR). The annexed notes form an integral part of and should be read in conjunction with these financial statements. F-5 Statement of Cash Flows Note Cash flows from operating activities Profit before taxation Adjustments for: Finance income Finance costs Loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment Depreciation property, plant and equipment Change in lease prepayment for land-use rights Operating profit before working capital changes Decrease/(increase) in inventories Decrease/(increase) in trade and other Receivables (Decrease)/increase in trade and other payables Increase in receivable from related party Cash generated from operations Finance income received Income tax paid Net cash from operating activities Cash flows from investing activities Purchase of property, plant and equipment Advance payment for leasehold buildings Construction in progress Investment in a subsidiary Loan granted to subsidiary Net cash used in investing activities 5 5 8 10 8 8 8 Cash flows from financing activities Bank borrowings obtained Repayment of bank borrowings Issue in share capital Dividends paid Finance costs paid Net cash used in financing activities Net increase in cash and bank balances Cash and bank balances at beginning of financial year Exchange differences on translation of cash and bank balances at beginning of financial year Cash and bank balances at end of financial year 17 Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR 14,145 18,857 26,258 (51) 104 29 14,227 638 (47) 106 127 13 19,056 (300) (108) 110 -* 181 26 26,467 1,054 1,190 (1,453) 14,602 51 (3,812) 10,841 (4,915) 1,767 15,608 47 (4,107) 11,548 (1,025) 656 (122) 27,030 108 (4,795) 22,343 (710) (710) (59) (126) (185) (574) (44) (1,133) (2,955) (4,706) 1,516 (1,526) (5,611) (104) (5,725) 4,406 1,686 (1,349) (7,903) (106) (7,672) 3,691 1,796 (1,796) 969 (110) 859 18,496 8,199 14,330 16,811 1,725 (1,210) 2,494 14,330 16,811 37,801 * Amount is less than EUR 1,000 The annexed notes form an integral part of and should be read in conjunction with these financial statements. F-6 1. THE COMPANY The financial statements of the Company have been prepared on a voluntary basis in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) in so far as these have been endorsed by the EU. The principal activity of the Company is the manufacture and distribution of bullet proof and toughened glass products. The principal and registered place of business of the Company is located at No. 6, Hougang Xijie, Guanghai Road, Guangzhou the People's Republic of China (the “PRC”). The immediate holding company is Hing Wah Holding Ltd., which is incorporated in Hong Kong. Via a non-cash capital contribution of all the share capital of Hing Wah Holding Limited in November 2010 into China Specialty Glass AG, a holding company incorporated in Grünwald, Munich, Germany, Hing Wah Holding Limited became a subsidiary of China Specialty Glass AG effective November 2010. Subsequently China Specialty Glass AG intends to seek a listing on the German Stock Exchange (Prime Standard Segment). As at the date of this report, there is only one class of shares in the Company, being ordinary shares. The rights and privileges of the shares are stated in the By-laws. There are no founder, management or deferred or unissued shares reserved for issuance for any purpose. The figures presented in the financial statements have been rounded to the nearest EUR thousand. The financial statements for the years ended 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010 (including comparatives) are expected to be approved and authorized for issue by the directors at the end of June 2011. F-7 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES 2.1 Statement of compliance and basis of preparation of Financial Statements The stand alone single entity Financial Statements are prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) including related interpretations, in so far as these have been endorsed by the EU, and have been consistently applied throughout the financial years ended 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010. These Financial Statements are the first set of financial statements prepared in accordance with IFRS by the Company. The significant accounting policies that have been applied in the preparation of these Financial Statements are summarised below. These accounting policies have been used throughout all periods presented in the Financial Statements. The Financial Statements are presented in accordance with IAS 1 Presentation of Financial Statements (Revised 2007). In accordance with IFRS 1, the Company presents three statements of Financial Position in its first IFRS Financial Statements. The financial year of the Company is from 1 January to 31 December. The financial statements have been prepared for the purpose of inclusion in the Prospectus for the Initial Public Offering of China Specialty Glass AG, which is intended to take place in 2011. For purpose of comparison the Company added statements of comprehensive income, statements of changes in equity, and statements of cash flow as of 31 December 2008. In future periods, the Company presents two comparative periods for the statement of financial position only when it: (i) applies an accounting policy retrospectively, (ii) makes a retrospective restatement of items in its Financial Statements, or (iii) reclassifies items in the Financial Statements. IFRS 1, First-time Adoption of Financial Reporting Standards, has been applied in preparing these Financial Statements. The Company maintains its accounting records in Chinese Renminbi (RMB) and prepares its statutory financial statements in accordance with People’s Republic of China (PRC) generally accepted accounting practice. The financial information in these financial statements is based on the statutory records without any differences between PRC accounting records and IFRS, except for the separate disclosure of land use rights as other assets or lease prepayment for land-use rights respectively. This difference has however no effect on the net assets or on the comprehensive income of the Company. F-8 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.1 Statement of compliance and basis of preparation of Financial Statements (continued) The transition to IFRS does not materially affect the reported financial position, financial performance or cash flow. Consequently, the Company does not prepare reconciliations from PRC GAAP to IFRS. 2.2 Published Amendments but not yet applied Standards, Interpretations and At the time of preparation of the financial statements, the following releases of the IASB as well as their changes and revisions were not compulsorily applicable in the 2010 financial year, and were not applied by the Company: 1. IAS 24 and changes to IFRS 8: “Related party disclosures” (effective 1 January 2011) 2. Changes to IAS 32: “Financial instruments: presentation” (Classification of Rights Issues) (effective 1 February 2010) 3. Changes to IFRS 1 and IFRS 7: “First-time adoption of IFRS” and “Financial instruments: disclosures” (Limited Exemption from Comparative IFRS 7 Disclosures for First-Time Adoptors) (effective 1 July 2010) 4. Changes to IFRIC 14: “The Limit on an Defined Benefit Asset, Minimum Funding Requirements and their Interaction” (Prepayments of a Minimum Funding Requirement) ” (effective 1 January 2011) 5. IFRIC 19 and consequential changes to IFRS 1: “Extinguishing Financial Liabilities with Equity Instruments” and “First-time adoption of IFRS” (effective 1 July 2011) Annual Improvements 2010 ” (effective 1 July 2010) 6. The following accounting standards and amendments to existing standards have been published but, as at 31 December 2010, are not yet effective and have not yet been adopted by the European Union: · Amendments to IFRS 1: First-time Adoption: Additional Exemptions to First-time Adopters (effective from 1 July 2011) · Amendments to IFRS 7: Financial instruments disclosures (effective from 1 July 2012) · IFRS 9: Financial Instruments (effective from 1 January 2013) · Amendments to IAS 12: Deferred Tax Recovery of Underlying Assets (effective from 1 January 2012) F-9 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.2 Published but not yet Amendments (continued) applied Standards, Interpretations and The management of the Company assumes that the new and amended standards and interpretations will likely not have a material effect on the consolidated financial statements when they are applied by the Company. The Financial Statements have been prepared in accordance with the significant accounting policies set out below and these accounting policies are in accordance with IFRS. The preparation of the Financial Statements in conformity with IFRS requires the use of judgments, estimates and assumptions that affect the application of accounting policies as disclosed below, reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the Financial statements and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the financial years. 2.3 Overall Considerations The significant accounting policies that have been used in the preparation of these financial statements are summarized below. The financial statements have been prepared using the measurement bases and accounting policies specified by IFRS for each type of asset, liability, income and expense. These are more fully described below. 2.4 Presentation of Financial Statements The financial statements are presented in accordance with IAS 1 Presentation of Financial Statements. The statement of comprehensive income has been prepared using the function of expense method. The Company has elected to adopt IAS 1 (Revised 2007) by presenting the 'Statement of comprehensive income' in one statement. F-10 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.5 Critical accounting estimates and judgment Estimates and judgments are continually evaluated and are based on historical experiences and other factors, including expectations of future events that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. The Company makes estimates and assumptions concerning the future. The resulting accounting estimates and assumptions that have a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next financial year are discussed below: 2.6 Key sources of estimation uncertainty Depreciation of property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment are depreciated on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. Management estimates the useful lives of these assets to be within 5 to 30 years. The carrying amounts of the Company’s property, plant and equipment as at 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010 were EUR 2,224,000, EUR 2,119,000 and EUR 2,839,000 respectively. Changes in the expected level of usage and technological developments could impact the economic useful lives and the residual values of these assets, therefore future depreciation charges could be revised. Income tax The Company has exposure to income taxes in the PRC. Significant judgment is required in determining the provision for income taxes. There are also claims for which the ultimate tax determination is uncertain during the ordinary course of business. The Company recognises liabilities for expected tax issues based on estimates of whether additional taxes will be due. When the final tax outcome of these matters is different from the amounts that were initially recognised, such differences will impact the income tax and deferred tax provisions in the period in which such determination is made. The carrying amount of the Company’s income tax payables as at 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010 amounted to EUR 888,000, EUR 1,549,000 and EUR 1,311,000 respectively. F-11 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.6 Key sources of estimation uncertainty (continued) Inventories Inventories are measured at the lower of cost and net realizable value. In estimating net realizable values, management takes into account the most reliable evidence available at the times the estimates are made. Changes in these estimates could result in revisions to the valuation of inventories. The carrying value of inventories at 31 December 2010 is TEUR 1,591 (TEUR 2,356 at 31 December 2009 and TEUR 1,990 at 31 December 2008). Provisions The respective legislation in the PRC requires the Company to commit itself to remediate any environmental damages which may have been incurred. Management is of the opinion that no environmental damage has been caused by the Company and hence has not provided for this. 2.7 Critical judgment made in applying accounting policies In the process of applying the Company’s accounting policies as described below, management is of the opinion that there are no instances of application of judgments which are expected to have a significant effect on the amounts recognised in the financial statements. Estimation of cost attributable to other assets (land use rights) and to property, plant and equipment. In 2007, the Company made an advance payment for land use rights and building, which it intended to purchase. The advance payment of EUR 1,801,000 was not attributed separately to land use rights and to the building at the time of making the advance payment. Management obtained a valuation report which stated the market value of the land use rights and the market value of the building. The total market value was above the total of the advanced payment made. Management then allocated the advanced payment pro rata the market valuation to the land use rights and the building. In 2009, the Company decided no longer to purchase the land use rights and building but to lease them and a lease agreement was made for a period of 30 years commencing on 1 July 2009. This agreement was subsequently replaced by one dated April 2010, also with a 30 year term. The lease agreement can be extended by negotiation by 60 days before the lease term expires. According to the PRC law, the lease term may not F-12 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.7 Critical judgment made in applying accounting policies (continued) Estimation of cost attributable to other assets (land use rights) and to property, plant and equipment (continued) exceed 20 years however. If it exceeds twenty years, the period in excess is invalid. Therefore, the term of the legal lease expires on 31 March 2030 as the lease is invalid after 1 April 2030. However the Company assumes it will be able to extend the lease as described above and an extension is legal under the laws of the PRC. Impairment of trade receivables The Company’s management assesses the collectability of trade receivables. This estimate is based on the credit history of the Company’s customers and the current market condition. Management assesses the impairment loss at the date of the statement of financial position and makes the provision, if any. 2.8 Detailed Accounting Policies Other assets Other assets relate exclusively to an advance payment for land use rights. In 2009 an operating lease was concluded in respect of these land use rights and the advance payment was subsequently treated as a lease prepayment for landuse rights. Other assets are recognized at cost less accumulated impairment losses and are written off where, in the opinion of the directors, no further future economic benefits are expected to arise. Property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and impairment losses. The cost of property, plant and equipment comprises the purchase price and any costs directly attributable to bringing the asset to the working condition and location for its intended use. Expenditure incurred after property, plant and equipment have been put into operation, such as repairs and maintenance, is normally recognized in profit or loss in the period in which it is incurred. In situations where it can be clearly demonstrated that the expenditure has resulted in an increase in the future economic benefits expected to be obtained from the use of the property, plant and equipment, and the expenditure of the item can be measured reliably, the expenditure is capitalised as an additional cost of that asset. F-13 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed Accounting Policies (continued) Property, plant and equipment (continued) Advance payments for property, plant and equipment acquired are recognised as an asset when payment for the property, plant and equipment has been made in advance of the final delivery of the property, plant and equipment. Depreciation on property, plant and equipment is calculated using the straightline method to write off the cost of property, plant and equipment, less any estimated residual values, over the following estimated useful lives: Leasehold building Plant and machinery Furniture, fixtures and office equipment Motor vehicles 30 years 10 years 5 years 10 years The estimated residual values, estimated useful lives and depreciation method of the property, plant and equipment are reviewed, and adjusted as appropriate, at each statement of financial position date. The gain or loss on disposal or retirement of an item of property, plant and equipment recognized in profit or loss is the difference between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the relevant asset. Lease prepayment for land-use rights Following the conclusion of a lease agreement in 2009, the advance payment for land use rights was treated as a lease prepayment for land-use rights. The prepayment is, except for an immaterial portion, non current and is being expensed to income over the 30 year term of the lease. Equity Investment in Subsidiary Equity investment is the investment in the entire share capital of the Company’s subsidiary, Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Limited. Due to the lack of a readily available market or a reliably determinable fair value, this investment is carried at cost, less allowance for impairment if required. The cost of the subsidiary was determined as the nominal value of its share capital as the transaction occurred between parties under common control and the controlling individual. The investment is subject to impairment testing. Subsidiaries are entities controlled by the Company. Control exists when the Company has the power to govern the financial and operating policies of an entity so as to obtain benefits from its activities. F-14 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed Accounting Policies (continued) Equity Investment in Subsidiary (continued) The existence and effect of potential voting rights that are currently exercisable or convertible are considered when assessing whether the Company controls another entity. Details of the subsidiary held are disclosed in note 11. No consolidated financial statements for the financial year ended 31 December 2010 have been prepared as the ultimate holding company, China Specialty Glass AG, publishes consolidated financial statements in which the financial statements of the Company, its subsidiary and its direct parent are included, that are publicly available in the context of an IPO prospectus. The registered address of the ultimate holding company is An den Römerhügeln 1, 82031 Grünwald, Munich, Germany. Prior to 2010 the Company had no subsidiaries and hence was not required to prepare consolidated financial statements. Impairment of non-financial assets Other assets and Property, plant and equipment are tested for impairment whenever there is any objective evidence or indication that these assets may be impaired. For the purpose of impairment testing, the recoverable amount (i.e. the higher of the fair value less cost to sell and the value-in-use) is determined on an individual asset basis unless the asset does not generate cash flows that are largely independent of those from other assets. If this is the case, the recoverable amount is determined for the cash-generating-unit (“CGU”) to which the asset belongs. If the recoverable amount of the asset (or CGU) is estimated to be less than its carrying amount, the carrying amount of the asset (or CGU) is reduced to its recoverable amount. The difference between the carrying amount and recoverable amount is recognised as an impairment loss in profit or loss, unless the asset is carried at revalued amount, in which case, such impairment loss is treated as a revaluation decrease. F-15 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed Accounting Policies (continued) Financial assets Financial assets are recognized in the statement of financial position when, and only when, the Company becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instrument. Regular purchases and sales of financial assets are accounted for at trade date, i.e. the date that the Company commits to purchase or sell the asset. The financial assets of the Company comprise loans and receivables and also the available for sale equity investment in its subsidiary, accounted for as described above. The Company does not have any other financial assets. The Company’s loans and receivables comprise trade and other receivables (excluding prepayments), receivables from related parties and cash and bank balances in the statement of financial position. The Company's loans and receivables are non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments that are not quoted in an active market. They arise principally via the provision of goods and services to distributors (e.g. trade receivables), but also incorporate other types of contractual monetary assets. They are initially recognized at fair value plus transaction costs that are directly attributable to their acquisition or issue if any, and are subsequently carried at amortized cost using the effective interest rate method, less provision for impairment. Impairment provisions are recognized when there is objective evidence that the Company will be unable to collect all of the amounts due under the terms of receivables, the amount of such a provision being the difference between the net carrying amount and the present value of the future expected cash flows associated with the impaired receivables. For trade receivables, which are reported net of impairment provisions, such provisions are recorded in a separate allowance account with the loss being recognized within administration expense in the statement of comprehensive income. On confirmation that the trade receivables will not be collectable, the gross carrying value of the asset is written off against the associated provision. Gains on loans and receivables are primarily from interest and are determined on the effective interest method. Losses are primarily from impairment and are determined by management analysis of the ageing of loans and receivables based on experience of default risk and history. F-16 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed Accounting Policies (continued) Financial assets (continued) Insofar as loans and receivables mature within 12 months after the statement of financial position date, they are presented as current assets. Insofar as they mature after 12 months after the statement of financial position date, they are presented as non current assets. Inventories Inventories are carried at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Cost is determined using the weighted average method. The cost of finished goods comprises raw materials, direct labour and other overheads that have been incurred in bringing the inventories to their present location and condition. Net realisable value is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business, less the estimated costs of completion and the estimated costs necessary to make the sale. In valuing inventory, it is assumed that inventory is utilised on a first in first out basis. The carrying values of inventories are disclosed under note 13. Equity reserves and dividend payments Share capital represents the nominal value of shares that have been issued in the Company. Share capital is determined using the nominal value of shares that have been issued. In accordance with the relevant laws and regulations of PRC, companies established in PRC are required to transfer 10% of their annual statutory net profit (after offsetting any prior years’ losses) to the statutory reserve. When the balance of such reserve reaches 50% of the company’s share capital, any further transfer of its annual statutory net profit is optional. Such reserve may be used to offset accumulated losses or to increase the registered capital of the company subject to the approval of the relevant authorities. However, except for offsetting prior years’ losses, such statutory reserve must be maintained at a minimum of 25% of the share capital after such usage. The statutory reserves are not available for dividend distribution to the shareholders. Retained earnings include all current and prior period results as determined in the statements of comprehensive income. F-17 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed Accounting Policies (continued) Equity reserves and dividend payments (continued) Foreign currency translation differences arising on the translation are included in the translation reserve. Dividend distributions payable to equity shareholders are included under 'current liabilities' as “dividends payable” when the dividends have been approved in a general meeting prior to the reporting date. Financial liabilities Financial liabilities are recognised when the Company becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the financial instrument. Financial liabilities are recognised initially at fair value, plus in the case of financial liabilities other than derivatives, directly attributable transaction costs. Subsequent to initial recognition, all financial liabilities are measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method, except for derivatives, which are measured at fair value. All interest related charges are recognised as an expense in profit or loss. Financial liabilities are derecognised when the obligation for the liabilities is discharged or cancelled or expired. For financial liabilities other than derivatives, gains and losses are recognised in profit or loss when the liabilities are derecognised or impaired, and through the amortisation process. The Company’s financial liabilities include dividends payable to related parties, interest-bearing bank borrowings, trade and other payables. Trade and other payables interest-bearing bank borrowings and dividends payable to related parties are initially recognised at fair value, and subsequently carried at amortised cost using the effective interest method. F-18 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed Accounting Policies (continued) Provisions and contingent liabilities Provisions are recognized when the Company has a present obligation (legal or constructive) where, as a result of a past event, it is probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation and a reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation. Provisions are not recognized for future operating losses. Where the Company expects some or all of a provision to be reimbursed, the reimbursement is recognized as a separate asset but only when the reimbursement is virtually certain. However, this asset may not exceed the amount of the related provision. The expense relating to any provision is presented in the combined statement of comprehensive income net of any reimbursement. Provisions are measured at the estimated expenditure required to settle the present obligation, based on the most reliable evidence available at the reporting date, including the risks and uncertainties associated with the present obligation. Where there are a number of similar obligations, the likelihood that an outflow will be required in settlement is determined by considering the class of obligations as a whole. Provisions are discounted to their present values, where the time value of money is material. In those cases where the possible outflow of economic resources as a result of present obligations is considered improbable or remote, no liability is recognized. All provisions and contingent liabilities are reviewed at each reporting date and adjusted to reflect the current best estimate. Provisions for environmental protection are recorded if future cash outflows are likely to be necessary to ensure compliance with environmental regulations or to carry out remediation work, such costs can be reliably estimated and no future benefits are expected from such measures. Estimating the future costs of environmental protection and remediation involves many uncertainties, particularly with regard to the status of laws and regulations. Management considers that environmental damage has not been caused by the Company and hence has not provided for environmental protection. F-19 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed Accounting Policies (continued) Revenue and other income Revenue is measured at the fair value of the consideration received or receivable and presented net of goods and services taxes and trade discounts. The Company sells bullet proof and toughened security glass to various customers in the automotive, banking and construction sectors. Revenue from the sale of manufactured products is recognised when the Company has transferred to customers the significant risks and rewards of ownership of the goods, which generally coincides with the delivery to and acceptance of goods by the customers; and when the Company can reliably measure the amount of revenue and the cost incurred and to be incurred in respect of the transaction; and it is probable that the collectability of the related receivables is reasonably assured. No revenue is recognised if there are significant uncertainties regarding recovery of the consideration due, associated costs or the possible return of goods. Finance income Finance income is recognised using the effective interest method. Employee benefits - Retirement benefits scheme Pursuant to the relevant regulations of the PRC government, the Company participates in a local municipal government retirement benefits scheme (the "Scheme"), whereby it is required to contribute a certain percentage of the basic salaries of its employees to the Scheme to fund their retirement benefits. The local municipal government undertakes to assume the retirement benefits obligations of all existing and future retired employees of the subsidiaries located in the PRC. The only obligation of the Company with respect to the Scheme is to pay the ongoing required contributions under the Scheme mentioned above. Contributions under the Scheme are recognized in profit or loss as incurred. There are no provisions under the Scheme whereby forfeited contributions may be used to reduce future contributions. These plans are considered defined contribution plans. The Company has no legal or constructive obligations to pay further contributions after its payment of the fixed contributions into the national pension schemes. Contributions to national pension schemes are recognized as an expense in the period in which the related service is performed. F-20 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed Accounting Policies (continued) Key management personnel Key management personnel are those persons having the authority and responsibility for planning, directing and controlling the activities of the entity. Directors and certain managers are considered key management personnel of the Company. Income tax Tax expense recognised in profit or loss comprises the sum of current and deferred tax charges. Current income tax assets and/or liabilities comprise those obligations to, or claims from, fiscal authorities relating to the current or prior reporting periods, that are unpaid at the reporting date. Current tax is payable on taxable profit, which differs from profit or loss in the financial statements. Calculation of current tax is based on tax rates and tax laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the end of the reporting period in the country in which the Company is operating. Value-added tax (“VAT”) The Company’s sale of goods in the PRC is subject to VAT at the applicable tax rate of 17% for the PRC domestic sales. Input VAT on purchases can be deducted from output VAT. The net amount of VAT recoverable from, or payable to, the tax authority is included as part of “other receivables” or “other payables” in the statement of financial position. Revenue, expenses and assets are recognised net of the amount of VAT except: Ø where the VAT incurred on a purchase of assets or services is not recoverable from the tax authority, in which case the VAT is recognised as part of the cost of acquisition of the asset or as part of the expense item as applicable; and Ø receivables and payables that are stated with the amount of VAT included. F-21 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed Accounting Policies (continued) Foreign currencies (i) Functional and presentation currency Items included in the financial statements are measured using the currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity operates (the “functional currency”). The Company conducts its business predominately in the PRC and hence its functional currency is the Renminbi (RMB). The presentation currency of the Company is EUR, being the presentation currency of its future ultimate German domiciled legal parent and holding company, and therefore the financial information has been translated from RMB to EUR at the following rates: 31 December 2008 31 December 2009 31 December 2010 Period end rates EUR 1.00 = RMB 9.2563 EUR 1.00 = RMB 9.9742 EUR 1.00 = RMB 8.8231 Average rates EUR 1.00 = RMB 10.1588 EUR 1.00 = RMB 9.4904 EUR 1.00 = RMB 8.9789 The results and financial positions of the Company in its functional currency RMB are translated into the presentation currency for the purpose of presentation in the IPO prospectus of its future ultimate legal parent as follows: (1) Assets and liabilities for each statement of financial position presented are translated at the closing rate at the date of that statement of financial position; (2) Income and expenses for each income statement are translated at average exchange rates (unless this average is not a reasonable approximation of the cumulative effect of the rates prevailing on the transaction dates, in which case income and expenses are translated at the dates of the transactions); and (3) All resulting exchange differences are recognised in the foreign currency translation reserve, a separate component of equity. F-22 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed Accounting Policies (continued) Foreign currencies (continued) (ii) Transactions and balances Foreign currency transactions are measured and recorded in the functional currency using the exchange rates prevailing at the dates of the transactions. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are translated at the closing rates ruling at the respective statement of financial position dates. Foreign exchange gains and losses resulting from the settlement of such transactions and from the translation at year-end exchange rates of monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are recognised in profit or loss. Non-monetary items that are measured in terms of historical cost in a foreign currency are translated using the exchange rates as at the dates of the initial transactions. Non-monetary items measured at fair value in a foreign currency are translated using the exchange rates at the date when the fair value was determined. Related parties The Company has the following types of related parties: (i) entities or individuals which directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, (1) control, or are under common control with, the Company; (2) have an interest in the Company that gives them significant influence over the Company; (ii) the key management personnel of the Company or its direct parent and its ultimate parent company; (iii) close members of the family of any individual referred to in (i) or (ii); F-23 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed Accounting Policies (continued) Leases Lessee Leases where substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of assets remain with the lessor are accounted for as operating leases. Annual rentals applicable to such operating leases are recognised in profit or loss on a straightline basis over the lease terms except where an alternative basis is more representative of the pattern of benefits to be derived from the leased assets. Leases where substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are transferred to the lessee are accounted for as finance leases. Segment reporting Operating segments are reported in a manner consistent with the internal reporting provided to the chief operating decision-maker. The chief operating decision-maker, who is responsible for allocating resources and assessing performance of the operating segments, has been identified as the board of directors of the Company which makes strategic decisions. The management of the Company bases its decisions on the internal reporting on sales to car manufacturers, banks and financial institutions and construction companies, which are the Company’s three business segments. Segment information is presented in respect of the Company’s business segments. The accounting policies the Company uses for segment reporting under IFRS 8 are the same as those used in its financial statements. Development activities Expenditure on research (or the research phase of an internal project) is recognized as an expense in the period in which it is incurred. Costs that are directly attributable to the development phase of new products and ranges are also expensed as they do not meet the criteria to be recognized as an intangible asset in accordance with IAS 38. The amounts of this expense on product research and development in 2008, 2009 and 2010 were TEUR 965, TEUR 1,384 and TEUR 1,878 respectively. F-24 3. REVENUE An analysis of the Company's revenue is as follows: Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR 40,216 50,910 69,564 Revenue Sales of goods Revenue is generated from sales of bullet proof and toughened security glass to various customers in the automotive, banking and construction sectors within the PRC. Further details are given in the segment reporting in Note 25. 4. COST OF SALES Cost of sales comprise purchasing materials, labour costs for personnel employed in production, depreciation and amortization of non-current assets used for production purposes, trading goods and others (mainly tools, packaging materials and maintenance costs). The following table shows a breakdown of costs of sales for the period under review for each category: Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Materials Labour Depreciation of property, plant and equipment Operating lease expense Electricity and water Others F-25 19,826 1,220 23,629 1,582 32,504 1,606 28 21 1,056 849 23,000 126 26 1,600 1,069 28,032 167 36 1,818 1,980 38,111 5. FINANCE INCOME AND FINANCE COSTS Finance income Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Finance income 51 47 108 Finance costs Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Finance expense on bank borrowings 6. (104) (106) (110) PROFIT BEFORE TAXATION The Company's profit before taxation is arrived at after charging: Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Depreciation of property, plant and equipment - included in cost of sales - included in administrative expenses Cost of inventories sold recognised as expenses Operating lease expense Research costs expensed 28 1 29 105 22 127 167 14 181 19,826 33 965 23,629 38 1,384 32,504 49 1,878 Costs relating to employees are disclosed in detail in note 26. F-26 7. TAXATION Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Current income tax on profit arising from operations in PRC Deferred tax (credit)/expense (Note 12) 3,531 4,868 3,822 14 3,545 (142) 4,726 184 4,006 Deferred tax has been provided as the Company has temporary differences which gave rise to a deferred tax asset at the statement of financial position dates. These differences are mainly due to differences in the timing of revenue recognition between the revenue recognition adapted for the Company’s tax accounts and the revenue recognition adapted in the Company’s financial statements. Reconciliation between tax expense and profit before taxation at statutory tax rates is as follows: Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Profit before taxation Tax calculated at statutory tax rate (2008: 25%, 2009: 25% and 2010: 15%) Tax effect on non-deductible expense Effect of reduction in tax rate 14,145 18,857 26,258 3,536 4,714 3,939 6 3 3,545 12 4,726 11 56 4,006 The Company is subject to PRC income tax on profit arising or derived from the tax jurisdiction in which the Company operates and is domiciled. Business operations set up in the special economic zones by foreign enterprises are subject to a reduced enterprise income tax rate. The provision for PRC income tax on profits arising from operations in the PRC is calculated based on enterprise income tax rates of 25%, 25% and 15% for the financial year ended 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010 respectively, in accordance with the relevant PRC income tax rules and regulations. F-27 7. TAXATION (continued) Movements in corporate income tax payable are as follows: 2008 TEUR Beginning of financial year Current year tax expenses on profit Income tax paid Tax recoverable (Note 16) Withholding tax on dividend Exchange difference on translation End of financial year 1,032 3,531 (3,812) 137 888 Year ended 31 December 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR 888 4,868 (4,107) (100) 1,549 1,549 3,822 (4,795) 430 114 192 1,312 The tax receivable results from the fact that the Company paid tax at 25% in the first quarter of 2010 and was however subsequently granted status as a high tech enterprise, which afforded it the benefit of a lower preferential rate of 15% for 2010. The Company expects to be able to claim back the overpaid tax. F-28 8. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT Advance Payments for leasehold buildings Leasehold buildings Plant and Machinery Furniture Fixtures and office equipment Motor Vehicles Construction in progress Total TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR Cost At 1 January 2008 Additions Translation adjustment At 31 December 2008 Additions Reclassification 1,099 - 432 31 - - 1,562 - - 710 - - - 710 174 - 138 5 - - 317 1,273 - 1,280 36 - - 2,589 57 2 - - 185 - - - - - 126 (1,273) 1,273 Translation adjustment (6) (91) (95) (3) - - (195) 120 1,182 1,242 35 - - 2,579 Additions - 292 257 3 22 44 618 Written off - - (5) - - - (5) (134) 134 - - - - - 14 161 166 5 -* -* 346 - 1,769 1,660 43 22 44 3,538 At 1 January 2008 - - 258 30 - - 288 Depreciation charge - - 28 1 - - 29 - - 44 4 - - 48 At 31 December 2009 Reclassification Translation adjustment At 31 December 2010 Accumulated depreciation Translation adjustment At 31 December 2008 - - 330 35 - - 365 Depreciation charge - 21 105 1 - - 127 - (1) (29) (2) - - (32) Translation adjustment At 31 December 2009 - 20 406 34 - - 460 Depreciation charge - 54 126 1 - - 181 Written off - - (5) - - - (5) - 3 56 4 - - 63 - 77 583 39 - - 699 - 950 1 - - 2,224 Translation adjustment At 31 December 2010 Net Book Value At 31 December 2008 1,273 At 31 December 2009 120 1,162 836 1 - - 2,119 At 31 December 2010 - 1,692 1,077 4 22 44 2,839 * Amount less than EUR 1,000 F-29 8. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT (continued) During 2007 an interest free deposit of RMB 18,751,554 (equivalent EUR 1,801,000) was made to acquire land use rights and buildings from a related party. However, during 2009 the Company decided to lease the land and buildings instead. Accordingly, a tenancy agreement was signed for a period of 30 years commencing on 1 July 2009. This agreement was subsequently replaced by one dated April 2010, also with a 30 year term. Based on a valuation report the acquisition costs were split pro rata between land use rights (TEUR 670) and buildings (TEUR 1,131). Due to the relatively long-term nature of the lease in relation to the buildings, this agreement is treated as a finance lease, hence the recognition of the buildings in the statement of financial position under property plant and equipment as leasehold buildings from the signing of the lease agreement in 2009. The related lease agreement is between HWG-Ltd. and its related party Mr. Chun Li Shi and its terms include staged rent increases over the term of the lease. Until the signing of the lease agreement, the buildings were not used by the Company and the advance payment was disclosed as advance payment for leasehold buildings. The lease agreement can be extended by negotiation by 60 days before the lease term expires. According to the PRC law, the lease term may not exceed 20 years however. If it exceeds twenty years, the period in excess is invalid. Therefore, the term of the legal lease expires on 31 March 2030 as the lease is invalid after 1 April 2030. However the Company assumes it will be able to extend the lease as described above and an extension is legal under the laws of the PRC. The rental payments under this agreement have been paid in advance until 2039; hence there are no future lease payments to be made under the current lease agreement. During 2009 and 2010 the Company paid land levelling costs in connection with the construction of a new building as well as the construction of the building at the Company’s main operational premises on behalf of a related party who will retain title to the building. It was intended that the Company would lease the building from the related party, who will waive lease payments in consideration for the land levelling costs and construction paid by the Company. Hence the amount has been treated as advance payment for leasehold buildings, as due to the likely long term nature of the lease, the arrangement would be considered to be a finance lease. The advance payment has since been re-classified as leasehold building. All property, plant and equipment held by the Company are located in the PRC. F-30 9. LEASE PREPAYMENT FOR LAND-USE RIGHTS This relates to the land use rights for which an advance payment was made in 2007 as described in note 8. Following the conclusion of the lease agreement described in note 8, which the Company determined to be an operating lease in respect of the land, as the term is relatively short compared to the useful life of the land, the advance payment was reclassified as a lease prepayment for landuse rights. It is being expensed to income over the 30 years term of the lease. The terms of the lease are as described in note 8. 10. OTHER ASSETS Other assets relate to advance payments made for land use rights. In 2009 the Company decided not to go ahead with the intended acquisition of these land use rights but to enter into a leasing agreement. Changes in the carrying value of the other assets over the period 2007 to 2009 relate solely to translation adjustments. Following the conclusion of the lease agreement in 2009, the other assets are being disclosed as lease prepayment for land-use rights. 11. INVESTMENT IN A SUBSIDIARY AND LOAN TO SUBSIDIARY 2008 TEUR Unquoted equity investment, at cost Loan to subsidiary Year ended 31 December 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR - - 1,133 - - 3,060 On 17 May 2010, the Company incorporated a wholly owned subsidiary, Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Limited, with a paid-in capital of RMB 2,000,000 (equivalent to EUR 226,700 at 31 December, 2010 exchange rate). On 20 October 2010, the Company increased the paid-in capital by RMB 8,000,000 (equivalent to EUR 906,700 at 31 December, 2010 exchange rate). As at 31 December 2010, the subsidiary is dormant. The Company intends to explore business opportunities in mid-west PRC via this subsidiary. In the process of the incorporation and subsequent capital increase, the Company injected cash and cash equivalents of RMB 10,000,000 into this subsidiary. The loan to the subsidiary is unsecured, and is charged an interest of 5.56% p.a. It is expected to be repaid by December 2015. F-31 12. DEFERRED TAX ASSET Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Balance at beginning Transfer from income statement (Note 7) Exchange difference on translation End of financial year 40 33 (14) 7 33 142 (9) 166 166 (184) 18 - The deferred tax asset is explained under note 7. 13. INVENTORIES Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Raw materials Finished goods 1,078 912 1,990 1,113 1,243 2,356 694 897 1,591 The amount of inventories recognized as an expense during 2008, 2009 and 2010 was TEUR 19,826, TEUR 23,629 and TEUR 32,504 respectively included in cost of sales. F-32 14. TRADE AND OTHER RECEIVABLES Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Trade receivables Other receivables 5,320 242 5,562 9,614 9,614 11,219 748 11,967 Trade receivables are non-interest-bearing and generally have credit terms of 30 to 60 days. Management aims to deal only with customers of good to high credit quality. Other receivables at 31 December 2008 relate to payments in advance to suppliers and at 31 December 2010 relate solely to security deposits given to suppliers in the context of a supplier contracts to ensure delivery of raw materials on a timely basis. In the ageing analysis, the advance payment has been included in the category “Within 30 days” and the security deposit amount has been included in the category “More than 60 days”. The aging of trade receivables and other receivables is as follows: Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Within 30 days 31 to 60 days More than 60 days 3,830 1,732 5,562 All trade and other receivables are denominated in Renminbi. F-33 4,937 3,499 1,178 9,614 7,319 3,684 964 11,967 14. TRADE AND OTHER RECEIVABLES (continued) Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Financial Assets Loans and receivables Trade and other receivables Cash and cash equivalents Related party receivables Total financial assets classified as loans and receivables 5,320 14,330 - 9,614 16,811 - 11,967 37,801 71 19,650 26,425 49,839 All financial assets classified as loans and receivables are current and noninterest bearing. Management considers the carrying amounts recognized in the statement of financial position to be a reasonable approximation of their fair value due to the short duration. Finance income of TEUR 51, TEUR 47 and TEUR 108 was earned on cash and cash equivalents in 2008, 2009 and 2010 respectively. Apart from this no net gains or losses on loans and receivables occurred in 2008, 2009 or 2010. The maximum credit risk is assessed by management to be the amounts shown in the above table as at the respective reporting dates. 15. RELATED PARTY RECEIVABLES Related party receivables related to: 1) rental deposit paid to Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center, for renewal of rental agreement; and 2) salary paid on behalf for Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Ltd. The amounts are unsecured, not interest bearing and without fixed terms of repayment. F-34 16. CASH AND BANK BALANCES Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Cash at banks Cash on hand 14,309 21 14,330 16,798 13 16,811 37,788 13 37,801 The cash at banks bear effective interest rates of 0.722%, 0.361% and 0.361% per annum as at years ended 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010 respectively. 17. SHARE CAPITAL AND RESERVES The Company was incorporated on 24 October 1994 with share capital of HKD 4,000,000 (Equivalent of EUR 424,000). These shares were issued at par on incorporation. In April 2010, the immediate holding company, Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Ltd. injected a further HKD 10,000,000 (equivalent to EUR 969,000) of share capital as additional working capital. The share capital is fully paid up. The shares all have equal rights pertaining to voting and dividends. Currency restrictions may have a negative effect on both the timing and the amount of future dividends. The registered capital of the Company is fully paid up. The share capital is not divided up into shares as there is only one shareholder. The shares have voting rights pro rata the proportion of nominal capital owned. The share capital has remained unchanged during the reporting periods. The holders of ordinary shares are entitled to receive dividends as declared from time to time and are entitled to one vote per share at shareholders’ meetings. All shares will rank pari passu with respect to the Company’s residual assets. Dividends from Chinese companies generally require government approval and can only be distributed if the statutory reserves comply with relevant legislation. Transfer of dividends outside of the PRC may be affected by regulations of State Administration of Foreign Exchange (SAFE) on transfers. F-35 17. SHARE CAPITAL AND RESERVES (continued) Statutory reserve In accordance with the relevant laws and regulations of the PRC, a Company established in the PRC is required to transfer 10% of its profit after taxation prepared in accordance with the accounting regulation of the PRC to the statutory reserve until the reserve balance reaches 50% of the Company’s share capital, any further transfer of its annual statutory net profit is optional. Such reserve may be used to offset accumulated losses or increase the registered capital of these subsidiaries, subject to the approval from the PRC authorities, and are not available for dividend distribution to the shareholders. The statutory reserve of the Company amounts to EUR 724,000 at 31 December 2010 (2009: EUR 213,000 and 2008: EUR 213,000). Foreign currency translation reserve Foreign currency translation reserve represents the foreign currency translation difference arising from the translation of the financial statements from RMB to EUR. Retained earnings The retained earnings reserve comprises the cumulative net gains and losses recognized in the Company’s income statement. F-36 18. TRADE AND OTHER PAYABLES Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Trade payables Other payables and accruals 1,676 554 2,230 3,102 649 3,751 3,887 1,021 4,908 Trade payables generally have credit terms of 30 to 60 days. All trade and other payables are denominated in Renminbi. Financial Liabilities at Amortized Cost Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Dividends payable to related parties Interest-bearing bank borrowings Trade payables 8,103 1,383 1,676 11,162 1,604 3,102 4,706 2,267 1,813 3,887 7,967 All financial liabilities recorded at amortized cost fall due within one year. Due to the short-term nature of these, management considers the carrying amounts of financial liabilities measured at amortized cost in the statement of financial position to be reasonable approximation of their fair value. 19. INTEREST-BEARING BANK BORROWINGS Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Short-term bank loans 1,383 1,604 1,813 The Company's interest-bearing bank loans are secured by guarantee from related parties and bear effective interest rates of 8.89%, 5.44% and 5.72% per annum as at years ended 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010 respectively. Finance costs related to these loans amounted to TEUR 104, TEUR 106 and TEUR 110 in the years 2008, 2009 and 2010 respectively. F-37 20. DIVIDENDS PAYABLE According to PRC laws, any dividends declared out of profits earned from 1 January 2008 onwards to foreign investors would attract withholding tax. The amount of withholding tax payable is dependent on the country of residence of the investor. In the case of Hong Kong, the applicable tax rate is 5%. Withholding tax payable of TEUR 114 has been disclosed under income tax payable. 21. COMMITMENTS Operating Lease Commitments The Company leases its production facilities and office premises under noncancellable operating lease arrangements from a related party. The leases have varying terms and the total future minimum lease payments of the Company under non-cancellable operating leases are as follows: Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Not later than one year Later than one year and not later than five years Later than five years 33 38 43 130 163 105 143 150 47 240 The leases on the Company’s production facilities and office premises on which rentals are payable will expire between 31 March 2011 and 31 March 2017, and the current rent payable on the leases range between RMB 5,000 and RMB 18,000 per month which are subject to revision on expiry. The lease agreements can be extended by negotiation by 60 days before the lease term expires. The operating lease for land described in note 8 has been prepaid and hence does not give rise to any commitments. The terms of this agreement are as described in note 8. F-38 21. COMMITMENTS (continued) Capital Commitments On 30 May 2010, the Company concluded an Investment and Construction Project Contract with the Management Committee of Guangdong – Wenchuan Industrial Park (the “Management Committee”) to invest and establish a glass production project and research and development base in Guangdong – Wenchuan Industrial Park, Sichuan. The total investment commitments of the project is RMB 0.3 billion (equivalent to approximately EUR 34 million at 31 December 2010 exchange rates). As well as the investment commitment the Company is expected but not committed to pay annual taxes of more than RMB 18 million. However the Company will benefit under the contract from tax advantages and subsidies. Under the contract, the Management Committee will transfer usage rights for land to be used for the construction of the base to the Company at a preferential price and the Company shall pay a deposit of RMB 50 million (equivalent to EUR 5.6 million) as a down payment for the land use rights. The land use rights have a term of 50 years. This contract gives rise to various contingencies which are set out under Note 27. The Company is using its Sichuan based subsidiary to carry out the investments required under the contract and has internally agreed with the subsidiary to transfer rights and obligations from the Investment Contract to the subsidiary, whilst remaining as guarantor and financing party for the investments. F-39 22. FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT The Company’s activities expose it to credit risk, liquidity risk, and interest rate risk. The Company’s overall risk management strategy seeks to minimize adverse effects from the unpredictability of financial markets on the Company’s financial performance. The board of directors provides guidance for overall risk management as well as policies covering specific areas. Management analyses and formulates measures to manage the Company’s exposure to financial risk in accordance with the objectives and underlying principles approved by the board of directors. Generally, the Company’s employs a conservative strategy regarding its risk management. As the Company’s exposures to market risk are kept at minimum level, the Company has not used any derivatives or other financial instruments for hedging purposes. The Company does not hold or issue derivative financial instruments for trading purposes. As at 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010, the Company's financial instruments mainly consisted of trade receivables, cash and bank balances, trade and other payables, interest-bearing bank borrowings and dividends payable to related parties. (i) Credit risk Credit risk is the risk of financial loss to the Company if a customer fails to meet its contractual obligations, and arises principally from the Company’s trade and other receivables. Trade receivables The Company’s exposure to credit risk is influenced mainly by the individual characteristics of each customer. The Company typically gives existing customers credit terms from 30 days to 60 days. In deciding whether credit shall be extended, the Company will take into consideration factors such as the relationship with the customer, payment history and credit worthiness. The Company’s top ten customers in aggregate formed approximately 41%, 38% and 39% of the trade receivables balances as at 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010 respectively. F-40 22. FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued) (ii) Credit risk (Continued) The Company performs ongoing credit evaluation of its customers’ financial condition and requires no collateral from its customers. There is no impairment loss recognized in the income statements as all the receivables were subsequently received. (iii) Liquidity risk Liquidity risk is the risk that the Company will encounter difficulty in raising funds to meet commitments associated with financial instruments. The Company’s policy is to regularly monitor current and expected liquidity requirements to ensure that it maintains sufficient reserve for cash to meet its liquidity requirement in the short and long term. The bank borrowings for the years ended 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010 have maturity period of less than 1 year from the respective statement of financial position dates. The maturity profile of the Company’s financial liabilities as at balance sheet date, based on the contracted undiscounted amounts, is as follows: Total carrying amountall current TEUR At 31 December 2008 Trade payables Dividend payable Interest-bearing bank borrowings At 31 December 2009 Trade and other payables Interest-bearing bank borrowings At 31 December 2010 Trade and other payables Dividend payable Interest-bearing bank borrowings F-41 1,676 8,103 1,383 11,162 3,102 1,604 4,706 3,887 2,267 1,813 7,967 22. FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued) (iv) Market risk Market risk is the risk that changes in market prices, such as foreign exchange rates and interest rates will affect the Company’s income or the value of its holdings of financial instruments. The objective of market risk management is to manage and control market risk exposure within acceptable parameters. (v) Currency risk Currency risk is the risk that the value of a financial instrument will fluctuate due to changes in foreign exchange rates. Currency risk arises when transactions are denominated in foreign currencies. The Company carries out its business in the PRC and most of its transactions are denominated in Renminbi. Accordingly, the Company’s exposure to risk resulting from changes in foreign currency exchange rates is minimal. However, the Company is exposed to currency risk resulting from the translation of its financial statements from Renminbi to the presentation currency. During the reporting periods the effect on net profit if the exchange rate between Renminbi and Euro changed by 5%, with all other variables held constant is estimated to be +/- EUR 0.5 million in 2008, +/- EUR 0.7 million in 2009 and +/- EUR 1.1 million in 2010. At the following financial position dates, if the exchange rate between Renminbi and Euro changed by 5%, with all other variables held constant, the effect on the Company’s equity is estimated to be +/- EUR 0.6 million in 2008, +/- EUR 1.2 million in 2009 and +/- EUR 2.5 million in 2010. (vi) Interest rate risk The Company is exposed to interest rate risk to the extent that annually it renews its interest-bearing financing, which is however fixed rate. F-42 23. CAPITAL MANAGEMENT The Company’s objectives when managing capital are: (i) To safeguard the Company’s ability to continue as a going concern, so that it continues to provide returns to shareholders and benefits for other stakeholders; (ii) To support the Company’s stability and growth; and (iii) To provide capital for the purpose of strengthening the Company’s risk management capability. The Company actively and regularly reviews and manages its capital structure to ensure optimal capital structure and shareholders’ returns, taking into consideration the future capital requirements of the Company and capital efficiency, prevailing and projected profitability, projected operating cash flows, projected capital expenditures and projected investment opportunities. The Company currently does not adopt any formal dividend policy. Estimates are continually evaluated and are based on historical experiences and other factors, including expectations of future events that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. F-43 24. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS DISCLOSURES - SIGNIFICANT RELATED PARTY An entity or individual is considered a related party of the Company for the purposes of the financial statements if: (i) it possesses the ability, directly or indirectly, to control or exercise significant influence over the operating and financial decision of the Company or vice versa; or (ii) it is subject to common control or common significant influence. Related party information The following persons and entities are considered to be related parties: a) Entities / individuals with common control or significant influence over the Company. Related Party Mr. SZE Nang Heung Type of business N.A. China Specialty Glass AG Luckyway Global Group Limited Investment holding company, Germany Investment holding company Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited (“HWG HKHolding”) Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Limited Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center (formerly known as Guangzhou City Liwan District Glass Factory) Investment holding company, Hong Kong Manufacturing of specialty glass, Sichuan Province, PRC Property management, Guangzhou City, Guangdong Province, PRC F-44 Relationship with the Company Indirect holder of the entire share capital of the Company, ultimate controlling shareholder, CEO; director of the Company from October 1994 until December 2000 and from September 2004 until January 2008 as well as director of HWG HK-Holding since July 2007 Ultimate holding company of the Company Major shareholder of the ultimate holding company and 100% owned by Mr. SZE Nang Heung Present sole shareholder of the Company Present sole subsidiary of the Company Company owned by Mr. SHI Chunli, former majority shareholder of the Company, member of key management and son of Mr. SZE 24. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES TRANSACTIONS (continued) HK Chung Hwa Enterprises Development Company Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited Guangzhou Xinghua Glass Products Co., Ltd. Xi’an Mamen Security Technology Co., Ltd. b) - SIGNIFICANT Manufacture, subcontracting and sales of glasses for motor vehicles and other uses in Guangzhou City, Guangdong Province, PRC Holding company Glass production and sales Security glass production and sales RELATED PARTY Mr. SZE indirectly owns 100% of this company. Mr. SZE holds 99.9% of the shares until selling them to a non related third party on 23 February 2010. Subsidiary wholly owned by Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited. Subsidiary wholly owned by Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited. Key management and close family of key management or of controlling shareholder Related Party Relationship with the Company Mr. SZE Nang Heung Indirect holder of the entire share capital of the Company, ultimate controlling shareholder, CEO; director of the Company from October 1994 until December 2000 and from September 2004 until January 2008 as well as director of HWG HK-Holding since July 2007 Director of the Company since January 2008 Member of the Management Board and son of Mr. SZE Nang Heung as well as director of the Company since September 2004 Director of the Company from January 2008 until June 2009. Supervisor of the Company since January 2008 Mr. ZHOU Chao Mr. SHI Chunli Mr. CHEN Zong Mr. LI Qiaorong F-45 24. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES TRANSACTIONS (continued) - SIGNIFICANT RELATED PARTY Transactions and amounts due to related parties In addition to the balances disclosed elsewhere in the Financial Statements, such as dividends payable to related parties, the Company had the following transactions with related parties at agreed terms: 2008 TEUR 2009 TEUR 2010 TEUR (i) 33 35 42 Rental deposit due to rental agreement (ii) - - 4 Salary paid on behalf (iii) - - 67 Loan to subsidiary for project investment (iv) - - 3,060 Note Rental charged on factory and office building (i) Rental of factory and office building The Company leases several buildings and land use rights under operating leases from Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center and under a finance lease from Mr. SHI Chunli. The terms of the lease agreements are disclosed in notes 8 and 21. (ii) Deposit for land use rights and building/finance lease During 2007, a deposit of RMB 18,751,554 (equivalent EUR 1,801,000) was paid to acquire land use rights and a building from Mr. SHI Chunli. However, during 2009 the Company decided to lease the land use rights and building instead, to avoid the seller having to pay tax of approximately EUR 200,000. Accordingly, a tenancy agreement was signed for a period of 30 years commencing on 1 July 2009 and the deposit paid was then converted into rental prepayment. This agreement was subsequently replaced by a similar one dated April 2010. Although the lease agreement under the laws of the PRC is only valid until 2030, the Company’s management is of the opinion that they can continue to use the buildings until the end of the 30 year term by extending or renewing the lease. F-46 24. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES TRANSACTIONS (continued) - SIGNIFICANT RELATED PARTY (iii) Salary paid on behalf of Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Ltd. The Company pays salary for management staff on behalf of Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Ltd. since 2010. (iv) Project investment paid on behalf of subsidiary Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Limited was granted a loan for project investment financing. The terms of the loan are disclosed in note 11. (v) Sale and purchase of goods There were no sales or purchases of goods or services or other transactions between the Company and related companies. (vi) Sale of shares to Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited On 15 January 2008, 100% of the shares of the Company were transferred at nominal value from its initial shareholders Guangzhou Property Management which held 70% of the shares and HK Chung Hwa which held 30% of the shares to Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited. This transfer was financed by an unsecured interest free loan granted by Mr. SZE to HWG HK Holding. No written agreement exists to document this loan. (vii) Trademark Licence and Transfer Agreements Mr. SZE concluded trademark license contracts with the Company in 2005, according to which the Company is entitled to use two trademarks without royalty fee or licence fee. In 2010 Mr. SZE concluded an agreement transferring the trademarks to the Company without consideration. F-47 24. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES TRANSACTIONS (continued) - SIGNIFICANT RELATED PARTY Director’s and key management personnel remuneration 2008 TEUR Director's remuneration - salaries and related cost - retirement scheme contribution Key management personnel (other than director) - salaries and related cost - retirement scheme contribution As at 31 December 2009 TEUR 2010 TEUR 27 1 28 36 2 38 46 2 48 17 1 18 13 1 14 5 1 6 Credit guarantees and mortgages Related parties have provided guarantees and mortgages for no consideration for the Company’s bank loans: (i) Mortgages and a guarantee for a credit facility in the amount of RMB 7,400,000 (TEUR 839) have been provided by Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center from 8 September 2010 to 7 September 2011 for a short-term loan for the provision of working capital. (ii) Mortgages and a guarantee for a credit facility in the amount of RMB 8,600,000 (TEUR 975) have been provided by Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center from 6 September 2010 to 5 September 2011 for a short-term loan for the provision of working capital. (iii) Mr. SHI Chunli has provided a guarantee for a maximum facility of RMB 20 million (EUR 2.27 million). (iv) Mr. SZE Nang Heung has provided a guarantee for a maximum facility of RMB 20 million (EUR 2.27 million). F-48 24. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES TRANSACTIONS (continued) - SIGNIFICANT RELATED PARTY Credit guarantees and mortgages (continued) (v) Mr. SZE Nang Heung has provided a guarantee for the loan from the Company to HWG-SC in the amount of RMB 33 million (EUR 3.74 million). Undertakings Mr. SZE has given an undertaking for no consideration with the Company according to which he would reimburse the Company for any losses incurred for any additional social insurance and housing funds payments which may be levied in respect of prior periods. Mr. SZE Nang Heung has given an undertaking for no consideration that he would take all responsibility for any damages or negative influence which may be caused to the Company by his failure to make a registration under the “Notice of the State Administration of Foreign Exchange on Relevant Issues concerning Foreign Exchange Administration for Domestic Residents to Engage in Financing and in Return Investment via Overseas Special Purpose Companies” (“SAFE Notice 75”). Mr. SHI Chunli has given an undertaking for no consideration to bear any administrative and civil liabilities in respect of land allocated to Guangzhou Property Management Center, on which buildings are located that are leased by the Company, for which the necessary legal formalities have not been completed. F-49 25. SEGMENT INFORMATION a. Business segment Management determines the operating segments, which represents product category, based on reports reviewed and used for strategic decisions. The Company’s business segments are organized into three main business segments: · Automotive Security Glass · Bank Security Glass · Construction Glass The accounting policies used for segment reporting are the same as in these financial statements. During the periods under audit there were no inter-segment sales and all sales were made within the PRC. During 2008, 2009 and 2010, sales with the top ten customers accounted for approximately 30% of total sales. No customer accounted for more than 10% of sales. The subsidiary founded in Sichuan in 2010 was not operationally trading in 2010, and as such earned no sales and contributed neither sales nor profits to the business segment. Relevant items of income and expenditure and other financial data such as capital expenditure have been allocated to the segments as far as this was possible. Where this was not possible, they have been disclosed in total. F-50 25. SEGMENT INFORMATION (continued) Year ended 31 December 2008 External sales Cost of sales Results Segment gross margin Finance income Unallocated corporate expenses Finance costs Profit before taxation Income tax expenses Net profit Other information Segment assets Unallocated corporate assets Consolidated total assets Automotive Security Glass TEUR Bank Security Glass TEUR Construction Glass TEUR Total TEUR 15,448 (6,964) 17,530 (10,354) 7,238 (5,682) 40,216 (23,000) 8,484 7,176 1,556 17,216 51 (3,018) (104) 14,145 (3,545) 10,600 3,019 2,382 832 24,892 Segment liabilities Unallocated corporate liabilities Consolidated total liabilities Capital expenditure Depreciation of property, plant and machinery 6,233 18,659 12,604 12,604 710 9 F-51 12 7 28 25. SEGMENT INFORMATION (continued) Year ended 31 December 2009 External sales Cost of sales Results Segment gross margin Finance income Unallocated corporate expenses Finance costs Profit before taxation Income tax expenses Net profit Other information Segment assets Unallocated corporate assets Consolidated total assets Automotive Security Glass TEUR Bank Security Glass TEUR Construction Glass TEUR Total TEUR 22,354 (10,350) 23,039 (13,313) 5,517 (4,369) 50,910 (28,032) 12,004 9,726 1,148 22,878 47 (3,962) (106) 18,857 (4,726) 14,131 5,828 3,600 1,428 31,753 Segment liabilities Unallocated corporate liabilities Consolidated total liabilities Capital expenditure Depreciation of property, plant and machinery 10,856 20,897 6,904 6,904 185 27 39 F-52 60 126 25. SEGMENT INFORMATION (continued) Year ended 31 December 2010 External sales Cost of sales Results Segment gross margin Finance income Unallocated corporate expenses Finance costs Profit before taxation Income tax expenses Net profit Automotive Security Glass TEUR Bank Security Glass TEUR Construction Glass TEUR Total TEUR 29,971 13,456 32,083 19,274 7,510 5,381 69,564 38,111 16,515 12,809 2,129 31,453 108 (5,193) Other information Segment assets Unallocated corporate assets Consolidated total assets (110) 26,258 (4,006) 22,252 6,508 4,067 1,540 59,651 Segment liabilities Unallocated corporate liabilities Consolidated total liabilities Capital expenditure Depreciation of property, plant and machinery b. 12,115 47,536 10,299 10,299 618 18 39 107 Geographical segment As the business of the Company is engaged entirely in the PRC, no reporting by geographical location of operations is presented. F-53 164 26. EMPLOYEES BENEFITS The average number of employees was as follows: Average for the year 2008 2009 2010 36 91 340 467 Management and administration Sales Production Total 39 83 342 464 46 64 341 451 The aggregate payroll costs of these employees were as follows: Year ended 31 December 2008 2009 2010 TEUR TEUR TEUR Wages and salaries Social security cost 1,610 195 1,805 2,002 209 2,211 2,280 144 2,424 Retirement Benefit Plans The eligible employees of the Company who are citizens of the PRC are members of a state-managed retirement benefit scheme operated by the local government. The Company is required to contribute a certain percentage of their payroll costs to the retirement benefit scheme to fund the benefits. The only obligation of the Company with respect to the retirement benefit scheme is to make the specified contributions. The cost of retirement benefit contributions charged to the profit or loss in the years 2008, 2009 and 2010 amount to approximately EUR 195,000, EUR 209,000 and EUR 144,000 respectively. F-54 27. CONTINGENCIES Investment and Construction Project Contract for planned Sichuan facility As explained in Note 21, on 30 May 2010, the Company concluded an Investment and Construction Project Contract with the Management Committee of Guangdong – Wenchuan Industrial Park (the “Management Committee”) to invest and establish a glass production project and research and development base in Guangdong – Wenchuan Industrial Park, Sichuan. With the Management Committee’s approval of the project construction plan, the Company will be responsible for the project construction and production processes in accordance with the rules and regulations in the People’s Republic of China. In the event of non-compliance of construction speed and production of the various phases, or if the Company fails to satisfy the expected level of investment or the expected level of tax payments as required for the first stage within 5 years, the Management Committee has the right to take back all the land use rights of the project free of charge. The Company may also be liable for compensatory damages if it is responsible for a breach of contract with adverse effects for the Management Committee. Without the consent of the Management Committee, the Company is not allowed to (i) transfer the land use rights to a third party within 10 years and (ii) pledge the land use rights for any credit facility within 3 years. The Company is using its Sichuan based subsidiary to carry out the investments required under the contract and has internally agreed with the subsidiary to transfer rights and obligations from the Investment Contract to the subsidiary, whilst remaining as guarantor and financing party for the investments and contingencies. Social insurance back payments According to PRC law, in particular, Chinese regulations for social insurance and housing funds, the Company is required to make contributions for the social insurance and for the housing funds to its employees. The Company has in the past not paid the full amount which should have been paid in respect of these contributions, but considers the risk for additional payments for prior periods to be not probable. The Company estimates that such a claim for additional payments would not exceed TEUR 264. Mr. SZE has undertaken an agreement with the Company according to which he would reimburse the Company for any losses incurred for such additional social insurance and housing funds payments. F-55 27. CONTINGENCIES (continued) Tax risks Various uncertainties exist relating to the following matters which could result in additional tax liabilities for HWG-Ltd. or the Group: i. Depreciation was over claimed by HWG-Ltd. in relation to residual values of property, plant and equipment in 2007. The additional tax payments, if any, which could arise from this matter, are estimated to be in the region of TEUR 7. ii. Entertainment expenses claimed by HWG-Ltd. had exceeded the cap under the Old and New Enterprise Income Tax Law. The additional tax payments, if any, which could arise from this matter, are estimated to be in the region of TEUR 47. 28. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS No items, transaction or event of a material or unusual nature has arisen in the interval between 31 December 2010 and the date of the report from the Reporting Accountants. 29. APPROVAL OF FINANCIAL STATEMENTS These financial statements have been approved for issuance. June , 2011 The directors. F-56 AUDIT OPINION To Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd., Guangzhou, People's Republic of China We have audited the financial statements converted from Renminbi (Chinese currency) to Euro - comprising the statements of comprehensive income, the statements of financial position, the statements of changes in equity, the statements of cash flow and the notes to the financial statements - for the financial years ended 31 December 2008, 2009 and 2010 of Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd., Guangzhou, People's Republic of China. The preparation of the financial statements in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), as endorsed for application in the European Union and as set forth in the notes to the financial statements is the responsibility of the management of the Company and of the Board of Management of China Specialty Glass AG, Grünwald, near Munich. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the financial statements based on our audit. We conducted our audit of the annual financial statements in accordance with § [Article] 317 HGB [„Handelsgesetzbuch”: „German Commercial Code”] and German generally accepted standards for the audit of financial statements promulgated by the Institut der Wirtschaftsprüfer [Institute of Public Auditors in Germany] (IDW). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit such that misstatements materially affecting the presentation of the net assets, financial position and results of operations in the annual financial statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards are detected with reasonable assurance. Knowledge of the business activities and the economic and legal environment of the Company and expectations as to possible misstatements are taken into account in the determination of audit procedures. The effectiveness of the accounting-related internal control system and the evidence supporting the disclosures in the books and records, the annual financial statements are examined primarily on a test basis within the framework of the audit. The audit includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the annual financial statements. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion. Our audit has not led to any reservations. In our opinion based on the findings of our audit, the financial statements comply, as set forth in the notes to the financial statements, with the IFRS, as endorsed for application in the European Union, and give a true and fair view of the net assets, financial position and results of operations of the Company in accordance with these requirements. Hamburg, 11 April 2011 Grant Thornton GmbH Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft (German certified audit firm) Graf von Kanitz Wirtschaftsprüfer (German certified auditor) F-57 Robinson Wirtschaftsprüfer (German certified auditor) Interim financial statements of GUANGZHOU HING WAH GLASS INDUSTRY CO., LTD. for the three months to 31 March 2011 in accordance with IFRS as endorsed for application by the EU (reviewed) F-58 Condensed Interim Statement of Comprehensive Income Three months ended 31 March 2011 TEUR Three months ended 31 March 2010 TEUR Revenue Cost of sales 16,441 (8,850) 11,454 (6,451) Gross profit 7,591 5,003 Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Finance income Finance costs Research and development costs (609) (326) 79 (30) (391) Profit before taxation 6,314 Taxation (950) Net profit Other comprehensive income: Currency translation reserve movement Total Comprehensive Income Profit attributable to owners of the parent Total comprehensive income attributable to owners to the parent (441) (190) 18 (22) (338) 4,030 (685) 5,364 3,345 (2,345) 3,019 2,325 5,670 5,364 3,345 3,019 5,670 The comparability is affected by movements in the relative value of the functional currency (RMB) compared to the presentational currency (EUR). F-59 Condensed Interim Statement of Financial Position Assets Non-current Property, plant and equipment Lease prepayment for land-use rights Related party loans Investment in a subsidiary Current Inventories Trade and other receivables Amount due from related parties Tax receivables Cash and bank balances Total assets Equity and Liabilities Capital and Reserves Share capital Statutory reserve Foreign currency translation reserve Retained earnings Current liabilities Corporate income tax payables Trade and other payables Interest-bearing bank borrowings Dividend payable to related party Total equity and liabilities 31 March 2011 TEUR 31 December 2010 TEUR 2,689 2,839 712 5,090 1,083 9,574 751 3,060 1,133 7,783 2,238 12,935 133 418 36,700 52,424 61,998 1,591 11,967 71 438 37,801 51,868 59,651 1,393 724 1,393 724 1,118 49,136 52,371 3,463 43,772 49,352 1,032 4,805 1,311 4,908 1,624 1,813 2,166 9,627 61,998 2,267 10,299 59,651 The comparability is affected by movements in the relative value of the functional currency (RMB) compared to the presentational currency (EUR). F-60 Condensed Interim Statement of Changes in Equity Share capital TEUR Balance at 1 January 2010 Total comprehensive income Transfer to statutory reserve Balance at 31 March 2010 Share issue Total comprehensive income Transfer to statutory reserve Balance at 31 December 2010 Total comprehensive income Balance at 31 March 2011 Statutory Translation reserve reserve TEUR TEUR Retained earnings TEUR Total Equity TEUR 424 213 (158) 24,370 24,849 - - 2,325 3,345 5,670 - 193 - (193) 424 406 2,167 27,522 969 - - - - - 1,296 16,568 - 318 - 724 3,463 43,772 49,352 - (2,345) 5,364 3,019 724 1,118 49,136 52,371 1,393 1,393 (318) 30,519 969 17,864 - The comparability is affected by movements in the relative value of the functional currency (RMB) compared to the presentational currency (EUR). F-61 Condensed Interim Statement of Cash Flows Cash flows from operating activities Profit before taxation Adjustments for: Depreciation of property, plant and equipment Finance income Finance costs Movement in lease prepayment for land use rights Operating profit before working capital changes Increase in inventories (Increase)/decrease in trade, other and related party current receivables Increase in trade and other payables Cash generated from operations Finance income received Income tax paid Net cash generated from operating activities Three months ended 31 March 2011 TEUR Three months ended 31 March 2010 TEUR 6,314 4,030 104 (79) 30 6 37 (18) 22 6 6,375 (738) 4,077 (156) (1,549) 119 4,207 79 (1,177) 3,109 4,450 (568) 7,803 18 (1,707) 6,114 (80) (2) (2,288) (2,368) (2) Cash flows from financing activities Repayment of bank loan Finance costs paid (112) (30) (22) Net cash used in financing activities (142) (22) Cash flows from investing activities Purchase of property, plant and equipment Granting of loan to related party Net cash used in investing activities Net increase in cash and bank balances Cash and bank balances at beginning of the period Effects of currency translation Cash and bank balances at end of the period 599 6,090 37,801 (1,700) 16,811 1,767 36,700 24,668 The comparability is affected by movements in the relative value of the functional currency (RMB) compared to the presentational currency (EUR). F-62 NOTES TO THE CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. Nature of operations The principal activity of Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Limited (hereafter “the Company”) is the manufacture and distribution of bullet proof and toughened glass products. The principal place of business is located at No. 6, Hougang Xijie, Guanghai Road, Guangzhou the People's Republic of China (the “PRC”). The Company sells its products to customers in the PRC. The immediate holding company is Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited which is incorporated in Hong Kong. On 22 November 2010, all shares in Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited were transferred into China Specialty Glass AG, Grünwald, Munich, Germany. China Specialty Glass AG then intends seek a listing on the Prime Standard segment of the German Stock Exchange. In May 2010 the Company itself incorporated a subsidiary, Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Limited. The financial statements of the Company, its subsidiary, Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Limited, its immediate parent, Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited, and its ultimate parent, China Specialty Glass AG, are included in the consolidated financial statements of China Specialty Glass AG, so that the Company itself does not have to prepare consolidated financial statements. 2. General Information and Statement of compliance with IFRS These condensed single entity interim financial statements of the Company are prepared for the three months period ended 31 March 2011 with comparatives. They have been prepared for the purpose of inclusion in the IPO prospectus of the Company’s future ultimate parent, China Specialty Glass AG. The condensed interim financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) adopted by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) and its interpretations of the International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee (IFRIC) for interim financial information effective within the European Union. Accordingly, these condensed interim financial statements do not include all of the information required in annual financial statements by IFRS. The condensed interim financial statements have been reviewed. In the opinion of the Company’s Management, the condensed interim financial statements include all adjustments of a normal and recurring nature considered necessary for a fair presentation of results for interim periods. Results of the period ended 31 March 2011 are not necessarily indicative of future results. The preparation of interim financial statements in conformity with IAS 34 “Interim Financial Reporting” requires the Management Board to make judgments, estimates and assumptions that affect the application of policies and reported amounts of assets and liabilities, income and expenses. Actual results may differ from these estimates. The accounting principles and practices as applied in the condensed interim financial statements correspond to those pertaining to the most recent annual financial statements. A detailed description of the accounting policies is published in the notes to the financial statements of the Company’s financial statements as of December 31, 2010. The condensed interim financial statements of the Company have been rounded to the nearest thousand Euro. Amounts are stated in thousands of Euros (TEUR) except where otherwise indicated. The condensed interim financial statements of the Company for the period from January 1 to March 31, 2011 are expected to be authorized for issue in accordance with a resolution of the Management Board in June 2011. F-63 NOTES TO THE CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 3. Significant accounting policies and changes in estimates These condensed stand alone single entity interim financial statements have been prepared using accounting policies specified by those IFRS that are in effect at the end of the reporting period (31 March 2011). The three months financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the accounting policies adopted in the financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2010. The accounting policies have been applied consistently throughout the Company for the purpose of preparation of these condensed three months financial statements. The material principles on recognition and measurement are corresponding to the principles on recognition of the financial statements as of 31 December 2010 and outlined in those financial statements. The Company had to apply the following new standards, amendments to existing standards or new interpretations for the first time: · Improvements of IFRS 2010 (amendments), are to be applied for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2010 and 1 January 2011. · IFRS 1 (amendments) – Limited exemption from comparative IFRS 7 disclosures for first-time adopters, to the extent to which they may be applicable on financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2010 · IAS 24 (revised) – Related Party Disclosures - , to the extent to which they may be applicable for financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2011 · IFRS 32 (amendments)- Classification of Right Issues, to the extent to which they may be applicable for financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2010 · IFRIC 14 (amendments) – Prepayments of a Minimum Funding Requirements, to the extent to which they may be applicable for financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2011 · IFRIC 19 (amendments) – Extinguishing Financial Liabilities with Equity Instruments, to the extent to which they may be applicable for financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2010 The first-time application of these standards and interpretations is expected to have no significant impact on the net-assets, financial position and results of operations of the Company. The Company has not early applied the following new and amended standards and interpretations, which have been issued but are not yet effective or as well as partly not yet adopted by the European Union: IFRS 7 (amendments), Disclosures – Transfer of Financial assets - to the extent to which they may be applicable on financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2010 · IFRS 9 – Financial Instruments - to the extent to which they may be applicable for financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2013 (not yet adopted by the European Union). · IFRS 1 (amendments) – “Severe hyperinflation” and “Removal of fixed dates for first-time adopters” – to the extent to which they may be applicable for financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2011 (not yet adopted by the European Union). · IAS 12 (amendments) – Deferred taxes: Recovery of underlying assets – This amendment is applicable for periods beginning on 1 January 2012 (not yet adopted by the European Union). · F-64 NOTES TO THE CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 3. Significant accounting policies and changes in estimates (continued) The management board anticipates that the application of these standards and interpretations will have no significant impact on the net-assets, financial position and results of operations of the Company. There have been no significant changes in estimates compared to the financial statements of the Company for the year ended 31 December 2010. 4. Currency translation Items included in the condensed interim financial statements are measured using the currency of the primary economic environment in which the Company operates (the “functional currency”). The Company conducts its business predominately in the PRC and hence its functional currency is the Renminbi (RMB). The presentation currency of the Company is EURO (EUR), being the presentation currency of its future ultimate German domiciled legal parent and holding Company, and therefore the financial information has been translated from RMB to EURO at the following rates: 31 March 2010 31 December 2010 31 March 2011 5. Period end rates EUR 1.00 = RMB EUR 1.00 = RMB EUR 1.00 = RMB 9.1561 8.8231 9.2343 Average rates EUR 1.00 = RMB 9.4436 EUR 1.00 = RMB 8.9789 EUR 1.00 = RMB 8.9807 Significant events and transactions With the exception of the continued measures to prepare for the expected Initial Public Offering of the Company’s German parent company CSG AG in 2011, no significant event or transaction has taken place between 31 December 2010 and 31 March 2011. F-65 NOTES TO THE CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 6. Segment reporting Management determines the operating segments, which represents product categories, based on reports reviewed and used for strategic decisions. The Company’s business segments are organized into three main operating segments: · · · Automotive Security Glass Bank Security Glass Construction Glass All of these segments are managed by the Company. All operating segments are monitored and strategic decisions are made on the basis of the segmental gross margins. Items of expense and income below the gross profit margin are not analysed by management on a segmental basis, as these are not considered relevant for the operational and strategic analysis of the business. During the period under review, there were no inter-segment transfers. The accounting policies the Company uses for segment reporting under IFRS 8 are the same as those used in its financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2010. The segment information provided to the management for the reportable segments for the comparative financial period from 1 January 2011 to 31 March 2011 is as follows: Automotive Security Glass TEUR Bank Security Glass TEUR Construction Glass TEUR Revenue Cost of sales Gross profit 7,940 3,629 4,311 6,514 3,836 2,678 1,987 1,385 602 Segment assets 31 March 2011 6,733 3,233 3,557 Unallocated Total TEUR TEUR - 48,475 16,441 8,850 7,591 61,998 Unallocated assets for both financial periods are assets which cannot be reasonably allocated to the operating segments and included property, plant & equipment, intangible assets, deferred tax assets, related party loans and investment in subsidiary, other receivables and cash and bank balances. F-66 NOTES TO THE CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 6. Segment reporting (continued) The segment information provided to the management for the reportable segments for the financial period from 1 January 2010 to 31 March 2010 is as follows: Automotive Security Glass Bank Security Glass Construction Unallocated Glass TEUR Total TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR Revenue Cost of sales Gross profit 5,222 2,394 2,828 4,768 2,915 1,853 1,464 1,142 322 - 11,454 6,451 5,003 Segment assets 31 March 2010 5,512 2,842 964 27,503 36,821 During the interim period, the top 10 customers, which are all distributors, contributed 29% (31 March 2010: 30%) of the Company’s revenue. The Company did not make export sales. The totals presented for the Company’s operating segments can be derived directly from the Company’s key financial figures for sales, cost of sales and total assets as presented in the financial statements without reconciliation. F-67 NOTES TO THE CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 7. Analysis of selected items of the condensed interim financial statements Sales increased approximately 44% as compared to the same period of 2010 mainly due to increases in sales volume and average selling prices. Selling and distribution expenses increased on an absolute basis due to the increase in sales. The absolute increase in administrative expenses mainly relates to salary increments of employees, increase in entertainment, local tax dike and other expenses which comprised mainly gift pay made to employees during the Chinese New Year of 2011. The increase of R&D expenses in the first three months of 2011 when compared with the first three months of 2010 was mainly attributable to the innovation of a new product, intruder resistant glass, as well as the associated quality control and design costs for the improvement of various products during the first three months of 2011. The composition and amounts of non-current assets at 31 March 2011 remained broadly comparable to the composition and amounts of non-current assets at 31 December 2010, except for loans to related parties which increased significantly by EUR 2.2 million, due to an unsecured, interest-bearing loan granted by the Company to Mr. Sze to assist with funding the investments in Sichuan in the future. The loan is detailed under note 9. Inventory and trade and other receivables fluctuated with the trading cycle. The tax receivable results from the fact that the Company paid tax at 25% in the first quarter of 2010, however was subsequently granted status for three years initially as a high tech enterprise, which afforded it the benefit of a lower preferential rate of 15% for 2010. The Company expects to be able to claim back the overpaid tax. The preferential status is renewable as long as the Company maintains its high-tech status. Capital and reserves increased compared with capital and reserves at 31 December 2010, due to the profitable operations of the Company in the first three months of 2011. The composition and amounts of current liabilities at 31 March 2011 remained broadly comparable to the composition and amounts of current liabilities at 31 December 2010. 8. Commitments and contingencies Between the financial statements of the Company for the year ended 31 December 2010 and the accounting period of the interim financial statements as at 31 March 2011, no material changes in commitments and contingencies have occurred. F-68 NOTES TO THE CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 9. Related party disclosures – Significant related party transactions Related party information a) Entities/individuals with common control or significant influence over the Company or under common control. - Mr. SZE Nang Heung: Indirect holder of the entire share capital of the Company, ultimate controlling shareholder, CEO; director of the Company from October 1994 until December 2000 and from September 2004 until January 2008 as well as director of Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Ltd. since July 2007. - Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Ltd.: Mr. SZE Nang Heung holds 74.3% of shares while 25.7% of shares were transferred to four investors. - Luckyway Global Group Limited, Tortola, British Virgin Islands (incorporated on 10 March 2010). Mr. SZE holds 100% of the shares in Luckyway Global Group Limited - China Specialty Glass AG, Grünwald near Munich, Germany (incorporated on 10 May 2010). Luckyway Global Group Limited holds 100% of the shares in China Specialty Glass AG. - Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Limited, Chengdu City, Sichuan Province, PRC. 100% subsidiary of the Company. - Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center (formerly known as Guangzhou City Liwan District Glass Factory): Company owned by Mr. SHI Chunli, former majority shareholder of the Company, member of key management and son of Mr. SZE. - HK Chung Hwa Enterprises Development Company: Mr SZE indirectly owns 100% of this Company. - Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited: Mr. SZE holds 99.9% of the shares until selling them to a non related third party on 23 February 2010. - Guangzhou Xinghua Glass Products Co., Ltd.: Subsidiary wholly owned by Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited. - Xi’an Mamen Security Technology Co., Ltd.: Subsidiary wholly owned by Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited. b) Key management/directors of the Company and subsidiary - Mr. ZHOU Chao - Mr. SHI Chunli - Mr. WANG Xue Yan F-69 NOTES TO THE CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 9. Related party (continued) disclosures – Significant party transactions Three months ended 31 March 2011 TEUR Three months ended 31 March 2010 TEUR 36 - 11 9 Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Ltd. Salaries and allowance paid on behalf by Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industrial Co., Ltd. 15 - Key management personnel compensation (Loan to Mr. Sze described below) - salaries and related cost - retirement scheme contribution 15 -* 17 1 Income statement items. Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Limited Interest on loan (loan described below) Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center Rental charged on factory and office building related * - less than one thousand Included in “salaries and related cost” are amounts of director’s remuneration totaling TEUR 11 for the three months ended 31 March 2011 (three months ended 2010: TEUR 17). Loans to related parties in the statement of financial position relate to a loan granted to Mr. SZE of RMB 20 million (EUR 2.2 million at 31 March 2011 exchange rates) as well as a loan to the Company’s 100% subsidiary in the amount of RMB 27 million (EUR 2.9 million at 31 March 2011 exchange rates). Both loans are unsecured, bear interest at the rate of 5.56% per annum and have to be repaid five years after granting of the loan. The loan granted to Mr. SZE is intended for financing of the planned development work in connections with the Company’s Sichuan subsidiary and the funds loaned to Mr. SZE are expected to be transferred to the Company’s Sichuan subsidiary in the near future. Receivables from related parties relate to interest on the loan from the Company’s Sichuan subsidiary in the amount of TEUR 36 receivables for salary paid on behalf of Hingwah Holdings (Hong Kong) Ltd. including prior year amounts of TEUR 93 and the rental deposit on the rental agreement owed by Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center of TEUR 4. Sale and purchase of goods There were no sales or purchases of goods or services or other transactions between the Company and related parties. F-70 NOTES TO THE CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 9. Related party (continued) disclosures – Significant related party transactions Leasing The Company leases several buildings and land use rights under operating leases from Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center and under a finance lease from Mr. SHI Chunli. Credit guarantees and mortgages Related parties have provided guarantees and mortgages for certain of the Company’s bank loans: Guarantees and mortgages for the following credit facilities have been provided by Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center for the below stated periods for a short-term loan for the provision of working capital: As at 31 March 2011 As at 31 December 2010 RMB 7,350,000 (EUR 0.8 million) 8 September 2010 to 7 September 2011 8 September 2010 to 7 September 2011 RMB 8,550,000 EUR 0.9 million) 5 September 2010 to 5 September 2011 6 September 2010 to 5 September 2011 Loan amount During the first quarter ended 31 March 2011, the Company had repaid RMB1 million of the loan (c. EUR 0.1 million). Mr. SHI has provided a guarantee for a maximum facility of RMB 20 million (EUR 2.2 million) at no cost. Mr. SZE has provided a guarantee for a maximum facility of RMB 20 million (EUR 2.2 million) at no cost. 10. Events after the reporting date The Company expects its ultimate holding company, China Specialty Glass AG, to issue its prospectus for its listing on the Prime Standard segment of the German Stock Exchange in 2011. There are no significant non-adjusting events or any significant adjusting events to report between the reporting date and the date of preparation of these financial statements. F-71 REVIEW OPINION To Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co. Ltd., Guangzhou, PRC We have reviewed the condensed interim financial statements – comprising the statement of comprehensive income, statement of financial position, cash flow statement, statement of changes in equity and selected explanatory notes – of Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co. Ltd., for the period from 1 January 2011 to 31 March 2011. The preparation of the condensed interim financial statements in accordance with those IFRS applicable to interim financial reporting as adopted by the EU, is the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to issue a report on the condensed interim financial statements based on our review. We conducted our review of the condensed interim financial statements in accordance with the German generally accepted standards for the review of financial statements promulgated by the Institut der Wirtschaftsprüfer (IDW). Those standards require that we plan and perform the review so that we can preclude through critical evaluation, with a certain level of assurance, that the condensed interim financial statements have not been prepared, in material aspects, in accordance with the IFRS applicable to interim financial reporting as adopted by the EU. A review is limited primarily to inquiries of company employees and analytical assessments and therefore does not provide the assurance attainable in a financial statement audit. Since, in accordance with our engagement, we have not performed a financial statement audit, we cannot issue an auditor's report. Based on our review, no matters have come to our attention that cause us to believe that the condensed interim financial statements have not been prepared, in material respects, in accordance with the IFRS applicable to interim financial reporting as adopted by the EU. Hamburg, 2 May 2011 Grant Thornton GmbH Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft Friedrich Graf von Kanitz Wirtschaftsprüfer F-72 Timothy Robinson Wirtschaftsprüfer Consolidated financial statements of CHINA SPECIALTY GLASS AG for the short financial period 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 in accordance with IFRS as endorsed for application by the EU (audited) F-73 Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income Period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 Notes TEUR Revenue 4 9,066 Cost of sales 5 (4,900) Gross profit 4,166 Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Finance income Finance costs Research and development costs (398) (214) 34 (9) (173) Profit before taxation Taxation 6 6 7 8 3,406 (643) Net profit Other Comprehensive Income: Currency translation reserve movement Total Comprehensive Income 2,763 Profit attributable to owners of the parent Total comprehensive income attributable to owners to the parent 2,763 1,365 4,128 4,128 The comparability is affected by movements in the relative value of the functional currency (RMB) of the Chinese operating subsidiary compared to the presentational currency (EUR). Due to the fact that the Group only came into existence on 22 November 2010, as described in note 1 below, there are no comparative figures. The annexed notes form an integral part of and should be read in conjunction with these financial statements. F-74 Consolidated Statement of Financial Position 31 December 2010 TEUR 22 November 2010 TEUR 9 3,764 2,741 Lease prepayment for land-use rights Other assets Intangible assets 10 11 9 751 3,173 13 7,701 731 330 13 3,815 Current assets Inventories Trade and other receivables Tax receivable Related party receivables Cash and bank balances 12 13 8 14 15 1,591 12,727 438 5 37,912 52,673 60,374 2,480 12,656 427 4 36,666 52,233 56,048 Equity and Liabilities Capital and Reserves Share capital Statutory reserve Foreign currency translation reserve Retained earnings 16 16 16 16 15,050 724 3,521 30,516 49,811 15,050 724 2,156 27,753 45,683 Current liabilities Corporate income tax payable Trade and other payables Interest-bearing bank borrowings Related party payables 8 17 18 14 1,311 4,996 1,813 2,443 10,563 656 5,665 1,759 2,285 10,365 60,374 56,048 Note Assets Non-current assets Property, plant and equipment Total assets Total equity and liabilities The comparability is affected by movements in the relative value of the functional currency (RMB) of the Chinese operating subsidiary compared to the presentational currency (EUR). The annexed notes form an integral part of and should be read in conjunction with these financial statements. F-75 Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity Note Balance at 22 November 2010 Total comprehensive income Balance at 31 December 2010 Share capital TEUR 16 Statutory reserve TEUR 16 Translation reserve TEUR 16 Retained earnings TEUR 16 Total Equity TEUR 16 15,050 724 2,156 27,753 45,683 - - 1,365 2,763 4,128 15,050 724 3,521 30,516 49,811 *Amount is less than EUR 1,000 The comparability is affected by movements in the relative value of the functional currency (RMB) of the Chinese operating company compared to the presentational currency (EUR). In recording the reverse acquisition of CSG AG by the Group as described in note 3, consolidated equity at the commencement of the legal group in Germany, i.e. when the capital increase was recorded in the trade registry in Germany on November 22, 2010, has been disclosed to show the share capital of the legal parent CSG AG, taking into account the capital increase made in the reverse acquisition. Costs of this capital increase were not material. Statutory reserves, retained earnings and the foreign currency translation reserve are shown as a continuation of the consolidated statement of changes in equity of HWG HKHolding. The annexed notes form an integral part of and should be read in conjunction with these financial statements. F-76 Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows Note Cash flows from operating activities Profit before taxation Adjustments for: Loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment Depreciation of property, plant and equipment Finance income Finance costs Decrease in lease prepayment for land-use rights Operating profit before working capital changes Decrease in inventories Decrease in trade and other receivables Decrease in trade and other payables Cash from operations Finance income Income tax paid Net cash from operating activities Cash flows from investing activities Acquisition of property, plant and equipment Construction in progress Deposit for land use rights and design rights Net cash from investing activities Period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 TEUR 3,406 9 6 6 10 9 9 -* 18 (34) 9 2 3,401 950 432 (749) 4,034 34 (136) 3,932 (3) (939) (2,843) (3,785) Cash flows from financing activities Amount due to related parties Finance costs Net cash used in financing activities 9 (9) - Net increase in cash and bank balances 147 Cash and bank balances at beginning of the period Effects of currency translation 36,666 1,099 Cash and bank balances at end of the period 37,912 * Amount less than EUR 1,000 The comparability is affected by movements in the relative value of the functional currency (RMB) of the Chinese operating company compared to the presentational currency (EUR). Due to the fact that the Group only came into existence on 22 November 2010, as described in note 1 below, there are no comparative figures. The annexed notes form an integral part of and should be read in conjunction with these financial statements. Approximately EUR 870,000 of IPO related expenses were paid directly by the Group’s immediate shareholder without cash inflows or outflows for the Group. F-77 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. THE GROUP The principal activity of the China Specialty Glass Group which comprises China Specialty Glass AG, Grünwald, Germany ("CSG AG") , Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited (“HWG HK-Holding”), its 100% subsidiaries Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Limited ("HWG-Ltd."), and Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Co., Ltd. ("HWG-SC"), (hereafter “Group”), is the manufacture and distribution of bullet proof and toughened glass products. The Group's principal place of business is located at No. 6, Hougang Xijie, Guanghai Road, Guangzhou the People's Republic of China (the “PRC”). Its registered place of business is the registered office of its ultimate parent company CSG AG in An den Römerhügeln 1, 82031 Grünwald, Munich, Germany. The Group sells its products to customers in the PRC. The Group was formed on 22 November 2010 when the transfer of the entire share capital in HWG HK-Holding into CSG AG, Grünwald, Munich, Germany, took legal effect. Hence the Group has no historical financial data. The operating business of the Group was and is carried out by HWG-Ltd. It is intended that China Specialty Glass AG will seek a listing on the German Stock Exchange (Prime Standard Segment) in 2011. As the formation of the Group had legal effect on 22 November 2010, the first consolidated financial data of the Group is derived from the consolidated financial statements for the short financial year from 22 November to 31 December 2010 prepared in accordance with IFRS, as endorsed for application in the EU, as at 31 December 2010. As the 22 November 2010 is the initial moment of the legal existence of the Group, there are no comparative figures for the consolidated statement of comprehensive income, the consolidated statement of changes in equity or the consolidated statement of cash flow, and the comparatives for the consolidated statement of financial position are those of the opening consolidated statement of financial position dated 22 November 2010. As at the date of this report, there is only one class of shares in CSG AG, being ordinary shares. The rights and privileges of the shares are stated in the Articles of Association. There is no founder, management or deferred or unissued shares reserved for issuance for any purpose. F-78 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES 2.1 Statement of compliance and basis of preparation These consolidated financial statements of the Group are prepared for the period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010. The consolidated financial statements of the Group have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) in so far as these have been endorsed by the EU. They are the first consolidated financial statements prepared by the Group which are compliant with International Financial Reporting Standards, as adopted for use in the EU. The consolidated interim financial statements of the Group have been rounded to the nearest thousand Euro. Amounts are stated in thousands of Euros (TEUR) except where otherwise indicated. The consolidated financial statements of the Group for the period from 22 November to 31 December 2010 are expected to be authorized for issue by the Supervisory Board of CSG AG at the end of June 2011. F-79 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.2. Published Amendments but not yet applied Standards, Interpretations and At the time of preparation of the group financial statements, the following releases of the IASB as well as their changes and revisions were not compulsorily applicable in the 2010 financial year, and were not applied by the CSG AG Group: · IAS 24 and changes to IFRS 8: “Related party disclosures” (effective 1 January 2011) · Changes to IAS 32: “Financial instruments: presentation” (Classification of Rights Issues) (effective 1 February 2010) · Changes to IFRS 1 and IFRS 7: “First-time adoption of IFRS” and “Financial instruments: disclosures” (Limited Exemption from Comparative IFRS 7 Disclosures for First-Time Adoptors) (effective 1 July 2010) · Changes to IFRIC 14: “The Limit on an Defined Benefit Asset, Minimum Funding Requirements and their Interaction” (Prepayments of a Minimum Funding Requirement) ” (effective 1 January 2011) · IFRIC 19 and consequential changes to IFRS 1: “Extinguishing Financial Liabilities with Equity Instruments” and “First-time adoption of IFRS” (effective 1 July 2011) · Annual Improvements 2010 ” (effective 1 July 2010) The following accounting standards and amendments to existing standards have been published but, as at 31 December 2010, are not yet effective and have not yet been adopted by the European Union: · Amendments to IFRS 1: First-time Adoption: Additional Exemptions to First-time Adopters (effective from 1 July 2011) · Amendments to IFRS 7: Financial instruments disclosures (effective from 1 July 2012) · IFRS 9: Financial Instruments (effective from 1 January 2013) · Amendments to IAS 12: Deferred Tax Recovery of Underlying Assets (effective from 1 January 2012) The Management Board of CSG AG assumes that the new and amended standards and interpretations will likely not have a material effect on the consolidated financial statements when they are applied by the Group. F-80 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.3 Overall Considerations The Financial Statements have been prepared in accordance with the significant accounting policies set out below and these accounting policies are in accordance with IFRS. The preparation of the Financial Statements in conformity with IFRS requires the use of judgments, estimates and assumptions that affect the application of accounting policies as disclosed below, reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the Financial statements and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the financial years. The significant accounting policies that have been used in the preparation of these financial statements are summarized below. The financial statements have been prepared using the measurement bases and accounting policies specified by IFRS for each type of asset, liability, income and expense. These are more fully described below. 2.4 Presentation of Financial Statements The consolidated financial statements are presented in accordance with IAS 1 Presentation of Financial Statements. The statement of comprehensive income has been prepared using the function of expense method. The Group has elected to adopt IAS 1 (Revised 2007) by presenting the 'Statement of Comprehensive Income' in one statement. F-81 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.5 Critical accounting estimates and judgment Estimates and judgments are continually evaluated and are based on historical experiences and other factors, including expectations of future events that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. The Group makes estimates and assumptions concerning the future. The resulting accounting estimates and assumptions that have a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next period are discussed below: 2.6 Key sources of estimation uncertainty Depreciation of property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment are depreciated on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. Management estimates the useful lives of these assets to be within 3 to 30 years. Changes in the expected level of usage and technological developments could impact the economic useful lives and the residual values of these assets, therefore future depreciation charges could be revised. The net book value of property, plant and equipment subject to this estimation uncertainty is TEUR 3,764 at 31 December 2010 (TEUR 2,741 at 22 November 2010). Income tax The Group has exposure to income taxes primarily in the PRC. Significant judgment is required in determining the provision for income taxes. There are also claims for which the ultimate tax determination is uncertain during the ordinary course of business. The Group recognises liabilities for expected tax issues based on estimates of whether additional taxes will be due. When the final tax outcome of these matters is different from the amounts that were initially recognised, such differences will impact the income tax and deferred tax provisions in the period in which such determination is made. The value of tax assets subject to this estimation uncertainty is TEUR 438 at 31 December 2010 (TEUR 427 at 22 November 2010) and the value of tax liabilities subject to estimation uncertainty is TEUR 1,311 at 31 December 2010 (TEUR 656 at 22 November 2010). F-82 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.6 Key sources of estimation uncertainty (continued) Inventories Inventories are measured at the lower of cost and net realizable value. In estimating net realizable values, management takes into account the most reliable evidence available at the times the estimates are made. Changes in these estimates could result in revisions to the valuation of inventories. The carrying value of inventories at 31 December 2010 is TEUR 1,591 (TEUR 2,480 at 22 November 2010). Provisions The respective legislation of the Group’s primary operating environment in the PRC requires the Group to commit itself to remediate any environmental damages which may have been incurred. Management is of the opinion that no environmental damage has been caused by the Group and hence has not provided for this. F-83 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.7 Critical judgment made in applying accounting policies In the process of applying the Group’s accounting policies as described below, the management is of the opinion that there are no instances of application of judgments which are expected to have a significant effect on the amounts recognised in the financial statements. Allocation of cost attributable to other assets (land use rights) and to property plant and equipment In 2007, the Group made an advance payment for land use rights and building, which it intended to purchase. The advance payment of EUR 1,801,000 was not attributed separately to land use rights and to the building at the time of making the advance payment. Management obtained a valuation report which stated the market value of the land use rights and the market value of the building. The total market value was above the total of the advanced payment made. Management then allocated the advanced payment pro rata the market valuation to the land use rights and the building. In 2009, the Group decided no longer to purchase the land use rights and building but to lease them and a lease agreement was made for a period of 30 years commencing on 1 July 2009. This agreement was subsequently replaced by one dated April 2010, also with a 30 year term. The lease agreement can be extended by negotiation by 60 days before the lease term expires. According to the PRC law, the lease term may not exceed 20 years however. If it exceeds twenty years, the period in excess is invalid. Therefore, the term of the legal lease expires on 31 March 2030 as the lease is invalid after 1 April 2030. However the Company assumes it will be able to extend the lease as described above and an extension is legal under the laws of the PRC. Impairment of trade receivables The Group’s management assesses the collectability of trade receivables. This estimate is based on the credit history of the Group’s customers and the current market condition. Management assesses the impairment loss at the date of the statement of financial position and makes the provision, if any. F-84 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed accounting policies Lease prepayment for land-use rights The lease prepayment for land-use rights relates exclusively to land use rights, which the Group is leasing under a lease, which it has determined to be an operating lease and for which it has paid the leased payments due over the entire initial lease term in advance. The prepayment is being expensed to income over the term of the lease. Other assets Other assets relate to an advance payment for land use rights and design rights in connection with the construction work for the Group's planned facility in Sichuan. Other assets are recognized at cost less accumulated impairment losses and are written off where, in the opinion of the directors, no further future economic benefits are expected to arise. Property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and impairment losses. The cost of property, plant and equipment comprises the purchase price and any costs directly attributable to bringing the asset to the working condition and location for its intended use. Expenditure incurred after property, plant and equipment have been put into operation, such as repairs and maintenance, is normally recognized in profit or loss in the period in which it is incurred. In situations where it can be clearly demonstrated that the expenditure has resulted in an increase in the future economic benefits expected to be obtained from the use of the property, plant and equipment, and the expenditure of the item can be measured reliably, the expenditure is capitalised as an additional cost of that asset. Advance payments for property, plant and equipment acquired are recognised as an asset when payment for the property, plant and equipment has been made in advance of the final delivery of the property, plant and equipment. F-85 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed accounting policies (continued) Property, plant and equipment (continued) Depreciation on property, plant and equipment is calculated using the straightline method to write off the cost of property, plant and equipment, less any estimated residual values, over the following estimated useful lives: Leasehold building Plant and machinery Furniture, fixtures and office equipment Motor vehicles 30 10 5 10 years years years years The estimated residual values, estimated useful lives and depreciation method of the property, plant and equipment are reviewed, and adjusted as appropriate, at each statement of financial position date. The gain or loss on disposal or retirement of an item of property, plant and equipment recognized in profit or loss is the difference between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the relevant asset. Intangible assets Intangible assets relate primarily to software licences and are stated at cost less accumulated amortization. The cost of intangible assets comprises the purchase price and any costs directly attributable to bringing the asset to the working condition and location for intended use. Software is amortized on a straight-line basis over 3 years. Impairment of non-financial assets Other assets and property, plant and equipment, lease prepayment for land-use rights and intangible assets are tested for impairment whenever there is any objective evidence or indication that these assets may be impaired. For the purpose of impairment testing, the recoverable amount (i.e. the higher of the fair value less cost to sell and the value-in-use) is determined on an individual asset basis unless the asset does not generate cash flows that are largely independent of those from other assets. If this is the case, the recoverable amount is determined for the cash-generating-unit (“CGU”) to which the asset belongs. F-86 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed accounting policies (continued) Impairment of non-financial assets (continued) If the recoverable amount of the asset (or CGU) is estimated to be less than its carrying amount, the carrying amount of the asset (or CGU) is reduced to its recoverable amount. The difference between the carrying amount and recoverable amount is recognised as an impairment loss in profit or loss, unless the asset is carried at revalued amount, in which case, such impairment loss is treated as a revaluation decrease. Financial assets The financial assets of the Group are categorised as loans and receivables. The Group does not have any other financial assets. The Group’s loans and receivables comprise trade receivables, related party receivables and cash and cash equivalents in the statement of financial position. Regular purchases and sales of financial assets are accounted for at trade date. The Group's loans and receivables are non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments that are not quoted in an active market. They arise principally via the provision of goods and services to distributors (e.g. trade receivables), but also incorporate other types of contractual monetary assets. They are initially recognized at fair value plus transaction costs that are directly attributable to their acquisition or issue if any, and are subsequently carried at amortized cost using the effective interest rate method, less provision for impairment. Impairment provisions are recognized when there is objective evidence that the Group will be unable to collect all of the amounts due under the terms of receivables, the amount of such a provision being the difference between the net carrying amount and the present value of the future expected cash flows associated with the impaired receivables. For trade receivables and related party receivables, which are reported net of impairment provisions, such provisions are recorded in a separate allowance account with the loss being recognized within administrative expense in the statement of comprehensive income. On confirmation that the trade receivables or related party receivables will not be collectable, the gross carrying value of the asset is written off against the F-87 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed accounting policies (continued) Financial assets (continued) associated provision. Gains on loans and receivables are primarily from interest and are determined on the effective interest method. Losses are primarily from Impairment and are determined by management analysis of the ageing of loans and receivables based on experience of default risk and history. Loans and receivables are presented as current assets, as all mature within 12 months after the end of the reporting period. Loans and receivables are measured on initial recognition at fair value plus transaction cost and subsequently carried at amortised cost using the effective interest method. Allowances for impairment are recognised in profit or loss when there is objective evidence that the asset is impaired. The allowance recognised is calculated as the difference between the asset's carrying amount and the present value of estimated future cash flows, discounted at the effective interest rate computed at initial recognition. Inventories Inventories are carried at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Cost is determined using the weighted average method. The cost of finished goods comprises raw materials, direct labour and other overheads that have been incurred in bringing the inventories to their present location and condition. Net realisable value is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business, less the estimated costs of completion and the estimated costs necessary to make the sale. In valuing inventory, it is assumed that inventory is utilised on a first in first out basis. Equity reserves and dividend payments Share capital represents the nominal value of shares that have been issued in the Group. Share capital is determined using the nominal value of shares that have been issued. Retained earnings include all current and prior period results as determined in the statement of comprehensive income. Foreign currency translation differences arising on the translation are included in the translation reserve. F-88 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed accounting policies (continued) Equity reserves and dividend payments (continued) Dividend distributions payable to equity shareholders are included in 'other liabilities' when the dividends have been approved in a general meeting prior to the reporting date. In accordance with the relevant laws and regulations of PRC, the subsidiaries of the Group established in PRC are required to transfer 10% of its annual statutory net profit (after offsetting any prior years’ losses) to the statutory reserve. When the balance of such reserve reaches 50% of the subsidiary’s share capital, any further transfer of its annual statutory net profit is optional. Such reserve may be used to offset accumulated losses or to increase the registered capital of the subsidiaries subject to the approval of the relevant authorities. However, except for offsetting prior years’ losses, such statutory reserve must be maintained at a minimum of 25% of the share capital after such usage. The statutory reserves are not available for dividend distribution to the shareholders. Financial liabilities Financial liabilities are recognised when the Group becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the financial instrument. Financial liabilities are recognised initially at fair value, plus in the case of financial liabilities other than derivatives, directly attributable transaction costs. Subsequent to initial recognition, all financial liabilities are measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method, except for derivatives, which are measured at fair value. All interest related charges are recognised as an expense in profit or loss. Financial liabilities are derecognised when the obligation for the liabilities is discharged or cancelled or expired. For financial liabilities other than derivatives, gains and losses are recognised in profit or loss when the liabilities are derecognised or impaired, and through the amortisation process. The Group’s financial liabilities include trade and other payables, interest-bearing bank borrowings and related party payables. F-89 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed accounting policies (continued) Trade and other payables Trade and other payables, interest-bearing bank borrowings and related party payables are initially recognised at fair value, and subsequently carried at amortised cost using the effective interest method. Provisions and contingent liabilities Provisions are recognized when the Group has a present obligation (legal or constructive) where, as a result of a past event, it is probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation and a reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation. Provisions are not recognized for future operating losses. Where the Group expects some or all of a provision to be reimbursed, the reimbursement is recognized as a separate asset but only when the reimbursement is virtually certain. However, this asset may not exceed the amount of the related provision. The expense relating to any provision is presented in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income net of any reimbursement. Provisions are measured at the estimated expenditure required to settle the present obligation, based on the most reliable evidence available at the reporting date, including the risks and uncertainties associated with the present obligation. Where there are a number of similar obligations, the likelihood that an outflow will be required in settlement is determined by considering the class of obligations as a whole. Provisions are discounted to their present values, where the time value of money is material. In those cases where the possible outflow of economic resources as a result of present obligations is considered improbable or remote, no liability is recognized. All provisions and contingent liabilities are reviewed at each reporting date and adjusted to reflect the current best estimate. F-90 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed accounting policies (continued) Provisions and contingent liabilities (continued) Provisions for environmental protection are recorded if future cash outflows are likely to be necessary to ensure compliance with environmental regulations or to carry out remediation work, such costs can be reliably estimated and no future benefits are expected from such measures. Estimating the future costs of environmental protection and remediation involves many uncertainties, particularly with regard to the status of laws and regulations. Management considers that environmental damage has not been caused by the Group and hence has not provided for environmental protection. Revenue and other income Revenue is measured at the fair value of the consideration received or receivable and presented net of goods and services taxes and trade discounts. The Group sells bullet proof and toughened security glass to various customers in the automotive, banking and construction sectors. Revenue from the sale of manufactured products are recognised when the Group has transferred to customers the significant risks and rewards of ownership of the goods, which generally coincides with the delivery to and acceptance of goods by the customers; and when the Group can reliably measure the amount of revenue and the cost incurred and to be incurred in respect of the transaction; and it is probable that the collectability of the related receivables is reasonably assured. No revenue is recognised if there are significant uncertainties regarding recovery of the consideration due, associated costs or the possible return of goods. Finance income Finance income is recognised using the effective interest method. F-91 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed accounting policies (continued) Employee benefits - Retirement benefits scheme Pursuant to the relevant regulations of the PRC government, the Group participates in a local municipal government retirement benefits scheme (the "Scheme"), whereby the subsidiaries located in the PRC are required to contribute a certain percentage of the basic salaries of its employees to the Scheme to fund their retirement benefits. The local municipal government undertakes to assume the retirement benefits obligations of all existing and future retired employees of the subsidiaries located in the PRC. The only obligation of the Group with respect to the Scheme is to pay the ongoing required contributions under the Scheme mentioned above. Contributions under the Scheme are recognized in profit or loss as incurred. There are no provisions under the Scheme whereby forfeited contributions may be used to reduce future contributions. These plans are considered defined contribution plans. The Group has no legal or constructive obligations to pay further contributions after its payment of the fixed contributions into the national pension schemes. Contributions to national pension schemes are recognized as an expense in the period in which the related service is performed. Key management personnel Key management personnel are those persons having the authority and responsibility for planning, directing and controlling the activities of the entity. Directors and certain managers are considered key management personnel of the Group. Income tax Tax expense recognised in profit or loss comprises the sum of current and deferred tax charges. Current income tax assets and/or liabilities comprise those obligations to, or claims from, fiscal authorities relating to the current or prior reporting periods, that are unpaid at the reporting date. Current tax is payable on taxable profit, which differs from profit or loss in the financial statements. Calculation of current tax is based on tax rates and tax laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the end of the reporting period in the country in which the Group is operating. F-92 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed accounting policies (continued) Value-added tax (“VAT”) The Group’s sale of goods in the PRC is subject to VAT at the applicable tax rate of 17% for the PRC domestic sales. Input VAT on purchases can be deducted from output VAT. The net amount of VAT recoverable from, or payable to, the tax authority is included as part of “other receivables” or “other payables” in the statement of financial position. Revenue, expenses and assets are recognised net of the amount of VAT except: (i) where the VAT incurred on a purchase of assets or services is not recoverable from the tax authority, in which case the VAT is recognised as part of the cost of acquisition of the asset or as part of the expense item as applicable; and (ii) receivables and payables that are stated with the amount of VAT included. Foreign currencies (iii) Functional and presentation currency Items included in the financial statements are measured using the currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity operates (the “functional currency”). The Group conducts its business predominately in the PRC and the functional currency of the sole main operating subsidiary HWG Ltd. is the Renminbi (RMB). HWG HK-Holding prepared its financial statements in its functional currency of Hong Kong Dollar and CSG AG prepared its financial statements in its functional currency EUR. The presentation currency of the Group is EUR, being the presentation currency of its ultimate German domiciled legal parent, and therefore the financial information has been translated from RMB to EUR and HKD to EUR before consolidation in EUR at the following rates: F-93 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed accounting policies (continued) Foreign currencies (continued) 22 November 2010 Rate applicable to opening balance sheet at 22 November 2010 EUR 1.00 = HKD 10.6574 EUR 1.00 = RMB 9.0964 Period end rates 31 December 2010 EUR 1.00 = HKD 10.3247 EUR 1.00 = RMB 8.8231 Average rates EUR 1.00 = HKD 10.2342 EUR 1.00 = RMB 8.9789 The results and financial positions of the Group entities in their respective functional currencies are translated into the presentation currency for the purpose of presentation in the IPO prospectus of its ultimate legal parent as follows: (iv) (1) Assets and liabilities for each statement of financial position presented are translated at the closing rate at the date of that statement of financial position; (2) Income and expenses for each statement of comprehensive income are translated at average exchange rates (unless this average is not a reasonable approximation of the cumulative effect of the rates prevailing on the transaction dates, in which case income and expenses are translated at the dates of the transactions); and (3) All resulting exchange differences are recognised in the foreign currency translation reserve, a separate component of equity. Transactions and balances Foreign currency transactions are measured and recorded in the functional currency using the exchange rates prevailing at the dates of the transactions. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are translated at the closing rates ruling at the respective statement of financial position dates. Foreign exchange gains and losses resulting from the settlement of such transactions and from the translation at year-end exchange rates of monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are recognised in profit or loss. F-94 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued) 2.8 Detailed accounting policies (continued) Non-monetary items that are measured in terms of historical cost in a foreign currency are translated using the exchange rates as at the dates of the initial transactions. Non-monetary items measured at fair value in a foreign currency are translated using the exchange rates at the date when the fair value was determined. Related parties The Group has the following types of related parties: (i) entities or individuals which directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, (1) control, or are under common control with, the Group; (2) have an interest in the Group that gives them significant influence over the Group; (ii) the key management personnel of the Group or its ultimate parent; (iii) close members of the family of any individual referred to in (i) or (ii) Leases Leases where substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of assets remain with the lessor are accounted for as operating leases. Annual rentals applicable to such operating leases are recognised in profit or loss on a straightline basis over the lease terms except where an alternative basis is more representative of the pattern of benefits to be derived from the leased assets. Leases where substantially all the risks ands rewards of ownership are transferred to the lessee are accounted for as finance leases. Segment reporting Operating segments are reported in a manner consistent with the internal reporting provided to the chief operating decision-maker. The chief operating decision-maker, who is responsible for allocating resources and assessing performance of the operating segments, has been identified as the board of directors of the Group which makes strategic decisions. F-95 2. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED) 2.8 Detailed accounting policies (continued) The management of the Group bases its decisions on the internal reporting on sales to car manufacturers, banks and financial institutions and construction companies, which are the Group’s three business segments. Segment information is presented in respect of the Group’s business segments. The accounting policies the Group uses for segment reporting under IFRS 8 are the same as those used in its financial statements for the period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010. Development activities Expenditure on research (or the research phase of an internal project) is recognized as an expense in the period in which it is incurred. Costs that are directly attributable to the development phase of new products are also expensed, as they do not meet the criteria of IAS 38 for recognition as an intangible asset. F-96 3. FORMATION OF THE GROUP AND BASIS OF CONSOLDIATION The Group was formed on 22 November 2010 when the transfer of the entire share capital in HWG HK-Holding into CSG AG, Grünwald, Munich, Germany took legal effect. At the time of this transaction, CSG AG was essentially a shell company, without its own business. The purpose of the transaction was to enable the operating group of HWG HK-Holding to obtain a listing on the Prime Standard segment of the German Stock Exchange. Hence this transaction has been accounted for similarly to a reverse acquisition, without the recognition of goodwill. HWG HK-Holding is itself the sole shareholder of HWG-Ltd. which in turn is the sole shareholder of HWG-SC. HWG HK-Holding was incorporated by GNL07 Limited under the laws of Hong Kong on 26 July 2007. On 3 October 2007, Mr. SZE Nang Heung acquired one subscriber share from GNL07 Limited for a consideration of HKD 1. On the same date, a total of 9,999 shares of HKD 1 each were issued and allotted, credited as fully paid to Mr. SZE Nang Heung and as a result, HWG HK-Holding was owned 100% by Mr. SZE Nang Heung. Prior to the establishment of HWG HK-Holding, several share purchase agreements were concluded as follows. On 8 November 2006, an agreement was entered into among Mr. SZE Nang Heung, Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co. Ltd. (“HWG-Ltd.”) and Mr. CHI Mang Cheung. On the same date, another agreement was entered into among Mr. SZE Nang Heung, HWG-Ltd. and Mr. YAN Kong Wong. On 20 September 2006, an agreement was entered into among Mr. SZE Nang Heung, HWG-Ltd. and Mr. CHING Hoi Sze and on 22 September 2006, an agreement was entered into among Mr. SZE Nang Heung, HWG-Ltd. and Mr. HUNG Hui Ke (together the “Sale and Purchase Agreements”). Except for the contracting parties, the terms of the Sale and Purchase Agreements are substantially the same. Under the terms of the Sale and Purchase Agreements, HWG-Ltd. underwent a reorganisation to streamline the group structure in preparation for an overseas listing. HWG HK-Holding was established to hold 100% equity interest in HWG-Ltd. and an ultimate holding company was to be established outside of China as a listing vehicle for HWG-Ltd. After establishment of HWG HK-Holding, Mr. SZE Nang Heung agreed to transfer 25.7% of his shares to four minority investors. Mr. SZE Nang Heung remained controlling shareholder with 74.3% of shares. F-97 3. FORMATION OF THE GROUP AND BASIS OF CONSOLDIATION (continued) On 30 April 2010, the authorised share capital of HWG HK-Holding, was increased from HKD 10,000 to HKD 1,000,000 by the creation of 990,000 new shares of HKD 1 each. On the same date, 3,459 new shares were allotted to four minority investors and the paid up capital was increased from HKD 10,000 to HKD 13,459. Mr. SZE Nang Heung remained controlling shareholder with 74.3% of shares following this capital increase. HWG HK-Holding holds all shares of HWG-Ltd., which is the only operationally trading company of the Group. HWG-Ltd. was incorporated on 24 October 1994 as a sino-foreign joint venture company under the laws of the People’s Republic of China by Guangzhou Property Management Center (70%) and Hong Kong Chung Hwa Enterprises Development Co. (“HK Chung Hwa”) (30%). As of the time of its establishment, HWG-Ltd. had a registered capital of HKD 4,000,000.00 and the business name Guangzhou HingWah Auto Glass Industry Co., Ltd. with the business address at Nantougang, Chatou, Baiyun District, Guangzhou City, PRC. On 15 January 2008, HWG-Ltd. became a wholly foreign owned enterprise by the share transfers from its initial shareholders Guangzhou Property Management Center which held 70% of the shares and HK Chung Hwa which held 30% of the shares to HWG HK-Holding. The restructuring in the ownership of HWG-Ltd. was executed by Mr. SZE Nang Heung together with his son Mr. SHI Chun Li who directly or indirectly controlled Guangzhou Property Management Center and HK Chung Hwa as well as the HWG HK-Holding. At the time of the share transfer from Guangzhou Property Management Center and HK Chung Hwa to the HWG HK-Holding, Mr. SZE Nang Heung held all shares in the HWG HK-Holding and Mr. SHI Chun Li who is the son of Mr. SZE Nang Heung held 100% of the shares in Guangzhou Property Management Center and Mr. Zhefen Li held 100% of the shares in HK Chung Hwa as trustee for Mr. SZE Nang Heung. In 2010, HWG-Ltd.’s share capital was increased from HKD 4,000,000.00 by HKD 10,000,000.00 to HKD 14,000,000.00 through the issuance of new shares to its sole shareholder HWG HK-Holding against cash contributions. This capital increase became legally effective with approval from the Guangzhou Liwan BOFTEC on 3 March 2010 and registration with the Guangzhou AIC on 8 September 2010. F-98 3. FORMATION OF THE GROUP AND BASIS OF CONSOLDIATION (continued) On May 25, 2010, HWG-Ltd. incorporated a wholly owned subsidiary, HWG-SC in Chengdu City, Sichuan Province, China. HWG-SC has not been operationally trading at the date of these consolidated interim financial statements, although it has made significant investments and assumed liabilities in respect of these investments and entered into commitments in respect of planned investments in connection with the Group's planned facility in Sichuan. The business scope of HWG-SC is the production and processing of all kinds of glass product and sales of its products. With the exception of the reverse acquisition, the transactions described above did not represent business combinations as defined in IFRS 3 ‘Business Combinations’, but are deemed to be transactions under common control, as there was one ultimate controlling party involved. There is no guidance elsewhere in IFRS which covers the accounting for such transactions under common control. In the absence of an international standard or interpretation that specifically applies to such a transaction, paragraphs 10 to 12 of IAS 8 ‘Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and Errors’ set out the approach to be followed. This requires, inter alia, that where IFRS does not include guidance for a particular issue, the Directors may also consider the most recent pronouncements of other standard setting bodies that use a similar conceptual framework to develop accounting standards. 4. REVENUE An analysis of the Group's revenue, which is generated on sales of bullet proof and toughened security glass within the PRC, is as follows: Period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 TEUR Revenue Sales of goods 9,066 Further details are given in the segment analysis in Note 23. F-99 5. COST OF SALES Cost of sales comprises purchasing materials, labour costs for personnel employed in production, depreciation and amortization of non-current assets used for production purposes, trading goods and others (mainly tools, packaging materials and maintenance costs). The following table shows a breakdown of costs of sales for the period under review for each category: Period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 TEUR Materials Labour Depreciation of property, plant and equipment Operating lease expense Electricity and water Others 6. 3,795 180 18 8 204 695 4,900 FINANCE INCOME AND FINANCE COSTS Period from 22 November 2010 to Finance income 31 December 2010 TEUR Finance income on bank balance 34 Finance costs Finance expense on bank borrowings 9 F-100 7. PROFIT BEFORE TAXATION The Group's profit before taxation is arrived at after charging: Period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 TEUR Depreciation of property, plant and equipment - included in cost of sales - included in administrative expenses 18 -* Cost of inventories sold recognised as Expenses Operating lease expense Research costs expensed 3,795 -* 173 * Amount less than EUR 1,000 Costs relating to employees are disclosed in detail in note 25. 8. TAXATION Period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 TEUR Current income tax on profit arising from Operations 529 114 643 Non-refundable withholding tax According to PRC laws, any dividends declared out of profits earned from 1 January 2008 onwards to foreign investors attract withholding tax. The amount of withholding tax payable is dependent on the country of residence of the investor. In the case of Hong Kong, the applicable tax rate is 5%. HWG HKHolding received a dividend from HWG-Ltd. on which withholding tax of TEUR 114 was levied and which was a definitive expense of HWG-HK Holding as it was not refundable. F-101 8. TAXATION (continued) Reconciliation between current income tax on profit arising form operations and profit before taxation at statutory tax rates is as follows: Period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 TEUR Profit before taxation 3,337 Tax calculated at tax rate applicable in PRC for major operating subsidiary (2010: 15%) Exchange difference on translation 501 27 528 The Group’s subsidiary (“Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd.) is subject to PRC income tax on profit arising or derived from the tax jurisdiction in which it operates and is domiciled. Business operations set up in the special economic zones by foreign enterprises are subject to a reduced enterprise income tax rate. The provision for PRC income tax on profits arising from operations in the PRC is calculated based on enterprise income tax rates of 15% for the period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010, in accordance with the relevant PRC income tax rules and regulations. The Group was granted status as a high tech enterprise in 2010 and as such gained the benefit of the lower 15% tax rate. The German parent company generated losses in the short financial year 22 November to 31 December 2010, such that no tax charge arises. A deferred tax asset was not recognised for these tax losses for reasons of immateriality. Movements in corporate income tax payable are as follows: As at 31 December 2010 TEUR As at 22 November 2010 Current period tax expenses on profit Withholding tax Income tax paid Exchange difference on translation End of period 656 528 114 13 1,311 A tax receivable of TEUR 438 at 31 December 2010 (TEUR 427 at 22 November 2010 exchange rates) results from the fact that the Group’s subsidiary (“Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd.”) paid tax at 25% in the first quarter of 2010 and was however subsequently granted status as a high tech enterprise, which afforded it the benefit of a lower preferential rate of 15% for 2010. The Group expects to be able to claim back the overpaid tax. F-102 9. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS The following table shows property plant and equipment during the reporting period. Furniture fixtures and Construction Motor Leasehold Plant and office In vehicles buildings machinery equipment Progress Total TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR 2010 35 1,715 1,615 42 - 3,407 Additions -* 1 2 -* 939 942 Disposals - - (5) - - (5) Transfers - 1 - - (1) - 1 51 49 2 17 120 36 1,768 1,661 44 955 4,464 -* 75 553 38 - 666 Depreciation 1 -* 17 -* - 18 Written back - - (4) - - (4) -* 2 17 1 - 20 1 77 583 39 - 700 2010 35 1,691 1,078 5 955 3,764 At 22 November 35 1,640 1,062 4 - 2,741 Cost At 22 November Translation adjustment At 31 December 2010 Accumulated depreciation At 22 November 2010 Translation adjustment At 31 December 2010 Net book value At 31 December 2010 *Amount is less than EUR 1,000 F-103 9. PROPERTY, (continued) PLANT AND EQUIPMENT AND INTANGIBLE The following table shows intangible assets during the reporting period. Software Licences TEUR Cost At 22 November 2010 13 At 31 December 2010 13 Accumulated depreciation At 22 November 2010* 0 At 31 December 2010* 0 Net book value At 31 December 2010 13 At 22 November 2010 13 *Amount is less than EUR 1,000 F-104 ASSETS 9. PROPERTY, (continued) PLANT AND EQUIPMENT AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS During 2007, an interest free deposit of RMB 18,751,554 (equivalent EUR 1,801,000) was made by HWG Ltd. to acquire land use rights and buildings from a related party. However, during 2009 the subsidiary decided to lease the land and buildings instead. Accordingly, a tenancy agreement was signed for a period of 30 years commencing on 1 July 2009. This agreement was subsequently replaced by one dated April 2010, also with a 30 year term. Based on a valuation report the acquisition costs were split pro rata between land use rights (TEUR 670) and buildings (TEUR 1,131). Due to the relatively long-term nature of the lease in relation to the buildings, this agreement is treated as a finance lease, hence the recognition of the buildings in the statement of financial position under property plant and equipment as leasehold buildings from the signing of the lease agreement in 2009. The related lease agreement is between Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Limited and its related party Mr. Chun Li Shi and its terms include staged rent increases over the term of the lease. Until the signing of the lease agreement, the buildings were not used by the subsidiary and the advance payment was disclosed as advance payment for leasehold buildings. The lease agreement can be extended by negotiation by 60 days before the lease term expires. According to the PRC law, the lease term may not exceed 20 years however. If it exceeds twenty years, the period in excess is invalid. Therefore, the term of the legal lease expires on 31 March 2030 as the lease is invalid after 1 April 2030. However the subsidiary assumes it will be able to extend the lease as described above and an extension is legal under the laws of the PRC. The rental payments under this agreement have been paid in advance until 2039; hence there are no future lease payments to be made under the current lease agreement. During 2009 and 2010 the Group paid land levelling costs in connection with the construction of a new building as well as the construction of the building at the Company’s main operational premises on behalf of a related party who will retain title to the building. It was intended that the Group would lease the building from the related party, who will waive lease payments in consideration for the land levelling costs and construction paid by the Group. Hence the amount has been treated as advance payment for leasehold buildings, as due to the likely long term nature of the lease, the arrangement would be considered to be a finance lease. The advance payment has since been re-classified as leasehold building. All property, plant and equipment held by the Group are located in the PRC. F-105 10. LEASE PREPAYMENT FOR LAND-USE RIGHTS This relates to the land use rights for which an advance payment was made in 2007 as described in note 9. Following the conclusion of the lease agreement described in note 9, which the Group determined to be an operating lease in respect of the land, as the term is relatively short compared to the useful life of the land, the advance payment was reclassified as a lease prepayment for landuse rights. It is being expensed to income over the 30 years term of the lease. The terms of the lease are as described in note 9. With regard to the leasehold buildings, please refer to note 9. 11. OTHER ASSETS Other assets comprise advance payments which the Group has made for land-use rights and design/greening scheme fees in respect of the Group's planned facility in Sichuan. In respect of the advance payments for land-use rights, the Group made the advance payment in the context of a bidding process which has not yet been formally completed. The Management Board expect that the process will be formally completed in 2011 and that the title to the land-use rights will successfully pass to the Group. 12. INVENTORIES As at 31 December 2010 TEUR As at 22 November 2010 TEUR 694 897 1,591 1,070 1,410 2,480 Raw materials Finished goods The amount of inventories recognized as an expense during the period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 was TEUR 3,795 included in cost of sales. F-106 13. TRADE AND OTHER RECEIVABLES As at 31 December 2010 TEUR As at 22 November 2010 TEUR 11,219 760 11,979 748 12,727 11,967 26 11,993 663 12,656 Trade receivables Other receivables Sub total Payments in advance Total Trade receivables are non-interest bearing and generally have credit terms of 30 to 60 days (2009: 30 to 60 days). Other receivables at 31 December 2010 relate mainly to security deposits given to suppliers in the context of a supplier contracts to ensure delivery of raw materials on a timely basis. In the ageing analysis the amount has been included in the category "More than 60 days". Payments in advance relate to costs of the capital increase and costs of the listing of the shares of CSG AG planned for 2011, which have been already paid on account in 2010. The costs of the capital increase will be deducted directly from equity at the time of the capital increase. The aging of trade and other receivables is as follows: As at 31 December 2010 TEUR Within 30 days 31 to 60 days More than 60 days 7,319 3,684 976 11,979 F-107 As at 22 November 2010 TEUR 4,453 6,702 838 11,993 13. TRADE AND OTHER RECEIVABLES (continued) All trade receivables are denominated in Renminbi. As at 31 December 2010 TEUR Financial Assets Loans and receivables Trade and other receivables 11,979 Cash and cash equivalents 37,912 Related party receivables 5 Total financial assets classified as loans and receivables 49,896 As at 22 November 2010 TEUR 11,993 36,666 4 48,663 All financial assets classified as loans and receivables are current and noninterest bearing. Management considers the carrying amounts recognized in the statement of financial position to be a reasonable approximation of their fair value due to the short duration. Finance income of TEUR 34 was earned on cash and cash equivalents in the period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010. Apart from this no net gains or losses on loans and receivables occurred in the period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010. The maximum credit risk is assessed by Management to be the amounts shown in the above table as at the respective reporting dates. Management aims to deal only with customers of good to high credit quality. F-108 14. RELATED PARTY RECEIVABLES/PAYABLES Related party receivables relate to a rental deposit paid to Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center, for the renewal of a rental agreement. Related party payables relate both to a financing agreement made between Luckyway Global Group Limited and CSG AG, whereby Luckyway Global Group Limited finances the IPO costs on an interest free and short-term basis, and is to be refunded after the IPO and also to payments paid on behalf by a controlling shareholder and director of the Company, Mr. SZE Nang Heung, to fund the Group’s investment in Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd. and for other expenses. Amounts of related party liabilities at the respective reporting dates are as follows: As at 31 December 2010 TEUR As at 22 November 2010 TEUR 865 749 1,578 2,443 1,536 2,285 Luckyway Global Group Limited Mr. SZE Nang Heung The amounts are unsecured, not interest bearing and without fixed terms of repayment. F-109 15. CASH AND BANK BALANCES As at 31 December 2010 TEUR As at 22 November 2010 TEUR 37,898 14 37,912 36,647 19 36,666 Cash at banks Cash on hand The cash at banks in Renminbi bear effective interest rates of 0.361% per annum for the period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010. Cash and bank balances are denominated in the following currencies: As at 31 December 2010 TEUR As at 22 November 2010 TEUR 37,878 34 -* 37,912 36,631 35 -* 36,666 Renminbi Euro Hong Kong dollar *Amount is less than EUR 1,000 Renminbi is not freely remissible for use by the Group because of currency exchange restrictions. F-110 16. SHARE CAPITAL AND RESERVES CSG AG was incorporated on 10 May 2010 with share capital of EUR 50,000 divided into 50,000 non par value bearer shares of EUR 1.00 each. These shares were issued at par on incorporation. Subsequently the share capital was increased on 22 November 2010 to EUR 15,050,000 via non cash contribution by 15,000,000 non par-value bearer shares. The share capital is fully paid up. The shares all have equal rights pertaining to voting and dividends. Future dividend payments will probably depend on the Hong Kong holding company making a distribution to CSG AG, and this in turn will probably depend on HWGLtd. located in the PRC making a distribution to the Hong Kong holding company. Dividends from Chinese companies generally require government approval and can only be distributed if the statutory reserves comply with relevant legislation. Transfer of dividends outside of the PRC may be affected by regulations of State Administration of Foreign Exchange (SAFE) on transfers. Pursuant to section 5 of the Articles of Association the Management Board - with the consent of the Supervisory Board - is authorized to increase the capital of CSG AG by up to EUR 7,525,000 by way of issuance of up to 7,525,000 new bearer shares in exchange for contributions in cash or in kind (authorized capital). The Management Board is authorized to exclude the pre-emptive rights of shareholders with permission of the Supervisory Board in certain cases. The authorization is valid until 22 November 2015. The authorized capital as at 31 December 2010 amounts to EUR 7,525,000. In 2010 no capital increases were resolved from this authorized capital. Statutory reserve CSG AG is required to transfer 5% of the profit after tax as reported in its German statutory financial statements to statutory reserves (section 150 paragraph 2 of the German Stock Corporation Law), until this reserve together with the capital reserve attain at least 10% of the share capital. Under certain circumstances this reserve may be used to make up losses incurred or be converted into paid up capital, as long as the reserves amount to at least 10% of the share capital. The statutory reserve of CSG AG amounts to EUR NIL at 31 December 2010, as no profits have been earned in the short financial period ended 31 December 2010. F-111 16. SHARE CAPITAL AND RESERVES (continued) Statutory reserve (continued) In accordance with the relevant laws and regulations of the PRC, the Group’s subsidiaries which are established in the PRC are required to transfer 10% of profit after taxation prepared in accordance with the accounting regulation of the PRC to a statutory reserve until the reserve balance reaches 50% of each subsidiary’s respective share capital, any further transfer of its annual statutory net profit is optional. Such reserve may be used to offset accumulated losses or increase the registered capital of these subsidiaries, subject to the approval from the PRC authorities, and are not available for dividend distribution to the shareholders. The statutory reserve of the PRC subsidiaries and hence also of the Group amounts to EUR 724,000 at 31 December 2010 (22 November 2010: EUR 724,000). Foreign currency translation reserve Foreign currency translation reserve represents the foreign currency translation difference arising from the translation of the financial statements from RMB to EUR. Retained earnings The retained earnings reserve comprises the cumulative net gains and losses recognised in the Group’s income statement. F-112 17. TRADE AND OTHER PAYABLES As at 31 December 2010 TEUR Trade payables Other payables and accrued operating expenses As at 22 November 2010 TEUR 3,907 5,082 1,089 4,996 583 5,665 Trade payables generally have credit terms of 30 to 60 days (2010: 30 to 60 days). All trade and other payables are denominated in Renminbi. Financial Liabilities at Amortized Cost As at 31 December 2010 TEUR As at 22 November 2010 TEUR 1,813 1,759 3,907 2,443 8,163 5,082 2,285 9,126 Interest-bearing bank borrowings Trade payables Related party payables All financial liabilities recorded at amortized cost fall due within one year. Due to the short-term nature of these, management considers the carrying amounts of financial liabilities measured at amortized cost in the statement of financial position to be reasonable approximation of their fair value. 18. INTEREST-BEARING BANK BORROWINGS As at 31 December 2010 TEUR Short-term bank loans 1,813 As at 22 November 2010 TEUR 1,759 The Group's interest-bearing bank loans are secured by guarantee from related parties and bear effective interest rates of 5.841% per annum for the period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010. The loans are repayable in 4 instalments of principal every three months and settle in full within one year. Finance costs related to these interest-bearing bank loans amounted to TEUR 9 in the period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010. F-113 19. COMMITMENTS The Group leases its production facilities and office premises under noncancellable operating lease arrangements from a related party. The leases have varying terms and the total future minimum lease payments of the Group under non-cancellable operating leases are as follows: As at 31 December 2010 Not later than one year Later than one year and not later than five years Later than five years As at 22 November 2010 TEUR TEUR 43 42 150 47 240 146 49 237 The leases on the Group’s production facilities and office premises on which rentals are payable will expire between 31 March 2011 and 31 March 2017, and the current rent payable on the leases range between RMB 5,000 and RMB 18,000 per month which are subject to revision on expiry. The lease agreements can be extended by negotiation by 60 days before the lease term expires. Capital Commitments for planned Sichuan facility On 30 May 2010 the Group concluded an Investment and Construction Project Contract with the Management Committee of Guangdong – Wenchuan Industrial Park (the “Management Committee”) to invest and establish a glass production project and research and development base in Guangdong – Wenchuan Industrial Park, Sichuan. The total investment commitments of the project are RMB 300 million (equivalent to approximately EUR 34 million at 31 December 2010 exchange rates). As well as the investment commitment the Group is expected but not committed to pay annual taxes of more than RMB 18 million. However the Group will benefit under the contract from tax advantages and subsidies. Under the contract, the Management Committee will transfer usage rights for land to be used for the construction of the base to the Group at a preferential price and the Group shall pay a deposit of RMB 50 million (equivalent to EUR 5.6 million) as a down payment for the land use rights. The land use rights have a term of 50 years. This contract gives rise to various contingencies which are set out under Note 25. F-114 20. FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT The Group’s activities expose it to credit risk, liquidity risk, and interest rate risk. The Group’s overall risk management strategy seeks to minimize adverse effects from the unpredictability of financial markets on the Group’s financial performance. The board of directors provides guidance for overall risk management as well as policies covering specific areas. Management analyses and formulates measures to manage the Group’s exposure to financial risk in accordance with the objectives and underlying principles approved by the board of directors. Generally, the Group’s employs a conservative strategy regarding its risk management. As the Group’s exposures to market risk are kept at minimum level, the Group has not used any derivatives or other financial instruments for hedging purposes. The Group does not hold or issue derivative financial instruments for trading purposes. As at 31 December 2010, the Group's financial instruments mainly consisted of cash and bank balances, trade receivables, related party balances, trade payables, accrued liabilities, other payables and bank borrowings. (i) Credit risk Credit risk is the risk of financial loss to the Group if a customer fails to meet its contractual obligations, and arises principally from the Group’s trade receivables. Trade receivables The Group’s exposure to credit risk is influenced mainly by the individual characteristics of each customer. The Group typically gives the existing customers credit terms from 30 days to 60 days. In deciding whether credit shall be extended, the Group will take into consideration factors such as the relationship with the customer, its payment history and credit worthiness. The Group’s top ten customers in aggregate formed approximately 30% of the trade receivables balances during the short financial year 22 November to 31 December 2010. The Group performs ongoing credit evaluation of its customers’ financial condition and requires no collateral from its customers. There is no impairment loss recognized in the income statements as all the receivables were subsequently received. F-115 20. FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued) (ii) Liquidity risk Liquidity risk is the risk that the Group will encounter difficulty in raising funds to meet commitments associated with financial instruments. The Group’s policy is to regularly monitor current and expected liquidity requirements to ensure that it maintains sufficient reserve for cash to meet its liquidity requirement in the short and long term. The bank borrowings for the period ended 31 December 2010 have maturity period of less than 1 year from the statement of financial position date. The maturity profile of the Group’s financial liabilities as at reporting date, based on the contracted undiscounted amounts, is as follows: At 31 December 2010 Trade payables and other payables Interest-bearing bank borrowings Related party liabilities At 22 November 2010 Trade payables and other payables Interest-bearing bank borrowings Related party liabilities (iii) Total carrying amount TEUR (all current) 3,907 1,813 2,443 8,163 5,082 1,759 2,285 9,126 Market risk Market risk is the risk that changes in market prices, such as foreign exchange rates and interest rates will affect the Group’s income or the value of its holdings of financial instruments. The objective of market risk management is to manage and control market risk exposure within acceptable parameters. F-116 20. FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued) (iv) Currency risk Currency risk is the risk that the value of a financial instrument will fluctuate due to changes in foreign exchange rates. Currency risk arises when transactions are denominated in foreign currencies. The Group carries out its business in the PRC and most of its transactions are denominated in Renminbi. Accordingly, the Group’s exposure to currency risk resulting from transactions in foreign currency is minimal. However, the Group is exposed to currency risk resulting from the translation of its financial statements from Renminbi to the presentation currency. The effect on the Group’s net profit for the short financial period if the exchange rate between Renminbi and Euro and Hong Kong Dollar and Euro changed by 5%, with all other variables held constant, is estimated to be approximately EUR 170,000. At the following financial position dates, if the exchange rate between Renminbi and Euro and Hong Kong Dollar and Euro changed by 5%, with all other variables held constant, the effect on the Group’s equity is estimated as shown below: Increase or (decrease) in Equity 5% increase 5% decrease TEUR TEUR (v) Year ended 31 December 2010 (2,633) 2,633 Period ended 22 November 2010 (2,454) 2,454 Interest rate risk The Group is exposed to interest rate risk to the extent that annually it renews its interest-bearing financing, which is however fixed rate. F-117 21. CAPITAL MANAGEMENT The Group’s objectives when managing capital are: (a) To safeguard the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern, so that it continues to provide returns to shareholders and benefits for other stakeholders; (b) To support the Group’s stability and growth; and (c) To provide capital for the purpose of strengthening the Group’s risk management capability. The Group actively and regularly reviews and manages its capital structure to ensure optimal capital structure and shareholders’ returns, taking into consideration the future capital requirements of the Group and capital efficiency, prevailing and projected profitability, projected operating cash flows, projected capital expenditures and projected investment opportunities. The Group currently does not adopt any formal dividend policy. Despite having surplus cash and bank balances the Group renewed its bank loans in order to maintain business relationships with financing banks. Estimates are continually evaluated and are based on historical experiences and other factors, including expectations of future events that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. F-118 22. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS DISCLOSURES – SIGNIFICANT RELATED PARTY Related party information a) Entities/individuals with common control or significant influence over the Group or under common control. - Mr. SZE Nang Heung: Indirect holder via Luckyway Global Group Limited of the entire share capital of the Group, ultimate controlling shareholder, CEO; director of the Group from October 1994 until September 2000 and from September 2004 until January 2008 as well as director since July 2007. - Luckyway Global Group Limited is incorporated on 10 March 2010 and Mr. SZE holds 100% of the shares - Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center (formerly known as Guangzhou City Liwan District Glass Factory): Group owned by Mr. SHI Chunli, former majority shareholder of the Group, member of key management and son of Mr. SZE. - HK Chung Hwa Enterprises Development Group: Mr. SZE indirectly owns 100% of this group. - Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited: Mr. SZE holds 99.9% of the shares until selling them to a non related third party on 23 February 2010. - Guangzhou Xinghua Glass Products Co., Ltd.: Subsidiary wholly owned by Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited. - Xi’an Mamen Security Technology Co., Ltd.: Subsidiary wholly owned by Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited. b) Key management/directors of the Group and subsidiaries - Mr. SZE Nang Heung - Mr. ZHOU Chao - Mr. SHI Chunli - Mr. LEE Chi Hsiang - Ms. WANG Xue Yan - Mr. WONG Chi Man F-119 22. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES TRANSACTIONS (CONTINUED) – SIGNIFICANT RELATED PARTY Period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 TEUR Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center Rental charged on factory and office building 4 Key management personnel compensation - salaries and related cost 18 - retirement scheme contribution -* * Amount less than EUR 1,000 Included in “key management personnel compensation” is Management Board remuneration amounting to EUR 17,700 granted for the period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010. The members of the Supervisory Board of CSG AG were granted no remuneration in the period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010. They expect to be granted remuneration for the short financial year 2010 in 2011. Related party receivables and payables. The Group's related party receivables and payables are as explained and set out in note 14. Sale and purchase of goods There were no sales or purchases of goods or services or other transactions between the Group and related parties. Leasing The Group leases several buildings and land use rights under operating leases from Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center and under a finance lease from Mr. SHI Chunli. The terms of this finance lease are disclosed under note 9. Trademarks On 12 June 2010, Mr. SZE Nang Heung transferred two trademarks to Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd. without any consideration. F-120 22. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES TRANSACTIONS (CONTINUED) – SIGNIFICANT RELATED PARTY Credit guarantees and mortgages Related parties have provided guarantees and mortgages for no consideration for the Group’s bank loans: · Mortgages and a guarantee for a credit facility in the amount of RMB 7,400,000 (TEUR 839) have been provided by Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center from 8 September 2010 to 7 September 2011 for a short-term loan for the provision of working capital. · Mortgages and a guarantee for a credit facility in the amount of RMB 8,600,000 (TEUR 975) have been provided by Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center from 6 September 2010 to 5 September 2011 for a short-term loan for the provision of working capital. • Mr. SHI Chunli has provided a guarantee for a maximum facility of RMB 20 million (EUR 2.2 million). • Mr. SZE Nang Heung has provided a guarantee for a maximum facility of RMB 20 million (EUR 2.2 million). Undertakings Mr. SZE has given an undertaking for no consideration with the Group according to which he would reimburse the Group for any losses incurred for any additional social insurance and housing funds payments which may be levied in respect of prior periods. Mr. SZE Nang Heung has given an undertaking for no consideration that he would take all responsibility for any damages or negative influence which may be caused to the Group by his failure to make a registration under the “Notice of the State Administration of Foreign Exchange on Relevant Issues concerning Foreign Exchange Administration for Domestic Residents to Engage in Financing and in Return Investment via Overseas Special Purpose Companies” (“SAFE Notice 75”). Mr. SHI Chunli has given an undertaking for no consideration to bear any administrative and civil liabilities in respect of land allocated to Guangzhou Property Management Center, on which buildings are located that are leased by the Company, for which the necessary legal formalities have not been completed. F-121 23. SEGMENT INFORMATION The Management Board as Chief Decision Maker determines the operating segments, which represents product categories, based on reports reviewed and used for strategic decisions. The Group’s business segments are organized into three main operating segments: a. Automotive Security Glass b. Bank Security Glass c. Construction Glass All of these segments are managed by the Group. All operating segments are monitored and strategic decisions are made on the basis of the segmental gross margins. Items of expense and income below the gross profit margin are not analysed on a segmental basis, as these are not considered relevant for the operational and strategic analysis of the business. The Group’s revenues for financial period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 are derived solely from within the PRC and substantially all of its business assets are located there hence a further geographical segment analysis is not meaningful to the management of the Group. There were no inter-segment sales. During the period, the top 10 customers contributed 30% of the Group’s revenue. These sales were to external distributors. No customer accounted for more than 10% of sales. Relevant items of income and expenditure and other financial data such as capital expenditure have been allocated to the segments as far as this was possible. Where this was not possible, they have been disclosed in total. The accounting policies the Group uses for segment reporting under IFRS 8 are the same as those used in its financial statements for the period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010. The segment information provided to the Management Board for the reportable segments for the financial period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 is as follows: F-122 23. SEGMENT INFORMATION (CONTINUED) Automotive Security Glass TEUR Bank Security Glass TEUR Construction Glass TEUR 4,349 1,975 2,374 3,804 2,282 1,522 913 643 270 Revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Finance income Unallocated corporate expenses Finance costs Profit before taxation Income tax expenses Net profit Other information Segment assets Unallocated corporate assets Consolidated total assets Total TEUR 9,066 4,900 4,166 34 (785) (9) 3,406 (643) 2,763 6,508 4,067 1,540 12,115 48,259 60,374 Segment liabilities Unallocated corporate liabilities Consolidated total liabilities 10,563 10,563 Capital expenditure Depreciation of property, plant and machinery 942 4 5 9 * Amount less than EUR 1,000 Unallocated assets for the period are assets that cannot be reasonably allocated to the operating segment and included property, plant & equipment, intangible assets, lease prepayment for land-use rights, other receivables, tax receivable, related party receivables and cash and bank balances. F-123 18 24. EMPLOYEES BENEFITS Period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 Average number of employees of the Group 442 Management and administration Sales Production 53 57 332 442 The aggregate payroll costs of these employees were as follows: Period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 TEUR Wages and salaries Social security cost 260 11 271 Retirement Benefit Plans The eligible employees of the Group who are citizens of the PRC are members of a state-managed retirement benefit scheme operated by the local government. The Group is required to contribute a certain percentage of their payroll costs to the retirement benefit scheme to fund the benefits. The only obligation of the Group with respect to the retirement benefit scheme is to make the specified contributions. The cost of retirement benefit contributions charged to the profit or loss in the period from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010 amount to approximately EUR 11,000. F-124 25. CONTINGENCIES Investment and Construction Project Contract for planned Sichuan facility As explained in Note 19, on 30 May 2010, the Group concluded an Investment and Construction Project Contract with the Management Committee of Guangdong – Wenchuan Industrial Park (the “Management Committee”) to invest and establish a glass production project and research and development base in Guangdong – Wenchuan Industrial Park, Sichuan. With the Management Committee’s approval of the project construction plan, the Company will be responsible for the project construction and production processes in accordance with the rules and regulations in the People’s Republic of China. In the event of non-compliance of construction speed and production of the various phases, or if the Company fails to satisfy the expected level of investment or the expected level of tax payments as required for the first stage within 5 years, the Management Committee has the right to take back all the land use rights of the project free of charge. The Company may also be liable for compensatory damages if it is responsible for a breach of contract with adverse affects for the Management Committee. Without the consent of the Management Committee, the Company is not allowed to (i) transfer the land use rights to a third party within 10 years and (ii) pledge the land use rights for any credit facility within 3 years. Social insurance back payments According to PRC law, in particular, Chinese regulations for social insurance and housing funds, the Company is required to make contributions for the social insurance and for the housing funds to its employees. The Company has in the past not paid the full amount which should have been paid in respect of these contributions, but considers the risk for additional payments for prior periods to be not probable. The Company estimates that such a claim for additional payments would not exceed TEUR 264. Mr. SZE has undertaken an agreement with the Company according to which he would reimburse the Company for any losses incurred for such additional social insurance and housing funds payments. F-125 25. CONTINGENCIES (continued) Tax risks Various uncertainties exist relating to the following matters which could result in additional tax liabilities for HWG-Ltd. or the Group: i. Depreciation was over claimed by HWG-Ltd. in relation to residual values of property, plant and equipment in 2007. The additional tax payments, if any, which could arise from this matter are estimated to be in the region of TEUR 7. ii. Entertainment expenses claimed by HWG-Ltd. had exceeded the cap under the Old and New Enterprise Income Tax Law. The additional tax payments, if any, which could arise from this matter are estimated to be in the region of TEUR 47. 26. AUDIT FEE Fees for the short financial year 22 November to 31 December 2010 to the Group auditor amounted to TEUR 18. This all relates to audit. 27. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS There are no significant non-adjusting events or any significant adjusting events to report between the reporting date and the date of preparation of these consolidated financial statements. Grünwald, in June 2011 Nang Heung Sze Chun Li Shi Chairman of the Management Board Management Board Member Chi-Hsiang Michael Lee Management Board Member F-126 AUDIT OPINION We have audited the consolidated financial statements prepared by China Specialty Glass AG, Grünwald, comprising the statement of comprehensive income, statement of financial position, statement of cash flows, statement of changes in equity and the notes to the consolidated financial statements, together with the group management report for the short business year from 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010. The preparation of the consolidated financial statements and the group management report in accordance with the IFRS, as adopted by the EU, and the additional requirements of German commercial law pursuant to § (Article) 315a Abs. (paragraph) 1 HGB (“Handelsgesetzbuch”: German Commercial Code) are the responsibility of the parent Group’s Board of Management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the consolidated financial statements and on the group management report based on our audit. We conducted our audit of the consolidated financial statements in accordance with § 317 HGB and German generally accepted standards for the audit of financial statements promulgated by the Institut der Wirtschaftsprüfer (Institute of Public Auditors in Germany) (IDW). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit such way that misstatements materially affecting the presentation of the net assets, financial position and results of operations in the consolidated financial statements in accordance with the applicable financial reporting standards and in the group management report are detected with reasonable assurance. Knowledge of the business activities and the economic and legal environment of the Group and expectations as to possible misstatements are taken into account in the determination of audit procedures. The effectiveness of the accounting-related internal control system and the evidence supporting the disclosures in the consolidated financial statements and in the group management report are examined primarily on a test basis within the framework of the audit. The audit includes assessing the financial statements of those entities included in consolidation, the determination of the entities to be included in consolidation, the accounting and consolidation principles used and significant estimates made by the Group’s Board of Management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements and of the group management report. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion. Our audit has not led to any reservations. In our opinion based on the findings of our audit, the consolidated financial statements comply with the IFRS as adopted by the EU, the additional requirements of German commercial law pursuant to § 315a Abs. (paragraph) 1 HGB and give a true and fair view of the net assets, financial position and results of operations of the Group in accordance with these requirements. The group management report is consistent with the consolidated financial statements and as a whole provides a suitable view of the Group’s position and suitably presents the opportunities and risks of future development. Hamburg, May 2, 2011 Grant Thornton GmbH Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft Friedrich Graf von Kanitz Timothy Robinson Wirtschaftsprüfer Wirtschaftsprüfer (German certified auditor) (German certified auditor) F-127 Interim condensed consolidated financial statements of CHINA SPECIALTY GLASS AG for the three months to 31 March 2011 in accordance with IFRS as endorsed for application by the EU (reviewed) F-128 Condensed Consolidated Interim Statement of Comprehensive Income Three months ended 31 March 2011 TEUR Revenue Cost of sales 16,441 (8,850) Gross profit 7,591 Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Finance income Finance costs Research and development costs (609) (440) 37 (26) (391) Profit before taxation 6,162 Taxation (950) Net profit Other Comprehensive Income: Currency translation reserve movement Total Comprehensive Income 5,212 (2,346) 2,866 Profit attributable to: owners of the parent Total Comprehensive income attributable to: owners to the parent: 5,212 2,866 Due to the fact that the Group only came into existence on 22 November 2010, as described in note 1 below, there are no comparative figures for the first three months of 2010. The sub group at the level of the Group’s Hong Kong holding company, did however exist throughout 2010 and made revenues of EUR 11.5 million and a net profit of EUR 3.3 million in the first three months of 2010. F-129 Condensed Consolidated Interim Statement of Financial Position 31 March 2011 TEUR Assets Non-current Property, plant and equipment Lease prepayment for land use rights Other assets Loan to related party Intangible assets Current Inventories Trade and other receivables Related party receivable Tax receivable Cash and bank balances Total assets Equity and Liabilities Capital and Reserves Share capital Statutory reserve Foreign currency translation reserve Retained earnings Current Liabilities Corporate income tax payable Trade and other payables Interest-bearing bank borrowings Related party payables Total equity and liabilities 31 December 2010 TEUR 3,590 3,764 712 3,032 2,166 12 9,512 751 3,173 0 13 7,701 2,238 13,815 6 418 36,739 53,216 62,728 1,591 12,727 5 438 37,912 52,673 60,374 15,050 724 15,050 724 1,175 35,728 52,677 3,521 30,516 49,811 1,032 4,915 1,311 4,996 1,624 2,480 10,051 1,813 2,443 10,563 62,728 60,374 The comparability is affected by movements in the relative value of the functional currency (RMB) compared to the presentational currency (EUR). F-130 Condensed Consolidated Interim Statement of Changes in Equity Attributable to equity holders of the Group Share capital TEUR Balance at 31 December 2010 Total comprehensive income Balance at 31 March 2011 Statutory reserve TEUR Translation reserve TEUR 15,050 724 3,521 30,516 49,811 - - (2,346) 5,212 2,866 15,050 724 1,175 35,728 52,677 Retained earnings TEUR Total Equity TEUR *Amount is less than EUR 1,000 Due to the fact that the Group only came into existence on 22 November 2010, as described in note 1 below, there are no comparative figures for the first three months of 2010. F-131 Condensed Consolidated Interim Statement of Cash Flows Three months ended 31 March 2011 TEUR Cash flows from operating activities Profit before taxation Adjustments for: Interest income Interest expense Depreciation of property, plant and equipment Movement in lease prepayment for land-use rights Operating profit before working capital changes (Increase) in inventories (Increase) in trade and other receivables Increase in trade and other payables Cash generated from operations Interest income Income tax paid Net cash generated from operating activities (37) 26 106 6 6,263 (738) (2,141) 272 3,656 37 (1,177) 2,516 Cash flows from investing activities Acquisition of property, plant and equipment Loan granted to related party Net cash used in investing activities (98) (2,288) (2,386) 6,162 Cash flows from financing activities Repayment of bank loans Interest expense (112) (26) Net cash used in financing activities (138) Net decrease in cash and bank balances Cash and bank balances at beginning of the period Effects of currency translation Cash and bank balances at end of the period (8) 37,912 (1,165) 36,739 Due to the fact that the Group only came into existence on 22 November 2010, as described in note 1 below, there are no comparative figures for the first three months of 2010. F-132 Selected notes to the condensed consolidated interim financial statements of China Specialty Glass AG. 1. NATURE OF OPERATIONS AND FORMATION OF GROUP The principal activity of the China Specialty Glass Group (hereafter “Group”) which comprises China Specialty Glass AG, Grünwald, near Munich in Germany ("CSG AG"), Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited (“HWG HK-Holding”), its 100% subsidiaries Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Limited ("HWGLtd."), and Sichuan Hing Wah Glass Co., Ltd. ("HWG-SC"), (hereafter “Group”), is the manufacture and distribution of bullet proof and toughened glass products. The Group was formed on 22 November 2010 when the transfer of the entire share capital in HWG HK-Holding into CSG AG took legal effect. As the formation of the Group had legal effect on 22 November 2010, the first consolidated financial data of the Group was derived from the consolidated financial statements for the short financial year from 22 November to 31 December 2010 prepared in accordance with IFRS, as endorsed for application in the EU, as at 31 December 2010. Consequently, there are no comparative figures for the consolidated statement of comprehensive income, the consolidated statement of changes in equity or the consolidated statement of cash flow for the first three months of 2010. Before the transfer of the entire share capital of HWG HK-Holding, CSG AG was essentially a shell company, without its own business. The purpose of the transaction was to enable the operating sub-group of HWG HK-Holding to obtain a listing on the Prime Standard segment of the German Stock Exchange. Hence this transaction has been accounted for similarly to a reverse acquisition, without the recognition of goodwill. The operating business of the Group is carried out by HWG-Ltd. It is intended that China Specialty Glass AG will seek a listing on the German Stock Exchange (Prime Standard Segment) in 2011. F-133 2. General Information and Statement of compliance with IFRS These condensed consolidated interim financial statements of the Group are prepared for the three months period ended 31 March 2011. Due to the Group only having come into existence in November 2010, limited comparative data is available as explained above. These condensed consolidated interim financial statements have been prepared for the purpose of inclusion in the IPO prospectus of the Group’s ultimate parent, China Specialty Glass AG. The condensed consolidated interim financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) adopted by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) and its interpretations of the International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee (IFRIC) for interim financial information effective within the European Union. Accordingly, these condensed interim financial statements do not include all of the information required in annual financial statements by IFRS. The condensed consolidated interim financial statements have been reviewed. In the opinion of the Group’s Management Board, the condensed interim financial statements include all adjustments of a normal and recurring nature considered necessary for a fair presentation of results for interim periods. Results of the period ended 31 March 2011 are not necessarily indicative of future results. The preparation of interim financial statements in conformity with IAS 34 “Interim Financial Reporting” requires the Management Board to make judgments, estimates and assumptions that affect the application of policies and reported amounts of assets and liabilities, income and expenses. Actual results may differ from these estimates. The accounting principles and practices as applied in the condensed interim financial statements correspond to those pertaining to the most recent annual financial statements. A detailed description of the accounting policies is published in the notes to the financial statements of the Group’s financial statements for the short financial year 22 November to 31 December 2010. The condensed consolidated interim financial statements of the Group have been rounded to the nearest thousand Euro. Amounts are stated in thousands of Euros (TEUR) except where otherwise indicated. The condensed consolidated interim financial statements of the Group for the period from 1 January to 31 March 2011 are expected to be authorized for issue in accordance with a resolution of the Management Board in June 2011. F-134 3. Significant accounting policies and changes in estimates These condensed consolidated interim financial statements have been prepared using accounting policies specified by those IFRSs that are in effect at the end of the reporting period (31 March 2011). The condensed interim financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the accounting policies adopted in the financial statements for the short financial year 22 November to 31 December 2010. The accounting policies have been applied consistently throughout the Group for the purpose of preparation of these condensed interim consolidated financial statements. The material principles on recognition and measurement are corresponding to the principles on recognition of the consolidated financial statements for the short financial year 22 November to 31 December 2010 and outlined in those financial statements. The Group had to apply the following new standards, amendments to existing standards or new interpretations for the first time: · Improvements of IFRS 2010 (amendments), are to be applied for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2010 and 1 January 2011. · IFRS 1 (amendments) – Limited exemption from comparative IFRS 7 disclosures for first-time adopters, to the extent to which they may be applicable on financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2010. · IAS 24 (revised) – Related Party Disclosures - , to the extent to which they may be applicable for financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2011. · IFRS 32 (amendments) – Classification of Right Issues, to the extent to which they may be applicable for financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2010. · IFRIC 14 (amendments) – Prepayments of a Minimum Funding Requirements, to the extent to which they may be applicable for financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2011. · IFRIC 19 (amendments) – Extinguishing Financial Liabilities with Equity Instruments, to the extent to which they may be applicable for financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2010. The first-time application of these standards and interpretations is expected to have no significant impact on the net-assets, financial position and results of operations of the Group. F-135 3. Significant accounting policies and changes in estimates (continued) The Group has not early applied the following new and amended standards and interpretations, which have been issued but are not yet effective or as well as partly not yet adopted by the European Union: · IFRS 7 (amendments), Disclosures – Transfer of Financial assets - to the extent to which they may be applicable on financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2010 · IFRS 9 – Financial Instruments- to the extent to which they may be applicable for financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2013 (not yet adopted by the European Union). · IFRS 1 (amendments) – “Severe hyperinflation” and “Removal of fixed dates for first-time adopters” – to the extent to which they may be applicable for financial statements for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2011 not yet adopted by the European Union). · IAS 12 (amendments) – Deferred taxes: Recovery of underlying assets – This amendment is applicable for periods beginning on 1 January 2012 (not yet adopted by the European Union). The management board anticipates that the application of these standards and interpretations will have no significant impact on the net-assets, financial position and results of operations of the Group. There have been no significant changes in estimates compared to the financial statements of the Group for the short financial year 22 November to 31 December 2010. 4. Currency translation Items included in the condensed consolidated interim financial statements are measured using the currency of the primary economic environment in which the Group operates (the “functional currency”). The Group conducts its business predominately in the PRC and hence its functional currency is the Renminbi (RMB). The presentation currency of the Group is EURO (EUR), being the presentation currency of its ultimate German domiciled legal parent and holding Group, and therefore the financial information has been translated from RMB to EUR at the following rates: F-136 4. Currency translation (continued) Period end rates 5. Average rates 31 December 2010 EUR 1.00 = RMB 8.8231 EUR 1.00 = RMB 8.9789 31 March 2011 EUR 1.00 = RMB 9.2343 EUR 1.00 = RMB 8.9807 Significant events and transactions With the exception of the Group’s continued measures to prepare for its expected Initial Public Offering in 2011, no significant event or transaction has taken place between 31 December 2010 and 31 March 2011. 6. Segment reporting Management determines the operating segments, which represents product category, based on reports reviewed and used for strategic decisions. The Group’s business segments are organized into three main operating segments: · Automotive Security Glass · Bank Security Glass · Construction Glass All of these segments are managed by the Group. All operating segments are monitored and strategic decisions are made on the basis of the segmental gross margins. Items of expense and income below the gross profit margin are not analysed by management on a segmental basis, as these are not considered relevant for the operational and strategic analysis of the business. Management considers the Group’s total assets, comprising property, plant and equipment, inventory, trade and other receivables and cash and bank balances as reasonable allocable to the three operating segments on a pro rata basis determined by segment revenues. During the period under review, there were no inter-segment transfers. The accounting policies the Group uses for segment reporting under IFRS 8 are the same as those used in its financial statements for the short financial year 22 November 2010 to 31 December 2010. The segment information provided to the management for the reportable segments for the comparative financial period from 1 January 2011 to 31 March 2011 is as follows: F-137 6. Segment reporting (continued) Automotive Security Glass Bank Security Glass Construction Glass Unallocated Total TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR TEUR Revenue 7,940 6,514 1,987 - 16,441 Cost of sales 3,629 3,836 1,385 - 8,850 Gross profit 4,311 2,678 602 - 7,591 Segment assets 31 March 2011 6,733 3,233 3,557 49,205 62,728 Due to the fact that the Group only came into existence on 22 November 2010, as described above, there are no comparative figures for the first three months of 2010. Unallocated assets for both financial periods are assets which cannot be reasonably allocated to the operating segments and included property, plant & equipment, intangible assets, deferred tax assets, related party loans, other receivables and cash and bank balances. The Group’s revenues for financial period from 1 January 2011 to 31 March 2011 and its comparatives were derived wholly from the PRC and its business assets were substantially located there, hence a further geographical segment analysis is not meaningful to the management of the Group. During the interim period, there are no sales over 10% of the Group’s revenues which is dependent on a single customer. All sales were to external distributors. The totals presented for the Group’s operating segments can be derived directly from the Group’s key financial figures for sales, cost of sales and total assets as presented in the financial statements without reconciliation. F-138 7. Analysis of selected items of the condensed consolidated interim financial statements Sales increased approximately 44% as compared to the sales made by the Group’s sole operating subsidiary in the same period of 2010 mainly due to increases in sales quantity and average selling prices. Selling and distribution expenses increased in line with the increase in sales when compared to the sales of the Group’s sole operating subsidiary in the first three months of 2010. R&D expenses in the first three months of 2011 were mainly attributable to the innovation of a new product, intruder resistant glass, as well as the associated quality control and design costs for the improvement of various products. The composition and amounts of non-current assets at 31 March 2011 remained broadly comparable to the composition and amounts of non-current assets at 31 December 2010, except for loans to related parties which increased significantly by EUR 2.2 million, due to an unsecured, interest-bearing loan granted by the Group to Mr. SZE to assist with funding the investments in Sichuan in the future. The loan is detailed under note 9. Inventory and trade and other receivables fluctuated with the trading cycle. The tax receivable results from the fact that the Group paid tax at 25% in the first quarter of 2010, however was subsequently granted status as a high tech enterprise, which afforded it the benefit of a lower preferential rate of 15% for 2010. The Group expects to be able to claim back the overpaid tax. Capital and reserves increased compared with capital and reserves at 31 December 2010, due to the profitable operations of the Group in the first three months of 2011. The composition and amounts of current liabilities at 31 March 2011 remained broadly comparable to the composition and amounts of current liabilities at 31 December 2010. F-139 8. Commitments and contingencies Between the financial statements of the Group for the year ended 31 December 2010 and the accounting period of the interim financial statements as at 31 March 2011, no material changes in commitments and contingencies have occurred. 9. Related party disclosures – Significant related party transactions An entity or individual is considered a related party of the Group for the purposes of the financial statements if: (i) it possesses the ability, directly or indirectly, to control or exercise significant influence over the operating and financial decision of the Group or vice versa; or (ii) it is subject to common control or common significant influence. Related party information a) Entities/individuals with common control or significant influence over the Group. - Mr. SZE Nang Heung: Indirect holder of the entire share capital of the Group, ultimate controlling shareholder, CEO; director of the Group from October 1994 until December 2000 and from September 2004 until January 2008 as well as director of the Company since July 2007 - Luckyway Global Group Limited is incorporated on 10 March 2010 and Mr. SZE holds 100% of the shares - Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center (formerly known as Guangzhou City Liwan District Glass Factory): Group owned by Mr. SHI Chunli, former majority shareholder of the Group, member of key management and son of Mr. SZE - HK Chung Hwa Enterprises Development Group: Mr SZE indirectly owns 100% of this Group. - Guangzhou Xinghua Glass Products Co., Ltd.: Subsidiary wholly owned by Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited. - Xi’an Mamen Security Technology Co., Ltd.: Subsidiary wholly owned by Ma Men Holdings (HK) Limited. F-140 9. Related party disclosures – Significant related party transactions (continued) Three months ended 31 March 2011 TEUR Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd. Rental charged on factory and office building (expense) Rental deposit due to rental agreement renewal (receivable) Key management personnel compensation - salaries and related cost (expense) - retirement scheme contribution 11 6 53 -* * - less than one thousand EUR b) Key management/directors of the Group and its subsidiaries - Mr. SZE Nang Heung - Mr. SHI Chunli; - Mr. LEE Chi Hsiang Michael - Mr. ZHOU Chao; - Mr. CHEN Zong; - Mr. QIU Yiguan - Mr. LI Qiaorong - Mr. WONG Chi Man Included in “salaries and related cost” are amounts of directors’ remuneration totaling EUR 35,242 for the three months ended 31 March 2011. Loan to related parties in the statement of financial position relate to a loan granted to Mr. SZE of RMB 20 million (EUR 2.2 million at 31 March 2011 exchange rates) on 25 March 2011. The loan granted to Mr. SZE is intended for financing of the planned development work in connections with the Group’s Sichuan entity and the funds loaned to Mr. SZE are expected to be transferred to the Group’s Sichuan entity in the near future. This loan is unsecured, bears interest at the rate of 5.56% per annum and has to be repaid five years after granting of the loan. F-141 9. Related party disclosures – Significant related party transactions (continued) Related party payables relate both to a financing agreement made between Luckyway Global Group Limited and CSG AG, whereby Luckyway Global Group Limited finances the IPO costs on an interest free and short-term basis, and is to be refunded after the IPO and also to payments made by a controlling shareholder and director of the Company, Mr SZE, to fund the Group’s investment in Guangzhou Hing Wah Glass Industry Co., Ltd. and for other expenses. Sale and purchase of goods There were no sales or purchases of goods or services or other transactions between the Group and related parties. Leasing The Group leases several buildings and land use rights under operating leases from Guangzhou City Liwan District Yaoxiang Property Management Center and under a finance lease from Mr. SHI Chunli. 10. Events after the reporting date The Group expects its ultimate holding company, China Specialty Glass AG, to issue its prospectus for its listing on the Prime Standard segment of the German Stock Exchange in 2011. There were no other significant non-adjusting events or any significant adjusting events to report between the reporting date and the date of preparation of these financial statements. F-142 REVIEW OPINION To China Specialty Glass AG We have reviewed the consolidated condensed interim financial statements – comprising the consolidated statement of comprehensive income, consolidated statement of financial position, consolidated cash flow statement, consolidated statement of changes in equity and selected condensed explanatory notes – of China Specialty Glass AG for the period from 1 January 2011 to 31 March 2011. The preparation of the consolidated condensed interim financial statements in accordance with those IFRS applicable to interim financial reporting as adopted by the EU, is the responsibility of the Group's management. Our responsibility is to issue a report on the consolidated condensed interim financial statements based on our review. We conducted our review of the consolidated condensed interim financial statements in accordance with the German generally accepted standards for the review of financial statements promulgated by the Institut der Wirtschaftsprüfer (IDW). Those standards require that we plan and perform the review so that we can preclude through critical evaluation, with a certain level of assurance, that the consolidated interim financial statements have not been prepared, in material aspects, in accordance with the IFRS applicable to interim financial reporting as adopted by the EU. A review is limited primarily to inquiries of company employees and analytical assessments and therefore does not provide the assurance attainable in a financial statement audit. Since, in accordance with our engagement, we have not performed a financial statement audit, we cannot issue an auditor's report. Based on our review, no matters have come to our attention that cause us to believe that the consolidated condensed interim financial statements have not been prepared, in material respects, in accordance with the IFRS applicable to interim financial reporting as adopted by the EU. Hamburg, 2 May 2011 Grant Thornton GmbH Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft Friedrich Graf von Kanitz Wirtschaftsprüfer F-143 Timothy Robinson Wirtschaftsprüfer Financial statements of CHINA SPECIALTY GLASS AG for the short financial period 10 May 2010 to 31 December 2010 in accordance with German GAAP (audited) F-144 China Specialty Glass AG, Grünwald Income statement for short financial year May 10 to December 31 2010 € 1. Amortisation of intangible assets 918.00 2. Other operating expenses 191,716.45 3. Result from ordinary activities -192,634.45 4. Net loss for the short financial year 192,634.45 F-145 China Specialty Glass AG, Grünwald BALANCE SHEET as at 31 December 2010 ASSETS 31 Dec 2010 EUR 10 May 2010 TEUR EQUITY AND LIABILITIES 31 Dec 2010 EUR 31 Dec 2010 EUR 10 May 2010 TEUR A. Long term assets A. Equity I. Intangible fixed assets I. Subscribed capital not called up share capital 15,050,000.00 0,00 50 -37 II. Capital reserves 85,050,000.00 0 Software licenses 12,852.00 0 II. Financial assets Investment in subsidiary III. Net loss for the short financial year 100,050,000.00 II. Bank balances C. Prepaid expenses 99,907,365.55 0 13 62,100.00 0 885,656.69 0 100,855,122.24 13 B. Provisions B. Current assets I. Other assets - of which due after more than one year: EUR 3,000.00 -192,634.45 0 Other provisions 751,730.57 0 34,166.16 13 6,373.51 0 100,855,122.24 13 C. Liabilities 1. Trade payables - of which due within one year: EUR 20,414.38 2. Other liabilities - of which to shareholders: EUR 865,242.31 - of which due within one year: EUR 865,242.31 F-146 20,414.38 865,242.31 China Specialty Glass AG Grünwald Notes to the financial statements for the short financial year 10 May 2010 to 31 December 2010 I. General Notes China Specialty Glass AG, Grünwald (hereafter also called "CSG AG" or "Company") was incorporated on 10 May 2010. These financial statements are therefore the first financial statements of the Company and are for the short financial year 10 May 2010 to 31 December 2010. Consequently, there are no prior year comparatives. The financial statements for the short financial year are prepared in accordance with the accounting regulations of the third book of the German Commercial Code (HGB) and the supplemental regulations for capital corporations (sections 264 et seqq. HGB) as updated by the German Accounting Modernization Act (BilMoG) and in accordance with the German Stock Corporation Act. The Company has utilized exemptions available to small capital corporations as the Company is a small capital corporation in accordance with section 267 paragraph 1 HGB and is not a capital market orientated company as defined by section 264d HGB. The presentation and format of balance sheet items is in accordance with section 266 HGB. The income statement was prepared in accordance with section 275 paragraph 2 HGB under the type of expenditure method. II. Accounting policies Intangible assets are recorded at cost less amortization, determined on a straight-line basis. Financial assets are recorded at cost or if they are impaired, not just temporarily, at the lower carrying value and relate exclusively to 100% of the shares in Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited, Hong Kong. Receivables and other assets and bank balances are recorded at nominal value. F-147 Prepayments have been recorded in accordance with section 250 HGB for payments in the reporting period, which relate to expenses of the following period. The share capital corresponds to the Company’s share capital in accordance with its Articles of Association and in the amount which is entered in the Trade Registry. The share capital is fully paid up. Other accruals have been set up for known risks and uncertain commitments in the amount determined reasonably likely to be required to settle them using prudent business judgment. All liabilities are disclosed at settlement value and are due within one year. Liabilities denominated in foreign currencies have been revalued at the appropriate mid-rate in accordance with section 256a HBG at year end. III. Notes regarding specific Balance sheet items Investment in subsidiary China Specialty Glass AG, Grünwald, holds 100% of the shares in Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Ltd., Hong Kong. The investment was contributed by contribution agreement dated 30 June 2010 in the context of the non-cash contribution capital increase effected in 2010. In its 2010 financial statements, Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Ltd., Hong Kong discloses equity of HKD 22,619,589 or EUR 2,190,823.00 (Exchange rate HKD 10.325 HKD = EUR 1.00) and profit for the year of HKD 22,626,942.31 or EUR 2,210,918.53 (Average rate of HKD 10.234 = EUR 1.00). Equity The share capital of CSG AG amounts to EUR 15,050,000.00 at 31 December 2010 (EUR 50,000.00 as at 10 May 2010) after the registration of the non-cash contribution capital increase in the trade registry on 22 November 2010, and is divided into 15,050,000 bearer shares without a nominal value with an arithmetic value of EUR 1.00 per share. All shares are fully paid up. According to section 5 of the Articles of Association, the Management Board is authorized to increase the Company’s share capital in the period until 22 November 2015 with the approval of the Supervisory Board by up to a total of EUR 7,525,000.00 by the issuance of up to 7,525,000 new bearer shares for F-148 cash or non-cash contribution (authorized capital). The Management Board is authorized to exclude pre-emptive shareholder rights in certain circumstances with the approval of the Supervisory Board. At 31 December 2010, the authorized capital amounts to EUR 7,525,000.00. No capital increases were resolved in 2010 from this authorized capital. Capital reserve The capital reserve contains the difference between the value of the shares in Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited, Hong Kong contributed into the company and the nominal value of the new shares issued in exchange. EUR Capital Reserve on 10 May 2010 0.00 Increase due to contribution of the shares in Hing Wah Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited 85,050,000.00 Capital Reserve on 31 December 2010 85,050,000.00 Liabilities Other Liabilities include a liability to shareholder of EUR 865,242.31. All liabilities fall due within one year and are not secured. IV. Further notes The members of the Management Board in the reporting period were: From 10 May 2010 to 27 May 2010: Mrs. Katja Gogalla, Munich, Germany Since 27 May 2010: Mr. Nang Heung Sze (Chairman of the Management Board, CEO), Canton, People’s Republic of China Mr. Chun Li Shi, COO, Canton, People’s Republic of China Mr. Chi Man Wong (until 12 November 2010), CFO, Hongkong Since 13 November 2010 Mr. Chi-Hsiang Michael Lee, CFO, Rancho Palos Verdes, CA, USA F-149 In 2010 the Company did not employ any staff. The members of the Supervisory Board in the reporting period were: From 10 May 2010 to 26 May 2010: Mr. Matthias Beer (Chairman), Attorney, Poing, Germany Mrs. Randi Mette Selnes, Employee, Munich, Germany Mrs. Edith Blum, Legal secretary, Zorneding, Germany Since 27 May 2010: Mr. Helmut Meyer (Chairman), Management Consultant, Grünwald, Germany Mr. Shi Xin Yong, Vice Director of China Building Materials Test and Certification Centre, Beijing, PR China Mr. ShunYao Huang (until 29 October 2010), Economist, Halifax N.S., Canada Since 29 October 2010 Mr. Volker Schlegel, Attorney, Cologne, Germany V. Loss The Management Board proposes to transfer the loss for 2010 of EUR 192,634.45 to reserves. VI. Other Notes Group CSG AG, Grünwald, is also the CSG group parent company and prepares consolidated financial statements in accordance with section 315a HGB and International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), which are published in the electronic Federal Gazette. The financial statements of the Company are included in these consolidated financial statements. Notifications according to section 20 of the German Stock Corporation Law (AktG) On 10 May 2010 the Company was informed by Blitzstart Holding AG, Munich, in accordance with section 20 paras. 1 and 4 AktG, that Blitz start Holding AG owned more than 25% and also a controlling holding in the Company. Via sale agreement dated 26 May 2010 to Luckyway Global Group Ltd. the Company was informed by Blitzstart Holding AG in accordance with section 20 para. 5 AktG F-150 that it now no longer either holds more than 25% or a controlling holding in the Company. On 26 May 2010 the Company was informed by Luckyway Global Group Ltd., Road Town, B.V.I., and Mr. Nang Heung Sze in accordance with section 20 paras. 1 und 4 AktG, that Luckyway Global Group Ltd. and indirectly Mr. Nang Heung Sze owned more than 25% and also a controlling holding in the Company. F-151 Concluding statement from dependency report The Management Board of CSG AG prepared a dependency report for the Supervisory Board in accordance with section 312 para. 1 AktG, which ends with the following statement: “Our Company received for each transaction listed in the dependency report reasonable consideration. Measures which put our Company at a disadvantage were not taken by or in the interest of the controlling entity or its related parties and the controlling entity or its relating parties did not fail to carry necessary measures out.“ Grünwald, 5 April 2011 Signed by Nang Heung Sze Management Board chairman Chun Li Shi Management Board member Chi-Hsiang Michael Lee Management Board member F-152 AUDIT OPINION To China Specialty Glass AG, Grünwald We have audited the annual financial statements, comprising the balance sheet, the income statement and the notes to the financial statements, together with the bookkeeping system of China Specialty Glass AG, Grünwald, for the short financial year from May 10 to December 31, 2010. The maintenance of the books and records and the preparation of the annual financial statements in accordance with German commercial law and supplementary provisions of the articles of incorporation are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the annual financial statements, together with the bookkeeping system, based on our audit. We conducted our audit of the annual financial statements in accordance with § [Article] 317 HGB [„Handelsgesetzbuch”: „German Commercial Code”] and German generally accepted standards for the audit of financial statements promulgated by the Institut der Wirtschaftsprüfer [Institute of Public Auditors in Germany] (IDW). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit such that misstatements materially affecting the presentation of the net assets, financial position and results of operations in the annual financial statements in accordance with [German] principles of proper accounting are detected with reasonable assurance. Knowledge of the business activities and the economic and legal environment of the Company and expectations as to possible misstatements are taken into account in the determination of audit procedures. The effectiveness of the accounting-related internal control system and the evidence supporting the disclosures in the books and records, the annual financial statements are examined primarily on a test basis within the framework of the audit. The audit includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the annual financial statements. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion. Our audit has not led to any reservations. In our opinion, based on the findings of our audit, the annual financial statements comply with the legal requirements and supplementary provisions of the articles of incorporation and give a true and fair view of the net assets, financial position and results of operations of the Company in accordance with [German] principles of proper accounting. Hamburg, April 11, 2011 Grant Thornton GmbH Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft (German certified audit firm) Graf von Kanitz Wirtschaftsprüfer (German certified auditor) F-153 Robinson Wirtschaftsprüfer (German certified auditor) SIGNATURES Sig. Sig. Sig. China Specialty China Specialty China Specialty Glass AG Glass AG Glass AG Nang Heung Sze Chun Li Shi Chi Hsiang Michael Lee Sig. Sig. VISCARDI AG VISCARDI AG Wilhelm Göbel Barbara Thätig Sig. Sig. biw Bank für Investments biw Bank für Investments und Wertpapiere AG und Wertpapiere AG Dirk Franzmeyer Michael Heinks S-1